Table of Contents

 

 

 

UNITED STATES

SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION

WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 20-F

 

(Mark One)

 

¨ REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(b) OR (g) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

OR

 

x ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended 31 December 2010

 

OR

 

¨ TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the transition period from                      to                     

 

OR

 

¨ SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(d) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

Date of event requiring this shell company report                     

 

Commission file number 0-16350

 

WPP plc

(Exact Name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Jersey

(Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

 

6 Ely Place

Dublin 2, Ireland

(Address of principal executive offices)

 

Andrea Harris, Esq.

Group Chief Counsel

6 Ely Place Dublin 2, Ireland

011-353-1-669-0333

(Name, Telephone, E-mail and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act.

 

Title of each class

 

Name of each exchange on which registered

Not applicable   Not applicable

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act.

 

Ordinary Shares of 10p each

 

(Title of Class)

 

American Depositary Shares, each representing five Ordinary Shares (ADSs)

 

(Title of Class)


Table of Contents

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act.

 

None

 

(Title of Class)

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report.

 

At December 31, 2010, the number of outstanding ordinary shares was 1,264,391,221 which includes at such date ordinary shares represented by 10,766,211 ADSs.

 

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act.

YES   x     NO   ¨

 

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.

YES   ¨     NO   x

 

Note – Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days.

YES   x     NO   ¨

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files).

YES   ¨     NO   ¨

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, or a non-accelerated filer. See definition of “accelerated filer and large accelerated filer” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act. (Check one):

 

Large accelerated filer   x                      Accelerated filer   ¨                      Non-accelerated filer   ¨

 

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

U.S. GAAP   ¨    International Financial Reporting Standards issued by the International Accounting Standards Board   x    Other   ¨

 

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question, indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow.

 

Item 17   ¨     Item 18   ¨

 

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act).

YES   ¨     NO   x

 

 

 


Table of Contents

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

       Page  

FORWARD – LOOKING STATEMENTS

     1   

Part I

     1   

Item 1

  

IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS

     1   

Item 2

  

OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

     1   

Item 3

  

KEY INFORMATION

     1   
  

A

  

Selected Financial Data

     1   
  

B

  

Capitalization and Indebtedness

     4   
  

C

  

Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds

     4   
  

D

  

Risk Factors

     5   

Item 4

  

INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY

     7   
  

A

  

History and Development of the Company

     7   
  

B

  

Business Overview

     8   
  

C

  

Organizational Structure

     17   
  

D

  

Property, Plant and Equipment

     19   

Item 4A

  

UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

     19   

Item 5

  

OPERATING FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS

     20   
  

A

  

Operating Results

     20   
  

B

  

Liquidity and Capital Resources

     27   
  

C

  

Research and Development, Patents and Licenses

     30   
  

D

  

Trend Information

     30   
  

E

  

Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

     32   
  

F

  

Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations

     33   

Item 6

  

DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

     39   
  

A

  

Directors and Senior Management

     39   
  

B

  

Compensation

     42   
  

C

  

Board Practices

     54   
  

D

  

Employees

     57   
  

E

  

Share Ownership

     59   

Item 7

  

MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

     61   
  

A

  

Major Shareholders

     61   
  

B

  

Related Party Transactions

     61   
  

C

  

Interests of Experts and Counsel

     61   

Item 8

  

FINANCIAL INFORMATION

     62   
  

A

  

Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

     62   
  

B

  

Significant Changes

     63   

Item 9

  

THE OFFER AND LISTING

     64   
  

A

  

Offer and Listing Details

     64   
  

B

  

Plan of Distribution

     65   
  

C

  

Markets

     65   
  

D

  

Selling Shareholders

     65   
  

E

  

Dilution

     65   
  

F

  

Expenses of the Issue

     65   


Table of Contents
       Page  

Item 10

  

ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

     66   
   A    Share Capital      66   
   B    Memorandum and Articles of Association      66   
   C    Material Contracts      74   
   D    Exchange Controls      77   
   E    Taxation      77   
   F    Dividends and Paying Agents      84   
   G    Statements by Experts      84   
   H    Documents on Display      84   
  

I

   Subsidiary Information      84   

Item 11

   QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK      85   

Item 12

   DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES      87   
   A    Debt Securities      87   
   B    Warrants and Rights      87   
   C    Other Securities      88   
  

D

   American Depositary Shares      88   

Part II

     90   

Item 13

   DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES      90   

Item 14

  

MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

     90   

Item 15

   CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES      90   

Item 16A

   AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT      92   

Item 16B

   CODE OF ETHICS      92   

Item 16C

   PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES      93   

Item 16D

   EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES      93   

Item 16E

  

PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS

     93   

Item 16F

   CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT      94   

Item 16G

   CORPORATE GOVERNANCE      94   

Part III

     95   

Item 17

   FINANCIAL STATEMENTS      95   

Item 18

   FINANCIAL STATEMENTS      95   

Item 19

   EXHIBITS      95   


Table of Contents

Forward-Looking Statements

 

In connection with the provisions of the Private Securities Litigation Reform Act of 1995 (the ‘Reform Act’), the Company (as defined below) may include forward-looking statements (as defined in the Reform Act) in oral or written public statements issued by or on behalf of the Company. These forward-looking statements may include, among other things, plans, objectives, projections and anticipated future economic performance based on assumptions and the like that are subject to risks and uncertainties. As such, actual results or outcomes may differ materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements. Important factors which may cause actual results to differ include but are not limited to: the unanticipated loss of a material client or key personnel, delays or reductions in client advertising budgets, shifts in industry rates of compensation, regulatory compliance costs or litigation, natural disasters or acts of terrorism, the Company’s exposure to changes in the values of major currencies other than the UK pound sterling (because a substantial portion of its revenues are derived and costs incurred outside of the United Kingdom) and the overall level of economic activity in the Company’s major markets (which varies depending on, among other things, regional, national and international political and economic conditions and government regulations in the world’s advertising markets). In addition, you should consider the risks described in Item 3D., captioned “Risk Factors,” which could also cause actual results to differ from forward-looking information. In light of these and other uncertainties, the forward-looking statements included in this document should not be regarded as a representation by the Company that the Company’s plans and objectives will be achieved.

 

The Company undertakes no obligation to update or revise any such forward-looking statements, whether as a result of new information, future events or otherwise.

 

PART I

 

ITEM 1. IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 2. OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 3. KEY INFORMATION

 

Overview

 

WPP plc (WPP) and its subsidiaries and affiliates comprise one of the largest communications services businesses in the world. At 31 December 2010, the Group had approximately 104,000 employees. Including all employees of associated companies, this figure was approximately 146,000. For the year ended 31 December 2010, the Group had revenue of approximately £9,331 million and operating profit of approximately £973 million.

 

Unless the context otherwise requires, the terms “Company”, “Group” and “Registrant” as used herein shall mean WPP and its subsidiaries.

 

A. Selected Financial Data

 

The selected financial data should be read in conjunction with, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to, the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company, including the notes thereto.

 

1


Table of Contents

The selected income statement data for the three years ended 31 December 2010 and the selected balance sheet data at 31 December 2010 and 2009 are derived from the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company that appear elsewhere in this Form 20-F. The selected financial data for prior periods is derived from the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company previously filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission as part of the Company’s Annual Reports on Form 20-F. The Consolidated Financial Statements were prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB), for all periods.

 

The reporting currency of the Group is the UK pound sterling and the selected financial data has been prepared on this basis.

 

Selected Consolidated Income Statement Data

 

       Year ended 31 December  
     2010     2009     2008     2007     2006  
       £m     £m     £m     £m     £m  

Revenue

     9,331.0        8,684.3        7,476.9        6,185.9        5,907.8   

Operating profit

     973.0        761.7        876.0        804.7        741.6   

Profit for the year

     661.0        506.9        513.9        515.1        482.6   

Profit attributable to equity holders of the parent

     586.0        437.7        439.1        465.9        435.8   

Earnings per ordinary share:

          

Basic

     47.5     35.9     38.4     39.6     36.3

Diluted

     45.9     35.3     37.6     38.0     35.2

Earnings per ADS 1 :

          

Basic

     237.5     179.5     192.0     198.0     181.5

Diluted

     229.5     176.5     188.0     190.0     176.0

Dividends per ordinary share

     16.25     15.47     14.32     11.93     9.94

Dividends per ADS (US dollars) 2

     126.7     135.9     139.5     113.3     90.9

1     Basic and diluted earnings per American Depositary Share (ADS) have been calculated using the same method as earnings per share, multiplied by a factor of five.

2     These figures have been translated for convenience purposes only, using the average rate for the year shown in the exchange rate table on page 4. This conversion should not be construed as a representation that the pound sterling amounts actually represent, or could be converted into, US dollars at the rates indicated.

        

         

 

Selected Consolidated Balance Sheet Data

 

       At 31 December  
     2010      2009      2008      2007      2006  
       £m      £m      £m      £m      £m  

Total assets

     24,345.1         22,351.5         24,463.3         17,252.0         14,695.9   

Net assets

     6,647.9         6,075.7         5,959.8         4,094.8         3,918.4   

Called-up share capital

     126.4         125.6         125.5         119.2         124.1   

Number of shares (in millions)

     1,264.4         1,256.5         1,255.3         1,191.5         1,240.6   

 

Dividends

 

Dividends on the Company’s ordinary shares, when paid, are paid to share owners as of a record date, which is fixed by the Company.

 

2


Table of Contents

The table below sets forth the amounts of interim, second interim and total dividends paid on the Company’s ordinary shares in respect of each fiscal year indicated. In the United States, the Company’s ordinary shares are represented by ADSs, which are evidenced by American Depositary Receipts (ADRs) or held in book-entry form. The dividends are also shown translated into US cents per ADS using the average Bloomberg Closing Mid Point rate for pounds sterling, as shown on page 4, for each year presented.

 

             Pence per ordinary share               US cents per ADS  
Year ended 31 December:    First
Interim
     Second
Interim 1
     Total      First
Interim
     Second
Interim 1
     Total  

2006

     3.60         7.61         11.21         33.18         70.13         103.31   

2007

     4.32         9.13         13.45         43.24         91.39         134.63   

2008

     5.19         10.28         15.47         48.07         95.21         143.28   

2009

     5.19         10.28         15.47         40.66         80.53         121.19   

2010

     5.97         11.82         17.79         46.15         91.37         137.52   

 

1     Income access share arrangements have been put in place by the Company. The mechanics of the income access share arrangements mean that the Company will declare a second interim rather than a final dividend. The Board has no plans to announce any additional dividend in respect of the year ended 31 December 2010.

 

The 2010 first interim dividend was paid on 8 November 2010 to share owners on the register at 8 October 2010. The 2010 second interim dividend is expected to be paid on 4 July 2011 to share owners on the register at 3 June 2011.

 

Exchange rates

 

Fluctuations in the exchange rate between the pound sterling and the US dollar will affect the dollar equivalent of the pound sterling prices of the Company’s ordinary shares on The London Stock Exchange Limited (The London Stock Exchange) and, as a result, are likely to affect the market price of the ADSs in the United States. US dollar amounts paid to holders of ADSs also depend on the sterling/US dollar exchange rate at the time of payment.

 

The following table sets forth for each of the most recent six months, the high and low Bloomberg Closing Mid Point rates. As of 18 April 2011, the Bloomberg Closing Mid Point rate was 1.6247.

 

Month ended    High      Low  

31 October 2010

     1.6020         1.5685   

30 November 2010

     1.6257         1.5556   

31 December 2010

     1.5884         1.5371   

31 January 2011

     1.6033         1.5495   

28 February 2011

     1.6250         1.6006   

31 March 2011

     1.6381         1.5986   

 

3


Table of Contents

The annual average of the Bloomberg Closing Mid Point rate for pounds sterling expressed in US dollars for each of the five years ended 31 December was:

 

Year ended 31 December    Average  

2006

     1.8432   

2007

     2.0019   

2008

     1.8524   

2009

     1.5667   

2010

     1.5461   

 

B. Capitalization and Indebtedness

 

Not applicable.

 

C. Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds

 

Not applicable.

 

4


Table of Contents

D. Risk Factors

 

The Company is subject to a variety of possible risks that could adversely impact its revenues, results of operations or financial condition. Some of these risks relate to the industries in which the Company operates while others are more specific to the Company. The table below sets out principal risks the Company has identified that could adversely affect it. See also the discussion of Forward-Looking Statements preceding Item 1.

 

Risk      Potential Impact
Clients       
The Group competes for clients in a highly competitive industry and client loss may reduce market share and decrease profits.     

Competitors include large multinational advertising and marketing communication companies and regional and national marketing services companies.

 

New market participants include database marketing and modeling companies, telemarketers and internet companies.

 

Service agreements with clients are generally terminated by the client on 90 days’ notice and many clients put their advertising and communications business up for competitive review from time to time. The ability to attract new clients and to retain existing clients may also in some cases be limited by clients’ policies about conflicts of interest.

The Group receives a significant portion of its revenues from a limited number of large clients and the loss of these clients could adversely impact the Group’s prospects, business, financial condition and results of operations.      A relatively small number of clients contribute a significant percentage of the Group’s consolidated revenues. The Group’s 10 largest clients accounted for almost 18% of revenues in the year ended 31 December 2010. Clients generally are able to reduce advertising and marketing spend or cancel projects on short notice. The loss of one or more of the Group’s largest clients, if not replaced by new client accounts or an increase in business from existing clients, would adversely affect the Group’s financial condition.
Corporate Responsibility         
The social and environmental impact of our work for clients.      The operating companies across 107 countries may not always consider the social and environmental impact of their work.
Damage to WPP’s reputation from undertaking controversial client work.      The operating companies may undertake controversial client accounts and may not always consider the impact on the Group.
Marketing ethics, compliance with marketing standards, and increasing transparency about our marketing practices.      Our work may not always comply with all laws and industry codes governing marketing material.
Compliance with privacy and data protection regulations.      Increased regulation unless the operating companies meet best practice standards, contribute to the debate on privacy, increase transparency for consumers on how their data are obtained and used.
Employment, including diversity and equal opportunities, business ethics, employee development, remuneration, communication and health and safety.      Failing to meet standards on diversity and gender would impact the perception of the Group and quality of work.
Climate change, including the emissions from energy used in our offices and during business travel.      Negative cost and reputational impact if the Group failed to meet target to reduce per head carbon intensity to 1.2 tonnes by 2020 (from 3.3 tonnes in 2006).
Economic       
The Group’s businesses are subject to economic and political cycles. Many of the economies in which the Group operates have significant economic challenges.      Reduction in client spending or postponing spending on the services offered by the Group or switching of client expenditure to non-traditional media and renegotiation of contract terms leading to reduced profitability and cash flow.
Financial       
Currency exchange rate fluctuations could adversely impact the Group’s consolidated results.      The Company’s reporting currency is pounds sterling. Given the Group’s significant international operations, changes in exchange rates cause fluctuations in the Company’s results when measured in pounds sterling.

 

5


Table of Contents
Risk      Potential Impact

Financial (continued)

        
Changes to the Group’s debt issue ratings by the rating agencies Moody’s Investor Services and Standard and Poor’s Rating Service may affect the Group’s access to debt capital.      If the Company’s financial performance and outlook materially deteriorate, a ratings downgrade could occur and the interest rates and fees payable on certain of the Company’s revolving credit facilities could be increased.
The Group may be unable to collect balances due from any client that files for bankruptcy or becomes insolvent.     

The Group is generally paid in arrears for its services. Invoices are typically payable within 30 to 60 days.

 

The Group commits to media and production purchases on behalf of some of its clients as principal or agent depending on the client and market circumstances. If a client is unable to pay sums due, media and production companies may look to the Group to pay such amounts to which it committed as an agent on behalf of those clients.

Mergers & Acquisitions       
The Group may be unsuccessful in evaluating material risks involved in completed and future acquisitions and may be unsuccessful in integrating any acquired operations with its existing businesses.      The Group regularly reviews potential acquisitions of businesses that are complementary to its operations and clients needs. If material risks are not identified prior to acquisition or the Group experiences difficulties in integrating an acquired business, it may not realise the expected benefits from such acquisition and the Group’s financial condition could be adversely affected.
Goodwill and other intangible assets recorded on the Group’s balance sheet with respect to acquired companies may become impaired.      The Group has a significant amount of goodwill and other intangible assets recorded on its balance sheet with respect to acquired companies. The Group annually tests the carrying value of goodwill and other intangibles for impairment. The estimates and assumptions about results of operations and cash flows made in connection with impairment testing could differ from future results of operations and cash flows. Future events could cause the Group to conclude that the asset values associated with a given operation have become impaired which could have a material impact on the Group’s financial condition.
Operational         
The Group operates in 107 countries and is exposed to the risks of doing business internationally.      The Group’s international operations are subject to exchange rate fluctuations, restrictions and/or taxation on repatriations of earnings, social, political and economic instability, conflicts of laws and interpretation of contracts.
People       
The Group’s performance could be adversely affected if it were unable to attract and retain key talent or had inadequate talent management and succession planning for key management roles.      The Group is highly dependent on the talent, creative abilities and technical skills of our personnel as well as their relationships with clients. The Group is vulnerable to the loss of personnel to competitors and clients leading to disruption to the business.
Regulatory/Legal       
The Group may be subject to regulations affecting its activities.      Governments, government agencies and industry self-regulatory bodies from time to time adopt statutes and regulations that directly or indirectly affect the form, content and scheduling of advertising, public relations and public affairs and market research or otherwise limit the scope of the activities of the Group and its clients which could have a material adverse impact on our financial position. Changes in tax laws or their application may also adversely affect the Group’s reported results.
The Group may be exposed to liabilities from allegations that certain of its clients’ advertising claims may be false or misleading or that its clients’ products may be defective.      The Group may be, or may be joined as a defendant, in litigation brought against its clients in respect of services provided by the Group.

The Group operates in 107 countries and is subject to increased anti-corruption legislation and enforcement not only in the US and UK.

    

The Group may be exposed to liabilities in the event of breaches of anti-corruption legislation.

Civil liabilities or judgements against the Company or its directors or officers based on U.S. federal or state securities laws may not be enforceable in the U.S. or in England and Wales or in Jersey.      The Company is a public limited company incorporated under the laws of Jersey. Some of the Company’s directors and officers reside outside of the United States. In addition, a substantial portion of the directly owned assets of the Company are located outside of the United States. As a result, it may be difficult or impossible for investors to effect service of process within the United States against the Company or its directors and officers or to enforce against them any of the judgements, including those obtained in original actions or in actions to enforce judgements of the U.S, courts, predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the federal or state securities laws of the United States.

 

6


Table of Contents

ITEM 4. INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY

 

The Company operates through a number of established global, multinational and national advertising and marketing services companies that are organised into four business segments. Our largest segment is Advertising and Media Investment Management where we operate the well-known advertising networks Ogilvy & Mather, JWT, Y&R, Grey, Bates 141 and the United Network, as well as Media Investment Management companies such as MediaCom, MEC, Mindshare and Maxus. Our other segments are Consumer Insight, where our operations are conducted through Kantar; Public Relations & Public Affairs, where we operate through well-known companies such as Burson-Marsteller, Cohn & Wolfe, Hill & Knowlton and Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide; and Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications, where our operations are conducted by B to D Group, ghg, Wunderman, Sudler & Hennessey, OgilvyOne Worldwide, Ogilvy CommonHealth Worldwide, G2, OgilvyAction, 24/7 Real Media Inc and other companies.

 

The Company’s ordinary shares are admitted to the Official List of the UK Listing Authority and trade on The London Stock Exchange and American Depositary Shares (which are evidenced by ADRs or held in book-entry form) representing deposited ordinary shares are quoted on the NASDAQ Global Select Market (NASDAQ). At 14 April 2011 the Company had a market capitalisation of £9,159 million.

 

The Company’s executive office is located at 6 Ely Place, Dublin 2, Ireland, Tel: 011-353-1-669-0333 and its registered office is located at 22 Grenville Street, St Helier, Jersey, JE4 8PX.

 

A. History and Development of the Company

 

WPP plc was incorporated in Jersey on 12 September 2008.

 

On 19 November 2008, under a scheme of arrangement between WPP 2008 Limited (formerly WPP Group plc), (Old WPP), the former holding company of the Group, and its share owners under Part 26 of the Companies Act 2006, and as sanctioned by the High Court, all the issued shares in that company were cancelled and the same number of new shares were issued to WPP plc in consideration for the allotment to share owners of one ordinary share in WPP plc for each ordinary share in WPP 2008 Limited held on the record date, 18 November 2008. Citibank, N.A., depositary for the ADSs representing Old WPP ordinary shares, cancelled Old WPP ADSs held in book-entry uncertificated form in the direct registration system maintained by it and issued ADSs representing ordinary shares of the Company in book entry uncertificated form in the direct registration system maintained by it to the holders. Holders of certificated ADSs, or ADRs, of Old WPP were entitled to receive Company ADSs upon surrender of the Old WPP ADRs to the Depositary. Each Old WPP ADS represented five ordinary shares of Old WPP and each Company ADS represents five ordinary shares of the Company.

 

As part of the scheme of arrangement noted above, 1,252,652,646 ordinary shares were issued at a price of 340.75 pence each. On 24 November 2008 the entire balance standing to the credit of the share premium account was transferred to retained earnings as sanctioned by The Royal Court of Jersey. As a result £4,143.1 million was added to retained earnings for both WPP plc and the Group. For the Company this amount is distributable.

 

Pursuant to Rule 12g-3 under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the Exchange Act), WPP plc succeeded to Old WPP’s registration and periodic reporting obligations under the Exchange Act.

 

7


Table of Contents

Old WPP became the holding company of the WPP Group on or about 25 October 2005 when the company now known as WPP 2005 Limited, the original holding company of the WPP Group, completed a reorganisation of its capital and corporate structure. WPP 2005 Limited (formerly WPP Group plc) was incorporated and registered in England and Wales in 1971 and is a private limited company under the Companies Act 1985, and until 1985 operated as a manufacturer and distributor of wire and plastic products. In 1985, new investors acquired a significant interest in WPP and changed the strategic direction of the Company from being a wire and plastics manufacturer and distributor to being a multinational communications services organisation. Since then, the Company has grown both organically and by the acquisition of companies, most significantly the acquisitions of JWT Group, Inc. in 1987, The Ogilvy Group, Inc. in 1989, Young & Rubicam Inc. (Young & Rubicam or Young & Rubicam Brands, as the group is now known) in 2000, Tempus Group plc (Tempus) in 2001, Cordiant Communications Group plc (Cordiant) in 2003, Grey Global Group, Inc. (Grey) in 2005, 24/7 Real Media Inc (TFSM) in 2007 and Taylor Nelson Sofres plc (TNS) in 2008.

 

The Company spent £295.9 million (excluding cash and cash equivalents acquired), £196.6 million and £1,054.0 million for acquisitions and investments in 2010, 2009 and 2008, respectively, including payments in respect of loan note redemptions and earnout consideration resulting from acquisitions in prior years. For the same periods, cash spent on purchases of property, plant and equipment and other intangible assets was £217.5 million, £253.3 million and £220.6 million, respectively, and cash spent on share repurchases and cancellations was £46.4 million, £9.5 million and £112.2 million, respectively.

 

B. Business Overview

 

The Company’s business comprises the provision of communications services on a national, multinational and global basis. It operates from almost 2,400 offices in 107 countries including associates. The Company organises its businesses in the following areas: Advertising and Media Investment Management; Consumer Insight; Public Relations & Public Affairs; and Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications (including direct, digital, promotion and relationship marketing).

 

Approximately 40% of the Company’s reported revenues in 2010 were from Advertising and Media Investment Management, with the remaining 60% of its revenues being derived from the business segments of Consumer Insight; Public Relations & Public Affairs; and Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications.

 

The following table shows, for the last three fiscal years, reported revenue attributable to each business segment in which the Company operates.

 

Revenue    2010     

% of

Total in

2010

     2009 1     

% of

Total in

2009

     2008 1     

% of

Total in

2008

 
       (£m)               (£m)               (£m)           

Advertising and Media Investment Management

     3,733.3         40.0         3,420.5         39.3         3,380.2         45.2   

Consumer Insight

     2,430.2         26.0         2,297.1         26.5         1,301.8         17.4   

Public Relations & Public Affairs

     844.5         9.1         795.7         9.2         752.3         10.1   

Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist

Communications

     2,323.0         24.9         2,171.0         25.0         2,042.6         27.3   

Total

     9,331.0         100.0         8,684.3         100.0         7,476.9         100.0   
1    

2009 and 2008 comparatives have been restated to reflect the transfer of certain revenues of RMG from Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications to Advertising and Media Investment Management.

 

8


Table of Contents

The following table shows, for the last three fiscal years, reported revenue attributable to each geographic area in which the Company operates and demonstrates the Company’s regional diversity.

 

Revenue    2010     

% of

Total in

2010

     2009     

% of

Total in

2009

     2008     

% of

Total in

2008

 
       (£m)               (£m)               (£m)           

North America 1

     3,299.8         35.3         3,010.0         34.7         2,603.2         34.8   

United Kingdom

     1,087.6         11.7         1,029.0         11.8         954.2         12.8   

Western Continental Europe 2

     2,325.3         24.9         2,327.8         26.8         1,879.1         25.1   

Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and

Central & Eastern Europe

     2,618.3         28.1         2,317.5         26.7         2,040.4         27.3   

Total

     9,331.0         100.0         8,684.3         100.0         7,476.9         100.0   
1    

North America includes the US with revenues of £3,097.9 million (2009: £2,835.8 million, 2008: £2,444.7 million).

2    

Western Continental Europe includes Ireland with revenues of £37.4 million (2009: £43.4 million, 2008: £41.3 million).

 

The Company’s principal activities within each of its business segments are described below.

 

Advertising and Media Investment Management

 

Advertising

 

The principal functions of an advertising agency are the planning and creation of marketing and branding campaigns and the design and production of advertisements for all types of media such as television, cable, the internet, radio, magazines, newspapers and outdoor locations such as billboards.

 

The Company’s principal advertising agencies include Ogilvy & Mather, JWT, Y&R, Grey, United Network and Bates 141. The Company also owns interests in Asatsu-DK (24.3%); CHI & Partners Limited (49.9%); GIIR, Inc (22.7%) and The Jupiter Drawing Room & Partners (49.0%).

 

Ogilvy & Mather is a full-service multinational advertising agency. Ogilvy & Mather was formed in 1948 and is headquartered in New York. Its strategy includes an integrated service offering known as 360 Degree Brand Stewardship ® , a business platform that enables Ogilvy & Mather to integrate its growing range of disciplines which includes OgilvyAction, Ogilvy’s brand activation company, Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide (OPR), Ogilvy CommonHealth Worldwide and Neo@Ogilvy.

 

JWT , one of the world’s first advertising agencies, was founded in 1864 and is a full service multinational advertising agency headquartered in New York. JWT’s relationships with a number of its major clients have been in existence for many years, exhibiting, management believes, an ability to adapt to meet the clients’ and market’s new demands.

 

Y&R , a full-service multinational advertising agency network headquartered in New York, was formed in 1923 and is now part of a collaborative, multidisciplinary model under Young & Rubicam Brands. Y&R’s clients also benefit from Y&R’s continued investment in its proprietary brand management tool, BrandAsset ® Valuator .

 

Grey commenced operations in 1917 and was incorporated in 1925 as Grey Advertising Inc. Grey has offices in approximately 96 countries.

 

United Network . In 2005, WPP’s Red Cell network was split in two parts, with several of the former Red Cell offices forming the United Network. United Network now includes Senora Rushmore United, Madrid; Berlin Cameron United, New York; Cole & Weber United, Seattle; 1861 United, Milan; LDV United, Antwerp; BTS United, Oslo; and Les Ouvriers du Paradis United, Paris.

 

Bates 141 is an Asia-dedicated advertising and brand activation network.

 

9


Table of Contents

Media Investment Management

 

GroupM is WPP’s global media investment management operation, serving as the parent company to agencies including MediaCom, MEC, Mindshare and Maxus. With its agencies, GroupM has capabilities in business science, consumer insight, communications and media planning implementation, interactions, content development, and sports and entertainment marketing. The primary purpose of GroupM is to maximise the performance of WPP’s media agencies, operating not only as a parent company but as a collaborator on performance-enhancing activities, such as trading, content creation, sports, digital, finance, tool development and other business-critical capabilities, in order to leverage the combination of GroupM’s core and talent resources.

 

MediaCom became part of GroupM following the Grey acquisition in March 2005 and, as part of WPP, is able to work together with sister media agencies, developing synergies in a number of relevant professional areas.

 

MEC was formed following the Group’s acquisition of Tempus in 2001 with the merger of its core brand CIA with The MediaEdge. In addition to its media planning and implementation capability, MEC has established and is growing its operations in interaction (digital, direct & search), entertainment marketing, sports, sponsorship and event marketing, cause-related marketing, content development, return on investment (ROI) and consumer insights, and is now developing a retail marketing practice.

 

Mindshare was originally formed from the merger of the media departments of JWT and Ogilvy & Mather. Mindshare has made significant investments in developing strategic resources, especially in the areas of communications planning, content, insights, digital and ROI, with its ambition moving from being marketing partners for their clients to being their business partners.

 

Maxus is a global communications consultancy, spanning across 60 offices in 50 countries, which helps marketers build interactive relationships between consumers and their brands.

 

tenthavenue, launched in March 2011, integrates some of the Group’s key specialist media offerings in online, mobile, experiential and out of home (OOH) communications in a single company. tenthavenue’s focus is on delivering tailored audiences and outcomes across multi-channels and devices, reaching specific audiences as they go about their daily lives. It incorporates lifestyle and environments agency Kinetic Worldwide; custom communication and in-flight publisher Spafax; performance marketing specialist Quisma; and mobile marketing agency Joule.

 

Consumer Insight

 

To help optimise its worldwide research offering to clients, the Company’s separate global research and strategic marketing consultancy businesses, which are described below, are managed on a centralised basis under the umbrella of the Kantar Group. In 2009 the Kantar Group announced a major re-organisation to strengthen its position as the world’s leading consumer insight business and streamline its offer for clients. The re-organisation simplified the Group’s overall offering through a series of structural changes, building on the acquisition of TNS in October 2008. The principal interests comprising the Kantar Group are:

 

The TNS Custom business and Research International were merged in 2009. The new global company is known as TNS. This custom research company specialises in a wide range of business sectors and areas of marketplace information including strategic market studies, brand positioning and equity research, customer satisfaction surveys, product development, international research and advanced modeling.

 

10


Table of Contents

In addition, following the acquisition of TNS four dedicated vertical sector operating units were established using the Kantar name:

 

   

Kantar Media through the coming together of Kantar Media Intelligence, Kantar Audience Measurement, TGI Global and Kantar Media US;

 

   

Kantar Health through the coming together of TNS Healthcare, Ziment Group and Mattson Jack Group;

 

   

Kantar Retail through the coming together of Glendinning, Cannondale Associates, Management Ventures, Retail Forward and Red Dot Square; and

 

   

Kantar Worldpanel a grouping of former TNS Worldpanel companies which will include links with IMRB International, a leading market research business in India and Lightspeed Research which provides online consumer panel access for tracking and ad hoc studies.

 

Millward Brown (MB) is one of the world’s leading companies in advertising research, including pre-testing, tracking and sales modeling, and offers a full range of services to help clients market their brands more effectively.

 

The Futures Company is a global trends and futures research and consultancy business.

 

Public Relations & Public Affairs

 

Public Relations & Public Affairs companies advise clients who are seeking to communicate with consumers, governments and/or the business and financial communities. Public Relations & Public Affairs activities include national and international corporate, financial and marketing communications, crisis management, reputation management, public affairs and government lobbying. The Company’s global networks in this area included Burson-Marsteller, Hill & Knowlton, Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide and Cohn & Wolfe.

 

Burson-Marsteller (B-M), founded in 1953 and now part of Young & Rubicam Brands, specialises in corporate and marketing communications, business-to-business services, crisis management, employee relations and government relations. The B-M network includes the businesses of Marsteller, a full service multimedia agency, and public affairs companies, Quinn Gillespie, Dewey Square Group and Penn, Schoen & Berland.

 

Hill & Knowlton (H&K), founded in 1927, is a worldwide public relations and public affairs firm headquartered in New York. H&K provides national and multinational clients with a wide range of communications services including corporate and financial public relations, marketing communications, internal communication, change management, crisis communications and public affairs counseling. The Hill & Knowlton network also includes the businesses of Blanc & Otus, H&K’s stand-alone technology company, and Wexler & Walker Public Policy Associates. In 2011, H&K merged with another of WPP’s public affairs companies, Public Strategies Inc. The combined entity trades under the H&K name.

 

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide is part of the Ogilvy & Mather worldwide network. OPR is a leading public relations and public affairs firm based in New York with practice areas in marketing, health and medical, corporate public affairs and technology and social marketing. The firm has offices in key financial, governmental and media centres as well as relationships with affiliates worldwide.

 

Cohn & Wolfe (C&W), a Young & Rubicam Brands company, is an international public relations agency established in 1970. It offers marketing-related public relations for its clients and provides its clients with business results and marketing communications solutions. In 2008 C&W merged with Grey Group’s public relations network, GCI.

 

11


Table of Contents

Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications

 

The Company’s activities in this business area include branding and identity; healthcare communications; direct, digital, promotion & relationship marketing; and specialist communications including custom media, demographic and sector marketing, sports marketing, and media and film production services.

 

Branding & Identity

 

B to D Group. This branding and design entity, formed in 2005, consists of Landor Associates (a Young & Rubicam Brands company), The Brand Union, VBAT, Addison Corporate Marketing, Lambie-Nairn, The Partners, FITCH and PeclersParis. The mission of the B to D Group is to maximise and leverage the strengths of each individual company in order to offer clients and prospects the most complete and compelling branding and design solutions. As part of the Group, the companies have access to new clients and untapped markets, as well as resources such as advanced knowledge sharing systems and financial tools. Employee exchange further enables the companies to share top-level strategic thinking, creativity and cultural knowledge.

 

BDGMcColl. BDGMcColl, Edinburgh-based architects and interior designers, specialise in the design of commercial buildings and interiors.

 

BDGworkfutures. BDGworkfutures is an international design consultancy focusing on strategy and design for working environments, working with corporate clients and within the Government sector.

 

Healthcare Communications

 

The Company has extensive expertise in healthcare communications, including the global networks of GCI Health, Sudler & Hennessey (a Young & Rubicam Brands company), Ogilvy CommonHealth Worldwide (part of the Ogilvy & Mather network) and ghg (part of Grey Group).

 

Direct, Digital, Promotion & Relationship Marketing

 

The Company has a number of operating businesses in this category, including:

 

   

EWA , which specialises in data and relationship management services;

 

   

G2 , part of Grey Group, which unifies all of the specialised marketing communications services into a global network providing services in branding and design, data consulting, direct communications, interactive marketing, and promotion, trade and shopper marketing;

 

   

Headcount Worldwide Field Marketing , which offers field marketing and brand development services, supported by strong customer relationship skills;

 

   

KBM Group, a Young & Rubicam Brands company, which provides information-based marketing solutions to businesses in targeted high-growth industries. KBM’s capabilities include data warehousing, data mining, information services and data analysis;

 

   

Mando Brand Assurance , which is a UK-based global promotional risk management company, underwriting marketing activity for major international brands;

 

   

OgilvyOne Worldwide , part of the Ogilvy & Mather Worldwide network, which is a direct marketing group, offering online marketing consulting and also traditional direct marketing communications such as direct response advertising techniques;

 

   

VML , headquartered in Kansas City and part of Young & Rubicam Brands, which specialises in digital and interactive services;

 

12


Table of Contents
   

Wunderman , part of Young & Rubicam Brands, which is an integrated marketing solutions company that delivers customer relationship management services to its clients. Since 2005, Wunderman has acquired several digital companies, including Aqua Online, AGENDA, Blast Radius, ZAAZ, Actis Systems, Kassius and Designkitchen, to enhance its offer to clients; and

 

   

OgilvyAction , part of the Ogilvy & Mather Worldwide network, which is a global marketing services network whose offers include shopper & trade marketing, experiential marketing, digital, retail design and sports & entertainment sponsorship.

 

Specialist Communications

 

Custom media

 

   

Forward is a full service custom media specialist, whose services include magazines, catalogues, magalogues, mini-zines, e-zines, web content and direct mail.

 

Demographic marketing

 

   

The Bravo Group, MosaicaMD, Kang & Lee and WING create multicultural marketing and communications programmes targeted to the fast-growing US Hispanic, African-American and Asian communities. Their multidisciplinary services include advertising, promotion and event marketing, public relations, research and direct marketing. The Bravo Group, MosaicaMD and Kang & Lee are part of Young & Rubicam Brands. WING is part of Grey Group.

 

Event/face-to-face marketing

 

   

MJM is a full-service communications company for live events, meetings, exhibits, trade shows, brand theatre and training, serving clients around the world.

 

Foodservice marketing

 

   

The Food Group specialises in targeted food advertising, marketing, and culinary and technology solutions.

 

Youth marketing

 

   

The Geppetto Group assists clients in communicating their products and services to the youth market (children and teenagers) and implementing creative branding solutions.

 

Real estate marketing

 

   

Pace is one of the largest specialists in the real estate communications market in the US, offering comprehensive services in the marketing of both commercial and residential property to developers, builders and real estate agents.

 

Sports marketing

 

   

OgilvyAction Sports & Entertainment Marketing is an international sports and entertainment marketing agency specialising in the marketing of exclusive and worldwide broadcasting and marketing rights to European football matches and the sponsorship consultancy of blue-chip clients across various sports.

 

   

PRISM Group is an international sports marketing network, working with blue-chip clients in sponsorship consultancy, sponsorship marketing, content PR and brand experiences.

 

13


Table of Contents

Media & production services

 

   

Metro provides a diverse range of technical and creative services, including multimedia, film, video and asset archiving, equipment sales and post-production systems to clients in the UK.

 

   

The Farm Group , headquartered in the UK, is a film and video production services company.

 

   

WPP has a minority stake in MRC , a leading independent studio in television, film and digital.

 

WPP Digital

 

WPP Digital provides access for WPP companies and their clients to a portfolio of digital talent and expertise, platforms and partnerships. WPP Digital comprises full-service interactive agencies, including Possible Worldwide (through the merger of Schematic, BLUE, Bridge Worldwide and Quasar in February 2011), Blue State Digital, production services company Deliver; and technology-led digital marketing company 24/7 Real Media Inc. In addition, WPP Digital holds minority investments in businesses providing creative services, analytics, mobile marketing, in-game advertising, video and social networking services.

 

Manufacturing

 

The original business of the Group remains as the manufacturing division, which operates through subsidiaries of Wire and Plastic Products Limited. The division produces a wide range of products for commercial, industrial and retail applications.

 

WPP Head Office

 

WPP and its offices in Dublin, London, New York, Tokyo, Hong Kong, Shanghai and Sao Paulo develop the professional and financial strategy of the Group, promote operating efficiencies, coordinate cross referrals of clients among the Group companies and monitor the financial performance of its operating companies. The principal activity of the Group continues to be the provision of communications and marketing services worldwide. WPP acts only as the parent company and does not trade. The parent company complements the operating companies in three distinct ways.

 

   

First, the parent company relieves them of much administrative work. Financial matters (such as planning, budgeting, reporting, control, treasury, tax, mergers, acquisitions, investor relations, legal affairs and internal audit) are co-ordinated centrally. For the operating companies, every administrative hour saved is an extra hour to be devoted to the pursuit of professional excellence.

 

   

Second, the parent company encourages and enables operating companies of different disciplines to work together for the benefit of clients. Such collaborations have the additional benefit of enhancing the job satisfaction of the Company’s people. The parent company also plays an across-the-Group role in the following functions: the management of talent, including recruitment and training; in property management; in procurement and information technology; in knowledge sharing and practice development.

 

   

And, finally, WPP itself can function as the 21 st century equivalent of the full-service agency. For some clients, predominantly those with a vast geographical spread and a need for marketing services ranging from advertising through design and website construction to research and internal communications, WPP can act as a portal to provide a single point of contact and accountability.

 

The parent company operates with a limited group of approximately 350 people.

 

14


Table of Contents

WPP Strategy

 

Our reason for being, the justification for WPP’s existence, continues to be to add value to our clients’ businesses and our people’s careers. Our goal remains to be the world’s most successful provider of communications services to multinational and local companies, not just the largest.

 

The Group has three strategic priorities.

 

   

First, our immediate priority is to continue to emerge from the financial crisis of 2008 a stronger company. Our 2010 results are an encouraging sign that we will or even have. Compared with the last downturn, our people are stronger: they are better resourced, motivated and incentivised than when we exited the last recessions in the early 1990s and 2000s. The Company is also more profitable, more liquid and better structured.

 

   

Second, in the medium term, to build upon the successful base we have established whilst integrating our most recent acquisitions effectively. At TNS the integration has gone well and the focus has to now be on revenue growth, capturing greater market share.

 

   

Our third priority, in the long-term or over the next five to 10 years, is to: increase the combined geographic share of revenues from the faster-growing markets of Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa and the Middle East, and Central and Eastern Europe, from around 27% to 35-40%; increase the share of revenues of new media from 29% to 35-40%; and maintain the share of more measurable marketing services—such as Consumer Insight and direct, digital and interactive—at 50% of revenues.

 

Corporate Responsibility

 

We focus our efforts on the issues we have identified as being most material (relevant and significant) to WPP. We consider five corporate responsibility issues to be of significance to WPP.

 

   

The social and environmental impact of our work for clients.

 

   

The impact of our work, including marketing ethics, compliance with marketing standards, protection of personal, consumer and corporate data and increasing transparency about our marketing practices.

 

   

Employment, including diversity and equal opportunities, business ethics, employee development, remuneration, communication and health and safety. In 2010, WPP invested £48.9 million (2009: £39.9 million) in training and wellbeing across the Group.

 

   

Social investment, including pro bono work, donations to charity and employee volunteering. In 2010, our total social investment was worth £14.3 million (2009: £14.9 million), equivalent to 1.7% of reported profit before tax. This includes £9.3 million in pro bono work (based on the fees the benefiting organisations would have paid for our work) and an estimated £5 million in donations. In addition, WPP media agencies negotiated free media space worth £20.2 million on behalf of pro bono clients.

 

   

Climate change, including the emissions from energy used in our offices and during business travel.

 

Clients

 

The Group services 336 of the Fortune Global 500, 29 of the Dow Jones 30, 61 of the NASDAQ 100, 35 of the Fortune e-50 and 708 national or multinational clients are served in three or more disciplines. More than 460 clients are served in four disciplines and these clients account for over 57% of Group revenues. The Group also works with over 340 clients across six or more countries. The Company’s 10 largest clients in 2010, measured by revenues, were, British American Tobacco p.l.c., Dell Inc., Ford Motor Company, GlaxoSmithkline plc, Johnson & Johnson, Kraft Foods, Inc., Microsoft

 

15


Table of Contents

Corporation, Nestlé S.A., The Procter & Gamble Company and Unilever PLC. Together, these clients accounted for approximately 18% of the Company’s revenues in 2010. No client of the Company represented more than 5% of the Company’s aggregate revenues in 2010. The Group’s companies have maintained long-standing relationships with many of its clients, with an average length of relationship for the top 10 clients of approximately 50 years.

 

Acquisitions & Investments

 

During 2010, acquisitions and increased equity stakes were focused on Advertising and Media Investment Management in Canada, the UK, France, Germany, Poland, Israel, Brazil, Colombia, Hong Kong, India and South Korea; on Consumer Insight in Poland, Hungary, Cyprus, Chile and Guatemala; on Public Relations & Public Affairs in the UK, Germany, Poland and Turkey; on direct, digital and interactive in the US, the UK, Germany, Brazil, China and Singapore; and on Healthcare Communications in the US, the UK and the Czech Republic. Total initial cash consideration spent on these acquisitions and investments, less cash and cash equivalents acquired, was £120.5 million in 2010.

 

Government Regulation

 

From time to time, governments, government agencies and industry self-regulatory bodies in the United States, European Union and other countries in which the Company operates have adopted statutes, regulations, and rulings which directly or indirectly affect the form, content, and scheduling of advertising, public relations and public affairs, and market research, or otherwise limit the scope of the activities of the Company and its clients. Some of the foregoing relate to privacy and data protection and general considerations such as truthfulness, substantiation and interpretation of claims made, comparative advertising, relative responsibilities of clients and advertising, public relations and public affairs firms, and registration of public relations and public affairs firms’ representation of foreign governments.

 

In addition, there is an increasing trend towards expansion of specific rules, prohibitions, media restrictions, labeling disclosures and warning requirements with respect to advertising for certain products, such as over-the-counter drugs and pharmaceuticals, cigarettes, food and certain alcoholic beverages, and to certain groups, such as children. Proposals have been made for the adoption of additional laws and regulations that could further restrict the activities of advertising, public relations and public affairs, and market research firms and their clients. Though the Company does not expect any existing or proposed regulations to materially adversely impact the Company’s business, the Company is unable to estimate the effect on its future operations of the application of existing statutes or regulations or the extent or nature of future regulatory action.

 

16


Table of Contents

C. Organizational Structure

 

The Company’s business comprises the provision of communications services on a national, multinational and global basis. It operates out of almost 2,400 offices in 107 countries including associates. For a list of the Company’s principal subsidiary undertakings and their jurisdictions of incorporation see note 29 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

The Company organises its businesses in the following areas: Advertising and Media Investment Management; Consumer Insight; Public Relations & Public Affairs; and Branding & Identity, Healthcare & Specialist Communications (including direct, digital, promotion and relationship marketing). A listing of the Group brands operating within these business segments as at April 2011 is set forth below.

 

Advertising

ADK 1

Bates 141

BrandBuzz 4

CHI & Partners 1

Dentsu Y&R 1, 2, 4

Grey

HS Ad 1

JWT

Ogilvy & Mather

Santo

Scangroup 1

Soho Square

Tapsa

TAXI

Team Detroit

The Jupiter Drawing Room & Partners 1

United Network

Y&R 4

 

Media Investment Management

GroupM:

Maxus

MediaCom

MEC

Mindshare

Outrider

Catalyst

Other media agencies:

KR Media 1

tenthavenue:

Kinetic Worldwide

Quisma

Spafax

 

Consumer Insight

Kantar:

Added Value

Center Partners

IMRB International

Kantar Health

Kantar Japan

Kantar Media

Kantar Operations

Kantar Retail

Kantar Worldpanel

Lightspeed Research

Millward Brown

  

Consumer Insight (continued)

The Futures Company

TNS

Other marketing consultancies:

Everystone 7

ohal

 

Public Relations & Public Affairs

Blanc & Otus 8

Buchanan Communications

Burston-Marsteller 4

Chime Communications PLC 1

Clarion Communications

Cohn & Wolfe 4

Dewey Square Group

Finsbury

Hill & Knowlton

Ogilvy Government Relations

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide

The PBN Company 1

Penn Schoen Berland 4

Prime Policy Group

Public Strategies 8

Quinn Gillespie

Robinson Lerer & Montgomery 4

Wexler & Walker Public Policy Associates 8

 

Branding & Identity

Addison Corporate Marketing 6

BDGMcColl

BDGworkfutures

Coley Porter Bell

Dovetail

FITCH 6

Lambie-Nairn 6

Landor Associates 4, 6

PeclersParis 6

The Brand Union 6

The Partners 6

VBAT 6

 

Healthcare Communications

Feinstein Kean Healthcare 9

GCI Health

ghg

Ogilvy CommonHealth Worldwide

Sudler & Hennessey 4

 

17


Table of Contents

Direct, Digital, Promotion & Relationship Marketing

A. Eicoff & Co

Actis Systems 5

AGENDA 5

Aqua Online 5

Blast Radius 5

Brierley & Partners 1

Designkitchen 5

Dialogue 141

Digit

EWA

FullSIX 3

Grass Roots 1

G2

    -G2 Branding & Design

    -G2 Interactive

    -G2 Direct & Digital

    -G2 Promotional Marketing

Headcount Worldwide Field Marketing

High Co 1

Kassius 5

KBM Group 5

Mando Brand Assurance

Maxx Marketing

OgilvyAction

OgilvyOne Worldwide

OgilvyAction Sports & Entertainment Marketing

OOT 2

RTCM 4

Smollan Group 1

Studiocom 4

These Days 5

Vice Media 3

VML 4

Wunderman 4

ZAAZ 5

 

Specialist Communications

Corporate/B2B

    Ogilvy Primary Contact

Custom media

    Forward

Demographic marketing

    The Bravo Group 4

    Kang & Lee 4

    MosaicaMD

    UniWorld 1

    WING 4

Employer branding/recruitment

    JWT Inside

Event/face-to-face marketing

    MJM

    Metro

Foodservice marketing

    The Food Group

  

Specialist Communications (continued)

Sports marketing

    PRISM Group

Entertainment marketing

    Alliance

Youth marketing

    The Geppetto Group

Real estate marketing

    Pace

Technology marketing

    Banner Corporation 4

Media & production services

    The Farm Group

    Hogarth Worldwide 2

    Imagina 3

    MRC 3

    The Weinstein Company 3

 

WPP Digital

24/7 Real Media

Blue State Digital

Deliver

Fabric Worldwide 3

iconmobile 1

Johannes Leonardo 3

Possible Worldwide

Syzygy 1

The Media Innovation Group

True Worldwide 3

 

WPP Digital Partner Companies

Ace Metrix 3

Buddy Media 3

eCommera 3

HDT Holdings Technology 3

In Game Ad Interactive 3

Invidi 3

Jumptap 3

LiveWorld 3

Moment Systems 3

Proclivity Systems 3

Say Media 3

Visible Technologies 1

Visible World 3

WildTangent 3

Yield Software 3

 

WPP Knowledge Communities

The Store

 

 

Notes

1     Associate

2     Joint venture

3     Investment

4     A Young & Rubicam Brands company

5     Part of the Wunderman network

6     A member of B to D Group

7     A Brand Union company

8     A Hill & Knowlton company

9     An Ogilvy company

 

18


Table of Contents

D. Property, Plant and Equipment

 

The majority of the Company’s properties are leased, although certain properties which are used mainly for office space are owned. In the United States owned properties include the 370,000 net square foot Young & Rubicam headquarters office building located at 285 Madison Avenue in New York, New York and the 152,000 square foot TNS property located near Toledo, Ohio. Other owned properties are in Latin America (principally in Argentina, Brazil, Chile, Mexico, Peru and Puerto Rico), Asia (India and China) and in Europe (Spain, France, UK and Italy). In Europe owned properties include the 135,626 square foot TNS office located at 2 Rue Francis Pedron, Chambourcy, Paris, France and the 101,592 square foot TNS House at Westgate, Hangar Lane, London. Manufacturing facilities are owned in the United Kingdom. Principal leased properties, which are accounted for as operating leases, include office space at the following locations:

 

Location    Use     
 
Approximate
square footage
  
  

636 Eleventh Avenue, New York, NY

   Ogilvy & Mather      554,800   

498 Seventh Avenue, New York, NY

   GroupM, Mindshare, Maxus,
Mediacom
     358,000   

200 Fifth Avenue, New York, NY

   Grey Global Group, Cohn &
Wolfe
     343,000   

500/550 Town Center Drive, Dearborn, MI

   Team Detroit, JWT, Ogilvy &
Mather, Y&R Advertising,
PRISM, Burrows, ZAAZ
     282,900   

466 Lexington Avenue, New York, NY

   JWT      270,300   

230 Park Ave South, New York, NY

   Burson-Marsteller,

Landor, Sudler & Hennessey

     265,800   

 

The Company considers its properties, owned or leased, to be in good condition and generally suitable and adequate for the purposes for which they are used. As of 31 December 2010, the fixed asset value (cost less depreciation) representing land, freehold buildings and lease-hold buildings as reflected in the Company’s consolidated financial statements was approximately £418.8 million.

 

In 2010 we were able to reduce our property portfolio by almost 4% to 22.8 million sq ft as a result of shedding excess space created by the integration of the custom business of TNS with Research International and, sadly, as a result of the severance program that saw our staff numbers decline by over 12% in 2009.

 

The combination of revenue growth and reduction in portfolio enabled us to reduce the establishment cost-to-revenue ratio from 8.0% in 2009 to 7.0% in 2010, equal to our medium term goal. Average square foot per head fell slightly to 229 sq ft from 230 sq ft in 2009, although our target is to achieve 220 sq ft in 2011.

 

Our key property task is to maintain the 7% establishment cost-to-revenue ratio as we continue to grow the business, by focusing on the key metrics of space per head and cost per square foot on all our lease renewals.

 

See note 3 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a schedule by years of future minimum rental payments to be made and future sublease rental payments to be received, as of 31 December 2010, under non-cancelable operating leases of the Company.

 

ITEM 4A. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

 

Not applicable.

 

19


Table of Contents

ITEM 5. OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS

 

Introduction

 

The Company’s reporting currency is the UK pound sterling. However, the Company’s significant international operations give rise to fluctuations in foreign exchange rates. To neutralise foreign exchange impact and to better illustrate the underlying change in revenue and profit from one year to the next, the Company has adopted the practice of discussing results in both reportable currency (local currency results translated into pounds sterling at the prevailing foreign exchange rate) and constant currency (current and prior year local currency results translated into US dollars at a budget, or “constant”, foreign exchange rate).

 

Certain Non GAAP measures included in this operating and financial review and prospects have been derived from amounts calculated in accordance with IFRS but are not themselves IFRS measures. They should not be viewed in isolation as alternatives to the equivalent IFRS measure, rather they should be read in conjunction with the equivalent IFRS measure. These include headline profit before interest and taxation (PBIT), headline PBIT margin (headline PBIT as a percent of revenues), constant currency, billings, free cash flow, and net and average net debt, which we define, explain the use of and reconcile to the nearest IFRS measure in the operating results overview below and on pages 21 and 28 to 30. In reviewing year on year revenue growth management also uses the measure of like-for-like revenue as discussed on page 21.

 

See Item 11 of this report for Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures about Market Risk.

 

A. Operating Results

 

Overview

 

The Company is one of the world’s most comprehensive marketing communications groups. It operates through a large number of established national, multinational and global advertising and marketing services companies. The Company offers services in four reporting segments:

 

   

Advertising and Media Investment Management;

 

   

Consumer Insight;

 

   

Public Relations & Public Affairs; and

 

   

Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications.

 

In 2010, 40% of the Company’s consolidated revenues were derived from Advertising and Media Investment Management, with the remaining 60% of its revenues being derived from the remaining three segments.

 

The following objectives represent the Group’s key performance indicators.

 

1.   First, to continue to raise operating margins to the levels of the best-performing competition. We achieved headline PBIT margin of 15% for two consecutive years, in 2007 and 2008. We continue to believe a headline PBIT margin of 18.3% is a tough, but realistic objective. BBDO, Dentsu and McCann have achieved this in the past, although the pressure became too great in some instances. Reported PBIT margin in 2010, 2008 and 2007 was 11.0%, 12.3% and 13.7%, respectively.

 

      

Management uses headline PBIT to assess the performance of the business. Management believes that it is both useful and necessary to report headline PBIT because this measure is used by management for internal performance analysis; the presentation of this measure facilitates comparability with other companies who may use similar titled measures, although management’s measure may not be calculated in the same way as similarly titled profit measures reported by

 

20


Table of Contents
 

other companies, and it is useful in connection with discussion with the investment community. A reconciliation of this measure to profit before interest and taxation is provided in note 31 of the Consolidated Financial Statements of the Company, which appear elsewhere in this Form 20-F.

 

2.   Second, to continue to increase flexibility in the cost structure. Great strides have been made in recent years. In 2010, variable staff costs made up 7.8% of revenues, the highest ratio for 10 years. This compares with 6.6% in 2008 and 5.7% in 2009, and illustrates the value of this flexibility in protecting margins in the event of an economic downturn.

 

3.   Third, to improve total share owner return by maximising the return on investment on the Company’s substantial free cash flow across the alternative uses of funds: capital expenditure; mergers and acquisitions; and dividends or share buy-backs.

 

4.   Fourth, we will continue to enhance the value added by the parent company and build unique integrated marketing approaches for clients. WPP is not just a holding company focused on planning, budgeting, reporting and financial issues, but a parent company that can add value to our clients and our people in the areas of human resources, property, procurement, information technology and practice development.

 

5.   Fifth, to continue to place greater emphasis on revenue growth through our practice development activities, aimed at helping us position our portfolio in the faster-growing functional and geographic areas.

 

6.   Sixth, to improve still further the quality of our creative output by stepping up our training and development programs, by recruiting the finest external talent, by celebrating and rewarding outstanding creative success both tangibly and intangibly, by acquiring strong creative companies, and by encouraging, monitoring and promoting our companies’ achievements in winning creative awards.

 

The following discussion is based on the Company’s audited Consolidated Financial Statements beginning on page F-1 of this report. The Group’s consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the IASB.

 

Management reviews the Group’s businesses in constant currency to better illustrate the underlying trends from one year to the next and also on a like-for-like basis, in which current year actual results on a constant currency basis (which include acquisitions from the relevant date of completion) are compared with prior year, constant currency actual results adjusted to include the results of acquisitions for the commensurate period in the prior year. Management believes that discussing like-for-like revenues provides a better understanding of the Company’s revenue performance and trends because it allows for more meaningful comparisons of current period revenue to that of prior periods. The following table reconciles revenue growth for 2010 and 2009 to like-for-like revenue growth for the same periods.

 

       £m                  

2008 Revenue

     7,477                   

Impact of exchange rate changes

     837        11.2        

Changes in scope of consolidation

     976        13.0        

Like-for-like decline

     (606     (8.1 %)         

2009 Revenue

     8,684        16.1        

Impact of exchange rate changes

     159        1.8        

Changes in scope of consolidation

     26        0.3        

Like-for-like growth

     462        5.3        

2010 Revenue

     9,331        7.4        

 

21


Table of Contents

Our reported revenue growth for the year of 7.4% reflected the comparative weakness of sterling against most currencies, other than the euro. On a constant currency basis, which excludes the impact of currency movements, revenues were up 5.6%.

 

On a like-for-like basis, excluding the impact of acquisitions and currency, revenues were up 5.3%, reflecting sequential quarterly improvement throughout the year. Revenue grew by 8.5% in the final quarter, the fastest rate of like-for-like quarterly growth since the fourth quarter of 2000. The month of December saw the first monthly double-digit growth rate since January 2001.

 

Throughout 2010 we have seen continued sequential improvement in our like-for-like quarterly revenue growth, with the final two quarters of the year at 7.5% and 8.5% respectively. This followed zero like-for-like growth in the first quarter and 4.7% in quarter two. This significant turnaround was directionally in line with our earlier forecasts (we anticipated like-for-like growth in the second quarter of 2010 as early as the third quarter trading update of 2009), but was considerably more violent than anticipated. In 2009, our budgets were optimistic anticipating like-for-like growth of - 2%. In fact we came in at - 8%. In 2010, on the other hand, we proved too pessimistic, budgeting like-for-like growth of zero and coming in at over 5%.

 

Segment performance

 

Performance of the Group’s businesses is reviewed by management based on headline PBIT. A table showing these amounts by segment and geographical area for each of the three years ended 31 December 2010 is presented in note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements. To supplement the reportable currency segment information presented in note 2 to the Consolidated Financial Statements, the tables below gives details of revenue growth by region and business segment on a reported, constant currency, and like-for-like basis.

 

       Reported
Revenue
growth %+/(-)
    

Constant
Currency
Revenue

growth %+/(-)

    Like-for-Like
Revenue
Growth %+/(-)
 
       2010     2009      2010      2009     2010      2009  

North America

     9.6        15.6         7.7         (0.7     7.6         (8.1

United Kingdom

     5.7        7.8         5.7         7.8        5.9         (6.0

Western Continental Europe 1

     (0.1     23.9         2.7         12.8        1.9         (10.2

Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe

     13.0        13.6         5.6         4.3        5.6         (6.8

Total Group

     7.4        16.1         5.6         4.9        5.3         (8.1

1     Western Continental Europe Includes Ireland.

               

 

Geographically, revenue growth continued to strengthen in the final quarter, particularly in the UK, Central and Eastern Europe, the Middle East, Latin America, Africa and Australia, with the US and Asia (excluding Australia and New Zealand) maintaining the strong growth seen in the third quarter. Western Continental Europe remained difficult, with growth in the final quarter of just over 3%, with France, Spain, Greece, Ireland and Belgium still under pressure. The US continued the strong growth seen in the third quarter, up 9.8%. The UK showed its strongest growth of the year at 9.7%. Latin America was up 6.5% in the fourth quarter in constant currency, but on a like-for-like basis was up almost 15%, reflecting the disposal of a call centre business in Argentina in September. Asia, excluding Australia and New Zealand, grew at 13.6%, which was the same as the third quarter. Mainland China and India continued their strong growth with revenue up over 18% and almost 15% respectively in the final quarter. Other major markets in Asia also showed strong growth, including South Korea, Singapore, Indonesia and more surprisingly Japan, driven by Ogilvy, GroupM and Kantar. Markets

 

22


Table of Contents

outside North America now account for 65% of our revenues, up from 61% five years ago. The influence of the faster-growing markets outside North America is increasing rapidly.

 

       Reported
Revenue
growth %+/(-)
    

Constant
Currency
Revenue

growth %+/(-)

    Like-for-Like
Revenue
Growth %+/(-)
 
       2010      2009      2010      2009     2010      2009  

Advertising and Media Investment Management

     9.1         0.9         7.0         (8.6     7.1         (8.5

Consumer Insight

     5.8         76.5         4.4         62.9        3.9         (9.5

Public Relations & Public Affairs

     6.1         5.8         4.3         (6.5     3.7         (7.4

Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications

     7.0         6.7         5.0         (4.5     4.5         (6.2

Total Group

     7.4         16.1         5.6         4.9        5.3         (8.1

 

The Group’s Advertising and Media Investment Management businesses continued their strong growth, with constant currency revenues up 11.6% in the fourth quarter, the strongest quarterly growth in the year, with Media Investment Management up over 17% and Advertising up well over 7%.

 

The Group’s Public Relations & Public Affairs businesses also had their strongest quarter, with revenues up 5.6%, compared with 5.1% in the third quarter and 3.2% in the first half. Consumer Insight also had a good quarter, with revenues up 5.3%, compared with 6.9% in the third quarter and 2.7% in the first half. The Group’s Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications businesses (including direct, digital and interactive) grew by 7.3% on a constant currency basis, down slightly on the strong growth of 8.1% in the third quarter, but well ahead of the first half growth of 2.1%. However, on a like-for-like basis, revenues were up 7.2% in the fourth quarter compared with 7.1% in the third quarter, adjusting for the disposal of the call centre business mentioned earlier.

 

This continuing improvement was driven largely by our uniquely global direct, digital and interactive businesses, amongst others comprising OgilvyOne, with global revenues of over $800 million, VML, with revenues over $100 million and Wunderman, with global revenues over $900 million. OgilvyInteractive, VML and Wunderman are three of the seven worldwide ‘digital leaders’, according to the leading independent digital research firm, Forrester Research. No other competitive group has more than one digital leader.

 

The Group has also recently announced the launch of Possible Worldwide, a global interactive marketing agency, formed through the combination of award-winning WPP digital agencies Schematic, Bridge Worldwide, BLUE and Quasar, with revenue of over $100 million, with 18 offices and 1,000 staff worldwide, and with operations in the US, Europe, Asia, the Middle East and Africa.

 

In constant currencies, Advertising and Media Investment Management revenues grew by 7.0%, with like-for-like revenues up similarly at 7.1%. All of the Group’s four largest advertising networks finished the year strongly, with growth in our Media Investment Management business over 13% in the year. Advertising showed sequential quarterly like-for-like growth in the last three quarters of 2010, following six quarters of decline. This strong revenue growth in 2010, together with the cost actions taken in 2009, resulted in the combined headline PBIT margin of this sector improving by approximately 1.5 margin points to 15.3%.

 

Consumer Insight revenues grew by 4.4% in constant currencies, with like-for-like revenues up similarly at 3.9%. Headline PBIT margins improved by 1.1 margin points to 9.7% as benefits resulting from the integration of TNS custom research and Research International and the other operations of both TNS and Kantar, in media, healthcare, retail and their related panel activities, were realised. Headline PBIT gross margins (headline PBIT as a proportion of gross profit rather than revenue) improved 1.5 margin points to 13.2%.

 

23


Table of Contents

The Group’s Public Relations & Public Affairs businesses had a strong end to the year, with constant currency revenue growth of 5.6% in quarter four, the highest quarter of the year. Headline PBIT margins rose by 0.5 margin points to 15.8%. Particularly strong performances were recorded by Burson-Marsteller and the Group’s specialist public relations businesses.

 

The Group’s Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications (including direct, digital and interactive) constant currency revenues grew by 5.0% in the year and 7.3% in the final quarter. The Group’s global direct, digital and interactive agencies grew strongly, as did Branding & Identity with revenue up almost 11% in the final quarter. This service sector showed a strong recovery in headline PBIT margins, up 2.0 margin points to 12.4%.

 

Marketing services comprised 60% of our revenues in 2010, a similar proportion to 2009. It is no longer accurate to call us an advertising agency, we are really a communications services company.

 

2010 compared with 2009

 

Revenues

 

Reported revenues were up 7.4% in 2010 to £9,331.0 million from £8,684.3 million in 2009. On a constant currency basis revenues were up 5.6% and on a like-for-like basis revenues were up 5.3%, see discussion on pages 22 to 24. In 2010 and 2009, acquisitions completed during the year had an immaterial impact on revenue.

 

Operating costs

 

Reported operating costs increased by 5.1%. Reported staff costs, excluding incentives, were up 3.2%. Incentive payments (including the cost of share-based compensation) increased 92.1% to £342 million from £178 million. On a reported basis, despite the almost doubling of incentive payments, the Group’s staff cost-to-revenue ratio fell to 58.3% compared with 58.9% in 2009.

 

Together with the improved top-line growth, the Group has benefited from the cost actions taken, particularly towards the end of 2009, to adjust headcount and staff costs. On a like-for-like basis, average headcount has fallen by over 4%, compared with 2009, although given the substantial increase in like-for-like revenues of 8.0% in the second half of the year, our operating companies have begun to invest in more talent.

 

Revenue conversion post-incentives, that is incremental profit as a proportion of incremental revenue, was very strong at 33%, as our operating companies benefited from the actions to reduce both staff costs and other operating costs in 2009 and during 2010.

 

Part of the Group’s strategy is to continue to ensure that variable staff costs (incentives, freelance and consultants costs) are a significant proportion of total staff costs and revenue, as this provides flexibility to deal with volatility in revenues and recessions or slow-downs. In 2010, the ratio of variable staff costs to total staff costs increased significantly to 13.4%, compared with 9.7% in 2009. As a proportion of revenue, variable staff costs were 7.8% in 2010 compared with 5.7% in 2009. These represent the highest ratios in the last 10 years. The business is, therefore, even better protected against economic downturns.

 

Operating profit

 

Reported PBIT rose over 25% to £1.028 billion in 2010 from £819 million in 2009 as a result of the above and reflecting a lower charge for goodwill impairment and amortisation of intangibles, partly offset by higher investment write-downs.

 

24


Table of Contents

Finance income, finance costs and revaluation of financial instruments

 

Finance income decreased to £81.7 million in 2010 from £150.4 million in 2009. Finance costs decreased to £276.8 million in 2010 from £355.4 million in 2009. Therefore, net finance costs were £195.1 million, down from £205.0 million last year, reflecting lower debt, partly offset by higher funding costs. Revaluation of financial instruments resulted in £18.2 million of income in 2010 and £48.9 million in 2009. The 2010 income is attributable to gains from movements in the fair value of treasury instruments.

 

Taxes

 

The Company’s effective tax rate on reported profit before tax in 2010 was 22.4%, a reduction of 1.1 percentage points from 2009, as a result of utilisation and recognition of losses and other temporary differences not previously recognised.

 

Profit for the year

 

Profit for the year increased by 30.4% to £661.0 million in 2010 from £506.9 million in 2009 on a reported basis and increased by 23.7% in constant currency, reflecting higher profit margins and lower effective tax rate. In 2010, £586.0 million of profit for the year was attributable to equity holders of the parent and £75.0 million attributable to non-controlling interests.

 

2009 compared with 2008

 

Revenues

 

Reported revenues were up 16.1% in 2009 to £8,684.3 million from £7,476.9 million in 2008 reflecting the strength of the euro and US dollar against sterling, as well as the impact of the first full-year inclusion of TNS in our results. On a constant currency basis revenues were up 4.9% and on a like-for-like basis revenues were down 8.1%, as detailed in the table on page 21. In 2009, acquisitions completed during the year had an immaterial impact on revenue. In 2008, acquisitions completed during the year contributed £376.3 million to revenue (£269.6 million was related to TNS).

 

Operating costs

 

Reported operating costs increased by 17.7%. Reported staff costs, excluding incentives, were up 19.4%. Incentive payments (including the cost of share-based compensation) fell by almost 17% to £177.8 million from £213.7 million. The Group’s staff cost to revenue ratio increased to 58.9% compared with 58.2% in 2008. Part of the Group’s strategy is to continue to ensure that variable staff costs (freelancers, consultants and incentive payments) are a significant proportion of total staff costs, as this provides flexibility to deal with volatility in revenues and recessions or slow-downs. In 2009, the ratio of variable staff costs to total staff costs fell to 9.7% compared with 11.4% in 2008. As a proportion of revenue, variable staff costs were 5.7% in 2009 compared with 6.6% in 2008.

 

Establishment costs as a proportion of revenues were 8.0% in 2009 compared to 7.0% in 2008. 2009 was a difficult year with our property portfolio. We were able to reduce it by 4% to 23.7 million sq. feet however it was not possible to adjust the property portfolio in line with the recession.

 

Goodwill impairment charges of £44.3 million and £84.1 million were recorded in the years ended 31 December 2009 and 2008, respectively. The impairment charges relate to certain under performing businesses in the Group. In certain markets, the impact of current local economic conditions and trading circumstances on these businesses was sufficiently severe to indicate impairment to the carrying value of goodwill. There were no impairment charges on acquired intangible assets in 2009. In 2008, an impairment charge was recorded for £1.5 million. Investment write-downs of £11.1 million and

 

25


Table of Contents

£30.5 million were taken in the years ended 31 December 2009 and 2008, respectively. Intangible amortisation in 2009 increased by £94.2 million compared to 2008 due to a full year of amortisation related to intangibles established in connection with the acquisition of TNS.

 

The Group released £19.4 million in 2009 to operating profit relating to excess provisions and other balances established in respect of acquisitions completed prior to 2008 and £23.7 million in 2008 related to acquisitions completed prior to 2007.

 

Operating profit

 

Reported operating profit was down 13.0% to £761.7 million in 2009 from £876.0 million in 2008. Reported operating margins decreased to 8.8% from 11.7%. Reported profit before interest and taxation (“PBIT”) was £818.7 million in 2009, down 11.2% from £922.0 million in 2008. Reported PBIT margins were 9.4% and 12.3% in 2009 and 2008, respectively. PBIT margins were negatively impacted by 2.6% in both years due to goodwill impairment, other goodwill and investment write-downs, and amortisation and impairment of acquired intangibles in each year. While the goodwill impairment charge in 2009 was lower by £39.8 million compared with 2008 and investment write-downs were lower by £19.4 million compared with 2008, intangibles amortisation in 2009 was higher by £94.2 million due to a full year of amortisation related to intangibles established in connection with the TNS acquisition. The impact of profits on disposal of investments was £31.1 million in 2009 and £3.4 million in 2008. Headline PBIT margin was 11.7% in 2009 against 15.0% last year. For 2009, the post-acquisition contribution of all acquisitions to the Group’s operating profit was immaterial. For 2008 it was £30.3 million.

 

Finance income, finance costs and revaluation of financial instruments

 

Finance income decreased to £150.4 million in 2009 from £169.6 million in 2008. Finance costs increased to £355.4 million in 2009 from £319.4 million in 2008. Therefore, net finance costs increased by £55.2 million, reflecting lower interest rates and higher average net debt as a result of the full year impact of the acquisition of TNS. Revaluation of financial instruments resulted in £48.9 million of income in 2009 and a charge of £25.4 million in 2008. The 2009 income is predominantly attributable to gains on termination of hedge accounting on repayment of TNS debt.

 

Taxes

 

The Company’s effective tax rate on reported profit before tax in 2009 was 23.5% compared to 31.2% in 2008. In 2008 there were significant expenses that were not deductible for tax purposes. In 2009 these expenses, such as goodwill impairment, were lower and were offset by other income that was not taxable such as the gain on disposal of investment and income attributable to the revaluation of financial instruments.

 

Profit for the year

 

Profit for the year decreased by 1.3% to £506.9 million in 2009 from £513.9 million in 2008 on a reported basis and decreased by 14.2% in constant currency, reflecting lower profit margins partially offset by lower tax expense. In 2009, £437.7 million of profit for the year was attributable to equity holders of the parent and £69.2 million attributable to non-controlling interests.

 

Inflation

 

As in 2009, in management’s opinion inflation did not have a material impact on the Company’s results for the year or financial position at 31 December 2010.

 

26


Table of Contents

Foreign currency fluctuations

 

See Item 11 for a discussion of the impact of currency exchange rate fluctuations on the Group’s consolidated results.

 

B. Liquidity and Capital Resources

 

General —The primary sources of funds for the Group are cash generated from operations and funds available under its credit facilities. The primary uses of cash funds in recent years have been for debt service and repayment, capital expenditures, acquisitions, share repurchases and cancellations and dividends. For a breakdown of the Company’s sources and uses of cash see the “Consolidated Cash Flow Statement” included as part of the Company’s Consolidated Financial Statements in Item 18 of this Report.

 

The Company spent £295.9 million (excluding cash and cash equivalents acquired) and £196.6 million for acquisitions and investments in 2010 and 2009, respectively, including payments on loan note redemptions and earnout consideration resulting from acquisitions in prior years. For the same periods, cash spent on purchases of property, plant and equipment and other intangible assets was £217.5 million and £253.3 million, respectively, cash spent on share repurchases and buy-backs was £46.4 million and £9.5 million, respectively, and dividends paid were £200.4 million and £189.8 million, respectively.

 

There are broadly three alternative uses of funds.

 

Capital expenditure, which usually approximates the depreciation cost. Pressure here has eased as technology pricing has fallen, although we are increasing investment in our digital and technology-based service offering, in line with our strategic goals. In 2009, we also invested significantly more in real estate following lease renewals, particularly in New York, to secure greater efficiencies.

 

Mergers and acquisitions, which have historically taken the lion’s share of free cash flow. Here we have raised the hurdle rate on capital employed so that our return on capital may be increased. Valuations remain reasonable, particularly outside the US, although some speculative froth does seem to have developed, especially in digital and interactive in the US and in some faster-growing markets, like Brazil. Our acquisition focus in 2010 was again on the triplet opportunities of faster-growing geographic markets, new technologies and consumer insights, totally consistent with our strategic priorities in the areas of geography, new communication services and measurability. The cost of the acquisition of TNS in 2008 was funded principally by debt. At the time of the transaction, we announced that, for the following two years, acquisitions would be limited to no more than £100 million per annum, the Group’s share buy-back program would be targeted up to 1% per annum and dividend growth at up to 15% per annum, with the objective of using surplus cash generated to reduce debt. In 2010, the Group spent £97 million on initial acquisition payments, net of cash acquired and disposal proceeds, so within the target set. It is likely we will continue to focus on small and medium-sized acquisitions in 2011.

 

Dividends or share buy-backs. We continue to focus on examining the relative merits of dividends and share buy-backs. Following the strong first half results in 2010, we re-instituted an increase in dividend with a 15% increase in the first interim dividend, the upper limit committed to at the time of the TNS acquisition. Following the continued improvement in profitability during the second half of 2010, the Board has also recommended an increase in the second interim dividend of 15%. This makes a total for the year of 17.79p per share, an all-time high for your Company. Dividends paid in 2010 were more than 3 times covered by profit for the year. The Board has also undertaken a review of its dividend pay-out policy and consulted institutional share owners and analysts. It seems clear from this analysis that in current stock market conditions, many share owners favour consistent dividend growth

 

27


Table of Contents

and better dividend yields over share re-purchases. Given these views, the Board plans to increase the dividend payout ratio as a proportion of post-tax profits from the current level of approximately 30% to approximately 40% over the medium term. Share buy-backs in 2010 cost £46 million, representing 0.5% of share capital, again well within the target set at the time of the TNS acquisition. It is likely that we will continue to ensure that share buy-backs at least equal the dilutive effect of option and restricted stock issuance.

 

The Group’s liquidity is affected primarily by the working capital flows associated with its media buying activities on behalf of clients. The working capital movements relate primarily to the Group’s billings. Billings comprise the gross amounts billed to clients in respect of commission-based/fee-based income together with the total of other fees earned. In 2010, billings were £42.7 billion, or 4.6 times the revenue of the Group. The inflows and outflows associated with media buying activity therefore represent significant cash flow within each month of the year and are forecast and re-forecast on a regular basis throughout the year by the Group’s treasury staff so as to ensure that there is continuing coverage of peak requirements through committed borrowing facilities from the Group’s bankers and other sources.

 

Liquidity risk management —The Group manages liquidity risk by ensuring continuity and flexibility of funding even in difficult market conditions. Undrawn committed borrowing facilities are maintained in excess of peak net borrowing levels and debt maturities are closely monitored. Targets for debt and cash position are set on an annual basis and, to assist in meeting this, working capital targets are set for all the Group’s major operations. See the discussions on pages 29 and 30 for the Group’s view on the use of net debt and average net debt to measure debt levels.

 

Debt

 

US$ bonds —The Group has in issue $600 million of 8% bonds due September 2014 and $650 million of 5.875% bonds due June 2014.

 

Eurobonds —The Group has in issue 600 million of 4.375% bonds due December 2013, 500 million of 5.25% bonds due January 2015 and 750 million of 6.625% bonds due May 2016.

 

Sterling bond s—The Group has in issue £400 million of 6% bonds due April 2017 and £200 million of 6.375% bonds due November 2020.

 

Revolving Credit Facilities —The Group has a $1.6 billion seven-year Revolving Credit Facility due August 2012 and a £200 million amortising Revolving Credit Facility maturing in July 2011. The Group’s borrowing under these facilities, which are drawn down predominantly in US dollars, euros, Canadian dollars and pounds sterling, averaged the equivalent of $818 million in 2010. The Group had available undrawn committed credit facilities of £1,145 million at 31 December 2010 (2009: £1,335 million).

 

Borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facilities are governed by certain financial covenants based on the results and financial position of the Group, including requirements that (i) the interest coverage ratio for each financial period equal or exceed 5.0 to 1 and (ii) the ratio of borrowed funds to earnings before interest, taxes, depreciation and amortisation at 30 June and 31 December in each year shall not exceed 3.5 to 1, both covenants as defined in the relevant agreement. The Group is in compliance with both covenants.

 

US Commercial Paper Program —The Group has a $1.4 billion US Commercial Paper Program using the $1.6 billion Revolving Credit Facility as a backstop. There was no US Commercial Paper outstanding at 31 December 2010.

 

28


Table of Contents

Convertible bonds —The Group has in issue £450 million of 5.75% convertible bonds due May 2014. At the option of the holder, the bonds are convertible into 76,530,612 WPP ordinary shares at an initial share price of £5.88 per share.

 

Hedging of financial instruments —The Group’s policy on interest rate and foreign exchange rate management sets out the instruments and methods available to hedge interest and currency risk exposures and the control procedures in place to ensure effectiveness. The Group uses derivative financial instruments to reduce exposure to foreign exchange risk and interest rate movements. The Group does not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for speculative purposes.

 

The Group bases its internal cash flow objectives on free cash flow. Management believes free cash flow is meaningful to investors because it is the measure of our funds available for acquisition-related payments, dividends to shareowners, share repurchases and debt repayment. The purpose of presenting free cash flow is to indicate the ongoing cash generation within the control of the Group after taking account of the necessary cash expenditures of maintaining the capital and operating structure of the Group (in the form of payments of interest, corporate taxation and capital expenditure). Net working capital movements are excluded from this measure since these are principally associated with our media buying activities on behalf of clients and are not necessarily within the control of the Group. This computation may not be comparable to that of similarly titled measures presented by other companies.

 

A tabular reconciliation of free cash flow is shown below.

 

       Year Ended 31 December  
      

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

   

2008

£m

 

Net cash inflow from operating activities

     1,361.2        818.8        922.7   

Issue of shares

     42.7        4.1        10.6   

Proceeds on disposal of treasury shares

     —          —          6.9  

Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment

     7.6        9.2        11.5   

Movements in working capital and provisions

     (225.5     102.1        109.3   

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

     (190.5     (222.9     (196.8

Purchase of other intangible assets (including capitalised computer software)

     (27.0     (30.4     (23.8

Dividends paid to non-controlling shareholders in subsidiary undertakings

     (66.7     (63.0     (63.5

Free cash flow

     901.8        617.9        776.9   

 

In 2010, net cash inflow from operating activities was £1,361.2 million. Free cash flow available for debt repayment, acquisitions, share buy-backs and dividends was £901.8 million. This free cash flow was partially absorbed by £215.2 million in net acquisitions and disposals, by £46.4 million in share repurchases and buy-backs and of £200.4 million in dividends, leaving £439.8 million, of free cash flow.

 

Management believes that net debt and average net debt is an appropriate and meaningful measure of the debt levels within the Group. This is because of the seasonal swings in our working capital generally, and those resulting from our media buying activities on behalf of our clients in particular, together with the fact that we choose for commercial reasons to locate the debt of the Group in particular countries and leave cash resources in others—though our cash resources could be used to repay the debt concerned. Average net debt is calculated as the average daily net borrowings of the

 

29


Table of Contents

Group and is a more accurate reflection of the amount of debt the Group has supporting its activities through the year. Net debt at a period end is calculated as the sum of the net borrowings of the Group, derived from the cash ledgers and accounts in the balance sheet.

 

The following table is an analysis of net debt.

 

       At 31 December  
      

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

   

2008

£m

 

Debt financing

     (3,853.6     (4,307.1     (5,640.1

Cash and short-term deposits

     1,965.2        1,666.7        2,572.5   

Net debt

     (1,888.4     (2,640.4     (3,067.6

 

At 31 December 2010, the Group’s net debt was £1,888 million, down £752 million from £2,640 million in 2009. Net debt averaged £3,056 million in 2010, against £3,448 million in 2009, down £0.4 billion at 2010 exchange rates, reflecting significant improvement in profitability and improved cash flows, despite a continued client emphasis on improved liquidity, as well as effectiveness and efficiency.

 

The Company’s borrowings are evenly distributed between fixed and floating rate debt. Given the strong cash generation of the business, its debt maturity profile and available facilities, the directors believe the Company has sufficient liquidity to match its requirements for the foreseeable future.

 

Refer to Item 5F for details on the Company’s material commitments for capital expenditures at 31 December 2010.

 

C. Research and Development, Patents and Licenses

 

Not applicable.

 

D. Trend Information

 

The discussion below and in the rest of this Item 5 includes forward-looking statements regarding plans, objectives, projections and anticipated future performance based on assumptions that are subject to risks and uncertainties. As such, actual results or outcomes may differ materially from those discussed in the forward-looking statements. See “Forward-Looking Statements” preceding Item 1 in this annual report.

 

In the first quarter of 2011, reported revenues were up 7.0% at £2.223 billion. Revenues in constant currency were up 8.4%, reflecting the strength of the pound sterling against the US dollar and Euro. On a like-for-like basis, excluding the impact of acquisitions and currency fluctuations, revenues were up 6.7% and gross profit 7.4% compared with the same period last year. Revenues have continued to recover following the stabilisation in quarter one of last year and the sequential improvement in like-for-like growth in quarters two, three and four of 2010.

The pattern of revenue growth in 2011 has started similarly to the second half of 2010, with improvements across all sectors and geographies. Our budgets for 2011 indicated like-for-like growth of 5% over last year and for the first three months we were in line with those projections. A first look at our flash quarter one revised forecasts, indicates further improvement for the year to over 6%, with a more balanced pattern over the two halves, despite tougher comparatives in the second half. In 2010 we were surprised at the speed of the recovery in the more mature markets of the United States and

Germany and more traditional media, like free-to-air television. This pattern has continued into the first

 

30


Table of Contents

quarter of 2011, although as indicated in the budgets for this year, the faster growing markets of Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa and the Middle East and Central and Eastern Europe are growing even faster. They were last into the recession and last out.

On a constant currency basis, the Group’s revenue grew by 8.4%, in line with the Group’s budget, but with gross profit, probably a better indicator of top-line growth and cost comparator, growing faster at 9.1%. In 2010, the United States behaved more like a faster growing market, with constant currency growth of 8.0%. In the first quarter of 2011 this has continued, with revenue on the same basis up 9.1% and only slightly below the third quarter of 2010, which saw the highest quarterly growth since the second quarter of 2007, at 9.9%. However, the world continues to move at very different speeds, with the BRICs (Brazil, Russia, India and China), Next 11 (Bangladesh, Egypt, Indonesia, Iran (?), Mexico, Nigeria, Pakistan, the Philippines, South Korea, Turkey, Vietnam) or CIVETS (Columbia, Indonesia, Vietnam, Egypt (still included), Turkey, South Africa) generally growing strongest, followed by the United States and Germany, then the United Kingdom, France, Italy and Spain with Japan, weakest, suffering from years of stagnation and now triple hit by the dreadful earthquake, tsunami and nuclear disasters. In the first quarter, revenue growth in the United Kingdom, on a constant currency basis, was up 7.7% with Western Continental Europe up 2.2% and Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa and the Middle East and Central and Eastern Europe growing strongly at 12.6%. Western Continental Europe remains the most challenging, with revenues in France and Spain the most affected, when compared with the same period last year. The Middle East has been affected by the current political turmoil in the first quarter, growing only 1.5%. Central and Eastern Europe grew at 9.1%, driven primarily by Russia and Poland, with the combined revenues in these two markets up over 13%. Latin America grew 10.4% on a constant currency basis, but 16.7%, like-for-like, following the disposal of a call centre business in Argentina in September 2010. Asia Pacific was up 12.5% on a constant currency basis and excluding Japan (which was flat) was up 13.8%, with all the Group’s major markets, except Malaysia, showing strong growth. Two of the Group’s biggest markets in Asia, Mainland China and India showed combined growth of 18.4%, versus 12.5% in 2010.

By communications services sector, Advertising and Media Investment Management continued to “bite-back” with revenues on a constant currency basis up 12.9%, followed by Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications (including direct, digital and interactive) up 7.9%. The Group’s direct and interactive networks of Wunderman and OgilvyOne, together with specialist digital agencies VML and JWT Inside showed strong growth. Public Relations & Public affairs continued the solid performance in 2010, with growth of 5.6%, which was slightly ahead of quarter four in 2010, the highest quarterly growth in 2010. Consumer Insight revenues were up 3.4% with gross profit up more at 3.6% (3.8% like-for-like), and with North America, the United Kingdom and Western Continental Europe weaker, but stronger growth in Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa and the Middle East, despite the current political and human challenges in North Africa, the Middle East and Japan.

The Company is in the process of reviewing its quarter one revised forecasts, but early indications are that revenues in the balance of the year will grow faster than budgeted, with full year like-for-like revenue growth of over 6%. The higher levels of incentive compensation paid out this year has focused attention on variable, rather than fixed, compensation and has helped to ease, to some extent, potential pressure on salaries. As our operating companies continue to be more positive about 2011, the increase in selective hiring and talent investment, particularly in the faster growing markets, originally seen in the second half of 2010, has continued into 2011.

During 2009 the Group took action to bring into balance the fall in revenues with staff costs, with a significant reduction in the number of people employed in the Group. As revenues stabilised towards the end of 2009 and growth returned in 2010, our operating companies began hiring again, although as mentioned above, mainly in the faster growing markets. Although hiring has begun again, the discipline of balancing revenues with headcount has continued. The number of people in the Group, on a like-for-

 

31


Table of Contents

like basis excluding associates, was up 4.2% or 4,350 at 31 March 2011 to 106,825, as compared to 31 March 2010, against an increase in revenues on the same basis of 6.7%. The average number of people in the Group in the first quarter of this year was up similarly by 4.2% to 106,076 compared to 101,763 for the same period last year. In 2009, the point-to-point headcount fell by 12%, in 2010 it rose 4.5% and in 2011, by 31 March, it had risen another 1%. Overall, therefore, the number of people in the business has fallen by over 6%, whilst revenues are now back to pre-Lehman levels on a like-for-like basis, a significant increase in productivity.

For the rest of 2011, the focus will continue to be on ensuring that our operating companies balance revenue and headcount growth, while at the same time capitalising on the various client and market opportunities that continue to arise and continuing to invest in both existing and new talent, where necessary.

Despite the recent developments and effect of the difficult political and human situations in the Middle East, North Africa and Japan (as a point of reference, the Middle East accounts for about 1.7% or $300 million of our approximately $16 billion of revenues forecast by analysts and Japan about 1.5% or $200 million), the continued doubts about sovereign debt in some Western European economies and the growing concerns in the United States about the failure to reduce the fiscal deficit, where the recent US Treasury purchase strike by PIMCO and US debt change in outlook by S&P have not helped, we are cautiously optimistic about the prospects for 2011 and, indeed for 2012.

The second quarter, according to our budgets and quarter one revised forecasts, shows stronger growth in Asia Pacific and Latin America, counter-balanced by lower growth in the United States, with these trends, as anticipated earlier this year, continuing into the final two quarters of 2011. 2012 will see the maxi-quadrennial impacts of the London 2012 Olympic and Paralympic Games, the Eastern European-based UEFA EURO 2012 Football Championships and United States Presidential elections (where media spending may reach $4 billion), all of which may add 1-2% to worldwide levels of advertising and marketing spending, whatever they are. It may be that to some extent we benefit from uncertainty, particularly in the mature economies, where risk averse managements prefer to invest in brand equity, rather than expand capacity. In addition, there are some indications that FMCG clients, lacking pricing power and facing commodity price increases, are decreasing promotional price discounts and increasing investment in advertising. The difficult year may well be 2013, when newly elected or re-elected governments have to wrestle with the impact of fiscal and monetary stimuli and the failure to deal quickly enough with fiscal deficits.

 

E. Off-Balance Sheet Arrangements

 

None.

 

32


Table of Contents

F. Tabular Disclosure of Contractual Obligations

 

The following summarises the Company’s estimated contractual obligations at 31 December 2010, and the effect such obligations are expected to have on its liquidity and cash flows in the future periods. Certain obligations presented below held by one subsidiary of the Company may be guaranteed by another subsidiary in the ordinary course of business.

 

                Payments due in  
(£m)    Total      2011      2012      2013      2014      2015      Beyond
2015
 

Debt financing under the Revolving Credit Facility and in relation to unsecured loan notes 1

  

        

Eurobonds

     1,585.9         —           —           514.4         —           428.6         642.9   

Sterling and convertible bonds

     1,050.0         —           —           —           450.0         —           600.0   

US$ bonds

     801.7         —           —           —           801.7         —           —     

Other

     116.4         —           100.3         —           16.1         —           —     

Subtotal

     3,554.0         —           100.3         514.4         1,267.8         428.6         1,242.9   

Interest payable

     966.7         209.4         208.4         206.7         148.5         81.2         112.5   

Total

     4,520.7         209.4         308.7         721.1         1,416.3         509.8         1,355.4   

Operating leases 2

     2,272.6         354.6         293.5         268.1         219.8         202.6         934.0   

Capital commitments 3

     40.7         32.6         8.1         —           —           —           —     

Investment commitments 3

     24.9         23.1         1.8         —           —           —           —     

Estimated obligations under acquisition earnouts and put option agreements

     446.3         344.3         46.6         16.8         8.6         4.1         25.9   

Total contractual obligations

     7,305.2         964.0         658.7         1,006.0         1,644.7         716.5         2,315.3   

 

1    

In addition to debt financing under the Revolving Credit Facility and in relation to unsecured loan notes, the Company had short-term overdrafts at 31 December 2010 of £255.4 million. The Group’s net debt at 31 December 2010 was £1,888.4 million and is analysed in Item 5B.

2    

Operating leases are net of sub-let rentals.

3    

Capital and investment commitments include commitments contracted, but not provided for in respect of property, plant and equipment and in respect of interests in associates and other investments, respectively.

 

The Company expects to make annual contributions to its funded defined benefit plans, as determined in line with local conditions and practices. Contributions in respect of unfunded plans are paid as they fall due. The total contributions (for funded plans) and benefit payments (for unfunded plans) paid for 2010 amounted to £53.3 million (2009: £47.7 million, 2008: £44.2 million). Employer contributions and benefit payments in 2011 are expected to be in the range of £40 million to £60 million depending on the performance of the assets. Projections for years after 2011 are subject to a number of factors, including future asset performance and changes in assumptions which mean the Company is unable to make sufficiently reliable estimations of future contributions.

 

Use of Estimates

 

The preparation of financial statements requires management to make estimates, judgements and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of assets and liabilities and disclosure of contingencies at the date of the financial statements, and the reported amounts of revenues and expenses during the reporting period. Actual results could differ materially from those estimates.

 

Critical Accounting Policies

 

The Company’s financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS. A summary of the Group’s principal accounting policies are described in the Accounting Policies section of the Financial Statements. The Company believes certain of these accounting policies are particularly critical to understanding the more significant judgements and estimates used in the preparation of its

 

33


Table of Contents

consolidated financial statements. Therefore, we have prepared the following supplemental discussion of critical accounting policies, which should be read together with our financial statements and notes thereto.

 

Goodwill and other intangibles

 

The Company has a significant amount of goodwill and other intangible assets. The Company initially tests the carrying value of goodwill and other indefinite lived intangible assets for impairment annually at 30 June of each year, and then updates the review at 31 December or whenever there is an indication of impairment.

 

Under IFRS, an impairment charge is required for both goodwill and other indefinite lived assets when the carrying amount exceeds the ‘recoverable amount’, defined as the higher of fair value less costs to sell and value in use. Our approach in determining the recoverable amount utilises a discounted cash flow methodology, which necessarily involves making numerous estimates and assumptions regarding revenue growth, operating margins, appropriate discount rates and working capital requirements. These estimates will likely differ from future actual results of operations and cash flows, and it is possible that these differences could be material. In addition, judgements are applied in determining the level of cash-generating unit we identify for impairment testing and the criteria we use to determine which assets should be aggregated. A difference in testing levels could affect whether an impairment is recorded and the extent of an impairment loss. Changes in our business activities or structure may also result in changes to the level of testing in future periods. Further, future events could cause the Company to conclude that impairment indicators exist and that the asset values associated with a given operation have become impaired. Any resulting impairment loss could have a material impact on the Company’s financial condition and results of operations.

 

Historically our impairment losses have resulted from a specific event, condition or circumstance in one of our companies, such as the loss of a significant client. As a result, changes in the assumptions used in our impairment model have not had a significant effect on the impairment charges recognised. The carrying value of goodwill and other intangible assets will continue to be reviewed at least annually for impairment and adjusted to the recoverable amount if required.

 

The most significant assumptions employed by the Company in determining recoverable amounts are as follows:

 

   

Future cashflows derived from each cash-generating unit are based on a projection period of up to five years. These projections utilise the latest budget information available for each cash-generating unit covering one or more twelve month periods from the balance sheet date. These budgets have been prepared by management;

 

   

After the projection period, an assumed annual long-term growth rate of 3%, with no improvements in operating margins. Management have made the judgement that this long-term growth rate does not exceed the long-term growth rate for the industry; and

 

   

The net present value of the future cash flows was discounted by using a pre-tax discount rate of 9.58%.

 

Acquisition accounting

 

The Group accounts for acquisitions in accordance with IFRS 3 (revised) ‘Business Combinations’. IFRS 3 (revised) requires the acquiree’s identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities (other than non-current assets or disposal groups held for sale) to be recognised at fair value at acquisition date. In assessing fair value at acquisition date, management make their best estimate of the likely

 

34


Table of Contents

outcome where the fair value of an asset or liability may be contingent on a future event. In certain instances, the underlying transaction giving rise to an estimate may not be resolved until some years after the acquisition date. IFRS 3 (revised) requires the release to profit of any acquisition reserves which subsequently become excess in the same way as any excess costs over those provided at acquisition date are charged to profit. At each period end management assess provisions and other balances established in respect of acquisitions for their continued probability of occurrence and amend the relevant value accordingly through the consolidated income statement or as an adjustment to goodwill as appropriate under IFRS 3 (revised). In 2010, operating profit includes credits totaling £16.5 million (2009: £19.4 million, 2008: £23.7 million) relating to the release of excess provisions and other balances established in respect of acquisitions completed prior to 2009.

 

Future anticipated payments to vendors in respect of contingent consideration (earnout agreements) are initially recorded at fair value which is the present value of the expected cash outflows of the obligations. The obligations are dependent on the future financial performance of the interests acquired (typically over a four to five year period following the year of acquisition) and assume the operating companies improve profits in line with directors’ estimates. The directors derive their estimates from internal business plans together with financial due diligence performed in connection with the acquisition. Subsequent adjustments to the fair value are recorded in the consolidated income statement within revaluation of financial instruments. For acquisitions completed prior to 1 January 2010, such adjustments are recorded in the consolidated balance sheet within goodwill. A summary of earnout related obligations included in creditors is shown in note 19 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

WPP has also entered into option agreements that allow the Group’s equity partners to require the Group to purchase the non-controlling interest. These agreements are treated as derivatives over equity instruments and are recorded in the consolidated balance sheet at fair value and the valuation is remeasured at each period end. Fair value is based on the present value of expected cash outflows and the movement in the fair value is recognised as income or expense within revaluation of financial instruments in the consolidated income statement.

 

Actual performance may differ from the assumptions used resulting in amounts ultimately paid out with respect to these earnout and option agreements at more or less than the recorded liabilities.

 

Revenue recognition

 

Advertising and Media Investment Management revenue is typically derived from commissions on media placements and fees for advertising services. Revenue may consist of various arrangements involving commissions, fees, incentive-based revenue or a combination of the three, as agreed upon with each client.

 

Revenue is recognised when the service is performed, in accordance with the terms of the contractual arrangement. Incentive-based revenue typically comprises both quantitative and qualitative elements; on the element related to quantitative targets, revenue is recognised when the quantitative targets have been achieved; on the element related to qualitative targets, revenue is recognised when the incentive is received or receivable.

 

The Group receives volume rebates from certain suppliers for transactions entered into on behalf of clients that, based on the terms of the relevant contracts and local law, are either remitted to clients or retained by the Group. If amounts are passed on to clients they are recorded as liabilities until settled or, if retained by the Group, are recorded as revenue when earned.

 

In applying the proportional performance method of revenue recognition for both market research and other long-term contracts, management is required to make significant judgements, estimates and

 

35


Table of Contents

assumptions. In assessing contract performance, both input and output criteria are reviewed. Costs incurred are used as an objective input measure of performance. The primary input of all work performed under these arrangements is labour. As a result of the relationship between labour and cost, there is normally a direct relationship between costs incurred and the proportion of the contract performed to date. Costs incurred as a proportion of expected total costs is used as an initial proportional performance measure. The indicative proportional performance measure is subsequently validated against other more subjective criteria (i.e. relevant output measures) such as the percentage of interviews completed, percentage of reports delivered to a client and the achievement of any project milestones stipulated in the contract. In the event of divergence between the objective and more subjective measures, the more subjective measures takes precedence since these are output measures.

 

Since project costs can vary from initial estimates, the reliance on total project cost estimate represents an uncertainty inherent in the revenue recognition process. Individual project budgets are reviewed regularly with project leaders to ensure that cost estimates are based upon up to date and as accurate information as possible, and take into account any relevant historic performance experience. Also, the majority of contracted services subject to proportional performance method revenue recognition are in relation to short term projects, averaging approximately 3 months. Due to this close and frequent monitoring of budgeted costs and the preponderance of short term projects, the impact of variances between actual and budgeted project costs has historically been minimal. The Company does not believe that the effect of these uncertainties, taken as a whole, will significantly impact their results of operations in the future.

 

Pension costs

 

Pension costs are assessed in accordance with the advice of local independent qualified actuaries. The latest full actuarial valuations for the various plans were carried out at various dates in the last three years. These valuations have generally been updated by the local independent qualified actuaries to 31 December 2010.

 

The Group has a policy of closing defined benefit plans to new members. This has been implemented across a significant number of pension plans. As a result, these plans generally have an ageing membership population. In accordance with IAS 19, the actuarial calculations have been carried out using the projected unit credit method. In these circumstances, use of this method implies that the contribution rate implicit in the current service cost will increase in future years.

 

The Group’s pension deficit was £239.9 million at 31 December 2010, compared to £248.0 million at 31 December 2009. The decrease in the deficit relates to positive investment performance and actions taken by WPP to curtail and settle plans. These factors are partially offset by a drop in discount rates and by the weakening of the sterling.

 

There are a number of areas in the pension accounting that involve judgements made by management. These include establishing the long-term expected rates of investment return on pension assets, mortality assumptions, discount rates, inflation, rate of increase in pensions in payment and salary increases.

 

Most of the Group’s pension plan assets are held by its plans in the UK and North America. In the UK, the forecasted weighted average return on assets decreased to 5.4% at 31 December 2010 from 5.6% at 31 December 2009, and in North America, the forecasted weighted average return decreased to 6.4% from 6.5%, broadly in line with the yields available in both markets. Management reviews the expected long-term rates of return on an annual basis and revises them as appropriate.

 

36


Table of Contents

Also, management periodically commission detailed asset and liability studies performed by third-party professional investment advisors and actuaries, which generate probability-adjusted expected future returns on those assets. These studies also project the estimated future pension payments and evaluate the efficiency of the allocation of the pension plan assets into various investment categories.

 

At 31 December 2010, the life expectancies underlying the value of the accrued liabilities for the main defined benefit pension plans operated by the Group were as follows:

 

Years life expectancy after age 65    All
Plans
     North
America
     UK     

Western
Continental

Europe

     Asia
Pacific 1
 

Current pensioners – male

     20.7         19.7         22.4         20.0         19.3   

Current pensioners – female

     22.7         21.6         23.8         23.3         24.7   

Future pensioners (current age 45) – male

     22.3         21.2         23.6         22.5         19.3   

Future pensioners (current age 45) – female

     23.9         22.5         25.0         25.2         24.9   

 

  1    

Includes Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe.

 

In the determination of mortality assumptions, management use the most up-to-date mortality tables available in each country.

 

For a 0.25% increase or decrease in the discount rate at 31 December 2010, the effect on the year-end 2010 pension deficit would be a decrease or increase, respectively, of approximately £26 million.

 

Deferred taxes

 

We record deferred tax assets and liabilities using tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the liability is settled or the asset is realised based on enacted, or substantively enacted legislation, for the effect of temporary differences between book and tax bases of assets and liabilities. Currently we have deferred tax assets resulting from operating loss carryforwards and deductible temporary differences, all of which could reduce taxable income in the future. Based on available evidence, both positive and negative, we determine whether it is probable that all or a portion of the deferred tax assets will be realised. The main factors that we consider include:

 

   

future earnings potential determined through the use of internal forecasts;

 

   

cumulative losses in recent years;

 

   

the various jurisdictions in which the potential deferred tax assets arise;

 

   

history of loss carryforwards and other tax assets expiring;

 

   

the timing of future reversal of taxable temporary differences;

 

   

the expiry period associated with the deferred tax assets; and

 

   

the nature of the income that can be used to realise the deferred tax asset.

 

If it is our belief that it is probable that some portion of these assets will not be realised, then no asset is recognised in relation to the portion not considered to be realisable. At 31 December 2010 no deferred tax asset has been recognised in respect of gross tax losses and other temporary differences of £4,834.9 million.

 

37


Table of Contents

If market conditions improve and future results of operations exceed our current expectations, our existing recognised deferred tax assets may be adjusted, resulting in future tax benefits. Alternatively, if market conditions deteriorate further or future results of operations are less than expected, future assessments may result in a determination that some or all of the deferred tax assets are not realisable. As a result, we may need to reverse all or a portion of the deferred tax assets, which may have a significant effect on our results of operations and financial condition.

 

New IFRS Accounting Pronouncements

 

See pages F-7 and F-8 to the Consolidated Financial Statements for a description of new IFRS accounting pronouncements.

 

38


Table of Contents

ITEM 6. DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

 

A. Directors and Senior Management

 

The directors and executive officers of the Company are as follows:

 

Philip Lader, age 65: Non-executive chairman. Philip Lader was appointed chairman in 2001. The US Ambassador to the Court of St James’s from 1997 to 2001, he previously served in several senior executive roles in the US Government, including as a Member of the President’s Cabinet and as White House Deputy Chief of Staff. Before entering government service, he was executive vice president of the company managing the late Sir James Goldsmith’s US holdings and president of both a prominent American real estate company and universities in the US and Australia. A lawyer, he is also a Senior Advisor to Morgan Stanley, a director of Marathon Oil, AES and Rusal Corporations, a trustee of the Smithsonian Museum of American History and the Atlantic Council and a member of the Council on Foreign Relations.

 

Sir Martin Sorrell, age 66: Chief executive. Sir Martin Sorrell joined WPP in 1986 as a director, becoming Group chief executive in the same year. He is a non-executive director of Formula One.

 

Paul Richardson, age 53: Finance director. Paul Richardson became Group finance director of WPP in 1996 after four years with the Company as director of treasury. He is responsible for the Group’s worldwide functions in finance, information technology, procurement, property, treasury, taxation, internal audit and corporate responsibility. He is a chartered accountant and fellow of the Association of Corporate Treasurers. He is a non-executive director of CEVA Group plc, Chime Communications PLC and STW Communications Group Limited in Australia, the last two being companies associated with the Group.

 

Mark Read, age 44: Strategy director and CEO, WPP Digital. Mark Read was appointed a director in March 2005. He has been WPP’s director of strategy since 2002 and is also chief executive of WPP Digital. He is a member of the Supervisory Board of HighCo and a director of CHI & Partners. He worked at WPP between 1989 and 1995 in both parent company and operating company roles. Prior to rejoining WPP in 2002, he was a principal at the consultancy firm of Booz-Allen & Hamilton and founded and developed the company WebRewards in the UK.

 

Colin Day, age 56: Non-executive director. Colin Day was appointed a director in July 2005. He is the chief executive of Filtrona plc and a non-executive director of Amec. He was the group finance director of Reckitt Benckiser plc, until April 2011, having been appointed to its board in September 2000. Prior to joining Reckitt Benckiser he was group finance director of Aegis Group plc and previously held a number of senior finance positions with ABB Group plc and De La Rue Group plc. He was a non-executive director of Vero Group plc until 1998, Bell Group plc until 2004, Imperial Tobacco plc until February 2007, easyJet plc until 30 September 2005 and Cadbury plc until 2010.

 

Esther Dyson, age 59: Non-executive director. Esther Dyson was appointed a director in 1999. In 2004 she sold her company, EDventure Holdings, to CNET Networks, the US-based interactive media company now owned by CBS. She left CNET at the end of 2006 and now operates as an independent investor and writer, again under the name of EDventure. She has been highly influential for the past 20 years on the basis of her insights into online/information technology markets and their social impact worldwide, including the emerging markets of Central and Eastern Europe and Asia. An active investor as well as an analyst/observer, she participated in the sale of Flickr to Yahoo! and of Medstory and Powerset to Microsoft. She sits on the boards of non-listed start-ups including Evernote (US), 23andMe (US), Airship Ventures (US), Eventful.com (US), Meetup Inc. (US), NewspaperDirect (Canada), Voxiva (US) and Yandex (Russia). She is also active in public affairs and was founding chairman of ICANN, the domain name policy agency, from 1998 to 2000. She currently sits on the board of the Sunlight Foundation, which advocates transparency in government.

 

39


Table of Contents

Orit Gadiesh, age 60: Non-executive director. Orit Gadiesh was appointed a director in April 2004. She is chairman of Bain & Company, Inc. and a world-renowned expert on management and corporate strategy. She holds an MBA from Harvard Business School and was a Baker Scholar. She is a member of the International Advisory Board at Haute Ecole Commerciale in France, as well as a member of the Foundation Board for the World Economic Forum and the Board of Directors of The Peres Institute for Peace. She is a member of the Council on Foreign Relations, and a trustee for Eisenhower Fellowships.

 

Ruigang Li, age 41: Non-executive director. Ruigang Li was appointed a director in October 2010. He is President of Shanghai Media Group (SMG) a multimedia conglomerate based in Shanghai. Since 2002, under Ruigang’s leadership, SMG has maintained the most complete portfolio of media and related businesses, including television, radio, print media, digital media, home shopping, content distribution, performing arts, training, and has become the largest content and service provider and distributor of Chinese language programs in the Chinese Mainland. Ruigang is also the Chairman of China Media Capital (CMC), China’s first and only sovereign private equity fund dedicated to the media sector both within China and abroad. CMC recently announced a partnership with News Corporation’s Star China to develop their joint interests in developing growth opportunities in the operational and investment platforms in China and overseas markets. Prior to his current role, Ruigang was a visiting scholar at Columbia University in New York.

 

Stanley (Bud) Morten, age 67: Non-executive director. Bud Morten was appointed a director in 1991. He is a consultant, private investor and one of the five public members of the Investment Advisory Council of the State of Connecticut. From 2003 to 2009 he was the Independent Consultant to Citigroup/Smith Barney with responsibility for its independent research requirements. Previously he was the chief operating officer of Punk, Ziegel & Co, a New York investment banking firm with a focus on the healthcare and technology industries. Before that he was the managing director of the equity division of Wertheim Schroder & Co, Inc. in New York. He is a former non-executive director of Register.com, which was sold to a private equity firm in November 2005. He is also a non-executive director of The Motley Fool, Inc., and of Darien Rowayton Bank, both of which are private companies.

 

Koichiro Naganuma, age 66: Non-executive director. Koichiro Naganuma was appointed a director in February 2004. He is chairman of the Board of Asatsu-DK Inc., also known as ADK. He is also vice chairman of Japan Advertising Association. Joining the agency in 1981, he was president and Group CEO from 1991-2010. ADK is Japan’s third largest advertising and communications company, and 10 th largest in the world.

 

Lubna Olayan, age 55: Non-executive director. Lubna Olayan was appointed a director in March 2005. Ms Olayan is the deputy chairperson and chief executive officer of the Olayan Financing Company, a subsidiary and the holding entity for the Olayan Group’s operations in the Kingdom of Saudi Arabia and the Middle East. Ms Olayan is a Board Member of two publicly listed companies, the Saudi Hollandi Bank and Schlumberger, and on the International Advisory Board of Akbank, Rolls-Royce and the National Bank of Kuwait. She is on the Board of Trustees of Cornell University, INSEAD and KAUST (King Abdullah University of Science and Technology) and on the Board of DSCA (Down Syndrome Charitable Association) and Al Fanar, the first Arab venture philanthropy organisation in the Arab region.

 

John Quelch, age 59: Non-executive director. John Quelch was appointed a director in 1988. He is the Dean, Vice President and Distinguished Professor of International Management at the China Europe International Business School. Between 2001 and 2011 he was the Lincoln Filene Professor of Business Administration and Senior Associate Dean at Harvard Business School. Between 1998 and 2001 he was Dean of the London Business School. Between 2002 and 2011 he served as chairman of

 

40


Table of Contents

the Massachusetts Port Authority, honorary counsel general of the Kingdom of Morocco in New England and as honorary chairman of the British American Business Council of New England. Professor Quelch’s writings focus on global business practice in emerging as well as developed markets, international marketing and the role of the multinational corporation and the nation state. He is a non-executive director of Alere, Inc and a member of the Council on Foreign Relations. He served previously on the boards of Blue Circle Industries plc, easyJet plc, Pentland Group plc, Pepsi Bottling Group and Reebok International Limited.

 

Jeffrey A. Rosen, age 63: Non-executive director. Jeffrey Rosen was appointed a director in December 2004. He is a deputy chairman and managing director of Lazard. He has over 30 years’ experience in international investment banking and corporate finance. He is a member of the Council on Foreign Relations and is President of the Board of Trustees of the International Center of Photography in New York.

 

Timothy (Tim) Shriver, age 51: Non-executive director. Tim Shriver was appointed a director in August 2007. He is Chairman and CEO of Special Olympics, serving over three million Special Olympic athletes and their families in 180 countries. In recent years, he has produced films for Disney, Dream Works and Fox Searchlight and Hallmark Hall of Fame. He co-founded the Collaborative for Academic, Social and Emotional Learning (CASEL) and currently chairs the CASEL Board. He is a member of the Council on Foreign Relations and is also a non-executive director of the Malaria No More, Neogenix Oncology, and he is the founder and President of the Center for Interface Action on Global Poverty.

 

Paul Spencer, age 61: Non-executive director. Paul Spencer was appointed a director in April 2004. He is a financier with 20 years’ experience in the financial management of a number of blue-chip companies, including British Leyland PLC, Rolls-Royce PLC, Hanson PLC and Royal & Sun Alliance PLC. He has held a number of non-executive directorships including until 2009 chairman of NS and I (National Savings). He is currently chairman of State Street Managed Pension Funds and Chairs audit at TR Property Investment Trust PLC. He is the independent Trustee of the BAT, BT, BA and Rolls-Royce Pension Funds. In the 2010 Honours he was awarded a CBE for services to the financial services industry. Paul is a governor of the charity Motability.

 

Sol Trujillo, age 59: Non-executive director. Sol Trujillo was appointed a director in October 2010. He is a highly experienced international business executive, who brings 30 years of international business experience to the Board, having served as CEO on three continents in media communications organisations; US West (now Qwest), Orange (now France Telecom) and Telstra, the Australian communications company. Recognised as a broadband and wireless pioneer, he has a reputation as an innovator in the digital space, described by President Reagan’s science advisor as “the nation’s first digital telecom CEO”. He has managed operations and remains active in business affairs in both developed and fast-growing markets from China and South Asia to Europe, North America, Africa and the Middle East... more than 20 countries around the world. He is a member of corporate boards in the US, EU and China – including in the US, Target and Promerica Bank; in Europe, Weather Investments S.p.A in Italy; and in Asia, Silk Road Technologies in China, where he is board chairman. In the public sector, Mr Trujillo served as a trade policy advisor to the Clinton and Bush administrations and remains active on public policy issues related to immigration, trade, productivity and fiscal affairs.

 

The board of directors has determined that all of the non-executive directors are independent under NASDAQ Rule 5605(a)(2).

 

41


Table of Contents

B. Compensation

 

Review of compensation

 

Following a very challenging 2009, the performance of the Group improved considerably in 2010. The design of compensation policy at WPP ensures that there is a clear and direct link between the performance of the Group and executive compensation throughout the Group. In 2010, the strong performance of the Group therefore resulted in both increased incentive levels for management and strong returns for share owners. The use of performance-driven compensation ensures the continued alignment of share owner and executive interests and is essential to enable the Company to attract, retain and motivate the most gifted talent in the industry.

 

The committee’s work during 2010 included:

 

   

a review of the total compensation packages of the executive directors relative to the marketplace to ensure competitiveness;

 

   

the approval of all stock plan awards used to attract, retain, reward and motivate employees;

 

   

a review of the fees of the chairman and the non-executive directors;

 

   

the approval of all incentive payments, payable in cash or in shares, for senior executives throughout the Group and setting appropriate performance targets for the Group chief executive and the other executive directors;

 

   

approving the deferral and further deferral of significant share incentive awards by the Group chief executive; and

 

   

implementation of clawback provisions in the Company’s senior management share incentive plans.

 

WPP competes on the basis of its intellectual capital. This intellectual capital is created entirely by its people, and the committee endeavours to strike the right balance of fairness between employees and share owners. For this reason, the design of all executive compensation at WPP is governed by three guiding principles: competitiveness, performance-driven reward and alignment with share owner interests.

 

These three principles are themselves derived from both our mission statement: to develop and manage talent; to apply that talent, throughout the world, for the benefit of clients; to do so in partnership; to do so with profit and our six business objectives (see pages 20 to 21).

 

The Compensation Committee regularly reviews fixed and variable compensation against appropriate benchmarks both internal and external. When making decisions on executive compensation, the committee is briefed on the remuneration levels within the Group. This includes, for example, the consideration of actual and budgeted salary increases across the organisation when determining executive salary increases. In addition, the committee approves the design of incentive plans and reviews all the awards made under those incentive plans. In 2010 the proportion of total compensation that was variable (due to linkage to performance) for Sir Martin Sorrell, Paul Richardson and Mark Read was 87.4%, 80.1% and 75.2%, respectively.

 

WPP is committed to aligning executive performance and reward with share owner interests. From a compensation perspective, this is encouraged in a number of ways:

 

   

Total Shareholder Return (TSR) has been chosen as the performance measure for the Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan (LEAP) plans as it represents the best objective measure of the success of the Company as far as share owners are concerned;

 

   

share ownership is encouraged for the WPP Leaders (approximately the top 200 executives), all of whom have stretching ownership goals;

 

42


Table of Contents
   

all eligible employees are given a share ownership opportunity through participation in the Worldwide Ownership Plan; and

 

   

the majority of the compensation package of executive directors is paid in the form of shares comprised of deferred share bonus and long-term incentive awards under the LEAP plans.

 

The role of the Compensation Committee in improving risk management

 

The Compensation Committee is always sensitive to the requirement that the decisions that it makes and the compensation programs the Group has in place serve to improve the management of risk in the Group. In particular:

 

   

the incentive plans take into account performance across a broad range of financial and non-financial measures;

 

   

Compensation Committee meetings are generally held at the time of Board meetings, at which the committee members are usually given a comprehensive briefing on issues and risks facing each of the business units as well as the Group as a whole;

 

   

one of the single biggest challenges for WPP is attracting and retaining key talent. Incentive plans are designed to be attractive in the marketplace and provide as much retention value as possible, such as the use of deferred share bonuses that normally vest after two years, and the use of restricted stock awards that vest after three years; and

 

   

the clawback provisions that have been added into key share incentive plans (i.e. those other than the all-employee plans) give the Compensation Committee the right to cancel or reduce unvested share awards should this be justified by a participant’s acts or omissions.

 

Key elements of short- and long-term remuneration

 

The principal elements of WPP executive remuneration currently comprise the following:

 

   

base salaries and fees (fixed);

 

   

short-term incentives paid both in cash (payable immediately) and shares which vest in the medium-term, usually after two years (variable); and

 

   

long-term incentives paid in shares (variable, subject to performance conditions, and in the case of LEAP, co-investment conditions).

 

Pension contributions, life assurance, healthcare and other benefits are also provided.

 

Compensation packages for the most senior people at WPP are normally reviewed every 24 months. These reviews are undertaken within the context of:

 

   

the mix of fixed and variable compensation;

 

   

the performance of the relevant business unit;

 

   

pay and employment conditions elsewhere in the Group; and

 

   

general market conditions.

 

In determining suitable benchmarks, the Compensation Committee looks at the compensation of executives holding similar roles in competitor organisations and, if appropriate, general industry data for organisations of comparable size and complexity.

 

43


Table of Contents

Base salary and fees

 

       Current salary and fees      Effective date  

Sir Martin Sorrell

   £1,000,000        1 Jan 2007   

Paul Richardson

   $925,000 and £100,000        1 Jan 2011   

Mark Read

   £425,000        1 Jan 2011   

 

As reported in previous years, fees of £100,000 are paid to each of the executive directors in respect of their directorships of WPP plc and are included in the numbers above.

 

Sir Martin Sorrell’s base salary was last increased on 1 January 2007. It was due to be reviewed in November 2008 with any change to be implemented from January 2009; however, Sir Martin informed the Compensation Committee that an increase would not be appropriate in light of business conditions. His salary and directors’ fees therefore remained unchanged throughout 2008, 2009 and 2010. As part of the extensive review of the executive directors’ compensation at the end of 2010, the committee considers that an increase in base salary and adjustments to incentive opportunities are appropriate. Consideration of these issues has continued during 2011 and the committee intends to consult share owners before the proposals are finalised. The final changes agreed will be disclosed in the 2011 Compensation Committee report.

 

As a result of the review, and being mindful of the time that has elapsed since the last salary increases, the committee decided to increase the base salary of the other two executive directors. Paul Richardson’s base salary was increased from $830,000 plus £100,000 fees to $925,000 plus £100,000 fees. The committee believed that Mark Read’s package of base salary and fees at £325,000 was uncompetitive and, given the increased importance of digital strategy to the Group and Mr Read’s continuing personal development, an increase to his remuneration was in order. As a result, Mark Read’s package of base salary and fees was increased to £425,000. These increases were the first increases since July 2008 and January 2009 respectively, and both increases were implemented with effect from 1 January 2011.

 

Retirement benefits

 

All pension benefits for the Company’s executive directors are currently on a defined contribution basis. Only the aggregate of base salary and director fees is pensionable. Details of pension contributions for executive directors for the period under review are set on page 50.

 

Short-term incentives

 

Each year WPP sets stretching performance targets for each operating company. Performance against these targets determines the size, if any, of the incentive pool for that unit. In aggregate, incentive payments in 2010 were higher than in 2009 due to improved performance. This trend was also reflected in the bonuses paid to executive directors.

 

Individual targets (both financial and strategic) for the operating company CEOs are set by WPP and in turn, these CEOs set similar targets for employees who report directly to them. Payment is in the form of both cash bonuses and deferred shares, being Performance Share Awards (PSAs), which vest a further two years after grant. The grant of PSAs typically occurs three months after the end of the financial year.

 

In a similar way, the Compensation Committee sets objectives for Sir Martin Sorrell and the other executive directors. The extent to which these objectives are met will determine the size of both annual cash bonuses (under the Short Term Incentive Plan, or STIP) and Executive Share Awards (ESAs, the portion of the annual bonus paid in shares which normally vest a further two years after grant).

 

44


Table of Contents

No changes were made in 2010 to the levels of short-term incentive payouts that would be payable for achieving either target or maximum performance. The target and maximum cash bonus and ESA awards for each of the three executive directors in 2010 were as follows (shown as a percentage of salary):

 

       Cash      ESA  
       Target %      Max %      Target %      Max %  

Sir Martin Sorrell

     100         200         67         100   

Paul Richardson

     80         120         100         133   

Mark Read

     50         75         67         100   

 

Consistent with previous years, for 2010 the performance of each executive director was measured in the three areas shown below.

 

   

Group financial objectives: Examples of measures include margin improvement and operating profit growth.

 

   

Individual strategic objectives: Examples of measures include relative financial performance, advancing CSR strategy, improving back office synergies and integrating digital assets.

 

   

Key business achievements: Examples of measures include improving creative reputation and developing digital strategy.

 

Each of these three elements is equally weighted for bonus purposes (i.e. one third of the bonus is payable for the achievement of each objective). Except for the Group financial objectives, the exact measures differ for each individual executive director.

 

After considering each of these areas and the respective measures for each executive director, the committee assessed the following levels of performance:

 

       2010 achievement as % of target      2009      2008  
Cash    Financial      Strategic      Business      Total             

Total %

of target

    

Total %

of target

 

Sir Martin Sorrell

     200         170         200         190                 41         125   

Paul Richardson

     150         105         150         135                 58         100   

Mark Read

     150         105         150         135                 72         125   

 

       2010 achievement as % of target      2009      2008  
ESA    Financial      Strategic      Business      Total             

Total %

of target

    

Total %

of target

 

Sir Martin Sorrell

     150         127         150         142                 82         112   

Paul Richardson

     133         93         133         120                 62         100   

Mark Read

     150         104         150         135                 72         125   

 

These achievement levels resulted in the following bonus payments:

 

       Cash bonus      ESA bonus  
      

Actual %

of target

    

Actual

£000

    

Actual %

of target

    

Actual

£000

 

Sir Martin Sorrell

     190         1,900         142         950   

Paul Richardson

     135         682         120         757   

Mark Read

     135         219         135         293   

 

45


Table of Contents

The executive directors are eligible, but decided not, to participate in a cash bonus deferral plan whereby they can defer receipt of part of their bonus for four years, and receive a 25% match in the form of WPP shares (subject to continuous employment).

 

In conjunction with the committee’s review of total compensation for the executive directors, the committee decided to adjust the levels of short-term incentive awards available for executive directors. The target and maximum levels for both Paul Richardson and Mark Read have been adjusted for 2011 in order to better balance the cash and share incentive elements of their remuneration, and to reflect market practice, and are shown below (as a percentage of salary):

 

       Cash      ESA  
       Target %      Max %      Target %      Max %  

Paul Richardson

     100         150         100         150   

Mark Read

     67         100         67         100   

 

As mentioned in the Base salary and fees section, a decision regarding adjustments to Sir Martin Sorrell’s incentive opportunities is pending the outcome of share owner consultation.

 

Long-term incentives

 

During the latter part of 2010, the Compensation Committee reviewed the long-term incentive plans to assess whether they continued to meet the strategic objectives of the Company particularly given the increased competitive pressures that have been fuelled by the general economic recovery and competitors’ behaviour. The committee reviewed grant levels, performance criteria and vesting schedules. The conclusion of the review was that the grant levels and vesting schedules remained appropriate and well suited to the nature of the business. While the committee believes that the relative TSR measure that has been used for a number of years continues to be the most appropriate performance measure, the committee periodically reviews whether the plans would be strengthened by the addition of one or two further non-market measures in order to balance TSR.

 

Other than stock options, all awards will be satisfied out of WPP shares held in treasury or one of the Company’s employee share ownership plans (ESOPs). The proceeds from any of the cash or share-based equity plans are not pensionable.

 

Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan III

 

In 2010, awards under LEAP III were made to 18 of the Group’s key executives. Details of the awards made to the executive directors can be found on page 52.

 

Participants have to commit and retain investments in WPP in order to receive awards under LEAP III. Such investments are in the form of WPP shares (investment shares) and, at the invitation of the Compensation Committee, also in the form of options over WPP shares purchased from an independent third party (investment options). LEAP III awards provide participants with the opportunity to earn additional WPP shares to match their investments (matching shares). The number of matching shares that a participant can receive at the end of the investment and performance period depends on the Company’s TSR performance measured over five years and compared with a peer group weighted by market capitalisation.

 

Following the end of a performance period, the Compensation Committee is required to perform a ‘fairness review’ on the basis of which it may, in exceptional circumstances, decide to vary the number of matching shares that will vest. This is because relative TSR may not always reflect the true performance of the Company. Factors the committee considers in its fairness review of any award

 

46


Table of Contents

include, amongst others, multiple measures of the Group’s financial performance (such as growth in revenue and in earnings per share), and any evidence of distortions in the share price of either WPP or the peer group (such as bid price premiums).

 

Vesting of the 2005 and 2006 LEAP awards

 

As previously reported in the 2009 Compensation Committee report, the 2005 award vested in March 2010 with a match of 2.50.

 

As described above, the Compensation Committee is required to perform a ‘fairness review’ before any awards can vest. When performing this fairness review in the context of determining the level of vesting of the 2006 award, the committee reviewed a broad range of factors in its consideration of whether the relative TSR achievement was a fair reflection of the performance of the Group over the five-year performance period or whether there were factors that required the result to be adjusted. For the vesting of the 2006 award, the committee considered the following factors: the constituents of the peer group and whether there were any events that had an undue impact on their TSR performance in either a positive or negative way; the impact of changes in exchange rates on the TSR calculation; and the financial performance of the Company, relative to its peers, covering a wide range of measures including EPS, PBIT, margin, revenue and several other factors.

 

Following the fairness review, the committee concluded that the relative TSR result fairly reflected the performance of the Company over the five-year investment period, and that no adjustment was deemed necessary. The relative TSR performance of the Company resulted in a match of 4.14 for each investment share committed to the program despite the fact that on a local currency basis the match was 4.80.

 

Restricted Stock Plan

 

Other than to satisfy awards under the short-term incentive plans (ESAs and PSAs), the principal use of the Restricted Stock Plan is for awards under the WPP Leaders and Partners program. This program is used to reward, retain and align the interests of about 1,250 of our key executives with the interests of share owners.

 

In the program, awards are made to participants that vest three years after grant, provided the participant is still employed within the Group. Executive directors are ineligible to participate in this plan.

 

Executive Stock Option Plan

 

In order to attract or retain key talent it is sometimes necessary to make special grants of options. No awards were granted in 2010 to any employee or executive director (1 award was granted to an employee in 2009). However, the Compensation Committee is conscious that stock options remain a powerful motivator and, in certain circumstances, it might be necessary to make awards to a broader population under the Executive Stock Option Plan.

 

Worldwide Ownership Plan

 

The Worldwide Ownership Plan is an all-employee plan that makes annual grants of stock options to employees with two years of service who work in wholly owned subsidiaries. During 2010, awards were made to over 45,000 employees. By 31 December 2010, options under this plan had been granted to approximately 97,700 employees over 43.4 million shares since March 1997. Executives who participate in one of the other share plans described above are ineligible to participate in this plan.

 

47


Table of Contents

Share incentive dilution for 2000 to 2010

 

The share incentive dilution level, measured on a 10-year rolling basis, has declined to 4.4% at 31 December 2010 (2009: 4.6%). It is intended that awards under all plans, with the exception of the Worldwide Ownership Plan, will all be satisfied with purchased shares held either in the ESOPs or in treasury.

 

48


Table of Contents

Key elements of short- and long-term remuneration

 

      Objective   Participation   Performance
period
  Conditions   Change of control

Short-term

                   
Base salary   To maintain package competitiveness at all levels within the Group.   All employees.   n/a   Salary levels are determined by taking a number of relevant factors into account, including individual and business unit performance, level of experience, scope of responsibility and the competitiveness of total remuneration.   n/a
Cash bonus   To incentivise delivery of value at all levels within the Group.   Approximately 10% of employees are eligible to receive a performance bonus.   1 year   Achievement of challenging performance goals (financial and non- financial) at the individual and business unit level.   The cash bonuses of executive directors do not crystalise on a change of control.
Performance share awards   To incentivise delivery of value and to align with interests of share owners.   Key operating company executives.   1 year   Achievement of challenging performance goals (financial and non- financial) at operating company level. Further two-year retention period.   See note below for Restricted Stock Plan.
Executive share awards   To incentivise delivery of value and to align with interests of share owners.   Key head office executives and executive directors.   1 year   Achievement of challenging individual annual bonus objectives. Further two- or three-year retention period.   See note below for Restricted Stock Plan.
Long-term                    
LEAP III and Renewed LEAP   To incentivise long-term performance by comparing WPP’s TSR against the TSR of key comparators (which are weighted by market capitalisation in the case of LEAP III), and maximise alignment with share owner interests through a high level of personal financial commitment.  

Participation offered only to those key executives (currently no more than 20

people) whose contributions transcend their day-to-day role, including executive

directors.

  5 years  

Relative TSR

performance against a group of key communication

services comparator

companies, (weighted by market capitalisation in the case of LEAP III), subject to a fairness review by the Compensation Committee.

  On a change of control, the investment period for all outstanding awards ends, the number of vesting shares is determined at that date (pro-rated in the case of LEAP III) and any other rights cease. The number of shares that vest may be reduced to prevent adverse US tax provisions applying. The Compensation Committee may determine that outstanding awards are exchanged for equivalent awards.
Restricted Stock Plan   To encourage a share ownership culture and long-term retention as well as supporting recruitment.   Directors and senior executives of the operating companies and senior head office executives.   n/a   Typically three-year retention period.   The vesting period for all outstanding awards is deemed to end. The Compensation Committee may determine that outstanding awards are exchanged for equivalent awards or that outstanding awards are unaffected by the change of control.
Executive Stock Option Plan   To provide a tool to promote retention and recruitment.   Occasional use only to deal with special situations.   3 years   Conditions, if any, are determined at the time of grant of the award.   The number of shares or ADRs is pro-rated down in accordance with the change of control date. The Compensation Committee may determine that outstanding awards are unaffected by the change of control.

Worldwide

Ownership Plan

  To develop a stronger ownership culture.   Employees with at least two years’ employment. Not offered to those participating in other share programs or to executive directors.   n/a   Three-year vesting period.   The number of shares or ADRs is pro-rated down in accordance with the change of control date. The Compensation Committee may determine that outstanding awards are unaffected by the change of control.

 

49


Table of Contents

Directors’ remuneration

 

For the fiscal year ended 31 December 2010 the aggregate compensation paid by WPP and its subsidiaries to all directors and officers of WPP as a group for services in all capacities was £9.9 million. Such compensation was paid by WPP and its subsidiaries primarily in the form of salaries, performance-related bonuses, other benefits and a deferred share award. The sum of £0.7 million was set aside and paid in the last fiscal year to provide pension benefits for directors and officers of WPP.

 

Executive directors’ emoluments

 

The value of salary and fees, benefits, pension contributions and annual incentives paid both in cash (under the STIP) and shares (ESAs) for the year ending 31 December 2010 are set out in the table below. The table also shows comparative numbers for 2009. In the case of the STIP and ESAs, the figures shown are the value of the awards in respect of the year in question (although they were received in the following year). Benefits include such items as healthcare, life assurance, spouse travel and allowances for cars and housing. Both Sir Martin Sorrell and Paul Richardson currently receive part of their remuneration in pounds sterling and part in US dollars. Any US dollar amounts received in 2010 have been converted into sterling at an exchange rate of $1.5461 to £1 ($1.5667 for 2009).

 

     

Salary and

fees

   

Other

benefits

    Short-term
incentive plans
(annual bonus)
   

Value of

ESAs

   

Total

annual
remuneration

    Pension
contributions
 
    2010     2009     2010     2009     2010     2009     2010     2009     2010     2009     2010     2009  
      £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000     £000  

Executive directors

                                                                                               

Sir Martin Sorrell 1, 2, 3

    1,009        1,007        374        345        1,900        406        950        546        4,233        2,304        400        401   

Paul Richardson

    637        630        106        101        682        290        757        389        2,182        1,410        191        189   

Mark Read

    325        325        2        1        219        117        293        157        839        600        33        33   

Total remuneration

    1,971        1,962        482        447        2,801        813        2,000        1,092        7,254        4,314        624        623   
1    

During 2010 an amount of £6,813 was paid to Sir Martin Sorrell in respect of tax liabilities incurred by him on expenditure on various items considered by the UK Tax authorities as benefits in kind but which the committee consider to be essential to his ability to deliver his services successfully to the Group (£8,323 in 2009).

2    

Payments made in accordance with the approval granted by share owners of amounts equal to the dividends that would be payable (totalling £1,081,172) were made to Sir Martin Sorrell during 2010 (£856,687 during 2009) in respect of the shares reflected in the UK and US Deferred Stock Units Awards Agreements (which are the agreements that now comprise the awards granted under the Capital Investment Plan in 1995).

3    

Benefits include other items such as healthcare, life assurance, spouse travel, allowance for cars and housing.

 

50


Table of Contents

ESAs and Restricted Stock Awards held by executive directors

 

All awards made under the Restricted Stock Plan are made on the basis of satisfaction of previous performance conditions and are subject to continuous employment until the vest date. The table includes awards that vested during 2010, awards that remained outstanding during 2010 and, by way of additional information, awards that have been granted since 31 December 2010.

 

Name         Award
date
   

Share

plan

  Share/ADR
price on
grant
date
    No. of
shares/ADRs
originally
awarded
    Value
on
grant
day
000
    Additional
shares
granted
in lieu of
dividends
    Total
shares
vesting
    Vesting
date
    Share
price on
vesting
   

Value
on
vesting

£000

 

Sir Martin Sorrell

  2007 ESA Award     03.03.08      ESA     £5.9025        149,851        £885        10,582        160,433        06.03.10        £6.455        1,036   
    2008 ESA Award     09.03.09      ESA     £3.83625        196,285        £753        —          —          06.03.11        —          —     
    2009 ESA Award     04.05.10      ESA     £6.7775        80,560        £546        —          —          06.03.13        —          —     
    2010 ESA Award     31.03.11      ESA     £7.6825        123,657        £950        —          —          06.03.13        —          —     

Paul Richardson

  2007 ESA Award     03.03.08      ESA     £5.9025        96,094        £567        6,785        102,879        06.03.10        £6.455        664   
    2008 ESA Award     09.03.09      ESA     £3.83625        143,369        £550        —          —          06.03.11        —          —     
    2009 ESA Award 1     04.05.10      ESA     $51.59        11,813        $609        —          —          06.03.13        —          —     
    2010 ESA Award 1     31.03.11      ESA     $61.76        19,121      $ 1,181        —          —          06.03.13        —          —     

Mark Read

  Def Bonus 2005     16.03.06      Deferred bonus     £6.7950        3,601        £24        1,280 2       4,881        16.03.10      £ 6.5452        32   
    Def Bonus 2006     27.04.07      Deferred bonus     £7.4775        9,526        £71        —          —          16.03.11        —          —     
    2007 ESA Award     03.03.08      ESA     £5.9025        43,202        £255        3,050        46,252        06.03.10        £6.455        299   
    2008 ESA Award     09.03.09      ESA     £3.83625        59,954        £230        —          —          06.03.11        —          —     
    2009 ESA Award     04.05.10      ESA     £6.7775        23,164        £157        —          —          06.03.13        —          —     
    2010 ESA Award     31.03.11      ESA     £7.6825        38,138        £293        —          —          06.03.13        —          —     
1  

Paul Richardson’s 2009 and 2010 ESA Awards were granted in respect of ADRs.

2    

Represents the combined total of matching shares and shares granted in lieu of dividends.

 

Other Long-Term Incentive Plan Awards

 

Renewed Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan

 

      Grant /
award
date
   

Investment

and performance

period

    Number of
investment
shares
    Share
price
on
grant
date
    Maximum
number of
matching
units at 1
Jan 2010
    During 2010    

Maximum
number of
matching
units at 31

Dec 2010

    Share
price
on
vest/
deferral
date
    Value
on
vest/
deferral
date
£000
 
Name             Granted/
(lapsed)
units
    Additional
dividend
shares
    Vested or
deferred
shares
       

Sir Martin Sorrell

    15.12.05        01.01.05 –31.12.09        203,394        £6.175        1,016,970        (508,485              53,760        562,245        —        £ 6.455        3,629   
      15.11.06        01.01.06 –31.12.10        156,536        £6.84        782,680        —          —          —          782,680        —          —     
      11.12.07        01.01.07 –31.12.11        148,742        £6.23        743,710        —          —          —          743,710        —          —     
      31.10.08        01.01.08 –31.12.12        218,596        £3.749        1,092,980        —          —          —          1,092,980        —          —     

Paul Richardson

    15.12.05        01.01.05 –31.12.09        81,358        £6.175        406,790        (203,395     21,504        224,899        —        £ 6.455        1,452   
      15.11.06        01.01.06 –31.12.10        66,102        £6.84        330,510        —          —          —          330,510        —          —     
      11.12.07        01.01.07 –31.12.11        59,497        £6.23        297,485        —          —          —          297,485        —          —     
      31.10.08        01.01.08 –31.12.12        109,298        £3.749        546,490        —          —          —          546,490        —          —     

Mark Read

    15.12.05        01.01.05 –31.12.09        10,170        £6.175        50,850        (25,425     —          25,425        —        £ 6.455        164   
      15.11.06        01.01.06 –31.12.10        16,525        £6.84        82,625        —          —          —          82,625        —          —     
      11.12.07        01.01.07 –31.12.11        14,874        £6.23        74,370        —          —          —          74,370        —          —     
      31.10.08        01.01.08 –31.12.12        21,859        £3.749        109,295        —          —          —          109,295        —          —     

 

 

51


Table of Contents

The vesting schedules used for the various awards under Renewed LEAP are shown in the following tables. When actual performance falls between these positions, the match is calculated on a proportionate basis.

 

Awards granted in 2006 and 2007         
Rank compared to peer group    Number of matching shares  

1

     5   

2

     5   

3

     4.5   

4

     3.5   

5

     2.5   

Median

     1.5   

Below median

     0   

 

Awards granted in 2008         
Rank compared to peer group    Number of matching shares  

1

     5   

2

     5   

3

     4   

4

     3   

Median

     1.5   

Below median

     0   

 

Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan III

 

 

 

Name   Grant /
award
date
   

Investment

and

performance period

   

Number
of
invest-

ment
shares

   

Number
of
invest-

ment
options

    Share
price on
grant
date
    Maximum
number of
matching
units at 1
Jan 2010
    During 2010     Maximum
number of
matching
units at 31
Dec 2010
    Share
price
on vest/
deferral
date
   

Value
on vest/
deferral

date

 
              Granted/
(lapsed)
units
    Additional
dividend
shares
    Vested or
deferred
shares
       

Sir Martin Sorrell

    15.12.09        01.01.09 – 31.12.13        365,878        —        £ 6.1025        1,829,390        —          —          —          1,829,390        —          —     
      24.11.10        01.01.10 – 31.12.14        416,666        —        £ 7.2475        —          2,083,330        —          —          2,083,330        —          —     

Paul Richardson

    15.12.09        01.01.09 – 31.12.13        103,423        —        £ 6.1025        517,115        —          —          —          517,115        —          —     
      24.11.10        01.01.10 – 31.12.14        100,968        —        £ 7.2475        —          504,840        —          —          504,840        —          —     

Mark Read

    15.12.09        01.01.09 – 31.12.13        27,406        —        £ 6.1025        137,030        —          —          —          137,030        —          —     
      24.11.10        01.01.10 – 31.12.14        25,281        —        £ 7.2475        —          126,405        —          —          126,405        —          —     

 

The vesting schedule used for the awards under LEAP III is shown in the following table. When actual performance is not exactly equal to a percentile in the table below, but is more than 50% and less than 90%, the percentage of Matching Shares will be determined on a straight-line basis between the relevant figures.

 

Awards granted in 2009 and 2010         

Aggregate market

Capitalisation percentile

   Number of matching shares  

90th percentile

     500%   

80th percentile

     420%   

70th percentile

     330%   

60th percentile

     240%   

50th percentile

     150%   

40th percentile

     0%   

30th percentile

     0%   

20th percentile

     0%   

10th percentile

     0%   

Bottom

     0%   

 

52


Table of Contents

The comparator groups used for the awards under Renewed LEAP (2006, 2007, 2008) and LEAP III (2009, 2010) are shown in the following table. Where a company that delists during a performance period has an undisturbed share price for less than 40% of that performance period, the Compensation Committee would usually exclude that company from the comparator group for the award in question. Otherwise, the company would usually be deemed to be disposed of and the proceeds reinvested, in respect of LEAP III, in a market capitalisation weighted index, and in respect of Renewed LEAP in a non-market capitalisation weighted index, both of which track the TSR of the remaining comparator companies.

 

Grant year    Comparator group
2006    Aegis, Arbitron, Dentsu, Gfk, Havas Advertising, Interpublic, Ipsos, Omnicom Group, Publicis and Taylor Nelson Sofres
2007    Aegis, Arbitron, Dentsu, Gfk, Havas Advertising, Interpublic, Ipsos, Omnicom Group, Publicis and Taylor Nelson Sofres
2008    Aegis, Arbitron, Dentsu, Gfk, Havas Advertising, Interpublic, Ipsos, Omnicom Group and Publicis
2009    Aegis, Arbitron, Dentsu, Gfk, Havas, Interpublic, Ipsos, Omnicom Group and Publicis
2010    Aegis, Arbitron, Dentsu, Gfk, Havas, Interpublic, Ipsos, Omnicom Group and Publicis

 

Non-executive directors’ remuneration

 

The fees paid to non-executive directors (NEDs) are normally reviewed every two years and any changes are approved by the Board. Other than the Audit Committee chairman, the fee levels shown below have been effective since 1 January 2007. Accordingly, the Compensation Committee recommended, and the Board determined, that the existing structure should be adjusted as follows:

 

Position/role    From
1 January
2011
     2010 fees
(effective
from
1 January
2007)
 

Chairman

   £ 425,000       £ 300,000   

Senior independent director

   £ 20,000       £ 10,000   

Non-executive director

   £ 65,000       £ 60,000   

Chairmanship of Audit and Compensation Committee

   £ 40,000       £ 20,000 1  

Chairmanship of Nomination Committee

   £ 15,000       £ 10,000   

Member of Audit and Compensation Committee

   £ 20,000       £ 5,000   

Member of Nomination Committee

   £ 5,000       £ 5,000   
1  

Fee for chairmanship of Audit Committee effective from 1 January 2009.

 

From 1 January 2011, the chairman is not entitled to any further fees or salary for either chairmanship or membership of any of the Company’s committees. UK-based NEDs who are required to travel outside the UK to consider Company-related matters at meetings called at short notice will be paid £1,000 for attendance at each of those meetings. The fees detailed above are the only payments receivable by NEDs. Mr Morten will also be paid a fee of £20,000 for additional services that he provides to the Board.

 

53


Table of Contents

The table below shows actual fees paid for the year 2010. The notice period for all NEDs is two months.

 

Director   Date of
original
contract
    Expiry
of
current
contract
    Committee membership   Fee
for
2010
£000
    Fee
for
2009
£000
 
P Lader     26.02.01        05.10.11      Chairman of the Company, chairman of Nomination Committee and member of Compensation Committee     315        315   
C Day     25.07.05        05.10.11      Member of Audit Committee and member of Compensation Committee from 1 December 2010     65        65   
E Dyson     29.06.99        05.10.11      Member of Compensation Committee and member of Nomination Committee     70        70   
O Gadiesh     28.04.04        05.10.11      Member of Nomination Committee     65        65   
R Li     11.10.10        11.10.13      Appointed to the Board in October 2010     14        n/a   
S W Morten     02.12.91        05.10.11      Senior independent director until April 2010 and ex officio member of all committees     70 1       71   
K Naganuma 2     23.01.04        05.10.11            —          —     
L Olayan 3     18.03.05        05.10.11      Member of Nomination Committee     —          —     
J A Quelch 4     10.07.91        05.10.11            94        85   
J Rosen     20.12.04        05.10.11      Chairman of Compensation Committee, member of Audit Committee and Senior Independent Director since April 2010     82        75   
T Shriver     06.08.07        05.10.11      Member of Audit Committee until 29 June 2010 and member of Compensation Committee from 29 June 2010     65        65   
P Spencer     28.04.04        05.10.11      Chairman of Audit Committee     80        80   
S Trujillo     12.10.10        12.10.13      Appointed to the Board in October 2010, member of the Audit Committee from 12 October 2010     15        n/a   
1    

Fee includes ex officio payment of £6,000.

2  

Received no fees in 2009 and 2010.

3    

Waived fees in 2009 and 2010.

4    

Fee includes £34,038 (£24,515 in 2009) for consulting services.

 

C. Board Practices

 

In accordance with the UK Corporate Governance Code, all of the directors will submit themselves for annual re-election at each Annual General Meeting. Directors may be appointed by share owners by ordinary resolution or by the Board on the recommendation of the Nomination Committee and must then stand for re-election at the next Annual General Meeting where they may be re-elected by ordinary resolution of the share owners.

 

Information regarding the period during which each director has served is set forth in Item 6A.

 

Policy on directors’ service contracts, notice periods, termination payments and external appointments

 

The Company’s policy is that contracts should be on a rolling basis and will not include either a fixed term or liquidated damages provisions. Sir Martin Sorrell’s service contract may be terminated by the Company or by Sir Martin without, in either case, notice needing to be given — a so called ‘contract at will’. This means that the Company may terminate Sir Martin’s service contract without the need to pay compensation for any notice period.

 

Executive director    Effective from    Notice period

Sir Martin Sorrell

   19 Nov 2008    “At will”

Paul Richardson

   19 Nov 2008    12 months

Mark Read

   19 Nov 2008    6 months

 

54


Table of Contents

Executive directors are permitted to serve as non-executives on the boards of other organisations. If the Company is a share owner in that organisation, non-executive fees for these roles are waived. However, if the Company is not a share owner in that organisation, any non-executive fees can be retained by the office holder.

 

Composition of the Compensation Committee

 

During 2010, the Compensation Committee comprised the following:

 

   

Jeffrey Rosen (chairman of the committee);

 

   

Esther Dyson;

 

   

Philip Lader;

 

   

Tim Shriver (from 29 June 2010); and

 

   

Colin Day (from 1 December 2010).

 

No member of the committee has any personal financial interest (other than as a share owner as disclosed on page 59) in the matters to be decided by the committee, potential conflicts of interest arising from cross-directorships or day-to-day involvement in running the Group’s businesses.

 

The terms of reference for the Compensation Committee are available on the Company’s website at www.wpp.com and will be on display at the Annual General Meeting (AGM), as set out in the Notice of AGM.

 

The committee’s principal responsibilities under its terms of reference include:

 

   

reviewing and approving the Company’s compensation strategy;

 

   

determining appropriate remuneration for executive directors;

 

   

approving the service agreements and severance arrangements for executive directors and other senior executives of the Company;

 

   

maintaining appropriate procedures for evaluation of executive performance;

 

   

overseeing succession planning and management development for senior executives in the group who are not members of the Board;

 

   

reviewing, approving and administering the Company’s executive long-term incentive plans, employee share schemes and other equity-related incentive plans;

 

   

reviewing proposed special incentive awards to senior executives;

 

   

monitoring prohibitions on personal loans to directors and officers;

 

   

determining targets for performance-related pay schemes;

 

   

advising on any major changes in employee benefit structures;

 

   

overseeing the provisions for selecting, appointing and setting the terms of reference for any remuneration consultants to the Company;

 

   

overseeing the preparation of and recommending to the board the approval of the annual report of the committee in compliance with the disclosure requirements of the Code of Best Practice and the Directors’ Remuneration Report Regulations 2002;

 

   

overseeing the adequacy of disclosures throughout the year regarding director compensation, stock transactions and benefits;

 

55


Table of Contents
   

approving the policy for authorising claims for expenses from directors and senior executives; and

 

   

ensuring that procedures are in place concerning compliance with the employee welfare provisions of the Company’s Code of Business Conduct and Ethics and the Company’s Policy Manual.

 

Advisors to the Compensation Committee

 

The Compensation Committee regularly consults with Group executives, particularly the Group chief executive (who is not present when matters relating to his own compensation or contracts are discussed and decided), the chief talent officer and the worldwide director of compensation & benefits. The latter two individuals provide a perspective on information reviewed by the committee and are a conduit for requests for information and analysis from the Company’s external advisors. Towers Watson, are the committee’s appointed compensation advisors; they did not provide any other material services to the Group. Squire Sanders Hammonds advises the committee on legal and tax issues relating to compensation and benefits, and provides legal advice on a range of matters to the Group.

 

The Compensation Committee receives external advice on all matters pertaining to the determination of fair and appropriate compensation packages for the executive directors. This advice covers competitive practice in comparator companies, tax and regulatory changes and governance issues related to the role of the Compensation Committee.

 

Review of the Audit Committee

 

During 2010, the Audit Committee comprised Paul Spencer, Jeffrey Rosen, Colin Day, Sol Trujillo and Tim Shriver. Tim Shriver stepped down from the committee in July 2010 and Sol Trujillo was appointed to the committee in October 2010.

 

Meetings of the Audit Committee, of which there were nine during 2010, were also attended (by invitation for all or part of any meeting) by the external auditors, the Company’s chairman, the Group finance director, Bud Morten, the director of internal audit, the Group chief counsel, deputy Group chief counsel and the Company Secretary. Preparatory meetings were also held with the internal and external auditors as well as members of the Company’s senior management including the heads of the Tax, Treasury, Legal and Group Reporting teams. The committee received presentations from the heads of Tax, Transaction Services and Treasury. The committee also received reports from the Disclosure Committee in relation to the Disclosure Committee’s review and work on financial reports. The Board received regular reports on all matters of particular significance arising at the committee meetings.

 

The committee’s terms of reference, which are reviewed with the Board annually and most recently in April 2011, are available for inspection on the Company’s website at www.wpp.com and are on display prior to and at all general meetings of the Company.

 

During the year, the committee and its members were formally assessed by the chairman of the Company for their technical suitability to be members of the committee and also for the committee’s overall effectiveness. The Board has designated Paul Spencer as the committee’s financial expert for Sarbanes-Oxley Act (SOX) purposes and as having recent and relevant financial experience for the purposes of the Combined Code and the UK Corporate Governance Code.

 

The committee has once again overseen the progress towards compliance with Section 404 of SOX for 2010, through regular status reports submitted by the internal and external auditors.

 

56


Table of Contents

The committee received and reviewed regular reports on both the Company’s Right to Speak helpline, which is made available to employees to enable them to communicate confidentially on matters of concern and the actions taken in response to those calls.

 

The committee has established a policy regarding non-audit services that may be provided by the external auditors, which prohibits certain categories of work in line with relevant guidance on independence, such as ethical standards issued by the Auditing Practices Board, standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) and SOX. Other categories of work may be provided by the auditors if it is appropriate for them to do so. The provision of such services and associated fees are pre-approved by the committee, either as individual assignments or as aggregate amounts for specified categories of services. All fees are summarised periodically for the committee to assess the aggregate value of non-audit fees against audit fees. The level of fees for 2010 is shown in note 3 to the financial statements and in Item 16C.

 

In line with the committee’s responsibility to review and appoint the external auditors and approve their remuneration and terms of engagement, in 2010 the committee monitored Deloitte’s independence, objectivity and performance with reference to frequent reports from Deloitte during the year covering the overall audit strategy and the progress and results of the audit. The committee recommends the reappointment of Deloitte.

 

Other work carried out by the committee in 2010 included:

 

   

monitoring the integrity of the Company’s financial statements and reviewing significant financial reporting judgements;

 

   

reviewing internal financial control and internal audit activities;

 

   

assisting the Board in meeting its responsibilities in respect of reviewing and reporting on the systems and key elements of risk management as they affect the Group;

 

   

reviewing the Group Treasury policy with particular focus on debtors, funding and the continued ability of the Group to adopt the going concern basis in preparing financial statements;

 

   

reviewing reports on any material litigation or regulatory reviews involving Group companies;

 

   

reviewing the Group’s mergers and acquisitions strategy, any significant acquisitions, due diligence procedures and integration processes and the debt financing by the Group;

 

   

reviewing new business models proposed by Group companies;

 

   

reviewing the Group’s Code of Business Conduct and supporting training programs;

 

   

reviewing the Group’s tax strategy;

 

   

monitoring the accounting and legal reporting requirements, including all relevant regulations of the UK Listing Authority, the SEC and NASDAQ and the Jersey Financial Services Commission with which the Company must comply; and

 

   

reviewing the procedures and supporting training programs being implemented by the Group in response to the UK Bribery Act and US Foreign Corrupt Practices Act and increased regulatory focus.

 

D. Employees

 

The assets of communications services businesses are primarily their employees, and the Company is highly dependent on the talent, creative abilities and technical skills of its personnel and the relationships its personnel have with clients. The Company believes that its operating companies

 

57


Table of Contents

have established reputations in the industry that attract talented personnel. However, the Company, like all communications services businesses, is vulnerable to adverse consequences from the loss of key employees due to the competition among these businesses for talented personnel. On 31 December 2010, the Group, including all employees of associated undertakings, had approximately 146,000 employees located in approximately 2,400 offices in 107 countries compared with 138,000 and 135,000 as of 31 December 2009 and 2008, respectively. Excluding all employees of associated undertakings, this figure is 104,052 (2009: 98,759, 2008: 112,262). The average number of employees in 2010 was 101,387 compared to 105,318 and 97,438 in 2009 and 2008, respectively, including acquisitions. Their geographical distribution was as follows:

 

                            
       2010      2009      2008  

North America

     25,546         25,004         24,493   

United Kingdom

     9,620         9,704         8,971   

Western Continental Europe

     21,154         22,230         19,448   

Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa and Middle East and Central  & Eastern

Europe

     45,067         48,380         44,526   
       101,387         105,318         97,438   

 

Their operating sector distribution was as follows:

 

        
                            
       2010      2009      2008  

Advertising and Media Investment Management

     42,424         42,906         45,754   

Consumer Insight

     28,167         28,325         14,934   

Public Relations & Public Affairs

     7,364         7,325         7,682   

Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications

     23,432         26,762         29,068   
       101,387         105,318         97,438   

 

58


Table of Contents

E. Share Ownership

 

Directors’ Interests

 

Directors’ interests in the Company’s ordinary share capital, all of which were beneficial (unless otherwise stated), are shown in the following table. Save as disclosed in this table and in the rest of Item 6, no director had any interest in any contract of significance with the Group during the year. Each executive director has a technical interest as an employee and potential beneficiary in shares in the Company held under the ESOPs. As at 31 December 2010, the Company’s ESOPs (which are entirely independent of the Company and have waived their rights to receive dividends) held in total 22,083,378 shares in the Company (24,941,529 in 2009). Further details of the long-term incentive plans are given in Item 6B.

 

     

At 1 Jan

2010 or
appointment
date

    Shares acquired
through long-
term incentive
plan awards in
2010
    Movement
during
2010 inc.
shares
purchased
in 2010
    At 31 Dec
2010 or
earlier
retirement
or
resignation
    Shares acquired
through long-
term incentive
plan awards in
2011
   

Other
movements
since

31 Dec
2010

    At 18 Apr
2011
   

Shares
contributed to
charity
2007-2011
(and no longer
beneficially
owned)

 
    Vested     (sold)         Vested     (sold)        

C Day

    5,240        —          —          10,000        15,240        —          —          —          15,240        —     

E Dyson

    35,000        —          —          —          35,000        —          —          —          35,000        —     

O Gadiesh

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

P Lader

    11,950        —          —          —          11,950        —          —          —          11,950        —     

R Li

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

S W Morten

    20,000        —          —          —          20,000        —          —          —          20,000        —     

K Naganuma 1

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

L Olayan

    —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —          —     

J A Quelch

    12,000        —          —          —          12,000        —          —          —          12,000        —     

M Read 2

    79,272        71,677        (56,698     2,875        97,126        139,782        (139,782     6,355        103,481        —     

P W G Richardson 2,3

    330,907        327,778        (164,219     324        494,790        456,926        (415,926     —          535,790        —     

J Rosen

    12,000        —          —          —          12,000        —          —          —          12,000        —     

T Shriver

    5,000        —          —          5,000        10,000        —          —          —          10,000        —     

P Spencer

    10,000        —          —          —          10,000        —          —          —          10,000        —     

S Trujillo

    —          —          —          10,000        10,000        —          —          —          10,000        —     

Sir Martin Sorrell 2,4,5,6 ,7

    16,405,342        722,678        (122,536     (147,883     16,857,601        930,262        —          (264,000     17,523,863        805,936 8  
1    

K Naganuma is a director of Asatsu-DK, which at 18 April 2011 had interests in 31,295,646 shares representing 2.47% of the issued share capital of the Company.

2    

Interests include investment shares committed to the 2007, 2008, 2009 and 2010 awards under the LEAP plans but do not include matching shares from these plans, if any.

3    

In September 2010, AIB Group (UK) plc released from its charge to Paul Richardson 256,319 shares in the Company. These shares and 203,471 WPP ordinary shares also owned by Paul Richardson were converted into 91,958 WPP American Depositary Receipts. In September 2010, Paul Richardson agreed to charge 91,958 ADRs to Bank of America, N .A. as security for bank facilities being made available to him.

4    

Includes 3,790,489 shares pursuant to the vesting of the 2004 and 2005 awards and part of the 2006 award granted under LEAP. The receipt of these awards has been deferred until November 2017.

5    

Includes 3,636,950 shares which originally formed part of the Capital Investment Plan (an award in respect of 4,691,392 shares in total, some of which have been received by Sir Martin Sorrell) and comprised the UK and US Deferred Stock Units Awards Agreements.

6    

In September 2010, Sir Martin Sorrell and the trustees of two family life interest trusts of Sir Martin Sorrell charged to HSBC Private Bank Limited 984,770 and 3,863,147 ordinary shares in the Company respectively as security for facilities. These shares were previously charged to AIB Group (UK) plc as security for facilities, but were released in September 2010. In September 2010, JMS Financial Services Limited Retirement Benefit Scheme transferred 3,001,073 ordinary shares in the Company to Sir Martin Sorrell. Sir Martin Sorrell charged these shares to HSBC as further security of the facilities made available to him. These shares were previously charged to AIB Group (UK) plc as security for facilities, but were released from the charge in September 2010.

7    

In March 2011, Sir Martin Sorrell gifted 264,000 ordinary shares to the JMMRJ Sorrell Charitable Foundation.

8    

The JMMRJ Sorrell Charitable Foundation, of which Sir Martin Sorrell is a joint trustee, is interested in 805,936 WPP plc shares. Sir Martin has no beneficial interest in these shares.

 

59


Table of Contents

Options held by executive directors

 

The options held by Mark Read at 31 December 2010 were granted prior to him becoming a director of the Company.

 

      

Grant/
award

date

   

End of

exercise

period

  Exercise
price
 

At 1 Jan

2010

(no. of
shares)

  Granted/
(lapsed)
2010
(no. of
shares)
 

Exercised
2010

(no. of
shares)

    Share
price
  on
exercise
    Value on
exercise
   

At 31 Dec

2010

(no. of
shares)

  Share
price 31  Dec
2010
1
 

Mark Read

     17.11.2003      17.11.2013   £5.595   10,615   —       —         —         —       10,615   £ 7.895   
       29.10.2004      29.10.2014   £5.535   9,879   —       —         —         —       9,879   £ 7.895   
1    

Share price 12-month high/low: £7.95/£5.725.

 

60


Table of Contents

ITEM 7. MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

 

A. Major Shareholders

 

As of the dates shown below, the Company is aware of the following interests of 3% or more in the issued ordinary share capital of the Company:

 

           18 April            16 April            30 April  
               2011              2010              2009  

Legal & General

     3.78     47,884,647         3.99     50,154,226         4.39     55,109,569   

BlackRock Inc.

     *        *         5.10     64,106,906         *        *   

AXA S.A.

     *        *         4.95     62,221,408         *        *   

Massachusetts Financial Services Company

     *        *         4.84     60,838,710         4.84     60,758,614   

Invesco plc

     *        *         *        *         4.60     57,745,790   
*   No interests in the issued ordinary share capital of the Company in excess of 3.0% have been notified to the Company.

 

The disclosed interests refer to the respective combined holdings of those entities and to interests associated with them. The Company has not been notified of any other holdings of ordinary share capital of 3% or more. None of these shareholders has voting rights that are different from those of the holders of the Company’s ordinary shares generally. As far as WPP is aware, it is neither directly nor indirectly owned or controlled by one or more corporations or by any government, or by any other natural or legal persons severally or jointly.

 

The number of outstanding ordinary shares at 31 December 2010 was 1,264,391,221 which includes the underlying ordinary shares represented by 10,766,211 ADSs. 223 share owners of record of WPP ordinary shares were US residents at 31 December 2010.

 

The geographic distribution of our share ownership as of 31 December 2010 is presented below:

 

United Kingdom

     38%      

United States

     34%      

Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East, Canada and Continental Europe

     28%      

Total

     100%      

 

B. Related Party Transactions

 

From time to time the Group enters into transactions with its associated undertakings. These transactions were not material for any of the years presented.

 

C. Interests of Experts and Counsel

 

Not applicable.

 

61


Table of Contents
ITEM 8. FINANCIAL INFORMATION

 

A. Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

 

See Item 18.

 

Outstanding legal proceedings

 

The Company has claims against others and there are claims against the Company in a variety of matters arising from the conduct of its business. In the opinion of the management of the Company, the ultimate liability, if any, that is likely to result from these matters would not have a material adverse effect on the Company’s financial position, or on the results of its operations.

 

Dividend distribution policy

 

The profit before tax for the year was £851.3 million (2009: £662.6 million, 2008: £746.8 million). The directors declared a second interim dividend of 11.82p (2009: 10.28p, 2008: 10.28p) per share to be paid on 4 July 2011 to share owners on the register at 3 June 2011 which, together with the first interim ordinary dividend of 5.97p (2009: 5.19p, 2008: 5.19p) per share paid on 8 November 2010, makes a total of 17.79p for the year (2009: 15.47p, 2008: 15.47p).

 

ADS holders are eligible for all stock dividends or other entitlements accruing on the underlying WPP plc shares and receive all cash dividends in US dollars. These are normally paid twice a year. Dividend cheques are mailed directly to the ADS holder on the payment date if ADSs are registered with WPP’s US Depositary, Citibank N.A. Dividends on ADSs that are registered with brokers are sent to the brokers, who forward them to ADS holders.

 

Dividend Access Trust

 

Following the scheme of arrangement on 19 November 2008, WPP put in place a dividend access plan (the “Dividend Access Plan”) under which share owners may elect to be paid dividends from WPP DAS Limited (a subsidiary of WPP formed in 2008 and resident for tax purposes in the UK) rather than from WPP (a company resident for tax purposes in Ireland). The Dividend Access Plan is primarily designed to ensure that share owners may continue to receive UK dividends, meaning in particular that under the Dividend Access Plan, no Irish tax is required to be withheld from the payment of dividends to share owners. The tax consequences of receiving dividends under the Dividend Access Plan or directly from WPP are described in Item 10E.

 

Share owners who hold more than 100,000 ordinary shares and who wish to receive their dividend from a United Kingdom source must make an election and should contact Computershare Investor Services for the relevant forms. Share owners who held 100,000 or fewer WPP ordinary shares on the date of admission of the Company’s shares to the London Stock Exchange, or (if later) on the first dividend record date after they became share owners in the Company, will be automatically deemed to have elected to receive a United Kingdom-sourced dividend. All elections remain in force indefinitely unless revoked. Unless share owners have made, or are deemed to have made, an election under the Dividend Access Plan, their dividends will be paid from an Irish source and be taxed accordingly.

 

In 2009 WPP DAS Limited issued one dividend access share to Computershare, which acts as trustee pursuant to a dividend access trust that has been constituted pursuant to a trust deed. The trust deed provides that:

 

  (a)   the dividend access trust will hold any dividends paid (not just declared) on the dividend access share in trust for share owners who have elected (or are deemed to have elected) to receive dividends pursuant to this arrangement; and

 

62


Table of Contents
  (b)   each registered share owner on a dividend record date who has made a valid election (or is deemed to have made a valid election) under the Dividend Access Plan will, assuming WPP DAS Limited has sufficient distributable reserves as at the time of the distribution to the trustee, be entitled to receive from the trustee an amount equal to the dividend it would have received from WPP, to the extent that the trustee has actually received an amount by way of dividend from WPP DAS Limited.

 

To ensure compliance with UK trust law rules, the period during which the dividend access trust may continue is restricted. However, the dividend access trust under current law is able to continue for 80 years.

 

Share owners will not have any interest in the dividend access share and will not have any rights against WPP DAS Limited as the issuer of the dividend access share. The only assets held in trust for the benefit of share owners will be dividends paid to the trustee in respect of the dividend access share.

 

Shortfall in dividend payment

 

To the extent that dividends paid to the dividend access trust are insufficient to fund an amount equal to the dividend paid on the relevant ordinary shares, any dividend on the dividend access share received by the dividend access trust will be allocated pro rata to the relevant share owners and WPP will pay the balance of the dividend due to those share owners by way of a dividend on the ordinary shares. Any such dividend paid on ordinary shares will have an Irish source and will generally be subject to Irish dividend withholding tax at such rate as may be applicable under Irish law or the exemptions from Irish dividend withholding tax contained in Irish law or any applicable double tax treaty. In such circumstances, there will be no grossing up by WPP nor will WPP DAS Limited or WPP compensate share owners for any adverse consequences including any Irish dividend withholding tax.

 

Termination

 

WPP and WPP DAS Limited reserve the right to suspend or terminate the Dividend Access Plan arrangements at any time, in which case, any dividends will be paid directly to all share owners (including share owners who have made or are deemed to have made) an election to participate in the Dividend Access Plan.

 

ADSs

 

In accordance with the provisions of the Deposit Agreement by and among WPP, Citibank, N.A., as Depositary, and the holders and beneficial owners of WPP’s ADSs, the Depositary has made an election on behalf of all holders of ADSs to receive dividends from WPP DAS Limited under the Dividend Access Plan. If a holder of ADSs does not wish to receive dividends from WPP DAS Limited under the Dividend Access Plan, the holder must withdraw his or her ordinary shares from the ADS program prior to the dividend record date set by the Depositary and request delivery of the ordinary shares. This will enable the holder to receive dividends from WPP (if necessary, by making an election to that effect).

 

WPP DAS Limited 2010 financial statements are presented on page F-49.

 

B. Significant changes

 

None.

 

63


Table of Contents

ITEM 9. THE OFFER AND LISTING

 

A. Offer and Listing Details

 

Share price history

 

The Company’s ordinary shares have been traded on The London Stock Exchange since 1971.

 

The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the reported high and low middle-market quotations for the Company’s ordinary shares on The London Stock Exchange, based on its Daily Official List.

 

       £ per
Ordinary Share
 
       High    Low  

2006

   7.07      6.09   

2007

   7.88      5.77   

2008

   6.48      3.10   

2009

     

First Quarter

   4.40      3.53   

Second Quarter

   4.93      3.98   

Third Quarter

   5.51      3.85   

Fourth Quarter

   6.15      5.26   

2010

     

First Quarter

   6.83      5.73   

Second Quarter

   7.40      6.08   

Third Quarter

   7.30      6.15   

October

   7.44      6.97   

November

   7.55      7.12   

December

   7.95      7.29   

Fourth Quarter

   7.95      6.97   

2011

     

January

   8.02      7.73   

February

   8.47      7.78   

March

   8.37      7.38   

First Quarter

   8.47      7.38   

 

64


Table of Contents

The ordinary shares have traded in the United States since 29 December 1987 in the form of ADSs, which are evidenced by ADRs or held in book entry form. The Depositary for the ADSs is Citibank, N.A. in New York. The following table sets forth, for the periods indicated, the reported high and low sales prices of the ADSs as reported by NASDAQ.

 

       US dollars per ADS  
       High          Low      

2006

     67.90         53.72   

2007

     77.93         59.47   

2008

     63.19         23.28   

2009

     

First Quarter

     31.26         24.54   

Second Quarter

     39.22         29.47   

Third Quarter

     44.96         31.03   

Fourth Quarter

     49.99         41.76   

2010

     

First Quarter

     51.55         44.30   

Second Quarter

     57.03         44.48   

Third Quarter

     57.07         46.97   

October

     58.51         55.23   

November

     61.33         55.56   

December

     61.97         57.02   

Fourth Quarter

     61.97         55.23   

2011

     

January

     63.91         60.65   

February

     68.78         62.84   

March

     68.17         58.74   

First Quarter

     68.78         58.74   

 

The Depositary held 53,831,058 ordinary shares as at 31 December 2010, approximately 4.26% of the outstanding ordinary shares, represented by 10,766,211 outstanding ADSs.

 

B. Plan of Distribution

 

Not applicable.

 

C. Markets

 

See the discussion under “Share price history” in Item 9A.

 

D. Selling Shareholders

 

Not applicable.

 

E. Dilution

 

Not applicable.

 

F. Expenses of the Issue

 

Not applicable.

 

65


Table of Contents

ITEM 10. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

A. Share Capital

 

Not applicable.

 

B. Memorandum and Articles of Association

 

WPP is a public limited company incorporated under the name “WPP plc” in Jersey with registered number 101749.

 

The following summarizes certain provisions of our memorandum and articles of association and applicable Jersey law. This summary is qualified in its entirety by reference to the Jersey Companies Law and our memorandum and articles of association. A copy of our memorandum and articles of association in the form adopted on 30 September 2008 is filed as an exhibit to a Form 6-K that we filed with the SEC on 9 December 2008.

 

Objects and Purposes

 

Under the Jersey Companies Law, the capacity of a Jersey company is not limited by anything contained in its memorandum or articles of association. Accordingly, the memorandum of association of a Jersey company does not contain an objects clause.

 

Rights attaching to WPP ordinary shares

 

Voting rights of share owners – subject to disenfranchisement in the event of: (A) non-payment of any call or other sum due and payable in respect of any ordinary share; or (B) any non-compliance with any statutory notice requiring disclosure of the beneficial ownership of any ordinary shares and subject to any special rights or restrictions as to voting for the time being attached to any ordinary shares (as to which there are none at present), on a show of hands every qualifying person (i.e. share owner, proxy or authorised corporate representative) present has one vote and on a poll every share owner present in person or by proxy has one vote for every ordinary share of which he or she is a holder, except that any proxy who has been appointed by the Depositary shall have such number of votes as equals the number of ordinary shares in relation to which such proxy has been appointed. In the case of joint holders, the vote of the person whose name stands first in the register of members and who tenders a vote is accepted to the exclusion of any votes tendered by any other joint holders.

 

Return of capital – the liquidator may, with the sanction of a special resolution of WPP and any other sanction required by the Statutes: (A) divide among the WPP share owners in specie the whole or any part of the assets of WPP; or (B) vest the whole or any part of the assets in trustees on such trusts for the benefit of share owners as the liquidator shall think fit, but no share owner shall be compelled to accept any assets upon which there is any liability. The “Statutes” means the Jersey Companies Law and every other statute, statutory instrument, regulation or order, for the time being in force, concerning companies registered under the Jersey Companies Law, including the Electronic Communication (Jersey) Law 2000 and the Companies (Uncertificated Securities) (Jersey) Order 1999.

 

Capitalisation of reserves

 

The board of directors may, with the authority of an ordinary resolution of WPP: (A) resolve to capitalise any sum standing to the credit of any reserve account of WPP (including share premium account and capital redemption reserve) or any sum standing to the credit of profit and loss account

 

66


Table of Contents

not required for the payment of any preferential dividend (whether or not it is available for distribution); and (B) appropriate that sum as capital to the share owners in proportion to the nominal amount of the ordinary shares held by them respectively and apply that sum on their behalf in paying up in full any unissued ordinary shares or debentures of WPP of a nominal amount equal to that sum and allot the ordinary shares or debentures credited as fully paid to those share owners, or as they may direct, in those proportions or in paying up the whole or part of any amounts that are unpaid in respect of any issued ordinary shares held by them respectively, or otherwise deal with such sum as directed by the resolution, provided that the share premium account and the capital redemption reserve and any sum not available for distribution in accordance with the Statutes may only be applied in paying up unissued ordinary shares to be allotted credited as fully paid up.

 

Transfer of ordinary shares

 

Subject to any restrictions in the articles of association, a share owner may transfer all or any of his ordinary shares in any manner that is permitted by the Statutes and is from time to time approved by the board of directors. WPP shall register the transfer of any ordinary shares held in uncertificated form by means of a relevant system in accordance with the Statutes. The board of directors may, in its absolute discretion, refuse to register any transfer of an uncertificated share where permitted by articles of association and the Statutes.

 

A share owner may transfer all or any of his certificated ordinary shares by an instrument of transfer in any usual form, or in such other form as the board of directors may approve. The instrument of transfer shall be signed by or on behalf of the transferor and, except in the case of a fully paid share, by or on behalf of the transferee. The board of directors may, in its absolute discretion, refuse to register any transfer of any certificated ordinary share that is not fully paid up (but not so as to prevent dealings in ordinary shares admitted to official listing by the United Kingdom Listing Authority (UKLA) from taking place on an open and proper basis) or on which WPP has a lien. The board of directors may also refuse to register any instrument of transfer of a certificated ordinary share unless it is lodged at the registered office, or such other place as the board of directors may decide, for registration, accompanied by the share certificate for the ordinary shares to be transferred and such other evidence as the board of directors may reasonably require to prove title of the intending transferor or his right to transfer the ordinary shares and it is in respect of only one class of WPP shares. If the board of directors refuses to register a transfer of a certificated ordinary share it shall, as soon as practicable and in any event within two months after the date on which the instrument of transfer was lodged or the operator-instruction was received, give to the transferee notice of the refusal. The board of directors must provide the transferee with such further information about the reasons for the refusal as the transferee may reasonably request. Unless otherwise agreed by the board of directors in any particular case, the maximum number of persons who may be entered on the register as joint holders of an ordinary share is four.

 

Changes in capital

 

Subject to the provisions of the Jersey Companies Law, WPP may by special resolution:

 

   

increase its share capital;

 

   

consolidate and divide all or any of its share capital into ordinary shares of a larger amount;

 

   

sub-divide all or part of its share capital into ordinary shares of a smaller amount;

 

   

cancel any ordinary shares that have not, at the date of the special resolution, been taken or agreed to be taken by any person and diminish the amount of its authorised share capital by the amount of the ordinary shares so cancelled; or

 

   

alter its share capital in any other manner permitted by the Jersey Companies Law.

 

67


Table of Contents

Subject to the provisions of the Jersey Companies Law, WPP may by special resolution:

 

   

purchase ordinary shares, including any redeemable ordinary shares; and

 

   

reduce its share capital and any capital redemption reserve or share premium account.

 

Authority to allot securities and disapplication of pre-emption rights

 

WPP may from time to time pass an ordinary resolution authorizing the board of directors to exercise all the powers of WPP to allot relevant securities up to the nominal amount specified in the resolution. The authority shall expire on the day specified in the resolution, not being more than five years after the date on which the resolution is passed.

 

On the passing of a special resolution, the board of directors shall have power to allot equity securities for cash but that power shall be limited: (A) to the allotment of equity securities in connection with a rights issue; and (B) to the allotment (other than in connection with a rights issue) of equity securities having a nominal amount not exceeding in aggregate the sum specified in the special resolution (i.e. the articles of association do not contain any pre-emption rights).

 

Variation of rights

 

Whenever the share capital of WPP is divided into different classes of ordinary shares (which it is not as at the date of this document), all or any of the rights for the time being attached to any class of ordinary shares in issue may, subject to the Statutes, be varied, either in such manner as those rights may provide or with the consent in writing of the holders of two-thirds in nominal value of the issued ordinary shares of that class or with the sanction of a special resolution passed at a separate general meeting of the holders of those ordinary shares. At any separate general meeting, the necessary quorum is two persons holding or representing by proxy at least one-third in nominal amount of the issued ordinary shares of the class in question (but at any adjourned meeting, one person holding ordinary shares of the class or his proxy is a quorum).

 

Disclosure of interests in ordinary shares

 

WPP may give a disclosure notice to any person whom it believes is either:

 

   

interested in the ordinary shares; or

 

   

has been so interested at any time during the three years on which the disclosure notice is issued.

 

The disclosure notice may require the person:

 

   

to confirm that fact or (as the case may be) to state whether or not it is the case; and

 

   

if he holds, or has during that time held, any such interest, to give such further information as may be required.

 

The notice may require the person to whom it is addressed, where either:

 

   

his interest is a present interest and another interest in the ordinary shares subsists; or

 

   

another interest in the ordinary shares subsisted during that three year period at a time when his interest subsisted, to give, so far as lies within his knowledge, such particulars with respect to that other interest as may be required by the notice including:

 

   

the identity of persons interested in the ordinary shares in question; and

 

68


Table of Contents
   

whether persons interested in the same ordinary shares are or were parties to either an agreement to acquire interests in a particular company, or an agreement or arrangement relating to the exercise of any rights conferred by the holding of the ordinary shares.

 

The notice may require the person to whom it is addressed, where his interest is a past interest, to give (so far as lies within his knowledge) particulars of the identity of the person who held that interest immediately upon his ceasing to hold it.

 

Failure to provide the information within 14 days after the notice has been given means that the holder of the relevant ordinary shares shall not be entitled to vote either personally or by proxy at a shareholders’ meeting or to exercise any other right confirmed by membership in relation to shareholder meetings for so long as the default continues (and, if those ordinary shares represent at least 0.25 percent of the issued ordinary shares of the class, the holder shall not be entitled to receive any payment by way of dividend or to transfer any rights in the ordinary shares).

 

Register of members

 

The register of members of WPP must be kept and maintained in Jersey.

 

Uncertificated ordinary shares – general powers

 

Subject to the Jersey Companies Law and the Uncertificated Securities Order (as defined in the articles of association), the board of directors may permit any class of ordinary shares to be held in uncertificated form and to be transferred by means of a relevant system and may revoke such permission. In relation to any uncertificated ordinary share, WPP may utilise the relevant system in which it is held to the fullest extent available from time to time in the exercise of any of its powers or functions under the Statutes or the articles of association or otherwise in effecting any actions. Any provision in the articles of association in relation to uncertificated ordinary shares that is inconsistent with any applicable statutory provision shall not apply. WPP may, by notice to the holder of an uncertificated share, require the holder to change the form of that ordinary share to certificated form within such period as may be specified in the notice. For the purpose of effecting any action by WPP, the board of directors may determine that holdings of the same share owner in uncertificated form and in certificated form shall be treated as separate holdings but ordinary shares of a class held by a person in uncertificated form shall not be treated as a separate class from ordinary shares of that class held by that person in certificated form.

 

Directors

 

The WPP directors (other than alternate directors) shall not, unless otherwise determined by an ordinary resolution of WPP, be fewer than six in number.

 

A director need not be a share owner.

 

There is no age limit for directors.

 

At each Annual General Meeting any director then in office who has been appointed by the board of directors since the previous Annual General Meeting or for whom it is the third Annual General Meeting following the Annual General Meeting at which he was elected or re-elected shall retire from office but shall be eligible for re-election.

 

The directors shall be paid fees not exceeding in aggregate £1,500,000 per annum (or such larger sum as WPP may, by ordinary resolution, determine) as the board of directors may decide to be

 

69


Table of Contents

divided among them. Such fee shall be divided among them in such proportion and manner as they may agree or, failing agreement, equally.

 

The board of directors may grant special remuneration to any director who performs any special or extra services to, or at the request of, WPP. Special remuneration may be payable to a director in addition to his ordinary remuneration (if any) as a director.

 

The directors shall also be paid out of the funds of WPP all expenses properly incurred by them in and about the discharge of their duties, including their expenses of travelling to and from the meetings of the board of directors, committee meetings and general meetings.

 

The board of directors may exercise all the powers of WPP to pay, provide or procure the grant of pensions or other retirement or superannuation benefits and death, disability or other benefits, allowances or gratuities to any person who is or has been at any time a director or in the employment or service of WPP or of any company that is or was a subsidiary of or associated with WPP or of the predecessors in business of WPP or any subsidiary or associated company or the relatives or dependants of any such person. For that purpose, the board of directors may procure the establishment and maintenance of, or participate in, or contribute to any non-contributory or contributory pension or superannuation fund, scheme or arrangement or pay any insurance premiums.

 

Subject to any applicable statutory provisions and to declaring his interests in accordance with the articles of association, a director may enter into or be interested in any transaction or arrangement with WPP, either with regard to his tenure of any office or position in the management, administration or conduct of the business of WPP, or as vendor, purchaser or otherwise. A director may hold and be remunerated in respect of any other office or place of profit with WPP (other than the office of auditor of WPP) in conjunction with his office as a director and he (or his firm) may also act in a professional capacity for WPP (except as auditor) and may be remunerated for it.

 

A director who, to his knowledge, is in any way, whether directly or indirectly, interested in a transaction or arrangement or a proposed transaction or arrangement with WPP or any of its subsidiaries, or if any situation exists in which a director has or can have a direct or indirect interest that conflicts with or may conflict with the interests of WPP, shall disclose to WPP the nature and extent of the interest or situation in accordance with the articles of association.

 

Board meetings and committee meetings shall not take place in the United Kingdom and no director may participate in any meeting if he is physically present in the United Kingdom at any time during the meeting. Any decision reached or resolution passed by the directors at any meeting that is held in the United Kingdom or any meeting in respect of which any director participating in the meeting is physically present in the United Kingdom during the meeting shall be invalid and of no effect. The place of the board meeting shall be deemed to be at the place at which the chairman of the meeting is physically present.

 

A director shall not vote or be counted in the quorum at a meeting in respect of any resolution concerning his own appointment (including fixing and varying its terms), or the termination of his own appointment, as the holder of any office or place of profit with WPP or any other company in which WPP is interested but, where proposals are under consideration concerning the appointment (including fixing or varying its terms), or the termination of the appointment, of two or more directors to offices or places of profit with WPP or any company in which WPP is interested, those proposals may be divided and considered in relation to each director separately, and in such case each of the directors concerned (if not otherwise debarred from voting under the articles of association) shall be entitled to vote and be counted in the quorum in respect of each resolution except that concerning his own appointment or the termination of his own appointment.

 

70


Table of Contents

A director shall not vote (or be counted in the quorum at a meeting) in respect of any transaction or arrangement or other proposal in which he has an interest that (together with any interest of a connected person) is to his knowledge a direct or indirect interest and as may reasonably be required as likely to give rise to a conflict. Notwithstanding the above, a director shall be entitled to vote (and be counted in the quorum) on: (A) any transaction or arrangement in which he is interested by virtue of an interest in ordinary shares, debentures or other securities of WPP or otherwise in or through WPP; (B) the giving of any guarantee, security or indemnity in respect of money lent or obligations incurred by him or by any other person at the request of, or for the benefit of, WPP or any of its subsidiaries; or a debt or obligation of WPP or any of its subsidiaries for which he himself has assumed responsibility under a guarantee or indemnity or by the giving of security; (C) (subject to the Statutes) indemnification (including loans made in connection with it) by WPP in relation to the performance of his duties on behalf of WPP or any of its subsidiaries; (D) any issue or offer of ordinary shares, debentures or other securities of WPP or any of its subsidiaries in respect of which he is or may be entitled to participate in his capacity as holder of any such securities or as an underwriter or sub-underwriter; (E) any transaction or arrangement concerning another company in which he and any connected person do not to his knowledge hold, directly or indirectly as shareholders, or through their direct or indirect holdings of financial instruments (within the meaning of Chapter 5 of the Disclosure and Transparency Rules) voting rights representing one percent or more of any class of ordinary shares in the capital of such company; (F) any arrangement for the benefit of employees of WPP or any of its subsidiaries that does not accord to him any privilege or benefit not generally accorded to the employees to whom the arrangement relates; and (G) the purchase or maintenance of insurance for the benefit of the directors or for the benefit of persons including the directors. “Disclosure and Transparency Rules” means the rules and regulations made by the Financial Services Authority in its capacity as the UK Listing Authority under Part VI of the UK Financial Services and Markets Act of 2000, as amended, and contained in the UK Listing Authority’s publication of the same name.

 

WPP shall not make a payment for loss of office to a director unless the payment has been approved by an ordinary resolution of WPP.

 

General meetings

 

The board of directors shall convene, and WPP shall hold, an Annual General Meeting in accordance with the Statutes. Other general meetings shall be held whenever the board of directors thinks fit or on the requisition of WPP share owners in accordance with the Statutes or the articles of association.

 

An Annual General Meeting shall be called by not less than 21 days’ written notice and any other general meeting shall be called by not less than 14 clear days’ written notice.

 

The requisite quorum for general meetings of WPP shall be two qualifying persons, entitled to vote on the business to be transacted at the meeting.

 

Borrowing powers

 

The board of directors may exercise all the powers of WPP to borrow money and to mortgage or charge all or any part of its undertaking, property and assets (both present and future) and uncalled capital and to issue debentures and other securities, whether outright or as collateral security for any debt, liability or obligations of WPP or of any third party. The board of directors shall restrict the borrowings of WPP and exercise all voting and other rights or powers of control exercisable by WPP in relation to its subsidiaries (if any) so as to secure (as regards subsidiaries only so far as by such

 

71


Table of Contents

exercise it can secure) that the aggregate principal amount outstanding at any time in respect of all borrowings by the WPP Group (exclusive of any borrowings that are owed by one WPP Group company to another WPP Group company) after deducting the amount of cash deposited will not, without the previous sanction of WPP in general meeting, exceed an amount equal to 2.5 times the adjusted capital and reserves (as defined in the articles of association) or any higher limit fixed by ordinary resolution of WPP that is applicable at the relevant time. “WPP Group” means WPP and its subsidiaries, subsidiary undertakings and associated undertakings.

 

To date, no resolution of the type referred to in this paragraph has been passed.

 

Dividends

 

Declaration of dividends – subject to the provisions of the Jersey Companies Law, WPP may, by ordinary resolution, declare a dividend to be paid to the share owners, according to their respective rights and interests in the profits, and may fix the time for payment of such dividend, but no dividend shall exceed the amount recommended by the board of directors.

 

Fixed and interim dividends – subject to the provisions of the Jersey Companies Law, the board of directors may pay such interim dividends as appear to the board of directors to be justified by the financial position of WPP and may also pay any dividend payable at a fixed rate at intervals settled by the board of directors whenever the financial position of WPP, in the opinion of the board of directors, justifies its payment. If the board of directors acts in good faith, none of the directors shall incur any liability to the share owners conferring preferred rights for any loss such share owners may suffer in consequence of the lawful payment of an interim dividend on any ordinary shares having non-preferred or deferred rights.

 

Calculation and currency of dividends – except insofar as the rights attaching to, or the terms of issue of, any shares otherwise provide: (A) all dividends shall be declared and paid according to the amounts paid up on the ordinary shares in respect of which the dividend is paid, but no amount paid up on an ordinary share in advance of calls shall be treated as paid up on the ordinary share; (B) all dividends shall be apportioned and paid pro rata according to the amounts paid up on the ordinary shares during any portion or portions of the period in respect of which the dividend is paid; (C) any amount paid by WPP by way of dividend will be deemed to include any amount that WPP may be compelled by law to withhold or deduct; and (D) dividends may be declared or paid in any currency. The board of directors may agree with any share owner that dividends that may at any time or from time to time be declared or become due on his ordinary shares in one currency shall be paid or satisfied in another, and may agree the basis of conversion to be applied and how and when the amount to be paid in the other currency shall be calculated and paid and for WPP or any other person to bear any costs involved.

 

Dividends not to bear interest – no dividend or other moneys payable by WPP on or in respect of any ordinary share shall bear interest as against WPP unless otherwise provided by the rights attached to the ordinary share.

 

Calls or debts or amounts required by law may be deducted from dividends – the board of directors may deduct from any dividend or other moneys payable to any person (either alone or jointly with another) on or in respect of an ordinary share all such sums as may be due from him (either alone or jointly with another) to WPP on account of calls or otherwise in relation to ordinary shares.

 

Dividends in specie – with the authority of an ordinary resolution of WPP and on the recommendation of the board of directors, payment of any dividend may be satisfied wholly or in part by the distribution of specific assets and in particular of paid up ordinary shares or debentures of any other company.

 

72


Table of Contents

Scrip dividends – the board of directors may, with the authority of an ordinary resolution of WPP, offer any share owners the right to elect to receive further ordinary shares (whether or not of that class) credited as fully paid, by way of scrip dividend instead of cash in respect of all (or some part) of any dividend specified by the ordinary resolution.

 

Subject to share owner approval at the Company’s Annual General Meeting, the Board also proposes to put in place a scrip dividend scheme which will enable share owners to elect to receive new fully paid ordinary shares in the Company instead of cash dividends, commencing with the second interim dividend for 2010. Details of the scrip dividend scheme, including the taxation of the scrip dividend and details of the election date for the proposed scrip dividend alternative in respect of the second interim dividend for 2010, will be sent to share owners together with the notice of the Company’s Annual General Meeting.

 

Unclaimed dividends – any dividend unclaimed for a period of 12 years after having become due for payment shall be forfeited and cease to remain owing by WPP.

 

Forfeiture of ordinary shares

 

If the whole or any part of any call or installment remains unpaid on any ordinary share after the due date for payment, the board of directors may serve a written notice on the share owner requiring him to pay so much of the call or installment as remains unpaid, together with any accrued interest.

 

The written notice shall state a further day, being not less than 14 clear days from the date of the notice, on or before which, and the place where, payment is to be made and shall state that, in the event of non-payment on or before the day and at the place appointed, the ordinary share in respect of which the call was made or installment is payable will be liable to be forfeited.

 

If the requirements of a notice are not complied with, any ordinary share in respect of which it was given may (before the payment required by the notice is made) be forfeited by a resolution of the board of directors. The forfeiture shall include all dividends declared and other moneys payable in respect of the forfeited ordinary share and not actually paid before the forfeiture.

 

Every ordinary share that is forfeited or surrendered shall become the property of WPP and (subject to the Statutes) may be sold, re-allotted or otherwise disposed of, upon such terms and in such manner as the board of directors shall decide either to the person who was before the forfeiture the share owner or to any other person and whether with or without all or any part of the amount previously paid up on the ordinary share being credited as so paid up.

 

Website communication with share owners

 

The articles of association enable WPP to use its website as a means of sending or supplying documents or information to share owners. Before communicating with a share owner by means of its website, WPP must have asked the share owner, individually, to agree (generally or specifically) that WPP may send or supply documents or information to him by means of a website. A member shall be deemed to have agreed that WPP may send or supply a document or information by means of a website if no response to the request is received within 28 days. When communicating with share owners by means of website communications, WPP will notify the share owners (by post or other permitted means) of the presence of a document or information on the website.

 

Directors’ indemnity, insurance and defence

 

As far as the legislation allows, WPP may:

 

(i) indemnify any director (or of an associated body corporate) against any liability;

 

73


Table of Contents

(ii) indemnify a director of a company that is a trustee of an occupational pension scheme for employees (or former employees) of WPP (or of an associated body corporate) against liability incurred in connection with WPP’s activities as trustee of the scheme;

 

(iii) purchase and maintain insurance against any liability for any director referred to in paragraph (i) or (ii) above; and

 

(iv) provide any director referred to in paragraph (i) or (ii) above with funds (whether by loan or otherwise) to meet expenditure incurred or to be incurred by him in defending any criminal, regulatory or civil proceedings or in connection with an application for relief (or to enable any such director to avoid incurring such expenditure).

 

C. Material Contracts

 

The following is a summary of each contract (not being a contract entered into in the ordinary course of business) that has been entered into by any member of the WPP Group: (a) within the two years immediately preceding the date of this Form 20-F which are, or may be, material to the WPP Group; or (b) at any time which contain obligations or entitlements which are, or may be, material to the WPP Group as at the date of this Form 20-F:

 

(i) on 3 August 1998, WPP 2005 Limited entered into an agreement with Asatsu pursuant to which WPP 2005 Limited subscribed for approximately 23% (at that time) of the share capital of Asatsu for approximately £139 million and Asatsu subscribed for 31,295,646 ordinary shares in WPP 2005 Limited representing approximately 4% (at that time) of the issued share capital of WPP 2005 Limited. Each party agreed not to transfer any shares held by them in the other for a period of five years and thereafter only to transfer such shares following a procedure set out in the agreement. Each party is further entitled to nominate a non-executive director to the board of the other subject to retaining its shareholding in the other. Due to the disparity of the percentage shareholdings of WPP 2005 Limited in Asatsu and of Asatsu in WPP 2005 Limited, an agreement was also entered into on 3 August 1998 imposing, inter alia , limitations, in certain circumstances, on the voting rights in respect of the shares held by WPP 2005 Limited in Asatsu;

 

(ii) on 23 June 2004, WPP Finance (UK) issued US$650,000,000 of 5.875% Notes due 2014 pursuant to the Indenture and the First Supplemental Indenture both dated as of 23 June 2004 among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP 2005 Limited, as guarantor and Citibank N.A., as Trustee, as supplemented by the First Supplemental Indenture dated as of 23 June 2004 among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP 2005 Limited, as Guarantor and Citibank N.A., as Trustee. The Notes were fully and unconditionally guaranteed by WPP 2008 Limited pursuant to the Second Supplemental Indenture dated 27 June 2006 and by WPP Young & Rubicam US Holdings (a subsidiary of WPP) pursuant to the Third Supplemental Indenture dated 19 December 2006. The Notes were fully and unconditionally guaranteed by WPP and WPP Air 1 Limited (a subsidiary of WPP) pursuant to the Fourth Supplemental Indenture dated 7 October 2008 and the Fifth Supplemental Indenture dated 30 April 2009. The Indenture contains events of default provisions (including a cross-default provision). It also contains a restriction on the Issuer or any of the guarantors referred to above consolidating or merging with any other person and conveying, transferring or leasing all or substantially all of their properties and assets to any person except where the entity resulting from such consolidation or merger or to whom such properties and assets are transferred becomes a primary obligor of the Notes and gives certain certificates and indemnities. The covenants of the Indenture also contain a negative pledge and a limitation on the sale and leaseback of any assets by the guarantors referred to above and their principal subsidiaries. The Indenture allows for defeasance of these covenants subject to certain conditions. The Indenture also contains a joint and several indemnity from the Issuer and the guarantors referred to above in favour of the Trustee;

 

74


Table of Contents

(iii) on 23 August 2005, WPP 2005 Limited, WPP Finance Co. Limited and WPP Group U.S. Finance Corp. (as borrowers), guaranteed by WPP 2005 Limited, entered into an agreement for a seven-year multi-currency revolving credit facility (with a US Dollar swingline option) of US$1,600,000,000 with a syndicate of banks and Citibank International plc as facility agent. The facility is available for drawing by way of multi-currency cash advances on a revolving basis, with an option to draw US Dollar swingline advances up to a sub-limit of US$1,400,000,000. The rate of margin for the facility is 0.25% per annum (increasing to 0.275% per annum following the fifth anniversary of the date of the facility) above LIBOR. The commitment fee payable on undrawn commitments is equal to 30% of the then applicable margin. The interest rate for swingline advances is the higher of the US prime commercial lending rate and 0.25% per annum above the federal funds rate. WPP acceded to the facility as a borrower and a guarantor and each of WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited acceded to the facility as guarantors, in each case pursuant to an amendment and restatement agreement dated 17 November;

 

(iv) on 5 December 2006, WPP 2008 Limited issued EUR 600,000,000 4.375% guaranteed bonds due 2013. The bonds are guaranteed by WPP 2005 Limited and were constituted by a Trust Deed dated 5 December 2006 between Citicorp Trustee Company Limited, the guarantor and WPP 2008 Limited. The administration of payments to bondholders is provided for in a Paying Agency Agreement dated 5 December 2006 between WPP 2008 Limited, Citibank, N.A., London Branch and others. The bonds are listed on the London Stock Exchange and the terms and conditions contain a redemption provision at the option of the bondholders on a Change of Control, a negative pledge provision and the events of default provisions in the terms and conditions contain a cross-default provision. The Trust Deed also contains an indemnity by WPP 2008 Limited in favour of Citicorp Trustee Company Limited. Pursuant to a supplemental trust deed dated 14 November 2008, WPP, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited acceded as additional guarantors to the bonds;

 

(v) on 4 April 2007, WPP 2008 Limited issued £400,000,000 6.0% guaranteed bonds due 2017. The bonds are guaranteed by WPP 2005 Limited and were constituted by a Trust Deed dated 4 April 2007 between Citicorp Trustee Company Limited, the guarantor and WPP 2008 Limited. The bonds are listed on the London Stock Exchange and the terms and conditions contain a redemption provision at the option of the bondholders on a Change of Control, a negative pledge provision and events of default provisions (including a cross-default provision). The Trust Deed also contains an indemnity by WPP 2008 Limited in favour of Citicorp Trustee Company Limited. Pursuant to a supplemental trust deed dated 14 November 2008, WPP, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited acceded as additional guarantors to the bonds;

 

(vi) on 6 November 2007, WPP Finance S.A. issued EUR 500,000,000 5.25% guaranteed bonds due 2015 and £200,000,000 6.375% guaranteed bonds due 2020. Both tranches of bonds are guaranteed by WPP 2005 Limited and WPP 2008 Limited and were constituted respectively by two Trust Deeds dated 6 November 2007 between Citicorp Trustee Company Limited, the guarantors and WPP Finance S.A. The bonds are listed on the London Stock Exchange and the terms and conditions contain a redemption provision at the option of the bondholders on a Change of Control, a negative pledge provision and events of default provisions (including a cross-default provision). The Trust Deeds also contain indemnities by WPP Finance S.A. in favour of Citicorp Trustee Company Limited. Pursuant to a supplemental trust deed dated 14 November 2008, WPP, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited acceded as additional guarantors to the bonds;

 

(vii) on 12 May 2008, WPP 2008 Limited issued EUR 750,000,000 6.625% guaranteed bonds due 2016. The bonds are guaranteed by WPP 2005 Limited and were constituted by a Trust Deed dated 12 May 2008 between Citicorp Trustee Company Limited, the guarantor and

 

75


Table of Contents

WPP 2008 Limited. The bonds are listed on the London Stock Exchange and the terms and conditions contain a redemption provision at the option of the bondholders on a Change of Control, a negative pledge provision and events of default provisions (including a cross-default provision). The Trust Deed also contains an indemnity by WPP 2008 Limited in favour of Citicorp Trustee Company Limited. Pursuant to a supplemental trust deed dated 14 November 2008, WPP, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited acceded as additional guarantors to the bonds;

 

(viii) on 9 July 2008, WPP 2008 Limited and WPP Finance Co. Limited (as borrowers) and WPP and WPP 2005 Limited (as guarantors) entered into an agreement for a three-year revolving credit facility arranged by Banc of America Securities Limited, Banco Santander S.A., Barclays Capital, BNP Paribas, Citigroup Global Markets Limited, HSBC Bank plc and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as arrangers with Banco Santander S.A., London Branch, Barclays Bank PLC, BNP Paribas, BoA Netherlands Coöperatieve U.A., Citibank, N.A., HSBC Bank plc and The Royal Bank of Scotland plc as original lenders and Citibank International plc as facility agent. The amount of the facility is £600,000,000. The facility is available for drawing by way of multi-currency cash advances on a revolving basis. Pursuant to a side letter dated 12 November 2008, and in accordance with the terms of a syndication side letter between WPP and the original lenders dated 9 July 2008, the original lenders agreed to invoke their rights to market flex in order to enhance the prospects of successfully syndicating the facility. As a result the rate of margin for the facility is, if the long-term senior unsecured debt rating of WPP published by Moody’s or Standard & Poor’s (the “Credit Rating”) is A-/A3 or higher, 1.125% per annum. If the Credit Rating is BBB+ or Baa1, the rate of margin for the facility shall be 1.25% per annum. If the Credit Rating is BBB or Baa2, the rate of margin for the facility is 1.75% per annum. If the Credit Rating is BBB- or Baa3 or lower, the rate of margin for the facility is 2.00% per annum. If Moody’s and Standard & Poor’s assign different Credit Ratings, the margin shall be the average of the margins determined by each Credit Rating. The commitment fee payable on undrawn commitments is equal to 40% of the then applicable margin. The facility agreement contains customary representations, covenants and events of default. The facility agreement also requires the prepayment of proceeds received from certain disposals. WPP acceded to the facility as a borrower and a guarantor and each of WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited acceded to the facility as guarantors, in each case pursuant to an amendment and restatement agreement dated 17 November 2008.

 

(ix) effective 19 November 2008, WPP entered into a deposit agreement with Citibank, N.A., as Depositary, and the holders and beneficial owners of ADSs that sets out the terms on which the Depositary has agreed to act as depositary with respect to the WPP ADSs issued in exchange for WPP 2008 Limited ADSs following effectiveness of the Scheme. The deposit agreement contains, amongst other things, customary provisions pertaining to the form of ADR certificates, the deposit and withdrawal of ordinary shares, distributions to holders of ADSs, voting of ordinary shares underlying ADSs, obligations of the Depositary and WPP, charges of the Depositary, and compliance with applicable law.

 

(x) On May 19, 2009, WPP plc issued £450,000,000 of 5.75% guaranteed convertible bonds due 2014. The bonds are guaranteed by WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited and were constituted by a trust deed dated May 19, 2009. The bonds are listed on the London Stock Exchange and the terms and conditions contain a conversion provision allowing bondholders to convert their bonds into ordinary shares of WPP plc within a specified period. The bonds contain a conversion option upon a change of control, a negative pledge and events of default provisions (including a cross default provision). The trust deed contains an indemnity in favour of Citicorp Trustee Company Limited.

 

(xi) On 10 June 2009, WPP Finance (UK) issued US$600,000,000 of 8% guaranteed senior notes due 2014 pursuant to the Indenture and the First Supplemental Indenture both dated as

 

76


Table of Contents

of 10 June 2009 among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP plc, WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited and WPP 2005 Limited as Guarantors, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee. The Indenture contains events of default provisions (including a cross-default provision). It also contains a restriction on the Issuer or any of the Guarantors referred to above consolidating or merging with any other person and conveying, transferring or leasing all or substantially all of their properties and assets to any person except where the entity resulting from such consolidation or merger or to whom such properties and assets are transferred becomes a primary obligor of the notes and gives certain certificates and indemnities. The covenants of the Indenture also contain a negative pledge and a limitation on the sale and leaseback of any assets by the Guarantors referred to above and their principal subsidiaries. The Indenture allows for defeasance of these covenants subject to certain conditions. The holders of the notes have the right to require the Issuer to repurchase the notes at a price equal to 101% of the principal amount of the notes in the event that there is a change of control of WPP plc and the notes lose their investment grade rating. The Indenture also contains a joint and several indemnity from the Issuer and the Guarantors referred to above in favour of the Trustee.

 

D. Exchange Controls

 

There are currently no Jersey foreign exchange control restrictions on remittances of dividends on the ordinary shares or on the conduct of the Registrant’s operations.

 

E. Taxation

 

The taxation discussion set forth below is intended only as a descriptive summary and does not purport to be a complete technical analysis or listing of all potential tax effects relevant to a decision to purchase, hold or in any way transfer ordinary shares or ADSs. Each investor should seek advice based on their individual particular circumstances from an independent tax adviser.

 

The following summary of the Republic of Ireland, Jersey (UK in relation to dividend distributions) and the United States tax consequences is not exhaustive of all possible tax considerations and should not be considered legal or tax advice. In addition, this summary does not represent a detailed description of the tax consequences applicable to persons subject to special treatment under the Republic of Ireland, Jersey and the United States tax laws. Prospective purchasers of ADSs are advised to satisfy themselves as to the overall tax consequences of their ownership of ADSs and the ordinary shares represented thereby by consulting their own tax advisors. In addition, this summary only addresses holders that hold ordinary shares or ADSs as capital assets, and it does not address the taxation of a United States shareholder (either corporate or individual) where that shareholder controls, or is deemed to control, 10% or more of the voting stock of the Company.

 

Republic of Ireland taxation

 

General

 

The paragraphs set out below summarise the Irish tax treatment for share owners (or holders of ADSs) of holding or disposing of ordinary shares (or ADSs). They are based on current Irish legislation and an understanding of current Republic of Ireland Revenue Commissioners’ practice as at the date of this document.

 

77


Table of Contents

Tax on chargeable gains

 

Liability for Irish tax on chargeable (taxable) gains will depend on the individual circumstances of share owners.

 

(a)   Disposal of ordinary shares by non-Irish-resident share owners

 

Share owners who are not resident or, in the case of individuals, ordinarily resident for tax purposes in the Republic of Ireland will not be liable for Irish tax on chargeable gains realised on a subsequent disposal of their ordinary shares unless in the case of non-corporate shareholders such ordinary shares are used, held or acquired for the purposes of a trade, profession or vocation carried on in the Republic of Ireland through a branch or agency. Such share owners may be subject to foreign taxation on any gain under local law.

 

A WPP share owner who is an individual and who is temporarily a non-resident of the Republic of Ireland at the time of the disposal may, under anti-avoidance legislation, still be liable to Irish taxation on any chargeable gain realised (subject to the availability of exemptions or reliefs).

 

Dividend withholding tax

 

Dividends received from WPP plc

 

Unless a share owner makes, or is deemed to have made, an election to receive dividends from WPP DAS Limited, a company incorporated in the UK, via the Dividend Access Plan, any dividends received will be received from WPP.

 

Dividends paid by WPP will generally be subject to Irish dividend withholding tax (DWT) at the standard rate of income tax (currently 20%) unless the share owner is within one of the categories of exempt shareholders referred to below. Where DWT applies, WPP will be responsible for withholding DWT at source. For DWT purposes, a dividend includes any distribution made by WPP to share owners, including cash dividends, non-cash dividends and additional shares taken in lieu of a cash dividend.

 

DWT is not payable where an exemption applies provided that WPP has received all necessary documentation required by the relevant legislation from a WPP Share Owner prior to payment of the dividend.

 

Certain categories of Irish resident share owners are entitled to an exemption from DWT, including in general (but not limited to) Irish resident companies, qualifying employee share ownership trusts, charities and pension funds. Except in very limited circumstances, distributions by WPP to an Irish-resident share owner who is an individual are not exempt from DWT.

 

Certain non-Irish resident share owners (both individual and corporate) are also entitled to an exemption from DWT. In particular, a non-Irish resident share owner is not subject to DWT on dividends received from WPP if the WPP Share Owner is:

 

   

an individual share owner who by virtue of the laws of the relevant country is resident for tax purposes in either a Member State of the European Union (apart from the Republic of Ireland) or in a country with which the Republic of Ireland has a double tax treaty (including the United States), and the individual is neither resident nor ordinarily resident in the Republic of Ireland; or

 

   

a corporate share owner that is not resident for tax purposes in the Republic of Ireland and which is ultimately controlled, directly or indirectly, by persons who by virtue of the laws of the

 

78


Table of Contents
 

relevant country are resident in either a member state of the European Union (apart from the Republic of Ireland) or in a country with which the Republic of Ireland has a double tax treaty (including the United States); or

 

   

a corporate share owner that is not resident for tax purposes in the Republic of Ireland nor ultimately controlled by persons so resident and which is resident for tax purposes in either a member state of the European Union (apart from the Republic of Ireland) or a country with which the Republic of Ireland has a double tax treaty (including the United States); or

 

   

a corporate share owner that is not resident for tax purposes in the Republic of Ireland and whose principal class of shares (or those of its 75% parent) is substantially and regularly traded on a recognised stock exchange in (i) the Republic of Ireland; (ii) a member state of the European Union (apart from the Republic of Ireland); (iii) a country with which the Republic of Ireland has a double tax treaty (including the United States); or (iv) an exchange approved by the Irish Minister for Finance; or

 

   

a corporate share owner that is not resident for tax purposes in the Republic of Ireland and is wholly owned, directly or indirectly, by two or more companies the principal class of shares of each of which is substantially and regularly traded on a recognised stock exchange in (i) the Republic of Ireland; (ii) a member state of the European Union (apart from the Republic of Ireland); (iii) a country with which the Republic of Ireland has a double tax treaty (including the United States); or (iv) an exchange approved by the Irish Minister for Finance, and provided that, in all cases noted above, the share owner has made the appropriate declaration to WPP prior to payment of the dividend.

 

Taxation of dividends

 

Non-Irish resident share owners are, unless entitled to exemption from DWT, liable to Irish income tax on dividends received from WPP. However, the DWT deducted by WPP discharges such liability to Irish income tax. Where a non-resident share owner is entitled to exemption from DWT, then no Irish income tax arises and, where DWT has been deducted by WPP, a claim may be made for a refund of the DWT.

 

(b)   Stamp duty

 

No Irish stamp duty or capital duty will arise on the issue or transfer for cash of ordinary shares provided such transactions do not relate to Irish stocks or securities of an Irish registered company.

 

United Kingdom taxation

 

Dividends received under the Dividend Access Plan

 

If a share owner makes, or is deemed to have made, an election to receive dividends via the Dividend Access Plan, such share owner will receive dividends directly from WPP DAS Limited (unless there is a shortfall in the Dividend Access Trust, in which case some or all of the dividend will be received from WPP). WPP DAS Limited is not required to withhold at source any amount in respect of UK tax from dividend payments it makes under the Dividend Access Plan regardless of who the recipient of the payment is. The Dividend Access Plan is described further in Item 8.

 

Jersey taxation

 

General

 

The following summary of the anticipated tax treatment in Jersey of WPP and share owners and holders of ADSs (other than residents of Jersey) is based on Jersey taxation law as it is understood to

 

79


Table of Contents

apply at the date of this document. It does not constitute legal or tax advice. Share owners or holders of ADSs should consult their professional advisers on the implications of acquiring, buying, holding, selling or otherwise disposing of ordinary shares or ADSs under the laws of the jurisdictions in which they may be liable to taxation. Share owners or holders of ADSs should be aware that tax rules and practice and their interpretation may change.

 

Income Tax

 

(a)   Holders of ordinary shares

 

WPP will be entitled to pay dividends to holders of ordinary shares without any withholding or deduction for or on account of Jersey tax. Holders of ordinary shares (other than residents of Jersey) will not be subject to any tax in Jersey in respect of the holding, sale or other disposition of such ordinary shares.

 

(b)   Holders of ADSs

 

Under Jersey law and the WPP Articles, WPP is only permitted to pay a dividend to a person who is recorded in its register of members as the holder of an ordinary share. The US Depositary will be recorded in WPP’s register of members as the holder of each ordinary share represented by an ADS. Accordingly, WPP will pay all dividends in respect of each ordinary share represented by an ADS to the US Depositary (as the registered holder of each such ordinary share) rather than to the holder of the ADS.

 

The US Depositary will not be subject to any tax in Jersey in respect of the holding, sale or other disposition of the ordinary shares held by it. In addition, holders of the ADSs (other than residents of Jersey) should not be subject to any tax in Jersey in respect of the holding, sale or other disposition of such ADSs.

 

Stamp duty

 

No stamp duty is payable in Jersey on the issue or inter vivos transfer of ordinary shares or ADSs.

 

Upon the death of a share owner, a grant of probate or letters of administration will be required to transfer the ordinary shares of the deceased person, except that where the deceased person was domiciled outside of Jersey at the time of death, WPP may (at its discretion) dispense with this requirement where the value of the deceased’s movable estate in Jersey does not exceed £10,000.

 

Upon the death of a share owner, Jersey stamp duty will be payable on the registration in Jersey of a grant of probate or letters of administration, which will be required in order to transfer or otherwise deal with:

 

(a) (where the deceased person was domiciled in Jersey at the time of death) the deceased person’s personal estate wherever situated (including any ordinary shares) if the net value of such personal estate exceeds £10,000; or

 

(b) (where the deceased person was domiciled outside of Jersey at the time of death) the deceased person’s personal estate situated in Jersey (including any ordinary shares) if the net value of such personal estate exceeds £10,000.

 

The rate of stamp duty payable is:

 

(i) (where the net value of the deceased person’s relevant personal estate does not exceed £100,000) 0.50 per cent. of the net value of the deceased person’s relevant personal estate; or

 

80


Table of Contents

(ii) (where the net value of the deceased person’s relevant personal estate exceeds £100,000) £500 for the first £100,000 plus 0.75 per cent. of the net value of the deceased person’s relevant personal estate which exceeds £100,000.

 

In addition, application and other fees may be payable.

 

US federal income taxation

 

Introduction

 

TO ENSURE COMPLIANCE WITH TREASURY DEPARTMENT CIRCULAR 230, HOLDERS OF WPP SHARES OR WPP ADSs ARE HEREBY NOTIFIED THAT: (A) ANY DISCUSSION OF US FEDERAL TAX ISSUES IS NOT INTENDED OR WRITTEN TO BE RELIED UPON, AND CANNOT BE RELIED UPON, BY HOLDERS OF ORDINARY SHARES OR ADSs FOR THE PURPOSE OF AVOIDING PENALTIES THAT MAY BE IMPOSED ON HOLDERS OF ORDINARY SHARES OR ADSs UNDER THE INTERNAL REVENUE CODE OF 1986; AND (B) HOLDERS OF ORDINARY SHARES OR ADSs SHOULD SEEK ADVICE BASED ON THEIR PARTICULAR CIRCUMSTANCES FROM AN INDEPENDENT TAX ADVISER.

 

The following is a summary of certain material US federal income tax consequences of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs by a US Holder (as defined below). The discussion does not cover all aspects of US federal income taxation that may be relevant to, or the actual tax effect that any of the matters described herein will have on, the acquisition, ownership or disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs by particular investors and does not address state, local, foreign or other tax laws. In particular, this summary does not address all of the tax considerations that may be relevant to investors subject to special treatment under the US federal income tax laws (such as financial institutions, insurance companies, investors liable for the alternative minimum tax, investors that own (directly or indirectly) 10% or more of the voting stock of WPP, investors that hold ordinary shares or ADSs through a permanent establishment, individual retirement accounts and other tax-deferred accounts, tax-exempt organisations, dealers in securities or currencies, traders that elect to mark to market, investors that will hold the ordinary shares or ADSs as part of straddles, hedging transactions or conversion transactions for US federal income tax purposes or investors whose functional currency is not the US dollar).

 

This summary deals only with US Holders (as defined below) who elect or are deemed to elect (because they have not withdrawn their ordinary shares from the ADS programme prior to the dividend record date set by the US Depositary) to participate in the Dividend Access Plan.

 

As used herein, the term “US Holder” means a beneficial owner of ordinary shares or ADSs that is, for US federal income tax purposes: (i) a citizen or individual resident of the United States; (ii) a corporation, or other entity treated as a corporation for US federal tax purposes, created or organised in or under the laws of the United States or any State thereof; (iii) an estate the income of which is subject to US federal income tax without regard to its source; or (iv) a trust if a court within the United States is able to exercise primary supervision over the administration of the trust and one or more US persons have the authority to control all substantial decisions of the trust, or the trust has elected to be treated as a domestic trust for US federal income tax purposes.

 

This discussion does not address any tax consequences applicable to holders of equity interests in a holder of ordinary shares or ADSs. The US federal income tax treatment of a partner in a partnership that holds ordinary shares or ADSs will depend on the status of the partner and the activities of the partnership. Holders of ordinary shares or ADSs that are partnerships should consult their tax advisers concerning the US federal income tax consequences to their partners of the acquisition, ownership and disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs.

 

81


Table of Contents

WPP believes that it is not currently, and it does not expect to become, a passive foreign investment company (a “PFIC”) for US federal income tax purposes and this summary assumes the correctness of this position. WPP’s possible status as a PFIC must be determined annually and therefore may be subject to change. If WPP were to be a PFIC in any year, materially adverse consequences could result for US Holders.

 

The summary is based on the US federal income tax laws, including the US Internal Revenue Code of 1986, its legislative history, existing and proposed regulations thereunder, published rulings and court decisions, all as currently in effect, and all of which are subject to change, perhaps with retroactive effect.

 

The summary of US federal income tax consequences set out below is for general information only. US Holders are urged to consult their own tax advisers as to the particular tax consequences to them of owning the ordinary shares or ADSs, including the applicability and effect of state, local, foreign and other tax laws and possible changes in tax law.

 

Classification of the ADSs

 

US Holders of ADSs should be treated for US federal income tax purposes as owners of the ordinary shares represented by the ADSs. Accordingly, the US federal income tax consequences discussed below apply equally to US Holders of ADSs.

 

Tax on Dividends

 

Distributions paid by WPP or WPP DAS Limited out of current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined for US federal income tax purposes) will generally be taxable to a US Holder as foreign source dividend income, and will not be eligible for the dividends received deduction generally allowed to US corporations.

 

A US Holder of ADSs generally will include dividends in gross income in the taxable year in which such holder actually receives the dividend. US Holders that surrender their ADSs in exchange for the underlying ordinary shares should consult their tax advisers regarding the proper timing for including dividends in gross income.

 

Distributions in excess of current and accumulated earnings and profits will be treated as a non-taxable return of capital to the extent of the US Holder’s basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs and thereafter as capital gains. However, WPP does not maintain calculations of its earnings and profits in accordance with US federal income tax accounting principles. US Holders should, therefore, assume that any distribution with respect to the ordinary shares or ADSs will constitute ordinary dividend income. US Holders should consult their tax advisers with respect to the appropriate US federal income tax treatment of any distribution received from WPP or WPP DAS Limited.

 

For taxable years that begin before 2013, dividends paid by WPP or WPP DAS Limited will be taxable to a non-corporate US Holder as “qualified dividend income” at the special reduced rate normally applicable to capital gains, provided WPP qualifies for the benefits of the income tax treaty between the United States and the Republic of Ireland (the “Treaty”), which WPP believes to be the case. However, there can be no assurance that WPP will qualify for the benefits of the Treaty going forward. A US Holder will be eligible for this reduced rate only if it has held the ordinary shares or ADSs for more than 60 days during the 121-day period beginning 60 days before the ex-dividend date.

 

Dividends paid in pounds sterling will be included in income in a US dollar amount calculated by reference to the exchange rate in effect on the day the dividends are received by the US Holder in the

 

82


Table of Contents

case of ordinary shares or the US Depositary (in case of ADSs), regardless of whether the pounds sterling are converted into US dollars at that time. If dividends received in pounds sterling are converted into US dollars on the day they are received, the US Holder generally will not be required to recognise a foreign currency gain or loss in respect of the dividend income. Generally, a gain or loss realised on a subsequent conversion of pounds sterling to US dollars or other disposition will be treated as US source ordinary income or loss.

 

Sale or other disposition

 

Upon a sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs (other than an exchange of ADSs for ordinary shares), a US Holder generally will recognise a capital gain or loss equal to the difference, if any, between the amount realised on the sale or other disposition and the US Holder’s adjusted tax basis in the ordinary shares or ADSs. This capital gain or loss will generally be US source and will be a long-term capital gain or loss if the US Holder’s holding period in the ordinary shares or ADSs exceeds one year. However, regardless of a US Holder’s actual holding period, any loss may be a long-term capital loss to the extent the US Holder receives a dividend that qualifies for the reduced rate described above under the section entitled “Tax on Dividends”, above, and exceeds 10% of the US Holder’s tax basis in its ordinary shares or ADSs. Deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

 

A US Holder’s tax basis in an ordinary share or an ADS will generally be its US dollar cost. The US dollar cost of an ordinary share or an ADS purchased with foreign currency will generally be the US dollar value of the purchase price on the date of purchase or, in the case of ordinary shares or ADSs traded on an established securities market, as defined in the applicable Treasury Regulations, that are purchased by a cash basis US Holder (or an accrual basis US Holder that so elects), on the settlement date for the purchase. Such an election by an accrual basis US Holder must be applied consistently from year to year and cannot be revoked without the consent of the Internal Revenue Service (the “IRS”).

 

The surrender of ADSs in exchange for ordinary shares (or vice versa) should not be a taxable event for US federal income tax purposes and US Holders should not recognise any gain or loss upon such a surrender. A US Holder’s tax basis in the withdrawn ordinary shares will be the same as the US Holder’s tax basis in the ADSs surrendered, and the holding period of the ordinary shares will include the holding period of the ADSs.

 

The amount realised on a sale or other disposition of ordinary shares or ADSs for an amount in foreign currency will be the US dollar value of this amount on the date of sale or disposition. On the settlement date, the US Holder will recognise US source foreign currency gain or loss (taxable as ordinary income or loss) equal to the difference (if any) between the US dollar value of the amount received based on the exchange rates in effect on the date of sale or other disposition and the settlement date. However, in the case of ordinary shares or ADSs traded on an established securities market that are sold by a cash basis US Holder (or an accrual basis US Holder that so elects), the amount realised will be determined using the exchange rate in effect on the settlement date for the sale, and no exchange gain or loss will be recognised at that time.

 

Foreign currency received on the sale or other disposition of an ordinary share or an ADS will have a tax basis equal to its US dollar value on the settlement date. Any gain or loss recognised on a sale or other disposition of a foreign currency (including upon exchange for US dollars) will be US source ordinary income or loss.

 

Backup withholding and information reporting

 

Payments of dividends and other proceeds with respect to ordinary shares or ADSs by a US paying agent or other US intermediary will be reported to the IRS and to the US Holder unless the

 

83


Table of Contents

holder is a corporation or otherwise establishes a basis for exemption. Backup withholding may apply to reportable payments if the US Holder fails to provide an accurate taxpayer identification number or certification of exempt status or fails to report all interest and dividends required to be shown on its US federal income tax returns. Any backup withholding tax will be refunded or allowed as a credit against the US Holder’s US federal income tax liability if the US Holder timely gives the appropriate information to the IRS. US Holders should consult their tax advisers as to their qualification for exemption from backup withholding and the procedure for obtaining an exemption.

 

F. Dividends and Paying Agents

 

Not applicable.

 

G. Statements by Experts

 

Not applicable.

 

H. Documents on Display

 

The Company is subject to the informational requirements of the Exchange Act. In accordance with these requirements, the Company files reports and other information with the United States Securities and Exchange Commission. You may read and copy any materials filed with the SEC at the Public Reference Room at 100 F Street N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. You may obtain information on the operation of the Public Reference Room by calling the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330. The SEC also maintains a web site at http://www.sec.gov that contains reports, proxy statements and other information regarding registrants that file electronically with the SEC.

 

I. Subsidiary Information

 

Not applicable.

 

84


Table of Contents

ITEM 11. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISK

 

The Company’s principal market risks are changes in interest rates and currency exchange rates. Following evaluation of these positions, the Company selectively enters into derivative financial instruments to manage its risk exposure. The fair value of derivatives held by the Company at 31 December 2010 is estimated to be a net asset of £66.1 million (£129.0 million net asset with respect to interest rate swaps and £62.9 million net liability for currency derivatives). These amounts are based on market values of equivalent instruments at the balance sheet date.

 

Interest rate risk

 

The Group is exposed to interest rate risk on both interest-bearing assets and interest-bearing liabilities. The Group has a policy of actively managing its interest rate risk exposure while recognising that fixing rates on all its debt eliminates the possibility of benefiting from rate reductions and similarly, having all its debt at floating rates unduly exposes the Group to increases in rates.

 

The Group’s principal borrowing currencies are US dollars, pounds sterling and euros. Borrowings in these currencies represented 96.0% of the Group’s gross indebtedness at 31 December 2010 (at $1,640 million, £1,350 million and 1,274 million) and 96.8% of the Group’s average gross debt during the course of 2010 (at $2,003 million, £1,653 million and 1,274 million). Including the effect of interest rate and cross-currency swaps, 82.5% of the year-end US dollar net debt is at fixed rates averaging 6.54% for an average period of 44 months; 73.3% of the sterling net debt is at a fixed rate of 6.07% for an average period of 83 months; and 66.7% of the euro net debt is at fixed rates averaging 6.50% for an average period of 63 months.

 

Other than fixed rate debt, the Group’s other fixed rates are achieved principally through interest rate swaps with the Group’s bankers. The Group also uses forward rate agreements and interest rate caps to manage exposure to interest rate changes. At 31 December 2010 no forward rate agreements or interest rate caps were in place. These interest rate derivatives are used only to hedge exposures to interest rate movements arising from the Group’s borrowings and surplus cash balances arising from its commercial activities and are not traded independently. Payments made under these instruments are accounted for on an accruals basis.

 

The following tables set forth the Company’s fixed and floating rate debt by currency, including the effect of interest rate and cross-currency swaps, as of 31 December 2010:

 

Currency    £m    

Fixed

rate 1

   

Floating

basis

    

Period

(months) 1

 

$ -fixed

     1,338.0        6.54     n/a         44   

    -floating

     283.0        n/a        LIBOR         n/a   

£ -fixed

     550.0        6.07     n/a         83   

    -floating

     200.0        n/a        LIBOR         n/a   

 -fixed

     728.7       6.50     n/a         63   

    -floating

     363.1        n/a        EURIBOR         n/a   

¥  -fixed

     71.1        2.07     n/a         36   

$C 2  -floating

     81.1        n/a        LIBOR         n/a   

Other

     (16.8     n/a        n/a         n/a   
       3,598.2                            
  1    

Weighted average. These rates do not include the effect of gains on interest rate swap terminations that are written to income over the life of the original instrument. At 31 December 2010 the amount still to be written to income was £1.7 million (2009: £2.2 million) in respect of US dollar swap terminations, to be written to income evenly until June 2014.

 
  2    

Represents Canadian dollars.

 

85


Table of Contents

The significant terms of the interest rate swap agreements in place as of 31 December 2010:

 

           $     £         $  

Notional principal amount

     1,100m        $300m        £200m        100m        $45m   

Average rate payable

    
 
6m Euribor
+ 0.6641
  
   
 
Fixed
2.5801
  
   
 
6m Libor
+ 0.6425
  
   
 
Fixed
5.5625
  
   

 

3m Libor

+0.5947

  

Average rate receivable

    
 
Fixed
4.7727
  
   
 
3m Libor
+0.2890
  
   
 
Fixed
6.00
  
   
 
 
3m
Euribor
+ 0.955
  
  
   
 
Fixed
6.29
  

Average term

    

 

50

months

  

  

   

 

120

months

  

  

   

 

76

months

  

  

   

 

42

months

  

  

   
 
43
months
  
  

Latest maturity date

     Jan-15        Oct - 20        Apr-17        Jun-14        Jul-14   

 

Foreign currency

 

The Group’s results in pounds sterling are subject to fluctuation as a result of exchange rate movements. The Group does not hedge this translation exposure to its earnings but does hedge the currency element of its net assets using foreign currency borrowings, cross-currency swaps and forward foreign exchange contracts.

 

The Group effects these currency net asset hedges by borrowing in the same currencies as the operating (or “functional”) currencies of its main operating units. The majority of the Group’s debt is therefore denominated in US dollars, pounds sterling and euros.

 

The Group utilises currency derivatives to hedge significant future transactions and cash flows and the exchange risk arising on translation of the Group’s investments in foreign operations. The Group is a party to a variety of foreign currency derivatives in the management of its exchange rate exposures. The instruments purchased are primarily denominated in the currencies of the Group’s principal markets.

 

Significant forward foreign exchange contracts held by the Group at 31 December 2010 are contracts of 88.1  million, R176.0 million and NZ$27.2 million. The forward exchange rates to sterling that the Group is fixed into are 1.1799, R11.088 and NZ$2.0762. The contracts all mature in 2011.

 

These arrangements are designed to address significant exchange exposures and are renewed on a revolving basis as required.

 

The following table sets forth details on the cross currency swaps as of 31 December 2010 by currency:

 

      /$     ¥/     $/     $/     $/     $/     $/     $/     $/     $/£     $/£     $/£     $/£  

Currency Payable

  228.0m      ¥ 9,000m        $115.0m        $110.0m        $110.0m        $180.4m        $180.3m        $180.3m        $180.8m        $110.8m        $110.8m        $111.0m        $111.0m   

Currency Receivable

  $ 278.3m        56.6m        85.6m        81.9m        81.9m        124.5m      124.5m      124.5m      124.8m        £75.0m        £75.0m        £75.0m        £75.0m   

Currency Rate Payable

   
 

 

3m
Euribor

+0.955

  
  

   
 
Fixed
2.0675
  
%
   

 

 

6m

Libor

 + 0.559

  

  

   

 

 

3m

Libor

+ 0.549

  

  

   

 

 

3m

Libor

+ 0.562

  

  

   
 
Fixed
5.615
  
   
 
Fixed
5.60
  
   

 

 

3m

Libor

+0.8575

  

  

   

 

 

6m

Libor

+0.845

  

  

   
 
Fixed
5.92
  
   
 
Fixed
5.92
  
   
 
Fixed
5.825
  
   
 
Fixed
5.95
  

Currency Rate Receivable

   
 
Fixed
5.8750
  
   
 

 

6m
Euribor

+ 0.555

  
  

%

   
 
 
6m
Euribor
 + 0.555
  
  
   
 
 
6m
Euribor
+ 0.555
  
  
   
 
 
6m
Euribor
+ 0.555
  
  
   
 

 

6m
Euribor

+0.795

  
  

   
 

 

6m
Euribor

+0.795

  
  

   
 

 

6m
Euribor

+0.795

  
  

   
 

 

6m
Euribor

+0.795

  
  

   
 
Fixed
5.75
  
   
 
Fixed
5.75
  
   
 
Fixed
5.75
  
   
 
Fixed
5.75
  

 

86


Table of Contents

Credit risk

 

The Group’s principal financial assets are cash and short-term deposits, trade and other receivables and investments, the carrying value of which represents the Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk in relation to financial assets.

 

The Group’s credit risk is primarily attributable to its trade receivables. The majority of the Group’s trade receivables are due from large national or multinational companies where the risk of default is considered low. The amounts presented in the consolidated balance sheet are net of allowances for doubtful receivables, estimated by the Group’s management based on prior experience and their assessment of the current economic environment. A relatively small number of clients make up a significant percentage of the Group’s debtors, but no single client represents more than 5% of total trade receivables as at 31 December 2010.

 

The credit risk on liquid funds and derivative financial instruments is limited because the counterparties are banks with high credit-ratings assigned by international credit-rating agencies or banks that have been financed by their government.

 

A relatively small number of clients contribute a significant percentage of the Group’s consolidated revenues. The Group’s clients generally are able to reduce advertising and marketing spending or cancel projects at any time for any reason. There can be no assurance that any of the Group’s clients will continue to utilise the Group’s services to the same extent, or at all, in the future. A significant reduction in advertising and marketing spending by, or the loss of one or more of, the Group’s largest clients, if not replaced by new client accounts or an increase in business from existing clients, would adversely affect the Group’s prospects, business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Non-derivative financial instruments

 

The fair value of our $1,250 million bonds, 1,850 million Eurobonds, £1,050 million bonds at 31 December 2010 was £4,034.1 million. The Group considers that the carrying amount of bank loans approximates the fair value. The fair value is calculated by reference to market prices at 31 December 2010. Considerable judgement is required in interpreting market data to develop the estimates of fair value, and, accordingly, the estimates are not necessarily indicative of the amounts that could be realised in a current market exchange. For additional information in respect of these instruments see Item 5B and note 10 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

Cash, accounts receivable, accounts payable, overdrafts and short-term borrowings (including those drawn under the Revolving Credit Facilities) are considered to approximate fair value because of the short maturity of such instruments.

 

Additional Information on the Company’s risk management policies and financial instruments is disclosed in notes 24 and 25 to the Consolidated Financial Statements.

 

ITEM 12. DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES

 

A. Debt Securities.

 

Not applicable.

 

B. Warrants and Rights.

 

Not applicable.

 

87


Table of Contents

C. Other Securities.

 

Not applicable.

 

D. American Depositary Shares

 

Fees and Charges

 

Holders of ADSs and persons depositing ordinary shares or surrendering ADSs for cancellation are currently required to pay the following service fees to the Depositary:

 

Service

  

Rate

   By Whom Paid

(1)    Issuance of ADSs upon deposit of ordinary shares (excluding issuances as a result of distributions described in paragraph (4) below).

   Up to U.S.$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) issued.    Person depositing ordinary
shares or person receiving
ADSs.

(2)    Delivery of deposited securities against surrender of ADSs.

   Up to U.S.$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) surrendered.    Person surrendering ADSs
for purpose of withdrawal of
deposited securities or
person to whom deposited
securities are delivered.

(3)    Distribution of cash dividends or other cash distributions ( i.e ., sale of rights and other entitlements).

   Up to U.S.$2.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) held, unless prohibited by the exchange upon which the ADSs are listed.    Person to whom distribution
is made.

(4)    Distribution of ADSs pursuant to (i) stock dividends or other free stock distributions, or (ii) exercise of rights to purchase additional ADSs.

   Up to U.S.$5.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) issued, unless prohibited by the exchange upon which the ADSs are listed.    Person to whom distribution
is made.

(5)    Distribution of securities other than ADSs or rights to purchase additional ADSs ( i.e. , spin-off shares).

   Up to U.S.$5.00 per unit of 100 securities (or fraction thereof) distributed.    Person to whom distribution
is made.

(6)    Depositary Services.

   Up to U.S.$2.00 per 100 ADSs (or fraction thereof) held as of the last day of each calendar year, except to the extent of any cash dividend fee(s) charged under paragraph (3) above during the applicable calendar year.    Person of record on last day
of any calendar year.

(7)    Transfer of ADRs.

   U.S.$1.50 per certificate presented for transfer.    Person presenting certificate
for transfer.

 

88


Table of Contents

Holders of ADSs and persons depositing ordinary shares or surrendering ADSs for cancellation and for the purpose of withdrawing deposited securities are also responsible for the payment of certain fees and expenses incurred by the Depositary, and certain taxes and governmental charges, such as:

 

  (i)   Taxes (including applicable interest and penalties) and other governmental charges;

 

  (ii)   Such registration fees as may from time to time be in effect for the registration of ordinary shares on the share register and applicable to transfers of ordinary shares or other securities on deposit to or from the name of the Custodian, the Depositary or any nominees upon the making of deposits and withdrawals, respectively;

 

  (iii)   Such cable, telex and facsimile transmission and delivery expenses as are expressly provided in the deposit agreement to be at the expense of the person depositing or withdrawing ordinary shares or holders of ADSs;

 

  (iv)   The expenses and charges incurred by the Depositary in the conversion of foreign currency;

 

  (v)   Such fees and expenses as are incurred by the Depositary in connection with compliance with exchange control regulations and other regulatory requirements applicable to ordinary shares, ordinary shares on deposit, ADSs and ADRs; and

 

  (vi)   The fees and expenses incurred by the Depositary, the Custodian or any nominee in connection with the servicing or delivery of ordinary shares on deposit.

 

WPP has agreed to pay various other charges and expenses of the Depositary. Please note that the fees and charges that holders of ADSs may be required to pay may vary over time and may be changed by WPP and by the Depositary. Holders of ADSs will receive prior notice of such changes.

 

Depositary Payments—Fiscal Year 2010

 

WPP did not receive any payments from Citibank, N.A., the Depositary for its American Depositary Receipt program, in 2010.

 

89


Table of Contents

PART II

 

ITEM 13. DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES

 

None.

 

ITEM 14. MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

 

None.

 

ITEM 15. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

Disclosure Controls and Procedures

 

We performed an evaluation under the supervision and with the participation of our management, including our Group Chief Executive and our Group Finance Director, of the effectiveness of our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e) under the Exchange Act) as of 31 December 2010. Notwithstanding the foregoing, a control system, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that it will detect or uncover failures within the Company to disclose material information otherwise required to be set forth in the Company’s periodic reports. Following the evaluation described above, our management, including the Group Chief Executive and Group Finance Director, concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures were effective at that time.

 

Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting

 

Our management is responsible for establishing and maintaining adequate internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rule 13a-15(f) of the Exchange Act). Our management, with the participation of our Group Chief Executive and our Group Finance Director, carried out an assessment of the effectiveness of our internal control over financial reporting (including those applicable to WPP DAS Ltd) at 31 December 2010. The assessment was performed using the criteria for effective internal control reflected in the Internal Control-Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission (COSO).

 

Based on our assessment of the system of internal control, management believes that as of 31 December 2010 our internal control over financial reporting (including those applicable to WPP DAS Ltd) was effective.

 

The Company’s internal control over financial reporting, (including those applicable to WPP DAS Ltd) at 31 December 2010, has been audited by Deloitte LLP, an independent registered public accounting firm, who also audited the Company’s consolidated financial statements. Their audit report on the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting is presented on page 91.

 

90


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of WPP plc

 

We have audited the internal control over financial reporting of WPP plc and subsidiaries (the “Company”) as at 31 December 2010, based on criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission. The Company’s management is responsible for maintaining effective internal control over financial reporting and for its assessment of the effectiveness of internal control over financial reporting, included in the accompanying Management’s Annual Report on Internal Control over Financial Reporting. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, including those controls applicable to the WPP DAS Ltd. (“the Trust”) based on our audit.

 

We conducted our audit in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether effective internal control over financial reporting was maintained in all material respects. Our audit included obtaining an understanding of internal control over financial reporting, assessing the risk that a material weakness exists, testing and evaluating the design and operating effectiveness of internal control based on the assessed risk, and performing such other procedures as we considered necessary in the circumstances. We believe that our audit provides a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

A company’s internal control over financial reporting is a process designed by, or under the supervision of, the company’s principal executive and principal financial officers, or persons performing similar functions, and effected by the company’s board of directors, management, and other personnel to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles. A company’s internal control over financial reporting includes those policies and procedures that (1) pertain to the maintenance of records that, in reasonable detail, accurately and fairly reflect the transactions and dispositions of the assets of the company; (2) provide reasonable assurance that transactions are recorded as necessary to permit preparation of financial statements in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles, and that receipts and expenditures of the company are being made only in accordance with authorizations of management and directors of the company; and (3) provide reasonable assurance regarding prevention or timely detection of unauthorised acquisition, use, or disposition of the company’s assets that could have a material effect on the financial statements.

 

Because of the inherent limitations of internal control over financial reporting, including the possibility of collusion or improper management override of controls, material misstatements due to error or fraud may not be prevented or detected on a timely basis. Also, projections of any evaluation of the effectiveness of the internal control over financial reporting to future periods are subject to the risk that the controls may become inadequate because of changes in conditions, or that the degree of compliance with the policies or procedures may deteriorate.

 

In our opinion, the Company maintained, in all material respects, effective internal control over financial reporting, including those applicable to the Trust, as at 31 December 2010, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the consolidated financial statements as at and for the year ended 31 December 2010 of the Company and financial statements as at and for the year ended 31 December 2010 of the Trust and our reports dated 29 April 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on those financial statements.

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

 

Deloitte LLP

London, United Kingdom

29 April 2011

 

91


Table of Contents

Changes in Internal Control Over Financial Reporting

 

There has been no change in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f) under the Exchange Act) that occurred during 2010, that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

ITEM 16A. AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

 

The audit committee consisted of Paul Spencer, Jeffrey Rosen, Colin Day and Sol Trujillo at 31 December 2010. The board of directors has determined that all members of the audit committee are “independent” as that term is defined in the applicable NASDAQ listing standards and rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

WPP does have an audit committee financial expert, Paul Spencer, serving as Chairman of its audit committee. See the biography of Paul Spencer in Item 6A.

 

ITEM 16B. CODE OF ETHICS

 

WPP has in place a Code of Business Conduct that constitutes a “code of ethics” as defined in applicable regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission. The Code of Business Conduct (which is regularly reviewed by the Audit Committee and the Board) and was updated in 2010, sets out the principal obligations of all employees. Directors and senior executives throughout the Group are required each year to sign this Code. A copy of the WPP Code of Business Conduct may be obtained free of charge by contacting the Company’s investor relations department in London or New York at the following addresses or telephone numbers:

 

London:

 

Deputy Group finance director

WPP

27 Farm Street

London W1J 5RL England

Tel: +44 (0)20 7408 2204

Fax: +44 (0)20 7493 6819

 

New York:

 

Investor Relations

WPP

100 Park Avenue

New York, New York 10017-5516

Tel: (212) 632-2200

Fax: (212) 632-2222

 

92


Table of Contents

ITEM 16C. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

 

       2010    2009
     £m    £m

Audit fees

   19.0    19.4

Audit-related fees 1

   0.3    0.3

Tax fees 2

   3.9    4.1

All other fees 3

   5.3    5.0
     28.5    28.8
  1    

Audit related fees include review of the interim financial statements and Form 20-F.

  2    

Tax fees comprise tax advisory, planning and compliance services.

  3    

Other fees comprise assurance services, including fees for due diligence, transition support fees and review of earn-out payment calculations.

 

Audit Committee Pre-Approval Policies and Procedures

 

The Audit Committee has adopted a pre-approval policy for the engagement of the external auditors in relation to the supply of permissible non-audit services (including taxation), taking into account relevant ethical and regulatory requirements. WPP’s policy regarding non-audit services that may be provided by the Group’s auditors, Deloitte LLP, prohibits certain categories of work in line with relevant guidance on independence, such as ethical standards issued by the Auditing Practices Board and independence rules of the SEC. Other categories of work may be undertaken by Deloitte LLP subject to an approvals process that is designed appropriately for different categories and values of proposed work.

 

ITEM 16D. EXEMPTIONS FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES.

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 16E. PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS.

 

At the Annual General Meeting of WPP plc on 2 June 2009 a special resolution was passed authorising WPP plc to make market purchases of its own shares up to a maximum number of 125,294,634 ordinary shares. This authority expired at the Annual General Meeting of WPP plc on 29 June 2010 and was replaced by a new authority to purchase up to a maximum number of 125,496,212 ordinary shares until the earlier of the conclusion of the Annual General Meeting of WPP plc in 2011 and 1 September 2011.

 

      

Total number of shares

purchased

     Average price     

Total number of shares purchased as part

of publicly announced plan

    

Maximum number of shares that

may yet be purchased under plan

 

January

                                125,294,634   

February

                                125,294,634   

March

     4,460,915       £ 6.42         4,460,915         120,833,719   

April

                                120,833,719   

May

                                120,833,719   

June

                                125,496,212   

July

                                125,496,212   

August

                                125,496,212   

September

                                125,496,212   

October

     2,297,811       £ 7.31         2,297,811         123,198,401   

November

     14,067       £ 7.35         14,067         123,184,334   

December

     122,897       £ 7.11         122,897         123,061,437   

Total

     6,895,690       £ 6.73         6,895,690            

 

93


Table of Contents

ITEM 16F. CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 16G. CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

 

The Company’s ADSs are listed on the NASDAQ Global Select Market. In general, under NASDAQ’s Rule 5615, foreign private issuers such as WPP listed on NASDAQ are permitted to follow home country corporate governance practices instead of certain provisions of NASDAQ’s Rule 5600 Series, which pertain to corporate governance by listed issuers. A foreign private issuer that elects to follow a home country practice instead of any such provisions of the Rule 5600 Series must submit in advance to NASDAQ a written statement from an independent counsel in such issuer’s home country certifying that the issuer’s practices are not prohibited by the home country’s laws. The Company’s independent Jersey counsel has certified to NASDAQ that the Company’s corporate governance practices are not prohibited by the laws of Jersey.

 

The requirements of the Rule 5600 Series and the corporate governance practices that the Company follows in lieu thereof are described below:

 

   

Rule 5620(c) requires that the quorum for any meeting of stockholders must not be less than 33  1 / 3 % of the outstanding shares of a company’s common voting stock. The Company’s Articles of Association provide that the necessary quorum for a general share owner meeting is a minimum of two persons entitled to vote on the business to be transacted, each being a share owner or a proxy for a share owner or a duly authorised representative of a corporate share owner.

 

   

Rule 5635(c) requires that issuers obtain stockholder approval before a stock option or purchase plan is established or materially amended or other equity compensation arrangement is made or materially amended pursuant to which stock may be acquired by officers, directors, employees or consultants of the issuer, subject to certain exceptions. The Company seeks share owner approval for the adoption or amendment of stock plans or stock purchase plans only as required by the Articles of Association of the Company, the Listing Rules of the UK Listing Authority (the Listing Rules) and the laws of Jersey. Subject to the exceptions permitted in the Listing Rules, this involves seeking share owner approval to any such plan that falls into either of the following categories (as defined in the Listing Rules):

 

  (a)   an employees’ share scheme if the scheme involves or may involve the issue of new shares or the transfer of treasury shares; and

 

  (b)   a long-term incentive scheme in which one or more directors of the Company is eligible to participate and to material amendments of that scheme to the extent required by the scheme’s rules. In this context, it should be noted that the provisions of the rules relating to whether amendments to the scheme rules must be approved by share owners must themselves be drafted to ensure compliance with the Listing Rules.

 

94


Table of Contents

PART III

 

ITEM 17. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 18. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

The Consolidated Financial Statements of WPP plc at 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008 are included in this report beginning on page F-1.

 

ITEM 19. EXHIBITS

 

Exhibit No.

    

Exhibit Title

  1.1         Memorandum and Articles of Association of WPP plc (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 1 of the Registrant’s Report on Form 6-K filed on 9 December 2008).
  2.1         Deposit Agreement dated as of 19 November 2008 among WPP plc, Citibank, N.A. as Depositary, and all holders and beneficial owners from time to time of American Depositary Receipts issued thereunder (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 99(A) to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form F-6EF filed on 18 November 2008).
  2.2         Indenture, dated as of 23 June 2004, among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP Group plc, as Guarantor, and Citibank, N.A., as Trustee (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.14 to the Registration Statement on Form F-4 filed by the Registrant on 21 September 2004 (File No. 333-119163)).
  2.3         First Supplemental Indenture, dated as of 23 June 2004, among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP Group plc, as Guarantor, and Citibank, N.A., as Trustee, pertaining to the issuance of U.S. $650,000,000 5.875% Notes due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.15 to the Registration Statement on Form F-4 filed by the Registrant on 21 September 2004 (File No. 333-119163)).
  2.4         Second Supplemental Indenture, dated as of 27 June 2006, among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP 2005 Limited and WPP Group plc, as Guarantors, and Citibank, N.A., as Trustee, pertaining to the issuance of U.S. $650,000,000 5.875% Notes due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.11 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2005).
  2.5         Form of 5.875% Notes Due 2014 (included as part of Exhibit 2.2).
  2.6         Form of Guarantee of 5.875% Notes due 2014 (included as part of Exhibit 2.2).
  2.7         Third Supplemental Indenture, dated as of 19 December 2006, among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP 2005 Limited, WPP Group plc and WPP Spangle, as Guarantors, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee, pertaining to the issuance of U.S. $650,000,000 5.875% Notes due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.4 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed by the Registrant on 27 March 2009 (File No. 333-158262)).
  2.8         Fourth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of 7 October 2008, among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited, in their capacities as partners of WPP Air UK, Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings (formerly known as WPP Spangle), WPP 2005 Limited and WPP Group plc, as Guarantors, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee, pertaining to the issuance of U.S. $650,000,000 5.875% Notes due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.5 to the Registrant’s Registration Statement on Form F-3 filed by the Registrant on 27 March 2009 (File No. 333-158262)).

 

95


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    

Exhibit Title

  2.9         Fifth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of 30 April 2009, among WPP Finance (UK), as Issuer, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited, in their capacities as partners of WPP Air UK, Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings, WPP 2005 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited (formerly known as WPP Group plc) and WPP plc, as Guarantors, and Wilmington Trust Company, as Trustee, pertaining to the issuance of U.S. $650,000,000 5.875% Notes due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.9 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  2.10       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to 600 million of 4.375% Bonds due 5 December 2013 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.19 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F filed for the year ended 31 December 2006).
  2.11       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, indenture instruments relating to £400 million of 6% Bonds due 4 April 2017 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.20 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F filed for the year ended 31 December 2006).
  2.12       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to 500 million of 5.25% bonds due 2015 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.21 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2007).
  2.13       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to £200 million of 6.375% bonds due 2020 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.22 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2007).
  2.14       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to 750 million of 6.25% Guaranteed Bonds due 2016 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.23 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2007).
  2.15       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to a U.S. $1,600,000,000 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement dated 23 August 2005 and Amended and Restated on 17 November 2008 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.15 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  2.16       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to a £600,000,000 Revolving Credit Facility Agreement dated 9 July 2008 and Amended and Restated on 17 November 2008 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.16 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  2.17       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to a £650,000,000 Term Facility Agreement dated 9 July 2008 and Amended and Restated on 17 November 2008 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.17 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  2.18       Fifth Supplemental Indenture, dated as of 7 October 2008, among WPP plc, WPP Air 1 Limited and WPP Air 3 Limited, in their capacities as partners of WPP Air UK, WPP Group plc, WPP 2005 Limited, Grey Global Group Inc. and American Stock Transfer & Trust Company, LLC, as Trustee, pertaining to Grey’s 5% Contingent Convertible Subordinated Debentures due 2033 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.18 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).

 

96


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    

Exhibit Title

  2.19       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to $600,000,000 of 8% Senior Notes due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.19 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2009).
  2.20       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to £450,000,000 of 5.75% Guaranteed Bonds due 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.20 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2009).
  2.21       Agreement of Registrant to file, if requested by the Securities and Exchange Commission, instruments relating to $30 million of 6.22% promissory notes due July 10, 2012, and $25 million of 6.34% promissory notes due July 10, 2014 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 2.21 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2009).
  4.1         J. Walter Thompson Company, Inc. Retained Benefit Supplemental Employee Retirement Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.9 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2000).
  4.2         Young & Rubicam Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.26 to Young & Rubicam’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 333-46929)).
  4.3         Amendment No. 2 to Young & Rubicam Inc. Deferred Compensation Plan effective as of 1 January 1999 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.27 to Young & Rubicam’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 31 December 1998).
  4.4         Young & Rubicam Inc. 1997 Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.6 to Young & Rubicam’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 333-46929)).
  4.5         Amendment to Young & Rubicam Inc. 1997 Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.28 to Young & Rubicam’s Registration Statement on Form S-1 (File No. 333-46929)).
  4.6         Amendment No. 2 to Young & Rubicam Inc. 1997 Incentive Compensation Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.23 to Young & Rubicam’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 31 December 1999).
  4.7         Young & Rubicam Inc. Director Stock Option Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.25 to Young & Rubicam’s Annual Report on Form 10-K for the year ended 31 December 1999).
  4.8         Young & Rubicam Inc. Executive Income Deferral Program (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.19 to the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2000).
  4.9         Ogilvy & Mather ERISA Excess Plan Summary Plan Description (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.12 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.10       Ogilvy & Mather Executive Savings Plan Summary Plan Description, in connection with a 25% matching contribution (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.13 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.11       Ogilvy & Mather Executive Savings Plan Summary Plan Description, in connection with a 50% matching contribution (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.14 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).

 

97


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    

Exhibit Title

  4.12       Ogilvy & Mather Deferred Compensation Plan Summary Plan Description (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.15 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.13       Grey Advertising Inc. amended and restated 1994 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.02 to Grey Global Group Inc. Quarterly Report on Form 10-Q for the quarter ended 30 September 1996 (File No. 000-07898)).
  4.14       WPP Executive Stock Option Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.18 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.15       WPP plc Performance Share Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.19 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.16       WPP plc Restricted Stock Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.20 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.17       WPP 2005 Executive Stock Option Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.21 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.18       WPP Annual Bonus Deferral Programme (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.22 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.19       2004-2006 Long Term Incentive Plan Participant Guide (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.41 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2005).
  4.20       GroupM Executive Savings Plan Summary Plan Description (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.24 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.21       WPP 2008 Executive Stock Option Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.27 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.22       UK Service Agreement, effective from 19 November 2008, between WPP 2005 Limited, Sir Martin Sorrell and WPP plc (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.28 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.23       Service Agreement in the USA, effective 26 November 2010, between WPP Group USA, Inc. and Sir Martin Sorrell.*
  4.24       Service Agreement in the USA, dated 30 April 2009, between WPP Group USA, Inc. and Paul W.G. Richardson (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.30 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.25       Director’s appointment agreement, dated 21 November 2008, between WPP plc and Paul Richardson (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.31 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.26       Service Agreement, dated 12 February 2009, between WPP 2005 Limited and Mark Read (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.32 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.27       Director’s appointment agreement, dated 21 November 2008, between WPP plc and Mark Read (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.33 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.28       Supplemental Retirement Agreement, dated as of 1 July 2008, by and between WPP Group USA, Inc. and Paul Richardson (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.34 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).

 

98


Table of Contents

Exhibit No.

    

Exhibit Title

  4.29       Amendment dated 19 November 2008 to Supplemental Retirement Agreement, dated as of 1 July 2008, by and between WPP Group USA, Inc. and Paul Richardson (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.35 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.30       Stock Purchase Agreement, dated 3 August 1998, among Asatsu Inc., WPP International Holding B.V. and WPP Group plc (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.36 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.31       24/7 Media, Inc. 1998 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 10.1 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1 of 24/7 Media, Inc. filed on June 4, 2009, File No. 333-56085).
  4.32       24/7 Real Media, Inc. 2002 Stock Incentive Plan (incorporated herein by reference to a proxy statement filed by 24/7 Real Media, Inc. on August 9, 2002, File No. 000-29768).
  4.33       Amendment No. 2 to the Grey Global Group Inc. 2003 Senior Management Incentive Plan, effective as of January 1, 2009 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.39 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008)
  4.34       Grey Advertising Inc. Senior Executive Officer Post-Employment Compensation Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.40 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.35       Amendment No. 1 to the Grey Advertising Inc. Senior Executive Officer Post-Employment Compensation Plan, effective as of January 1, 2009 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.41 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.36       Amendment No. 1 to the J. Walter Thompson Retained Benefit Supplemental Employee Retirement Plan, effective as of January 1, 2009 (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.42 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.37       Taylor Nelson Sofres 2001 Equity Participation Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.43 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.38       Taylor Nelson Sofres plc 2005 Long Term Incentive Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.44 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.39       Taylor Nelson Sofres New Share Plan (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.45 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2008).
  4.40       Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan III (incorporated herein by reference to Exhibit 4.42 of the Registrant’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended 31 December 2009).
  8.1         List of subsidiaries.*
  12.1       Certification of Group Chief Executive.*
  12.2       Certification of Group Finance Director.*
  13.1       Certification of Group Chief Executive under 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.*
  13.2       Certification of Group Finance Director under 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.*
  14.1       Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.*

 

*   Filed herewith.

 

99


Table of Contents

Signatures

 

The Registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this annual report on its behalf.

 

WPP plc

By:

 

/s/    P AUL W G R ICHARDSON

 

Paul W G Richardson

Group Finance Director

 

29 April 2011

 

100


Table of Contents

Item 18

 

INDEX TO FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

Financial
Statement
Number


          Page

 
  A.       Financial Statements of WPP plc as of and for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008         
        

(i)  Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-1   
        

(ii)  Accounting policies

     F-2   
        

(iii)  Consolidated income statement for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008

     F-9   
        

(iv)  Consolidated statement of comprehensive income for the years ended 31  December 2010, 2009 and 2008

     F-10   
        

(v)  Consolidated cash flow statement for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008

     F-11   
        

(vi)  Consolidated balance sheet at 31 December 2010 and 2009

     F-12   
        

(vii)   Consolidated statement of changes in equity for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008

     F-13   
        

(viii)  Notes to the consolidated financial statements

     F-15   
  B.       Financial Statements of WPP DAS Ltd as of and for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and the period from 9 July 2008 through 31 December 2008         
        

(i)  Report of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm

     F-48   
        

(ii)   Cash flow statement for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and the period from 9 July 2008 through 31 December 2008

     F-49   
        

(iii)  Balance sheet at 31 December 2010 and 2009

     F-49   
        

(iv)   Statement of changes in equity for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and the period from 9 July 2008 to 31 December 2008

     F-49   
        

(v)  Notes to the financial statements

     F-50   


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of WPP plc

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated balance sheets of WPP plc and subsidiaries (the “Company”) at 31 December 2010 and 2009, and the related consolidated income statements, consolidated statements of comprehensive income, consolidated cash flow statements, and consolidated statement of changes in equity for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2010. These consolidated financial statements are the responsibility of the Company’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these consolidated financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. An audit includes examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. An audit also includes assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, such consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company as at 31 December 2010 and 2009, and the results of its operations and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2010, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

 

We have also audited, in accordance with the standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States), the Company’s internal control over financial reporting as at 31 December 2010, based on the criteria established in Internal Control—Integrated Framework issued by the Committee of Sponsoring Organizations of the Treadway Commission and our report dated 29 April 2011 expressed an unqualified opinion on the Company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

Deloitte LLP

London, United Kingdom

29 April 2011

 

F-1


Table of Contents

Our 2010 financial statements

 

Accounting policies

 

The consolidated financial statements of WPP plc and its subsidiaries (the Group) for the year ended 31 December 2010 have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board as they apply to the financial statements of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2010.

 

Basis of preparation

The consolidated financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention, except for the revaluation of certain financial instruments. The principal accounting policies are set out below.

The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors and authorised for issue on 29 April 2011.

 

Basis of consolidation

The consolidated financial statements include the results of the Company and all its subsidiary undertakings made up to the same accounting date. All intra-Group balances, transactions, income and expenses are eliminated in full on consolidation. The results of subsidiary undertakings acquired or disposed of during the period are included or excluded from the consolidated income statement from the effective date of acquisition or disposal.

 

Goodwill and other intangible assets

Intangible assets comprise goodwill, certain acquired separable corporate brand names, acquired customer relationships, acquired proprietary tools and capitalised computer software not integral to a related item of hardware.

Goodwill represents the excess of fair value attributed to investments in businesses or subsidiary undertakings over the fair value of the underlying net assets, including intangible assets, at the date of their acquisition.

Goodwill impairment reviews are undertaken annually or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate a potential impairment. The carrying value of goodwill is compared to the net present value of future cash flows derived from the underlying assets using a projection period of up to five years for each cash-generating unit. After the projection period a steady growth rate representing an appropriate long-term growth rate for the industry is applied. Any impairment is recognised immediately as an expense and is not subsequently reversed.

Corporate brand names, customer relationships and proprietary tools acquired as part of acquisitions of businesses are capitalised separately from goodwill as intangible assets if their value can be measured reliably on initial recognition and it is probable that the expected future economic benefits that are attributable to the asset will flow to the Group.

Certain corporate brands of the Group are considered to have an indefinite economic life because of the institutional nature of the corporate brand names, their proven ability to maintain market leadership and profitable operations over long periods of time and the Group’s commitment to develop and enhance their value. The carrying value of these intangible assets is reviewed at least annually for impairment and adjusted to the recoverable amount if required.

Amortisation is provided at rates calculated to write off the cost less estimated residual value of each asset on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful life as follows:

 

Acquired intangibles

 

 

Brand names (with finite lives) – 10-20 years.

 

 

Customer related intangibles – 3-10 years.

 

 

Other proprietary tools – 3-10 years.

 

 

Other (including capitalised computer software) – 3-5 years.

 

Contingent consideration

Contingent consideration is accounted for in accordance with IFRS 3 (revised) Business Combinations.

Future anticipated payments to vendors in respect of contingent consideration (earnout agreements) are initially recorded at fair value which is the present value of the expected cash outflows of the obligations. The obligations are dependent on the future financial performance of the interests acquired (typically over a four to five year period following the year of acquisition) and assume the operating companies improve profits in line with directors’ estimates. The directors derive their estimates from internal business plans together with financial due diligence performed in connection with the acquisition.

 

F-2


Table of Contents

Accounting policies (continued)

 

Subsequent adjustments to the fair value are recorded in the consolidated income statement within revaluation of financial instruments. For acquisitions completed prior to 1 January 2010, such adjustments are recorded in the consolidated balance sheet within goodwill.

 

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment are shown at cost less accumulated depreciation and any provision for impairment with the exception of freehold land which is not depreciated. The Group assesses the carrying value of its property, plant and equipment to determine if any impairment has occurred. Where this indicates that an asset may be impaired, the Group applies the requirements of IAS 36 Impairment of Assets in assessing the carrying amount of the asset. This process includes comparing its recoverable amount with its carrying value. Depreciation is provided at rates calculated to write off the cost less estimated residual value of each asset on a straight-line basis over its estimated useful life, as follows:

 

 

Freehold buildings – 50 years.

 

 

Leasehold land and buildings – over the term of the lease or life of the asset, if shorter.

 

 

Fixtures, fittings and equipment – 3-10 years.

 

 

Computer equipment – 3-5 years.

 

Interests in associates and joint ventures

The Group’s share of the profits less losses of associate undertakings net of tax, interest and non-controlling interests is included in the consolidated income statement and the Group’s share of net assets is shown within interests in associates in the consolidated balance sheet. The Group’s share of the profits less losses and net assets is based on current information produced by the undertakings, adjusted to conform with the accounting policies of the Group.

The Group assesses the carrying value of its associate undertakings to determine if any impairment has occurred. Where this indicates that an investment may be impaired, the Group applies the requirements of IAS 36 in assessing the carrying amount of the investment. This process includes comparing its recoverable amount with its carrying value.

The Group accounts for joint venture investments under the equity method which is consistent with the Group’s treatment of associates.

 

Other investments

Other investments are designated as ‘available for sale’ and are shown at fair value with any movements in fair value taken to equity.

On disposal the cumulative gain or loss previously recognised in equity is included in the profit or loss for the year. Impairment losses recognised in profit or loss for equity investments classified as ‘available for sale’ are not subsequently reversed through profit or loss.

 

Inventory and work in progress

Work in progress is valued at cost, which includes outlays incurred on behalf of clients and an appropriate proportion of directly attributable costs and overheads on incomplete assignments. Provision is made for irrecoverable costs where appropriate. Inventory is stated at the lower of cost and net realisable value.

 

Trade receivables

Trade receivables are stated net of provisions for bad and doubtful debts.

 

Foreign currency and interest rate hedging

The Group’s policy on interest rate and foreign exchange rate management sets out the instruments and methods available to hedge interest and currency risk exposures and the control procedures in place to ensure effectiveness.

The Group uses derivative financial instruments to reduce exposure to foreign exchange risk and interest rate movements. The Group does not hold or issue derivative financial instruments for speculative purposes.

Derivatives are initially recognised at fair value at the date a derivative contract is entered into and are subsequently remeasured to their fair value at each balance sheet date. The resulting gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss immediately unless the derivative is designated and effective as a hedging instrument, in which event the timing of the recognition in profit or loss depends on the nature of the hedge relationship.

At the inception of the hedge relationship the entity documents the relationship between the hedging instrument and hedged item, along with its

 

F-3


Table of Contents

Accounting policies (continued)

 

risk management objectives and its strategy for undertaking various hedge transactions. Furthermore, at the inception of the hedge and on an ongoing basis, the Group documents whether the hedging instrument that is used in a hedging relationship is highly effective in offsetting changes in fair values or cash flows of the hedged item.

Note 25 contains details of the fair values of the derivative instruments used for hedging purposes.

Changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as fair value hedges are recorded in profit or loss immediately, together with any changes in the fair value of the hedged item that is attributable to the hedged risk.

The effective portion of changes in the fair value of derivatives that are designated and qualify as cash flow or net investment hedges is deferred in equity. The gain or loss relating to the ineffective portion is recognised immediately in profit or loss. Amounts deferred in equity are recycled in profit or loss in the periods when the hedged item is recognised in profit or loss. However, when the forecast transaction that is hedged results in the recognition of a non-financial asset or a non-financial liability, the gains and losses previously deferred in equity are transferred from equity and included in the initial measurement of the cost of the asset or liability.

Hedge accounting is discontinued when the hedging instrument expires or is sold, terminated, or exercised, or no longer qualifies for hedge accounting. At that time, any cumulative gain or loss on the hedging instrument recognised in equity is retained in equity until the forecast transaction occurs. If a hedged transaction is no longer expected to occur, the net cumulative gain or loss recognised in equity is transferred to net profit or loss for the period.

Derivatives embedded in other financial instruments or other host contracts are treated as separate derivatives when their risks and characteristics are not closely related to those of host contracts and the host contracts are not carried at fair value with unrealised gains or losses reported in the consolidated income statement.

 

Liabilities in respect of option agreements

Option agreements that allow the Group’s equity partners to require the Group to purchase a non-controlling interest are treated as derivatives over equity instruments and are recorded in the consolidated balance sheet at fair value and the valuation is remeasured at each period end. Fair value is based on the present value of expected cash outflows and the movement in the fair value is recognised as income or expense within revaluation of financial instruments in the consolidated income statement.

 

Derecognition of financial liabilities

In accordance with IAS 39 Financial Instruments: Recognition and Measurement, a financial liability of the Group is only released to the consolidated income statement when the underlying legal obligation is extinguished.

 

Convertible debt

Convertible debt is assessed according to the substance of the contractual arrangements and is classified into liability and equity elements on the basis of the initial fair value of the liability element. The difference between this figure and the cash received is classified as equity.

The consolidated income statement charge for the finance cost is spread evenly over the term of the convertible debt so that at redemption the liability equals the redemption value.

 

Bank borrowings

Other interest-bearing bank loans and overdrafts are recorded at the proceeds received, net of direct issue costs.

 

Borrowing costs

Finance costs of borrowing are recognised in the consolidated income statement over the term of those borrowings.

 

Revenue recognition

Revenue comprises commission and fees earned in respect of amounts billed. Direct costs include fees paid to external suppliers where they are retained to perform part or all of a specific project for a client and the resulting expenditure is directly attributable to the revenue earned. Revenue is stated exclusive of VAT, sales taxes and trade discounts.

 

Advertising and Media Investment Management

Revenue is typically derived from commissions on media placements and fees for advertising services.

 

F-4


Table of Contents

Accounting policies (continued)

 

Revenue may consist of various arrangements involving commissions, fees, incentive-based revenue or a combination of the three, as agreed upon with each client.

Revenue is recognised when the service is performed, in accordance with the terms of the contractual arrangement. The amount of revenue recognised depends on whether we act as an agent or as a principal in an arrangement with a client. Where we act as an agent, the revenue recorded is the net amount retained when the fee or commission is earned. Although the Group may bear credit risk in respect of these activities, the arrangements with our clients are such that we consider that we are acting as an agent on their behalf. In such cases, costs incurred with external suppliers (such as media suppliers) are excluded from our revenue. Where the Group acts as a principal and contracts directly with suppliers for media payments and production costs, the revenue recorded is the gross amount billed.

Incentive-based revenue typically comprises both quantitative and qualitative elements; on the element related to quantitative targets, revenue is recognised when the quantitative targets have been achieved; on the element related to qualitative targets, revenue is recognised when the incentive is received or receivable.

The Group receives volume rebates from certain suppliers for transactions entered into on behalf of clients that, based on the terms of the relevant contracts and local law, are either remitted to clients or retained by the Group. If amounts are passed on to clients they are recorded as liabilities until settled or, if retained by the Group, are recorded as revenue when earned.

 

Consumer Insight

Revenue recognised in proportion to the level of service performed for market research contracts is based on proportional performance. In assessing contract performance, both input and output criteria are reviewed. Costs incurred are used as an objective input measure of performance. The primary input of all work performed under these arrangements is labour. As a result of the relationship between labour and cost, there is normally a direct relationship between costs incurred and the proportion of the contract performed to date. Costs incurred as a proportion of expected total costs is used as an initial proportional performance measure. This indicative proportional performance measure is subsequently validated against other more subjective criteria (i.e. relevant output measures) such as the percentage of interviews completed, percentage of reports delivered to a client and the achievement of any project milestones stipulated in the contract. In the event of divergence between the objective and more subjective measures, the more subjective measures take precedence since these are output measures.

While most of the studies provided in connection with the Group’s market research contracts are undertaken in response to an individual client’s or group of clients’ specifications, in certain instances a study may be developed as an off-the-shelf product offering sold to a broad client base. For these transactions, revenue is recognised when the product is delivered. Where the terms of transaction provide for licensing the product on a subscription basis, revenue is recognised over the subscription period on a straight-line basis or, if applicable, based on usage.

Substantially all services are provided on a fixed price basis. Pricing may also include a provision for a surcharge where the actual labour hours incurred in completing a project are significantly above the labour hours quoted in the project proposal. In instances where this occurs, the surcharge will be included in the total revenue base on which to measure proportional performance when the actual threshold is reached provided that collectability is reasonably assured.

 

Public Relations & Public Affairs and Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications

Revenue is typically derived from retainer fees and services to be performed subject to specific agreement. Revenue is recognised when the service is performed, in accordance with the terms of the contractual arrangement. Revenue is recognised on long-term contracts, if the final outcome can be assessed with reasonable certainty, by including in the consolidated income statement revenue and related costs as contract activity progresses.

 

Taxation

Corporate taxes are payable on taxable profits at current rates. The tax expense represents the sum of the tax currently payable and deferred tax.

 

F-5


Table of Contents

Accounting policies (continued)

 

The Group is subject to corporate taxes in a number of different jurisdictions and judgement is required in determining the appropriate provision for transactions where the ultimate tax determination is uncertain. In such circumstances the Group recognises liabilities for anticipated taxes based on the best information available and where the anticipated liability is both probable and estimable. Where the final outcome of such matters differs from the amount recorded, any differences may impact the income tax and deferred tax provisions in the period in which the final determination is made.

The tax laws that apply to the Group’s subsidiaries may be amended by the relevant tax authorities. Such potential amendments are regularly monitored and adjustments are made to the Group’s tax liabilities and deferred tax assets and liabilities where necessary.

The tax currently payable is based on taxable profit for the year. Taxable profit differs from net profit as reported in the consolidated income statement because it excludes items of income or expense that are taxable or deductible in other years and it further excludes items that are never taxable or deductible. The Group’s liability for current tax is calculated using tax rates that have been enacted or substantively enacted by the balance sheet date.

Deferred tax is the tax expected to be payable or recoverable on differences between the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities in the financial statements and the corresponding tax bases used in the computation of taxable profit, and is accounted for using the balance sheet liability method. Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for all taxable temporary differences unless specifically excepted by IAS 12 Income Taxes. Deferred tax assets are recognised to the extent that it is probable that taxable profits will be available against which deductible temporary differences can be utilised. Such assets and liabilities are not recognised if the temporary difference arises from the initial recognition of goodwill or other assets and liabilities (other than in a business combination) in a transaction that affects neither the tax profit nor the accounting profit.

The carrying amount of deferred tax assets is reviewed at each balance sheet date and reduced to the extent that it is no longer probable that sufficient taxable profits will be available to allow all or part of the asset to be recovered.

Deferred tax liabilities are recognised for taxable temporary differences arising on investments in subsidiaries and associates, and interests in joint ventures, except where the Group is able to control the reversal of the temporary difference and it is probable that the temporary difference will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

Deferred tax assets and liabilities are offset when there is a legally enforceable right to set off current tax assets against current tax liabilities and when they relate to income taxes levied by the same taxation authority and the Group intends to settle its current tax assets and liabilities on a net basis.

Deferred tax is calculated at the tax rates that are expected to apply in the period when the liability is settled or the asset is realised based on enacted or substantively enacted legislation. Deferred tax is charged or credited in the consolidated income statement, except when it relates to items charged or credited directly to equity, in which case the deferred tax is also dealt with in equity.

 

Retirement benefit costs

For defined contribution plans, contributions are charged to the consolidated income statement as payable in respect of the accounting period.

For defined benefit plans the amounts charged to operating profit are the current service costs and gains and losses on settlements and curtailments. They are included as part of staff costs. Past service costs are recognised immediately in the consolidated income statement if the benefits have vested. If the benefits have not vested, the costs are recognised over the period until vesting occurs. The interest cost and the expected return on assets are shown within finance costs and finance income respectively. Actuarial gains and losses are recognised immediately in the statement of comprehensive income.

Where defined benefit plans are funded, the assets of the plan are held separately from those of the Group, in separate trustee-administered funds. Pension plan assets are measured at fair value and liabilities are measured on an actuarial basis using the projected unit method and discounted at a rate equivalent to the current rate of return on a high-quality corporate bond of equivalent currency and term to the plan liabilities. The actuarial valuations are obtained at least triennially and are updated at each balance sheet date.

 

F-6


Table of Contents

Accounting policies (continued)

 

Recognition of a surplus in a defined benefit plan is limited based on the economic gain the company is expected to benefit from in the future by means of a refund or reduction in future contributions to the plan, in accordance with IAS 19 Employee Benefits.

 

Finance leases

Assets held under finance leases are recognised as assets of the Group at the inception of the lease at the lower of their fair value and the present value of the minimum lease payments. Depreciation on leased assets is charged to the consolidated income statement on the same basis as owned assets. Leasing payments are treated as consisting of capital and interest elements and the interest is charged to the consolidated income statement as it is incurred.

 

Operating leases

Operating lease rentals are charged to the consolidated income statement on a straight-line basis over the lease term. Any premium or discount on the acquisition of a lease is spread over the life of the lease on a straight-line basis.

 

Translation of foreign currencies

Foreign currency transactions arising from normal trading activities are recorded at the rates in effect at the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies at the year end are translated at the year-end exchange rate. Foreign currency gains and losses are credited or charged to the consolidated income statement as they arise.

The income statements of overseas subsidiary undertakings are translated into pounds sterling at average exchange rates and the year-end net assets of these companies are translated at year-end exchange rates.

Exchange differences arising from retranslation of the opening net assets and on foreign currency borrowings (to the extent that they hedge the Group’s investment in such operations) are reported in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income.

Goodwill and fair value adjustments arising on the acquisition of a foreign entity are treated as assets and liabilities of the foreign entity and translated at the closing rate.

 

Share-based payments

The Group issues equity-settled share-based payments (including share options) to certain employees and accounts for these awards in accordance with IFRS 2 (Share-Based Payment). Equity-settled share-based payments are measured at fair value (excluding the effect of non-market-based vesting conditions) at the date of grant. Details regarding the fair value of equity settled share-based transactions are set out in notes 22 and 26.

The fair value determined at the grant date is recognised in the consolidated income statement as an expense on a straight-line basis over the relevant vesting period, based on the Group’s estimate of the number of shares that will ultimately vest and adjusted for the effect of non-market-based vesting conditions.

 

New IFRS accounting pronouncements

At the date of authorisation of these financial statements, the following Standards and Interpretations, which have not been applied in these financial statements, were in issue but not yet effective:

 

 

IFRIC 14 (amended)/IAS 19 (amended): The Limit on a Defined Benefit Asset, Minimum Funding Requirements and their Interaction;

 

 

IFRIC 19 Extinguishing Financial Liabilities with Equity Instruments;

 

 

IFRS 7 (amended): Financial Instruments: Disclosure;

 

 

IFRS 9 Financial Instruments;

 

 

IAS 1 (amended): Presentation of Financial Statements;

 

 

IAS 12 (amended): Income Taxes;

 

 

IAS 24 (revised): Related Party Transactions;

 

 

IAS 32 (amended): Classification of Rights Issues.

 

The Group does not consider that these Standards and Interpretations will have a significant impact on the financial statements of the Group except for additional disclosures when the relevant standards come into effect for periods commencing on or after 1 January 2011.

In the current year IFRS 2 (amended) Share-Based Payment became effective. The adoption of this Standard has not led to any changes in the Group’s accounting policies.

 

F-7


Table of Contents

Accounting policies (continued)

 

The Group adopted IFRS 3 (revised) Business Combinations and IAS 27 (revised) Consolidated and Separate Financial Statements during the year. The revisions to these standards applied to business combinations completed after 1 January 2010. The main impact of these revised standards was as follows:

 

 

In the year to 31 December 2010, all acquisition-related costs have been recognised as an operating cost in the consolidated income statement whereas previously they were capitalised. Prior periods have not been restated as this change in accounting is required to be applied prospectively from 1 January 2010;

 

 

The term ‘minority interest’ has been changed to ‘non-controlling interest’;

 

 

Contingent consideration payable is to be measured at fair value at the acquisition date. Any subsequent movements in the fair value of such consideration as a result of post-acquisition events must be recognised as a gain or loss in the consolidated income statement;

 

 

Equity interests held prior to control being obtained are re-measured to fair value at the acquisition date, with any resulting gain or loss recognised in the consolidated income statement. The Group excludes such gains or losses from headline PBIT (as defined in note 31);

 

 

Changes in ownership interest in a subsidiary that does not result in a change of control are treated as transactions among equity holders and are reported within equity shareowners’ funds. No gain or loss is recognised on such transactions and goodwill is not re-measured; and

 

 

Cash consideration for non-controlling interests is classified as a financing activity rather than an investing activity in the consolidated cash flow statement. Prior periods have been restated accordingly as this change in disclosure is required to be applied retrospectively.

 

Critical judgements in applying accounting policies

Management is required to make key decisions and judgements in the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies. The most significant areas where such judgements have been necessary are revenue recognition, goodwill and other intangibles, acquisition reserves, taxation and accounting for pension liabilities. Where judgement has been applied, the key factors taken into consideration are disclosed in the accounting policies and the appropriate note in these financial statements.

 

F-8


Table of Contents

Consolidated income statement

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009, 2008

 

    Notes  

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

   

2008

£m

 
                             

Revenue

  2     9,331.0        8,684.3        7,476.9   

Direct costs

        (770.5     (703.6     (467.5

Gross profit

        8,560.5        7,980.7        7,009.4   

Operating costs

  3     (7,587.5     (7,219.0     (6,133.4

Operating profit

        973.0        761.7        876.0   

Share of results of associates

  4     55.2        57.0        46.0   

Profit before interest and taxation

        1,028.2        818.7        922.0   

Finance income

  6     81.7        150.4        169.6   

Finance costs

  6     (276.8     (355.4     (319.4

Revaluation of financial instruments

  6     18.2        48.9        (25.4

Profit before taxation

        851.3        662.6        746.8   

Taxation

  7     (190.3     (155.7     (232.9

Profit for the year

        661.0        506.9        513.9   
                             

Attributable to:

                           

Equity holders of the parent

        586.0        437.7        439.1   

Non-controlling interests

        75.0        69.2        74.8   
          661.0        506.9        513.9   
                             

Earnings per share 1

                           

Basic earnings per ordinary share

  9     47.5     35.9     38.4

Diluted earnings per ordinary share

  9     45.9     35.3     37.6

 

Notes

The accounting policies on pages F-2 to F-8 and the accompanying notes on pages F-15 to F-47 form an integral part of this consolidated income statement.

1    

The calculations of the Group’s earnings per share are set out in note 9.

 

F-9


Table of Contents

Consolidated statement of comprehensive income

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009, 2008

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
   

2008

£m

 

Profit for the year

     661.0        506.9        513.9   

Exchange adjustments on foreign currency net investments

     156.3        (155.6     1,418.6   

Loss on revaluation of available for sale investments

     (59.8     (13.5     (51.3

Actuarial loss on defined benefit pension plans

     (0.4     (7.2     (82.2

Deferred tax credit/(charge) on defined benefit pension plans

     0.2        (4.4     0.7   

Other comprehensive income/(loss) relating to the year

     96.3        (180.7     1,285.8   

Total comprehensive income relating to the year

     757.3        326.2        1,799.7   
Attributable to:                         

Equity holders of the parent

     672.6        270.4        1,685.5   

Non-controlling interests

     84.7        55.8        114.2   
       757.3        326.2        1,799.7   

 

Note

The accounting policies on pages F-2 to F-8 and the accompanying notes on pages F-15 to F-47 form an integral part of this consolidated statement of comprehensive income.

 

F-10


Table of Contents

Consolidated cash flow statement

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009, 2008

 

    Notes    

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

   

2008

£m

 

Net cash inflow from operating activities

    11        1,361.2        818.8        922.7   

Investing activities

                               

Acquisitions and disposals

    11        (200.1     (118.4     (1,029.4

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

            (190.5     (222.9     (196.8

Purchases of other intangible assets (including capitalised computer software)

            (27.0     (30.4     (23.8

Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment

            7.6        9.2        11.5   

Net cash outflow from investing activities

            (410.0     (362.5     (1,238.5

Financing activities

                               

Share option proceeds

            42.7        4.1        10.6   

Cash consideration for non-controlling interests

    11        (15.1     (26.4     (19.7

Share repurchases and buy-backs

    11        (46.4     (9.5     (105.3

Net increase/(decrease) in borrowings

    11        19.8        (426.3     810.4   

Financing and share issue costs

            (3.5     (18.8     (19.4

Equity dividends paid

    8        (200.4     (189.8     (161.8

Dividends paid to non-controlling interests in subsidiary undertakings

            (66.7     (63.0     (63.5

Net cash outflow from financing activities

            (269.6     (729.7     451.3   

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

            681.6        (273.4     135.5   

Translation differences

            82.2        (98.7     120.3   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

            946.0        1,318.1        1,062.3   

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

    11        1,709.8        946.0        1,318.1   
                                 

 

Note

The accounting policies on pages F-2 to F-8 and the accompanying notes on pages F-15 to F-47 form an integral part of this consolidated cash flow statement.

 

F-11


Table of Contents

Consolidated balance sheet

 

At 31 December 2010, 2009

 

     Notes     

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

 

Non-current assets

                         

Intangible assets:

                         

Goodwill

     12         9,106.3        8,697.5   

Other

     12         1,904.5        2,000.7   

Property, plant and equipment

     13         708.4        680.5   

Interests in associates

     14         792.1        729.3   

Other investments

     14         173.7        294.6   

Deferred tax assets

     15         79.1        67.5   

Trade and other receivables

     17         323.5        286.1   
                13,087.6        12,756.2   

Current assets

                         

Inventory and work in progress

     16         366.0        306.7   

Corporate income tax recoverable

              82.9        73.0   

Trade and other receivables

     17         8,843.4        7,548.9   

Cash and short-term deposits

              1,965.2        1,666.7   
                11,257.5        9,595.3   

Current liabilities

                         

Trade and other payables

     18         (11,703.6     (9,774.0

Corporate income tax payable

              (115.8     (71.6

Bank overdrafts and loans

     20         (255.4     (720.7
                (12,074.8     (10,566.3

Net current liabilities

              (817.3     (971.0

Total assets less current liabilities

              12,270.3        11,785.2   

Non-current liabilities

                         

Bonds and bank loans

     20         (3,598.2     (3,586.4

Trade and other payables

     19         (388.6     (423.3

Corporate income tax liability

              (481.8     (485.5

Deferred tax liabilities

     15         (750.7     (809.6

Provision for post-employment benefits

     23         (241.5     (251.8

Provisions for liabilities and charges

     21         (161.6     (152.9
                (5,622.4     (5,709.5

Net assets

              6,647.9        6,075.7   

Equity

                         

Called-up share capital

     26         126.4        125.6   

Share premium account

              54.5        12.6   

Shares to be issued

              3.1        5.5   

Merger reserve

              (5,136.8     (5,138.0

Other reserves

     27         1,182.8        1,093.1   

Own shares

              (144.8     (154.0

Retained earnings

              10,361.4        9,949.2   

Equity share owners’ funds

              6,446.6        5,894.0   

Non-controlling interests

              201.3        181.7   

Total equity

              6,647.9        6,075.7   

 

Note

The accounting policies on pages F-2 to F-8 and the accompanying notes on pages F-15 to F-47 form an integral part of this consolidated balance sheet.

 

F-12


Table of Contents

Consolidated statement of changes in equity

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009, 2008

 

    Called-up
share
capital
£m
    Share
premium
account
£m
    Shares to
be issued
£m
   

Merger
reserve

£m

    Other
reserves 1
£m
    Own
Shares
£m
   

Retained
earnings

£m

   

Total
equity
share
owners’
funds

£m

   

Non-

controlling
interests
£m

   

Total

£m

 

Balance at 1 January 2008

    119.2        103.9        5.3        (1,365.9     (114.9     (255.3     5,482.1        3,974.4        120.4        4,094.8   
Reclassification due to Group reconstruction            3,780.6               (3,769.2     (11.4                                   
Transfer of share premium to retained earnings as part of the scheme of arrangement            (4,143.1                                 4,143.1                        
Ordinary shares issued in respect of acquisitions     8.0        259.7        2.8                                    270.5               270.5   
Other ordinary shares issued     0.2        8.3        (2.8     1.1                      1.1        7.9               7.9   
Share issue/cancellation costs            (0.8            (4.8                          (5.6            (5.6
Share cancellations     (1.9                          1.9               (112.2     (112.2            (112.2
Exchange adjustments on foreign currency net investments                                 1,379.2                      1,379.2        39.4        1,418.6   
Net profit for the year                                               439.1        439.1        74.8        513.9   
Dividends paid                                               (161.8     (161.8     (63.5     (225.3
Transfer to goodwill                   3.4                                    3.4               3.4   
Non-cash share-based incentive plans (including stock options)                                               62.3        62.3               62.3   
Tax adjustment of share-based payments                                               (9.0     (9.0            (9.0
Net movement in own shares held by ESOP Trusts                                        52.8        (56.4     (3.6            (3.6
Treasury shares disposals                                        12.7        (5.8     6.9               6.9   
Actuarial loss on defined benefit plans                                               (82.2     (82.2            (82.2
Deferred tax on defined benefit pension plans                                               0.7        0.7               0.7   
Loss on revaluation of available for sale investments                                 (51.3                   (51.3            (51.3
Share purchases – close period commitments                                 64.8               (5.0     59.8               59.8   
Recognition/remeasurement of financial instruments                                 (17.8            1.5        (16.3            (16.3
Acquisition of subsidiaries                                                             26.5        26.5   

Balance at 31 December 2008

    125.5        8.6        8.7        (5,138.8     1,250.5        (189.8     9,697.5        5,762.2        197.6        5,959.8   
Ordinary shares issued     0.1        4.0        (1.7     0.8                      0.3        3.5               3.5   
Exchange adjustments on foreign currency net investments                                 (142.2                   (142.2     (13.4     (155.6
Net profit for the year                                               437.7        437.7        69.2        506.9   
Dividends paid                                               (189.8     (189.8     (63.0     (252.8
Transfer from goodwill                   (1.5                                 (1.5            (1.5
Non-cash share-based incentive plans (including stock options)                                               54.9        54.9               54.9   
Net movement in own shares held by ESOP Trusts                                        45.3        (45.3                     
Treasury shares additions                                        (9.5            (9.5            (9.5
Actuarial loss on defined benefit plans                                               (7.2     (7.2            (7.2
Deferred tax on defined benefit plans                                               (4.4     (4.4            (4.4
Loss on revaluation of available for sale investments                                 (13.5                   (13.5            (13.5
Equity component of convertible bonds (net of deferred tax)                                 34.7                      34.7               34.7   
Recognition/remeasurement of financial instruments                                 (36.4            5.5        (30.9            (30.9
Acquisition of subsidiaries                                                             (8.7     (8.7
Balance at 31 December 2009     125.6        12.6        5.5        (5,138.0     1,093.1        (154.0     9,949.2        5,894.0        181.7        6,075.7   

 

F-13


Table of Contents

Consolidated statement of changes in equity (continued)

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009, 2008

 

 

    Called-up
share
capital
£m
    Share
premium
account
£m
    Shares to
be issued
£m
   

Merger
reserve

£m

    Other
reserves 1
£m
    Own
Shares
£m
   

Retained
earnings

£m

   

Total
equity
share
owners’
funds

£m

   

Non-

controlling
interests
£m

   

Total

£m

 

Balance at 31 December 2009

    125.6        12.6        5.5        (5,138.0     1,093.1        (154.0     9,949.2        5,894.0        181.7        6,075.7   
Ordinary shares issued     0.8        41.9        (2.4     1.2                      0.9        42.4               42.4   
Exchange adjustments on foreign currency net investments                                 146.6                      146.6        9.7        156.3   
Net profit for the year                                               586.0        586.0        75.0        661.0   
Dividends paid                                               (200.4     (200.4     (66.7     (267.1
Non-cash share-based incentive plans (including stock options)                                               70.4        70.4               70.4   
Tax adjustment on share-based payments                                               21.1        21.1               21.1   
Net movement in own shares held by ESOP Trusts                                        9.2        (55.6     (46.4            (46.4
Actuarial loss on defined benefit plans                                               (0.4     (0.4            (0.4
Deferred tax on defined benefit plans                                               0.2        0.2               0.2   
Loss on revaluation of available for sale investments                                 (59.8                   (59.8            (59.8
Recognition/remeasurement of financial instruments                                 2.9               0.9        3.8               3.8   
Acquisition of subsidiaries                                               (10.9     (10.9     1.6        (9.3
Balance at 31 December 2010     126.4        54.5        3.1        (5,136.8     1,182.8        (144.8     10,361.4        6,446.6        201.3        6,647.9   

 

Notes

The accounting policies on pages F-2 to F-8 and the accompanying notes on pages F-15 to F-47 form an integral part of this consolidated statement of changes in equity.

1    

Other reserves are analysed in note 27.

 

Total comprehensive income relating to the year ended 31 December 2010 was £757.3 million (2009: £326.2 million, 2008: £1,799.7 million)

 

F-14


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements

 

1. General information

 

WPP plc is a company incorporated in Jersey. The address of the registered office is 22 Grenville Street, St Helier, Jersey, JE4 8PX and the address of the principal executive office is 6 Ely Place, Dublin 2, Ireland. The nature of the Group’s operations and its principal activities are set out in note 2. These consolidated financial statements are presented in pounds sterling.

 

2. Segment information

 

The Group is a leading worldwide communications services organisation offering national and multinational clients a comprehensive range of communications services.

 

The Group is organised into four reportable segments – Advertising and Media Investment Management; Consumer Insight; Public Relations & Public Affairs; and Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications. This last reportable segment includes WPP Digital and direct, digital, promotional and relationship marketing.

 

IFRS 8 Operating Segments requires operating segments to be identified on the same basis as is used internally for the review of performance and allocation of resources by the Group chief executive. Provided certain quantitative and qualitative criteria are fulfilled, IFRS 8 permits the aggregation of these components into reportable segments for the purposes of disclosure in the Group’s financial statements. In assessing the Group’s reportable segments, the directors have had regard to the similar economic characteristics of certain operating segments, their shared client base, the similar nature of their products or services and their long-term margins, amongst other factors.

 

Operating sectors

Reported contributions were as follows:

 

     Revenue 1      Headline
PBIT 3
    

Headline
PBIT

margin

     Revenue 1,2      Headline
PBIT 2,3
     Headline
PBIT
margin 2
     Revenue 1,2      Headline
PBIT 2,3
     Headline
PBIT
margin 2
 
    

2010

£m

    

2010

£m

    

2010

%

    

2009

£m

    

2009

£m

    

2009

%

    

2008

£m

    

2008

£m

    

2008

%

 
Advertising and Media Investment Management      3,733.3         573.0         15.3         3,420.5         472.8         13.8         3,380.2         581.3         17.2   
Consumer Insight      2,430.2         234.8         9.7         2,297.1         196.9         8.6         1,301.8         147.6         11.3   
Public Relations & Public Affairs      844.5         133.1         15.8         795.7         122.1         15.3         752.3         124.9         16.6   
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications      2,323.0         287.8         12.4         2,171.0         225.4         10.4         2,042.6         264.4         12.9   
       9,331.0         1,228.7         13.2         8,684.3         1,017.2         11.7         7,476.9         1,118.2         15.0   

 

Notes

1    

Intersegment sales have not been separately disclosed as they are not material.

2    

2009 and 2008 comparatives have been restated to reflect the transfer of certain revenues of RMG from Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications to Advertising and Media Investment Management. Headline PBIT comparatives have not been restated as the impact was insignificant.

3    

A reconciliation from profit before interest and taxation (PBIT) to headline PBIT is provided in note 31. PBIT is reconciled to profit before taxation in the consolidated income statement.

 

Other information    Share-based
payments
     Capital
additions 1
     Depreciation
and
amortisation 2
     Goodwill
impairment &
write-downs
     Share of
results of
associates
     Interest in
associates
 
     £m      £m      £m      £m      £m      £m  
2010                                                      
Advertising and Media Investment Management      36.8         95.6         94.2         0.3         26.2         487.3   
Consumer Insight      13.7         58.9         49.8                 15.1         122.6   
Public Relations & Public Affairs      3.3         12.9         14.1         2.0         4.1         58.7   
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications      16.6         50.1         52.2         7.7         9.8         123.5   
       70.4         217.5         210.3         10.0         55.2         792.1   
2009                                                      
Advertising and Media Investment Management      23.1         166.5         99.7         33.3         30.7         445.9   
Consumer Insight      11.5         51.6         53.5                 16.9         114.5   
Public Relations & Public Affairs      4.4         19.2         15.2                 2.7         60.3   
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications      15.9         43.8         57.4         11.0         6.7         108.6   
       54.9         281.1         225.8         44.3         57.0         729.3   
2008                                                      
Advertising and Media Investment Management      33.3         93.3         86.2         9.1         32.7         474.9   
Consumer Insight      7.5         50.9         23.0         3.0         5.4         96.7   
Public Relations & Public Affairs      4.3         13.3         13.6                 4.1         59.6   
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications      17.2         63.1         50.2         73.5         3.8         83.1   
       62.3         220.6         173.0         85.6         46.0         714.3   

 

Notes

1    

Capital additions include purchases of property, plant and equipment and other intangible assets (including capitalised computer software).

2    

Depreciation of property, plant and equipment and amortisation of other intangible assets.

 

F-15


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

2. Segment information (continued)

 

 

     Assets             Liabilities  
Balance sheet    Segment
assets
     Unallocated
corporate
assets 1
     Consolidated
total assets
            Segment
liabilities
    Unallocated
corporate
liabilities 1
    Consolidated
total
liabilities
 
     £m      £m      £m             £m     £m     £m  
2010                                                             
Advertising and Media Investment Management      11,795.7                                    (9,553.6                
Consumer Insight      3,691.2                                    (1,143.9                
Public Relations & Public Affairs      1,699.6                                    (388.4                
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications      5,031.4                                    (1,409.4                
       22,217.9         2,127.2         24,345.1                  (12,495.3     (5,201.9     (17,697.2
2009                                                             
Advertising and Media Investment Management      10,539.1                                    (8,036.9                
Consumer Insight      3,714.6                                    (1,002.4                
Public Relations & Public Affairs      1,579.7                                    (324.9                
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications      4,710.9                                    (1,237.8                
       20,544.3         1,807.2         22,351.5                  (10,602.0     (5,673.8     (16,275.8

 

Note

1    

Included in unallocated corporate assets and liabilities are corporate income tax, deferred tax and net interest-bearing debt.

 

F-16


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

2. Segment information (continued)

 

 

Contributions by geographical area were as follows:

 

       

2010

£m

     

2009

£m

     

2008

£m

Revenue 1                        
North America 5       3,299.8       3,010.0       2,603.2
UK       1,087.6       1,029.0       954.2
Western Continental Europe 4   2,325.3       2,327.8       1,879.1
Asia Pacific, Latin America,                    
Africa & Middle East and                        
Central & Eastern Europe       2,618.3       2,317.5       2,040.4
        9,331.0       8,684.3       7,476.9
    Margin       Margin       Margin    
Headline PBIT 2                        
North America 5   14.7%   484.6   13.2%   397.9   16.8%   438.3
UK   13.6%   147.9   12.8%   131.5   13.0%   124.1
Western Continental Europe 4   9.5%   221.6   8.3%   193.4   13.1%   247.0
Asia Pacific, Latin America,                        
Africa & Middle East and                        
Central & Eastern Europe   14.3%   374.6   12.7%   294.4   15.1%   308.8
    13.2%   1,228.7   11.7%   1,017.2   15.0%   1,118.2
Non-current assets 3                        
North America 5       4,742.7       4,420.1        
UK       1,693.3       1,688.3        
Western Continental Europe 4   3,728.6       4,012.6        
Asia Pacific, Latin America,                    
Africa & Middle East and                        
Central & Eastern Europe       2,649.2       2,379.6        
       

12,813.8

      12,500.6        

Notes

1    

Intersegment sales have not been separately disclosed as they are not material.

2    

See note 31 for a reconciliation of headline PBIT to PBIT.

3    

Non-current assets excluding financial instruments and deferred tax.

4    

Western Continental Europe includes Ireland with revenue of £37.4 million (2009: £43.4 million, 2008: £41.3 million), headline PBIT of £2.0 million (2009: £3.9 million, 2008: £8.0 million) and non-current assets of £65.0 million (2009: £61.6 million).

5    

North America includes the US with revenues of £3,097.9 million (2009: £2,835.8 million, 2008: £2,444.7 million), headline PBIT of £448.7 million (2009: £370.9 million, 2008: £411.0 million) and non-current assets of £4,209.7 million (2009: £4,010.9 million).


3. Operating costs

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Total staff costs (note 5)      5,438.7        5,117.0        4,351.8   
Establishment costs      659.2        691.6        521.3   
Other operating costs (net)      1,489.6        1,410.4        1,260.3   
Total operating costs      7,587.5        7,219.0        6,133.4   
Operating costs include:                         
Goodwill impairment (note 12)      10.0        44.3        84.1   
Goodwill write-down relating to utilisation of pre-acquisition tax losses                    1.5   
Investment write-downs      37.5        11.1        30.5   
Cost of changes to corporate structure                    4.6   
Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangible assets (note 12)      170.5        172.6        78.4   
Amortisation of other intangible assets (note 12)      25.4        30.5        23.4   
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment      178.3        189.9        145.4   
Losses on sale of property, plant and equipment      0.7        0.4        1.9   
Gains on disposal of investments      (4.1     (31.1     (3.4
Gains on re-measurement of equity interest on acquisition of controlling interest      (13.7              
Net foreign exchange losses/(gains)      8.0        6.4        (18.3
Operating lease rentals:                         
Land and buildings      449.9        461.5        350.0   
Sublease income      (32.8     (27.0     (24.8
       417.1        434.5        325.2   
Plant and machinery      24.8        28.0        26.5   
       441.9        462.5        351.7   

 

In 2010, operating profit includes credits totalling £16.5 million (2009: £19.4 million, 2008: £23.7 million) relating to the release of excess provisions and other balances established in respect of acquisitions completed prior to 2009. Further details of the Group’s approach to acquisition reserves, as required by IFRS 3 (revised) Business Combinations, are given in note 28.

 

Investment write-downs of £37.5 million (2009: £11.1 million) relate to certain non-core minority investments in the US and Continental Europe where forecast financial performance and/or liquidity issues indicate a permanent decline in the recoverability of the Group’s investment.

 

All of the operating costs of the Group are related to administrative expenses.

 

F-17


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

3. Operating costs (continued)

 

 

Auditors’ remuneration:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
     2008
£m
 
Fees payable to the Company’s auditors for the audit of the Company’s annual accounts      1.4         1.5         1.7   
The audit of the Company’s subsidiaries pursuant to legislation      14.8         15.0         13.3   
       16.2         16.5         15.0   
Other services pursuant to legislation      3.1         3.2         3.8   
Fees payable to the auditors pursuant to legislation      19.3         19.7         18.8   
Tax advisory services      2.7         2.6         2.2   
Tax compliance services      1.2         1.5         0.9   
       3.9         4.1         3.1   
Corporate finance services      0.2         0.2         1.5   
Other services 1      5.1         4.8         4.4   
Total non-audit fees      9.2         9.1         9.0   
Total fees      28.5         28.8         27.8   

Note

1    

Other services include audits for earnout purposes and services for expatriate employees.

 

Minimum committed annual rentals

Amounts payable in 2011 under the foregoing leases will be as follows:

 

     Plant and machinery

     Land and buildings

 
     2011
£m
     2010
£m
     2009
£m
     2011
£m
     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
In respect of operating leases which expire:                                                      
– within one year      4.8         4.1         6.6         32.7         43.1         63.4   
– within two to five years      14.8         14.6         14.2         163.4         145.2         168.3   
– after five years      0.2         1.1         0.3         159.7         143.7         107.5   
       19.8         19.8         21.1         355.8         332.0         339.2   

 

Future minimum annual amounts payable under all lease commitments in existence at 31 December 2010 are as follows:

 

     Minimum
rental
payments
£m
     Less
sub-let
rentals
£m
    Net
payment
£m
 
Year ending 31 December                          
2011      375.6         (21.0     354.6   
2012      311.4         (17.9     293.5   
2013      278.1         (10.0     268.1   
2014      222.7         (2.9     219.8   
2015      204.9         (2.3     202.6   
Later years      936.0         (2.0     934.0   
       2,328.7         (56.1     2,272.6   

 


4. Share of results of associates

 

Share of results of associates include:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Share of profit before interest and taxation      86.0        86.3        71.5   
Share of exceptional losses      (0.3     (1.6     (0.5
Share of interest and non-controlling interests      (2.7     (0.7     0.5   
Share of taxation      (27.8     (27.0     (25.5
       55.2        57.0        46.0   

 


5. Our people

 

Our staff numbers averaged 101,387 against 105,318 in 2009 and 97,438 in 2008, including acquisitions. Their geographical distribution was as follows:

 

     2010      2009      2008  
North America      25,546         25,004         24,493   
UK      9,620         9,704         8,971   
Western Continental Europe      21,154         22,230         19,448   
Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe      45,067         48,380         44,526   
       101,387         105,318         97,438   

 

Their operating sector distribution was as follows:

 

    2010     2009     2008  
Advertising and Media Investment Management     42,424        42,906        45,754   
Consumer Insight     28,167        28,325        14,934   
Public Relations & Public Affairs     7,364        7,325        7,682   
Branding & Identity, Healthcare and Specialist Communications     23,432        26,762        29,068   
      101,387        105,318        97,438   

 

At the end of 2010 staff numbers were 104,052 (2009: 98,759, 2008: 112,262). Including all employees of associated undertakings, this figure was approximately 146,000 at 31 December 2010 (2009: 138,000, 2008: 135,000).

 

Total staff costs were made up as follows:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
     2008
£m
 
Wages and salaries      3,696.8         3,614.1         3,044.6   
Cash-based incentive plans      271.9         122.9         151.4   
Share-based incentive plans (note 22)      70.4         54.9         62.3   
Social security costs      450.1         442.5         346.4   
Pension costs (note 23)      120.6         116.4         98.3   
Other staff costs      828.9         766.2         648.8   
       5,438.7         5,117.0         4,351.8   
Staff cost to revenue ratio      58.3%         58.9%         58.2%   

 

Included above are charges of £7.7 million (2009: £6.1 million, 2008: £5.1 million) for share-based incentive plans in respect of key management personnel (who comprise the directors of the Group). Compensation for key management personnel also included £4.1 million (2009: £3.8 million, 2008: £3.6 million) of short-term benefits and £0.7 million (2009: £0.7 million, 2008: £0.6 million) of post-employment benefits.

 


6. Finance income, finance costs and revaluation of financial instruments

 

Finance income includes:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
     2008
£m
 
Expected return on pension plan assets (note 23)      30.6         28.7         31.3   
Income from available for sale investments      9.3         10.2         9.7   
Interest income      41.8         111.5         128.6   
       81.7         150.4         169.6   

 

Finance costs include:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
     2008
£m
 
Interest on pension plan liabilities (note 23)      45.9         46.1         38.9   
Interest on other long-term employee benefits      1.9         1.3         1.6   
Interest payable and similar charges 1      229.0         308.0         278.9   
       276.8         355.4         319.4   

 

F-18


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

6. Finance income, finance costs and revaluation of financial instruments (continued)

 

 

Revaluation of financial instruments 2 include:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
     2008
£m
 
Movements in fair value of treasury instruments      21.8        8.4         (13.9
Revaluation of put options over non-controlling interests      (3.6     15.3         (11.5
Gains on termination of hedge accounting on repayment of TNS debt             25.2           
       18.2        48.9         (25.4

Notes

1    

Interest payable and similar charges are payable on bank overdrafts, bonds and bank loans held at amortised cost.

2    

Financial instruments are held at fair value through profit and loss.

 

The majority of the Group’s long-term debt is represented by $1,250 million of US dollar bonds at an average interest rate of 6.9% (prior to any interest rate swaps or cross-currency swaps), 1,850 million of Eurobonds at an average interest rate of 5.52% (prior to any interest rate or currency swaps) and £1,050 million of sterling bonds including convertible bonds at an average interest rate of 5.96%.

 

Average borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facilities (note 10) amounted to the equivalent of $818 million at an average interest rate of 0.85% inclusive of margin.

 


7. Taxation

 

The tax charge is based on the profit for the year and comprises:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Corporation tax                         
Current year      276.2        209.8        217.7   
Prior years      (1.0     (1.7     7.0   
       275.2        208.1        224.7   
Deferred tax                         
Current year      (21.4     (16.1     (8.4
Net credit in relation to the amortisation of acquired intangible assets and other goodwill items      (37.5     (37.3     (12.4
       (58.9     (53.4     (20.8
Prior years      (26.0     1.0        29.0   
       (84.9     (52.4     8.2   
Tax charge      190.3        155.7        232.9   

 

The tax charge for the year can be reconciled to profit before taxation in the consolidated income statement as follows:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Profit before taxation      851.3        662.6        746.8   
Tax at the corporation tax rate of 25% 1 (2009: 25% 1 , 2008: UK 28.5%)      212.8        165.7        212.8   
Tax effect of share of results of associates      (13.8     (14.3     (13.4
Tax effect of items that are not taxable      (7.8     (63.7     (11.7
Tax effect of utilisation or recognition of tax losses not previously recognised      (47.5     (10.1     (6.5
Effect of different tax rates of subsidiaries operating in other jurisdictions      15.4        23.7        3.5   
Losses carried forward and temporary differences not recognised      58.2        55.1        12.2   
Prior period adjustments      (27.0     (0.7     36.0   
Tax charge      190.3        155.7        232.9   
Effective tax rate on profit before tax      22.4%        23.5%        31.2%   

 

7. Taxation (continued)

 

 

Note

1    

In November 2008, WPP introduced a new holding company that is tax resident in the Republic of Ireland. As a result, the tax reconciliation for the years ended 31 December 2010 and 31 December 2009 have been prepared using the Irish non-trading corporation tax rate of 25%, which is the rate applicable to WPP plc. In 2008 the reconciliation was prepared using the prevailing UK corporation tax rate of 28.5%.

 


8. Ordinary dividends

 

Amounts recognised as distributions to equity holders in the year:

 

     2010     2009     2008    

2010

£m

    

2009

£m

    

2008

£m

 
Per share    Pence per share          
2009 Second interim dividend paid      10.28     10.28     9.13     126.6         126.1         103.1   
2010 First interim dividend paid      5.97     5.19     5.19     73.8         63.7         58.7   
       16.25     15.47     14.32     200.4         189.8         161.8   

 

Second interim dividend for the year ended 31 December 2010:

 

     2010     2009     2008  
Per share    Pence per share  
2010 Second interim dividend      11.82     10.28     10.28

 

The payment of dividends will not have any tax consequences for the Group.

 


9. Earnings per share

 

Basic EPS

 

The calculation of basic EPS is as follows:

 

     2010     2009     2008  
Earnings 1 (£m)      586.0        437.7        439.1   
Average shares used in Basic EPS calculation (m)      1,233.1        1,218.7        1,143.4   
EPS      47.5     35.9     38.4

Note

1    

Earnings is equivalent to profit for the year attributable to equity holders of the parent.

 

Diluted EPS

 

The calculation of diluted EPS is set out below:

 

     2010     2009     2008  
Diluted earnings (£m)      614.3        437.7        439.9   
Average shares used in diluted EPS calculation (m)      1,339.0        1,238.2        1,169.6   
Diluted EPS      45.9     35.3     37.6

 

Diluted EPS has been calculated based on the diluted earnings amount above. On 19 May 2009 the Group issued £450 million 5.75% convertible bonds due May 2014. For the year ended 31 December 2010 these convertible bonds were dilutive and earnings were consequently increased by £28.3 million for the purpose of the calculation of diluted earnings. For the year ended 31 December 2009 these convertible bonds were accretive to earnings and therefore excluded from this calculation. For the year ended 31 December 2008 the $150 million 5% Grey convertible bonds were dilutive and earnings were consequently increased by £0.8 million for the purpose of this calculation; these bonds were redeemed on 28 October 2008. In addition, at 31 December 2010, options to purchase 11.6 million ordinary shares (2009: 33.2 million, 2008: 28.0 million) were outstanding, but were excluded from the computation of diluted earnings per share because the exercise prices of these options were greater than the average market price of the Group’s shares and, therefore, their inclusion would have been accretive.

 

F-19


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

9. Earnings per share (continued)

 

 

A reconciliation between the shares used in calculating basic and diluted EPS is as follows:

 

     2010
m
    

2009

m

    

2008

m

 
Average shares used in basic EPS calculation      1,233.1         1,218.7         1,143.4   
Dilutive share options outstanding      6.7         2.1         2.9   
Other potentially issuable shares      22.7         17.4         16.0   
£450 million 5.75% convertible bonds      76.5                   
$150 million Grey convertible bonds                      7.3   
Shares used in diluted EPS calculation      1,339.0         1,238.2         1,169.6   

 

At 31 December 2010 there were 1,264,391,221 ordinary shares in issue.

 


10. Sources of finance

 

The following table summarises the equity and debt financing of the Group, and changes during the year:

 

            Shares                   Debt  
     2010
£m
     2009
£m
           

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

 
Analysis of changes in financing                                            
Beginning of year      138.2         134.1                  3,586.4        4,385.7   
Other ordinary shares issued      42.7         4.1                           
Net increase/(decrease) in drawings on bank loans, corporate bonds and convertible bonds                               19.8        (426.3
Net amortisation of financing costs included in debt                               13.6        (32.8
Other movements                               0.5        (21.1
Exchange adjustments                               (22.1     (319.1
End of year      180.9         138.2                  3,598.2        3,586.4   

 

Note

The above table excludes bank overdrafts which fall within cash and cash equivalents for the purposes of the consolidated cash flow statement.

 

Shares

At 31 December 2010, the Company’s share base was entirely composed of ordinary equity share capital and share premium of £180.9 million (2009: £138.2 million), further details of which are disclosed in note 26.

 

Debt

US$ bonds The Group has in issue $600 million of 8% bonds due September 2014 and $650 million of 5.875% bonds due June 2014.

 

Eurobonds The Group has in issue 600  million of 4.375% bonds due December 2013, 500 million of 5.25% bonds due January 2015 and 750 million of 6.625% bonds due May 2016.

 

Sterling bonds The Group has in issue £400 million of 6% bonds due April 2017 and £200 million of 6.375% bonds due November 2020.

 

10. Sources of finance (continued)

 

 

Revolving Credit Facilities The Group has a $1.6 billion seven-year Revolving Credit Facility due August 2012 and a £200 million amortising Revolving Credit Facility maturing in July 2011. The Group’s borrowing under these facilities, which are drawn down predominantly in US dollars, euros, Canadian dollars and pounds sterling, averaged the equivalent of $818 million in 2010. The Group had available undrawn committed credit facilities of £1,145 million at December 2010 (2009: £1,335 million).

 

Borrowings under the Revolving Credit Facilities are governed by certain financial covenants based on the results and financial position of the Group.

 

US Commercial Paper Program

The Group has a $1.4 billion US Commercial Paper Program using the $1.6 billion Revolving Credit Facility as a backstop. There was no US Commercial Paper outstanding at 31 December 2010.

 

Convertible bonds

The Group has in issue £450 million of 5.75% convertible bonds due May 2014. At the option of the holder, the bonds are convertible into 76,530,612 WPP ordinary shares at an initial share price of £5.88 per share.

 

The convertible bonds have a nominal value of £450 million at 31 December 2010. In accordance with IAS 39, these bonds have been split between a liability component and an equity component by initially valuing the liability component at fair value based on the present value of future cash flows and then holding it at amortised cost. This fair value has been calculated assuming redemption in May 2014 and using a discount rate of 8.25%, based on the estimated rate of interest that would have applied to a comparable bond issued at that time without the convertible option. The equity component represents the fair value, on initial recognition, of the embedded option to convert the liability into equity of the Group.

 

The liability element is £413.2 million and the equity component is £44.5 million as at 31 December 2010.

 

The Group estimates that the fair value of the liability component of the convertible bonds at 31 December 2010 to be approximately £433.2 million. This fair value has been calculated by discounting the future cash flows at the market rate.

 

The following table is an analysis of future anticipated cash flows in relation to the Group’s debt, on an undiscounted basis which, therefore, differs from the fair value and carrying value:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
 
Within one year      (209.4     (210.0
Between one and two years      (308.7     (210.0
Between two and three years      (721.1     (228.1
Between three and four years      (1,416.3     (797.7
Between four and five years      (509.8     (1,396.6
Over five years      (1,355.4     (1,928.4
Debt financing under the Revolving Credit Facility and in relation to unsecured loan notes      (4,520.7     (4,770.8
Short-term overdrafts – within one year      (255.4     (720.7
Future anticipated cash flows      (4,776.1     (5,491.5
Effect of discounting/financing rates      922.5        1,184.4   
Debt financing      (3,853.6     (4,307.1

 

F-20


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

10. Sources of finance (continued)

 

 

Analysis of fixed and floating rate debt by currency including the effect of interest rate and cross-currency swaps:

 

2010

Currency

   £m     Fixed
rate 1
     Floating
basis
     Period
(months) 1
 
$    – fixed      1,338.0        6.54%         n/a         44   
     – floating      283.0        n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
£    – fixed      550.0        6.07%         n/a         83   
     – floating      200.0        n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
   – fixed      728.7        6.50%         n/a         63   
     – floating      363.1        n/a         EURIBOR         n/a   
¥    – fixed      71.1        2.07%         n/a         36   
$C 2    – floating      81.1        n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
Other           (16.8     n/a         n/a         n/a   
            3,598.2                             

 

2009

Currency

   £m      Fixed
rate 1
     Floating
basis
     Period
(months) 1
 
$    – fixed      1,106.1         6.54%         n/a         56   
     – floating      459.0         n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
£    – fixed      550.0         6.07%         n/a         95   
     – floating      200.0         n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
   – fixed      754.3         6.50%         n/a         75   
     – floating      375.9         n/a         EURIBOR         n/a   
¥    – fixed      59.8         2.07%         n/a         48   
$C 2    – floating      56.2         n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
Other           25.1         n/a         LIBOR         n/a   
            3,586.4                              

Notes

1    

Weighted average. These rates do not include the effect of gains on interest rate swap terminations that are written to income over the life of the original instrument. At 31 December 2010 the amount still to be written to income was £1.7 million (2009:£2.2 million) in respect of US dollar swap terminations, to be written to income evenly until June 2014.

2    

Represents Canadian dollars.

 

The following table is an analysis of future anticipated cash flows in relation to the Group’s financial derivatives, which include interest rate swaps, cash flow hedges and other foreign exchange swaps:

 

    Financial liabilities           Financial assets  
2010   Payable
£m
    Receivable
£m
          Payable
£m
    Receivable
£m
 
Within one year     74.1        46.3                160.0        205.4   
Between one and two years     36.6        29.2                85.7        123.5   
Between two and three years     335.2        241.1                758.8        847.0   
Between three and four years     368.7        291.0                804.8        877.8   
Between four and five years     480.6        355.8                556.5        656.4   
Over five years     27.1        27.1                457.3        488.4   
      1,322.3        990.5                2,823.1        3,198.5   
2009   Financial liabilities           Financial assets  
  Payable
£m
    Receivable
£m
          Payable
£m
    Receivable
£m
 
Within one year     284.5        272.8                170.5        218.7   
Between one and two years     38.1        31.8                78.4        111.7   
Between two and three years     45.4        39.0                107.5        128.9   
Between three and four years     325.9        249.7                796.3        881.8   
Between four and five years     336.7        242.4                841.0        909.3   
Over five years     489.3        384.4                803.8        925.5   
      1,519.9        1,220.1                2,797.5        3,175.9   

 

Included in these amounts are anticipated cash flows in relation to cash flow hedges.

 


11. Analysis of cash flows

 

The following tables analyse the items included within the main cash flow headings on page F-11.

 

Net cash from operating activities:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Profit for the year      661.0        506.9        513.9   
Taxation      190.3        155.7        232.9   
Revaluation of financial instruments      (18.2     (48.9     25.4   
Finance costs      276.8        355.4        319.4   
Finance income      (81.7     (150.4     (169.6
Share of results of associates      (55.2     (57.0     (46.0
Adjustments for:                         
Non-cash share-based incentive plans (including share options)      70.4        54.9        62.3   
Depreciation of property, plant and equipment      184.9        195.3        149.6   
Impairment of goodwill      10.0        44.3        84.1   
Goodwill write-down relating to utilisation of pre-acquisition tax losses                    1.5   
Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangible assets      170.5        172.6        78.4   
Amortisation of other intangible assets      25.4        30.5        23.4   
Investment write-downs      37.5        11.1        30.5   
Gains on disposal of investments      (4.1     (31.1     (3.4
Gains on re-measurement of equity interest on acquisition of controlling interest      (13.7              
Losses on sale of property, plant and equipment      0.7        0.4        1.9   
(Increase)/decrease in inventories and work in progress      (46.3     12.4        65.6   
(Increase)/decrease in receivables      (850.8     (90.0     492.6   
Increase/(decrease) in payables – short term      1,135.7        (51.3     (628.9
Increase/(decrease) in payables – long term      10.3        25.5        (23.1
(Decrease)/increase in provisions      (23.4     1.3        (15.5
Corporation and overseas tax paid      (207.4     (216.6     (182.5
Interest and similar charges paid      (219.7     (248.7     (269.2
Interest received    50.7     99.6     133.0  
Investment income      4.2        1.4        1.8   
Dividends from associates      53.3        45.5        44.6   
Net cash inflow from operating activities      1,361.2        818.8        922.7   

 

F-21


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

11. Analysis of cash flows (continued)

 

 

Acquisitions and disposals:


     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Initial cash consideration      (138.6     (35.4     (872.2
Cash and cash equivalents acquired (net)      57.0        1.3        (6.1
Earnout payments      (113.3     (81.5     (67.8
Loan note redemptions      (5.1            (2.6
Purchase of other investments (including associates)      (23.8     (53.3     (91.7
Proceeds on disposal of investments      23.7        50.5        11.0   
Acquisitions and disposals      (200.1     (118.4     (1,029.4
Cash consideration for non-controlling interests      (15.1     (26.4     (19.7
Net cash outflow      (215.2     (144.8     (1,049.1
Share repurchases and buy-backs:                   
     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Purchase of own shares by ESOP Trust      (46.4              
Share cancellations (excluding brokerage fees)                    (112.2
Shares purchased into treasury             (9.5       
Proceeds on disposal of treasury shares                    6.9   
Net cash outflow    (46.4)     (9.5)     (105.3)  
Net increase/(decrease) in borrowings:                   
     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Increase/(decrease) in drawings on bank loans      19.8        (1,068.0     1,273.3   
Proceeds from issue of £450 million convertible bonds             450.0          
Proceeds from issue of $600 million bonds             367.4          
Repayment of TNS debt             (175.7     (395.7
Repayment of 650 million bonds                    (515.1
Repayment of $100 million bonds                    (50.5
Repayment of $150 million convertible debt                    (96.2
Proceeds from issue of 750  million bonds                    594.6   
Net cash inflow/(outflow)      19.8        (426.3     810.4   
Cash and cash equivalents:                         
     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Cash at bank and in hand      1,877.1        1,570.5        2,485.9   
Short-term bank deposits      88.1        96.2        86.6   
Overdrafts 1      (255.4     (720.7     (1,254.4
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year      1,709.8        946.0        1,318.1   

Note

1    

Bank overdrafts are included in cash and cash equivalents because they form an integral part of the Group’s cash management.

 

The Group considers that the carrying amount of cash and cash equivalents approximates their fair value.


12. Intangible assets

 

Goodwill

 

The movements in 2010 and 2009 were as follows:

 

     £m  
Cost:         
1 January 2009      9,640.6   
Additions 1      21.1   
Exchange differences      (414.9
31 December 2009      9,246.8   
Additions 1      246.3   
Exchange differences      185.7   
31 December 2010      9,678.8   
Accumulated impairment losses and write-downs:         
1 January 2009      547.4   
Impairment losses for the year      21.6   
Exchange differences      (19.7
31 December 2009      549.3   
Impairment losses for the year      8.3   
Exchange differences      14.9   
31 December 2010      572.5   
Net book value:         
31 December 2010      9,106.3   
31 December 2009      8,697.5   
1 January 2009      9,093.2   

 

Note

1    

Additions represent goodwill arising on the acquisition of subsidiary undertakings including the effect of any revisions to fair value adjustments that had been determined provisionally at the immediately preceding balance sheet date, as permitted by IFRS 3 (revised) Business Combinations. The effect of such revisions was not material in either year presented. Goodwill arising on the acquisition of associate undertakings is shown within interests in associates and joint ventures in note 14.

 

Cash-generating units with significant goodwill as at 31 December 2010 and 2009 are:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
GroupM      2,105.0         2,044.3   
Kantar      1,740.0         1,738.6   
Y&R Advertising      1,092.7         1,019.2   
Wunderman      1,143.8         958.7   
Burson-Marsteller      545.9         516.1   
Other      2,478.9         2,420.6   
Total goodwill      9,106.3         8,697.5   

 

Other goodwill represents goodwill on a large number of cash-generating units, none of which is individually significant in comparison to the total carrying value of goodwill.

 

F-22


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

12. Intangible assets (continued)

 

 

Other intangible assets

 

The movements in 2010 and 2009 were as follows:

 

   

Brands
with an
indefinite
useful life

£m

    Acquired
intangibles
£m
    Other
£m
   

Total

£m

 

Cost:

                               

1 January 2009

    1,073.2        1,377.6        203.6        2,654.4   

Additions

                  33.5        33.5   

Disposals

                  (8.1     (8.1

New acquisitions

           6.6               6.6   

Other movements

           1.2        4.5        5.7   

Exchange differences

    (60.0     (88.4     (21.7     (170.1

31 December 2009

    1,013.2        1,297.0        211.8        2,522.0   

Additions

                  27.0        27.0   

Disposals

                  (14.2     (14.2

New acquisitions

           25.5        0.7        26.2   

Other movements

           1.1        4.0        5.1   

Exchange differences

    40.5        8.9        0.6        50.0   

31 December 2010

    1,053.7        1,332.5        229.9        2,616.1   

Amortisation and impairment:

                               

1 January 2009

           221.7        136.9        358.6   

Charge for the year

           172.6        30.5        203.1   

Disposals

                  (8.1     (8.1

Other movements

           (2.0     (3.1     (5.1

Exchange differences

           (14.8     (12.4     (27.2

31 December 2009

           377.5        143.8        521.3   

Charge for the year

           170.5        25.4        195.9   

Disposals

                  (14.0     (14.0

Other movements

           (2.4     2.3        (0.1

Exchange differences

           5.2        3.3        8.5   

31 December 2010

           550.8        160.8        711.6   

Net book value:

                               

31 December 2010

    1,053.7        781.7        69.1        1,904.5   

31 December 2009

    1,013.2        919.5        68.0        2,000.7   

1 January 2009

    1,073.2        1,155.9        66.7        2,295.8   

 

Brands with an indefinite life are carried at historical cost in accordance with the Group’s accounting policy for intangible assets. The carrying values of the separately identifiable brands are not individually significant in comparison with the total carrying value of brands with an indefinite useful life.

 

12. Intangible assets (continued)

 

 

Acquired intangible assets at net book value at 31 December 2010 include brand names of £357.4 million (2009: £377.5 million), customer-related intangibles of £327.3 million (2009: £403.5 million), and other assets (including proprietary tools) of £97.0 million (2009: £138.5 million).

 

In accordance with the Group’s accounting policy, the carrying values of goodwill and intangible assets with indefinite useful lives are reviewed for impairment annually or more frequently if events or changes in circumstances indicate that the asset might be impaired.

 

The carrying values of brands with an indefinite useful life are assessed for impairment purposes by using the royalty and loyalty methods of valuation, both of which utilise the net present value of future cash flows associated with the brands.

 

The 2010 goodwill impairment review was initially undertaken as at 30 June 2010 and then updated as at 31 December 2010. The review assessed whether the carrying value of goodwill was supported by the net present value of future cash flows, using a pre-tax discount rate of 9.58% (2009: 10.27%) and management forecasts for a projection period of up to five years, followed by an assumed annual long-term growth rate of 3.0% (2009: 3.0%) and no assumed improvement in operating margin. Management have made the judgement that this long-term growth rate does not exceed the long-term average growth rate for the industry.

 

Goodwill impairment charges of £10.0 million and £44.3 million were recorded in the years ended 31 December 2010 and 2009, respectively. The impairment charges relate to certain under-performing businesses in the Group. In certain markets, the impact of current local economic conditions and trading circumstances on these businesses was sufficiently severe to indicate impairment to the carrying value of goodwill.

 

Under IFRS, an impairment charge is required for both goodwill and other indefinite-lived assets when the carrying amount exceeds the ‘recoverable amount’, defined as the higher of fair value less costs to sell and value in use. Our approach in determining the recoverable amount utilises a discounted cash flow methodology, which necessarily involves making numerous estimates and assumptions regarding revenue growth, operating margins, appropriate discount rates and working capital requirements. These estimates will likely differ from future actual results of operations and cash flows, and it is possible that these differences could be material. In addition, judgements are applied in determining the level of cash-generating unit we identify for impairment testing and the criteria we use to determine which assets should be aggregated. A difference in testing levels could affect whether an impairment is recorded and the extent of impairment loss. Changes in our business activities or structure may also result in changes to the level of testing in future periods. Further, future events could cause the Group to conclude that impairment indicators exist and that the asset values associated with a given operation have become impaired. Any resulting impairment loss could have a material impact on the Group’s financial condition and results of operations.

 

Historically our impairment losses have resulted from a specific event, condition or circumstance in one of our companies, such as the loss of a significant client. As a result, changes in the assumptions used in our impairment model have not had a significant effect on the impairment charges recognised and a reasonably possible change in assumptions would not lead to an impairment. The carrying value of goodwill and other intangible assets will continue to be reviewed at least annually for impairment and adjusted to the recoverable amount if required.

 

F-23


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 


13. Property, plant and equipment

 

The movements in 2010 and 2009 were as follows:

 


    Land
£m
    Freehold
buildings
£m
    Lease-
hold
buildings
£m
   

Fixtures,
fittings
and
equip-

ment
£m

   

Com-

puter
equip-

ment
£m

   

Total

£m

 

Cost:

                                               

1 January 2009

    12.4        83.1        556.3        385.1        579.1        1,616.0   

Additions

           1.3        151.5        38.3        56.5        247.6   

New acquisitions

                  0.3        0.8        1.5        2.6   

Disposals

           (0.9     (28.1     (31.2     (63.2     (123.4
Exchange adjustments            (10.3     (60.9     (30.4     (38.5     (140.1

31 December 2009

    12.4        73.2        619.1        362.6        535.4        1,602.7   

Additions

           0.7        71.5        35.6        82.7        190.5   

New acquisitions

                  2.1        2.6        4.4        9.1   

Disposals

           (0.5     (43.0     (37.0     (60.7     (141.2
Exchange adjustments                   23.0        12.2        19.3        54.5   

31 December 2010

    12.4        73.4        672.7        376.0        581.1        1,715.6   

Depreciation:

                                               

1 January 2009

           27.3        265.8        218.8        413.4        925.3   

Charge for the year

           2.4        60.1        46.0        86.8        195.3   

Disposals

           (0.3     (26.6     (28.8     (58.8     (114.5
Exchange adjustments            (3.6     (21.3     (21.7     (37.3     (83.9

31 December 2009

           25.8        278.0        214.3        404.1        922.2   

Charge for the year

           2.7        58.2        42.9        81.1        184.9   

Disposals

           (0.5     (37.6     (35.9     (58.7     (132.7
Exchange adjustments                   13.1        7.0        12.7        32.8   

31 December 2010

           28.0        311.7        228.3        439.2        1,007.2   

Net book value:

                                               

31 December 2010

    12.4        45.4        361.0        147.7        141.9        708.4   

31 December 2009

    12.4        47.4        341.1        148.3        131.3        680.5   

1 January 2009

    12.4        55.8        290.5        166.3        165.7        690.7   

 

At the end of the year, capital commitments contracted, but not provided for in respect of property, plant and equipment were £40.7 million (2009: £17.8 million).


14. Interests in associates, joint ventures and other investments

 

The movements in 2010 and 2009 were as follows:

 


   

Net

assets of
associates
and joint
ventures
£m

   

Goodwill

and other
intangibles
of associates
and joint
ventures

£m

    Total
associates
and joint
ventures
£m
   

Other
invest-

ments
£m

 

1 January 2009

    340.4        373.9        714.3        310.9   

Additions

    17.9               17.9        52.4   
Goodwill arising on acquisition of new associates            26.5        26.5          
Share of results of associate undertakings (note 4)     57.0               57.0          
Dividends and other movements     (56.1     29.8        (26.3     1.0   

Exchange adjustments

    (19.8     (9.2     (29.0     (27.2

Disposals

    (0.7     (0.2     (0.9     (17.9
Reclassification to subsidiaries     (1.6     (3.9     (5.5       
Revaluation of other investments                          (13.5

Goodwill impairment

           (22.7     (22.7       
Amortisation of other intangible assets            (2.0     (2.0       

Write-downs

                         (11.1

31 December 2009

    337.1        392.2        729.3        294.6   

Additions

    8.0               8.0        20.2   
Goodwill arising on acquisition of new associates            5.6        5.6          
Share of results of associate undertakings (note 4)     55.2               55.2          
Dividends and other movements     (52.7     (0.9     (53.6       

Exchange adjustments

    35.9        36.9        72.8        (24.0

Disposals

                         (22.0
Reclassification to subsidiaries     (8.5     (10.4     (18.9       
Revaluation of other investments                          (59.8

Goodwill impairment

           (1.7     (1.7       
Amortisation of other intangible assets            (2.4     (2.4       

Write-downs

    (2.2            (2.2     (35.3

31 December 2010

    372.8        419.3        792.1        173.7   

 

The investments included above as ‘other investments’ represent investments in equity securities that present the Group with opportunity for return through dividend income and trading gains. They have no fixed maturity or coupon rate. The fair values of the listed securities are based on quoted market prices. For unlisted securities, where market value is not available, the Group has estimated relevant fair values on the basis of publicly available information from outside sources or on the basis of discounted cash flow models where appropriate.

 

F-24


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

14. Interests in associates, joint ventures and other investments (continued)

 

 

The carrying values of the Group’s associates and joint ventures are reviewed for impairment in accordance with the Group’s accounting policies.

 

The Group’s principal associates and joint ventures at 31 December 2010 included:

 

     %
owned
     Country of
incorporation
 
Asatsu-DK      24.3         Japan   
CHI & Partners Limited      49.9         UK   
Chime Communications PLC      15.0         UK   
Dentsu, Young & Rubicam Inc.      49.0         Japan   
GIIR, Inc      22.7         Korea   
High Co S.A.      34.1         France   
Ibope Latinoamericana SA      44.2         Brazil   
Ooh! Media Group Limited      27.2         Australia   
Scangroup Limited      27.5         Kenya   
Singleton, Ogilvy & Mather (Holdings) Pty Limited      33.3         Australia   
STW Communications Group Limited      20.6         Australia   
The Grass Roots Group PLC      44.8         UK   
The Jupiter Drawing Room Pty Limited      49.0         South Africa   

 

The market value of the Group’s shares in its principal listed associate undertakings at 31 December 2010 was as follows: Asatsu-DK: £180.9 million, Chime Communications PLC: £22.6 million, High Co S.A.: £30.0 million, GIIR, Inc: £22.4 million, Scangroup Limited: £30.0 million, STW Communications Group Limited: £52.2 million and Ooh! Media Group Limited: £22.3 million (2009: Asatsu-DK: £125.6 million, Chime Communications PLC: £24.3 million, High Co S.A.: £23.8 million, GIIR, Inc.: £21.2 million, Scangroup Limited: £12.6 million, STW Communications Group Limited: £31.3 million and Ooh! Media Group Limited: £6.6 million).

 

The carrying value (including goodwill and other intangibles) of these equity interests in the Group’s consolidated balance sheet at 31 December 2010 was as follows: Asatsu-DK: £220.7 million, Chime Communications PLC: £23.0 million, High Co S.A.: £30.9 million, GIIR, Inc: £18.7 million, Scangroup Limited: £17.1 million, STW Communications Group Limited: £69.4 million and Ooh! Media Group Limited: £17.9 million (2009: Asatsu-DK: £189.9 million, Chime Communications PLC: £22.0 million, High Co S.A.: £29.9 million, GIIR, Inc: £14.3 million, Scangroup Limited: £12.8 million, STW Communications Group Limited: £57.6 million and Ooh! Media Group Limited: £14.4 million).

 

Where the market value of the Group’s listed associates is less than the carrying value, an impairment review is performed utilising the discounted cash flow methodology discussed in note 12.

 

The Group’s investments in its principal associate undertakings are represented by ordinary shares.

 

Summarised financial information

The following tables present a summary of the aggregate financial performance and net asset position of the Group’s associate undertakings and joint ventures. These have been estimated and converted, where appropriate, to an IFRS presentation based on information provided by the relevant companies at 31 December 2010.

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Income statement                          
Revenue      2,142.3         1,968.9        1,588.3   
Operating profit      229.9         219.2        221.3   
Profit before taxation      245.1         237.0        221.3   
Profit for the year      179.1         166.0        147.6   
            2010
£m
    2009
£m
 
Balance sheet                          
Assets               4,355.7        3,929.4   
Liabilities               (2,394.1     (2,236.3
Net assets               1,961.6        1,693.1   

 

14. Interests in associates, joint ventures and other investments (continued)

 

 

The application of equity accounting is ordinarily discontinued when the investment is reduced to zero and additional losses are not provided for unless the investor has guaranteed obligations of the investee or is otherwise committed to provide further financial support for the investee.

 

At the end of the year, capital commitments contracted, but not provided for in respect of interests in associates and other investments were £24.9 million (2009: £22.3 million).

 


15. Deferred tax

 

The Group’s deferred tax assets and liabilities are measured at the end of each period in accordance with IAS 12. The recognition of deferred tax assets is determined by reference to the Group’s estimate of recoverability, using models where appropriate to forecast future taxable profits.

 

Deferred tax assets are recognised in relation to an element of the Group’s defined benefit pension provisions and share based payment schemes. Assets have only been recognised for territories where the Group considers that it is probable there would be sufficient taxable profits for the future deductions to be utilised.

 

Based on available evidence, both positive and negative, we determine whether it is probable that all or a portion of the deferred tax assets will be realised. The main factors that we consider include:

 

– the future earnings potential determined through the use of internal forecasts;

 

– the cumulative losses in recent years;

 

– the various jurisdictions in which the potential deferred tax assets arise;

 

– the history of losses carried forward and other tax assets expiring;

 

– the timing of future reversal of taxable temporary differences;

 

– the expiry period associated with the deferred tax assets; and

 

– the nature of the income that can be used to realise the deferred tax asset.

 

If it is probable that some portion of these assets will not be realised, then no asset is recognised in relation to that portion.

 

If market conditions improve and future results of operations exceed our current expectations, our existing recognised deferred tax assets may be adjusted, resulting in future tax benefits. Alternatively, if market conditions deteriorate further or future results of operations are less than expected, future assessments may result in a determination that some or all of the deferred tax assets are not realisable. As a result, all or a portion of the deferred tax assets may need to be reversed.

 

Certain deferred tax assets and liabilities have been offset as they relate to the same tax group. The following is the analysis of the deferred tax balances for financial reporting purposes:

 

     Gross
£m
    Offset
£m
    As
reported
£m
 
2010                         
Deferred tax assets      137.6        (58.5     79.1   
Deferred tax liabilities      (809.2     58.5        (750.7
       (671.6            (671.6
2009                         
Deferred tax assets      75.6        (8.1     67.5   
Deferred tax liabilities      (817.7     8.1        (809.6
       (742.1            (742.1

 

F-25


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

15. Deferred tax (continued)

 

 

The following are the major gross deferred tax assets recognised by the Group and movements thereon in 2010 and 2009:

 

    Tax
losses
£m
    Retirement
benefit
obligations
£m
    Deferred
comp-
ensation
£m
    US
stock
plans
£m
    Other
short-term
temporary
differences
£m
    Total
£m
 
1 January 2009     9.1        16.0        12.2               31.4        68.7   
(Charge)/credit to income     (1.3            (5.3            17.9        11.3   
Charge to equity            (4.4                          (4.4
Exchange adjustments     0.4        0.8        0.4               (1.6       
31 December 2009     8.2        12.4        7.3               47.7        75.6   
(Charge)/credit to income     (1.9     0.5        (1.8     30.6        18.0        45.4   
Credit to equity            0.2               19.0        0.2        19.4   
Exchange adjustments                                 3.3        3.3   
Transfer to current tax                                 (6.1     (6.1
31 December 2010     6.3        13.1        5.5        49.6        63.1        137.6   

 

Other short-term temporary differences comprise a number of items, none of which is individually significant to the Group’s consolidated balance sheet. At 31 December 2010 the balance related to temporary differences in relation to accounting provisions, tax credits, fixed assets, and tax deductible goodwill.

 

The Group incurred losses in certain jurisdictions in the current year. Deferred tax assets of £10.5 million have been recognised in these jurisdictions.

 

In addition the Group has recognised the following gross deferred tax liabilities and movements thereon in 2010 and 2009:

 

    Brands
and other
intangibles
£m
    Associate
earnings
£m
    Goodwill
£m
    Other
short-term
temporary
differences
£m
    Total
£m
 
1 January 2009     811.2        21.1        81.9        6.0        920.2   
New acquisitions     2.8                             2.8   
Prior year acquisitions 1     1.6               (20.7     (1.4     (20.5
(Credit)/charge to income     (55.9     0.1        18.6        (3.9     (41.1
Charge to equity                          9.8        9.8   
Exchange adjustments     (47.8     (1.0     (5.0     0.3        (53.5
31 December 2009     711.9        20.2        74.8        10.8        817.7   
New acquisitions     9.4                             9.4   
(Credit)/charge to income     (52.5     0.3        14.9        (2.2     (39.5
Exchange adjustments     19.3        0.7        2.7               22.7   
Transfer to current tax                          (1.1     (1.1
31 December 2010     688.1        21.2        92.4        7.5        809.2   

Note

1    

Adjustments made in the year ended 31 December 2009 in relation to deferred tax liabilities that had been provisionally estimated in the year ended 31 December 2008 for acquisitions completed in that year.

 

At the balance sheet date, the Group has gross tax losses and other temporary differences of £5,212.9 million (2009: £4,888.3 million) available for offset against future profits. Deferred tax assets have been recognised in respect of the tax benefit of £377.9 million (2009: £220.2 million) of such tax losses and other temporary differences. No deferred tax asset has been recognised in respect of the remaining £4,834.9 million (2009: £4,668.1 million) of losses and other temporary differences as the Group considers that there will not be enough taxable profits in the entities concerned such that any additional asset could be considered recoverable. Included in the total unrecognised temporary differences are losses of £30.9 million that will expire by 2019, £98.8 million that will expire by 2021, £235.6 million that will expire by 2023 and an additional £78.5 million that will expire by 2029. £3,118.7 million of losses may be carried forward indefinitely.

 

15. Deferred tax (continued)

 

At the balance sheet date, the aggregate amount of the temporary differences in relation to the investment in subsidiaries for which deferred tax liabilities have not been recognised was £11,462.1 million (2009: £13,940.2 million). No liability has been recognised in respect of these differences because the Group is in a position to control the timing of the reversal of the temporary differences and the Group considers that it is probable that such differences will not reverse in the foreseeable future.

 


16. Inventory and work in progress

 

The following are included in the net book value of inventory and work in progress:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Work in progress      362.6         304.1   
Inventory      3.4         2.6   
       366.0         306.7   

 


17. Trade and other receivables

 

The following are included in trade and other receivables:

 

Amounts falling due within one year:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Trade receivables      6,280.6         5,301.1   
VAT and sales taxes recoverable      72.1         81.6   
Prepayments and accrued income      1,620.5         1,427.7   
Other debtors      870.2         738.5   
       8,843.4         7,548.9   

 

The ageing of our trade receivables and other financial assets is as follows:

 


2010                     Past due but not impaired  
   

Carrying
amount at 31
December

2010
£m

    Neither
past due
nor
impaired
£m
    0-30
days
£m
    31-90
days
£m
    91-180
days
£m
    181
days-
1 year
£m
    Greater
than 1
year
£m
 
Trade
receivables
    6,280.6        3,502.2        1,926.4        695.3        131.7        12.0        13.0   
Other
financial
assets
    932.0        673.0        125.4        66.9        14.5        8.3        43.9   
      7,212.6        4,175.2        2,051.8        762.2        146.2        20.3        56.9   
2009                    

Past due but not impaired

 
   

Carrying
amount at 31
December

2009
£m

    Neither
past due
nor
impaired
£m
    0-30
days
£m
    31-90
days
£m
    91-180
days
£m
    181
days-
1 year
£m
    Greater
than 1
year
£m
 
Trade
receivables
    5,301.1        3,279.1        1,475.5        413.8        114.1        8.4        10.2   
Other
financial
assets
    781.8        529.7        133.1        26.8        25.4        21.9        44.9   
      6,082.9        3,808.8        1,608.6        440.6        139.5        30.3        55.1   

 

F-26


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

17. Trade and other receivables (continued)

 

 

Other financial assets are included in other debtors.

 

Past due amounts are not impaired where collection is considered likely.

 

Amounts falling due after more than one year:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Prepayments and accrued income      5.6         5.8   
Other debtors      123.2         92.2   
Fair value of derivatives      194.7         188.1   
       323.5         286.1   

 

Movements on bad debt provisions were as follows:


     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Balance at beginning of year      109.9        124.4        69.9   
New acquisitions      2.0        0.7        19.7   
Charged to operating costs      27.8        31.7        30.8   
Exchange adjustments      2.2        (8.5     21.3   
Utilisations and other movements      (27.3     (38.4     (17.3

Balance at end of year

     114.6        109.9        124.4   

 

The allowance for bad and doubtful debts is equivalent to 1.8% (2009: 2.0%; 2008: 2.1%) of gross trade accounts receivable.

 

The Group considers that the carrying amount of trade and other receivables approximates their fair value.

 


18. Trade and other payables: amounts falling due within one year

 

The following are included in trade and other payables falling due within one year:

 

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Trade payables      7,701.1         6,432.7   
Other taxation and social security      385.4         377.3   
Payments due to vendors (earnout agreements)      207.4         121.6   
Liabilities in respect of put option agreements with
vendors
     136.9         108.3   
Other creditors and accruals      2,196.9         1,823.2   
Deferred income      1,075.9         910.9   
       11,703.6         9,774.0   

 

The Group considers that the carrying amount of trade and other payables approximates their fair value.

 


19. Trade and other payables: amounts falling due after more than one year

 

The following are included in trade and other payables falling due after more than one year:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Payments due to vendors (earnout agreements)      67.9         140.6   
Liabilities in respect of put option agreements with vendors      34.1         59.9   
Fair value of derivatives      129.4         83.6   
Other creditors and accruals      157.2         139.2   
       388.6         423.3   

 

The Group considers that the carrying amount of trade and other payables approximates their fair value.

 

19. Trade and other payables: amounts falling due after more than one year (continued)

 

 

The following tables set out payments due to vendors, comprising deferred consideration and the directors’ best estimates of future earnout-related obligations:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Within one year      207.4         121.6   
Between one and two years      39.6         93.6   
Between two and three years      12.1         39.5   
Between three and four years      4.3         5.1   
Between four and five years      4.1         2.4   
Over five years      7.8           
       275.3         262.2   

 

     2010
£m
 
1 January 2010      262.2   
Earnouts paid      (113.3
Revised estimates 1      82.0   
New acquisitions (note 28)      32.8   
Exchange adjustments      11.6   
31 December 2010      275.3   

Note

1    

Revised estimates relate to acquisitions that were completed prior to 1 January 2010 and were recorded in the consolidated balance sheet within goodwill.

 

The potential undiscounted amount of all future payments that could be required under the earnout agreements for acquisitions completed in 2010 and for all earnout agreements at 31 December 2010 ranges from £nil million to £110.9 million and £nil million to £916.2 million, respectively.

 


20. Bank overdrafts, bonds and bank loans

 

Amounts falling due within one year:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Bank overdrafts      255.4         720.7   

 

The Group considers that the carrying amount of overdrafts and short-term borrowings approximates their fair value.

 

Amounts falling due after more than 1 year:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Corporate bonds and bank loans      3,598.2         3,586.4   

 

The Group estimates that the fair value of convertible and corporate bonds is £4,034.1 million at 31 December 2010 (2009: £3,676.4 million). The Group considers that the carrying amount of bank loans approximates their fair value.

 

The corporate bonds, convertible bonds, bank loans and overdrafts included within liabilities fall due for repayment as follows:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
Within one year      255.4         720.7   
Between one and two years      94.2           
Between two and three years      539.4         75.7   
Between three and four years      1,249.1         554.5   
Between four and five years      448.2         1,219.3   
Over five years      1,267.3         1,736.9   
       3,853.6         4,307.1   

 

F-27


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

 


21. Provisions for liabilities and charges

 

The movements in 2010 and 2009 were as follows:


     Property
£m
    Other
£m
    Total
£m
 
1 January 2009      66.6        69.3        135.9   
Charged to the income statement      11.2        8.5        19.7   
New acquisitions      0.1               0.1   
Prior year acquisitions 1             10.5        10.5   
Utilised      (5.6     (15.3     (20.9
Released to the income statement      (1.6     (1.6     (3.2
Transfers      (1.9     21.4        19.5   
Exchange adjustments      (3.1     (5.6     (8.7
31 December 2009      65.7        87.2        152.9   
Charged to the income statement      9.1        16.5        25.6   
New acquisitions             1.2        1.2   
Utilised      (7.0     (10.9     (17.9
Released to the income statement      (6.6     (3.4     (10.0
Transfers      (3.7     10.2        6.5   
Exchange adjustments      0.9        2.4        3.3   
31 December 2010      58.4        103.2        161.6   

Note

1    

Adjustments made in the year ended 31 December 2009 in relation to provisions for liabilities and charges that had been provisionally estimated in the year ended 31 December 2008 for acquisitions completed in that year.

 

Provisions comprise liabilities where there is uncertainty about the timing of settlement, but where a reliable estimate can be made of the amount. These include provisions for vacant space, sub-let losses and other property-related liabilities. Also included are other provisions, such as certain long-term employee benefits and legal claims, where the likelihood of settlement is considered probable.

 

The Company and various of its subsidiaries are, from time to time, parties to legal proceedings and claims which arise in the ordinary course of business. The directors do not anticipate that the outcome of these proceedings and claims will have a material adverse effect on the Group’s financial position or on the results of its operations.

 


22. Share-based payments

 

Charges for share-based incentive plans were as follows:


     2010
£m
     2009
£m
     2008
£m
 
Share-based payments      70.4         54.9         62.3   

 

Share-based payments comprise charges for stock options and restricted stock awards to employees of the Group.

 

As of 31 December 2010, there was £108.7 million (2009: £79.3 million) of total unrecognised compensation cost related to the Group’s restricted stock plans. That cost is expected to be recognised over a period of one to two years.

 

Further information on stock options is provided in note 26.

 

Restricted stock plans

The Group operates a number of equity-settled share incentive schemes, in most cases satisfied by the delivery of stock from one of the Group’s ESOP Trusts. The most significant current schemes are as follows:

 

Renewed Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan (Renewed LEAP) and Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan III (LEAP III)

Under Renewed LEAP and LEAP III, the most senior executives of the Group, including certain executive directors, commit WPP shares (‘investment shares’) in order to have the opportunity to earn additional WPP shares (‘matching shares’). The number of matching shares which a participant can receive at the end of the fixed performance period of five years is dependent on the performance (based on the Total Share Owner Return (TSR)) of the Company over that period against a comparator group of other listed communications services companies. The maximum possible number of matching shares for each of the 2010, 2009, 2008, 2007 and 2006 grants is five shares for each investment share. The 2006 Renewed LEAP plan vested in March 2011 at a match of 4.14 shares for each investment share.

 

22. Share-based payments (continued)

 

 

Performance Share Awards (PSA)

Grants of stock under PSA are dependent upon annual performance targets, typically based on one or more of: operating profit, profit before taxation and operating margin. Grants are made in the year following the year of performance measurement, and vest two years after grant date provided the individual concerned is continually employed by the Group throughout this time.

 

Leaders, Partners and High Potential Group

Stock option grants under the executive stock option plan were not significant in 2010, 2009 or 2008 as the Group made grants of restricted stock (to be satisfied by stock from one of the Group’s ESOP Trusts) to participants instead. Performance conditions include continued employment over the three-year vesting period.

 

Valuation methodology

For all of these schemes, the valuation methodology is based upon fair value on grant date, which is determined by the market price on that date or the application of a Black-Scholes model, depending upon the characteristics of the scheme concerned. The assumptions underlying the Black-Scholes model are detailed in note 26, including details of assumed dividend yields. Market price on any given day is obtained from external, publicly available sources.

 

Market/Non-market conditions

Most share-based plans are subject to non-market performance conditions, such as margin or growth targets, as well as continued employment. The Renewed LEAP and LEAP III schemes are subject to a number of performance conditions, including TSR, a market-based condition.

 

For schemes without market-based performance conditions, the valuation methodology above is applied and, at each year end, the relevant accrual for each grant is revised, if appropriate, to take account of any changes in estimate of the likely number of shares expected to vest.

 

For schemes with market-based performance conditions, the probability of satisfying these conditions is assessed at grant date through a statistical model (such as the Monte Carlo Model) and applied to the fair value. This initial valuation remains fixed throughout the life of the relevant plan, irrespective of the actual outcome in terms of performance. Where a lapse occurs due to cessation of employment, the cumulative charge taken to date is reversed.

 

Movement on ordinary shares granted for significant restricted stock plans

 

   

Non-vested
1 January
2010
number

m

   

Granted
number

m

    Lapsed
number
m
    Vested
number
m
   

Non-vested
31 December
2010

number

m

 
Renewed LEAP/LEAP III 1     3.6        2.0               (1.7     3.9   
Performance Share Awards (PSA)     8.4        0.9        (0.5     (3.7     5.1   
Leaders, Partners and High Potential Group     12.6        3.8        (1.1     (2.5     12.8   
Weighted average fair value (pence per share):                                        
Renewed LEAP/LEAP III 1     563p        668p        540p        618p        593p   
Performance Share Awards (PSA)     486p        566p        451p        559p        451p   
Leaders, Partners and High Potential Group     501p        702p        487p        619p        538p   

Note

1    

The number of shares granted represents the ‘investment shares’ committed by participants at grant date for the 2010 LEAP III plan in addition to the matched shares awarded on vest date for the 2005 Renewed LEAP plan which vested in March 2010. The actual number of shares that vest for each Renewed LEAP/LEAP III plan is dependent on the extent to which the relevant performance criteria are satisfied.

 

The total fair value of shares vested for all the Group’s restricted stock plans during the year ended 31 December 2010 was £61.8 million (2009: £55.0 million, 2008: £58.6 million).

 

F-28


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 


23. Provision for post-employment benefits

 

Companies within the Group operate a large number of pension plans, the forms and benefits of which vary with conditions and practices in the countries concerned. The Group’s pension costs are analysed as follows:

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Defined contribution plans      101.5        95.5        79.7   
Defined benefit plans charge to operating profit      19.1        20.9        18.6   
Pension costs (note 5)      120.6        116.4        98.3   
Expected return on pension plan assets (note 6)      (30.6     (28.7     (31.3
Interest on pension plan liabilities (note 6)      45.9        46.1        38.9   
       135.9        133.8        105.9   

 

Defined benefit plans

The pension costs are assessed in accordance with the advice of local independent qualified actuaries. The latest full actuarial valuations for the various pension plans were carried out at various dates in the last three years. These valuations have generally been updated by the local independent qualified actuaries to 31 December 2010.

 

The Group has a policy of closing defined benefit plans to new members. This has been implemented across a significant number of the pension plans.

 

Contributions to funded plans are determined in line with local conditions and practices. Contributions in respect of unfunded plans are paid as they fall due. The total contributions (for funded plans) and benefit payments (for unfunded plans) paid for 2010 amounted to £53.3 million (2009: £47.7 million, 2008: £44.2 million). Employer contributions and benefit payments in 2011 are expected to be in the range of £40 million to £60 million depending on the performance of the assets.

 

(a) Assumptions

The main weighted average assumptions used for the actuarial valuations at 31 December are shown in the following table:

 

     2010
% pa
     2009
% pa
     2008
% pa
     2007
% pa
 
UK                                    
Discount rate      5.4         5.7         6.0         5.8   
Rate of increase in salaries      3.4         3.5         3.0         4.8   
Rate of increase in pensions in payment      4.0         4.2         3.9         4.1   
Inflation      3.2         3.5         2.8         3.3   
Expected rate of return on equities      7.5         7.5         7.3         7.3   
Expected rate of return on bonds 1      4.5         4.8         4.9         5.3   
Expected rate of return on insured annuities      5.4         5.7         6.0         5.8   
Expected rate of return on property      6.9         6.9         6.9         5.0   
Expected rate of return on cash and other      4.0         4.4         4.9         4.8   
Weighted average return on assets      5.4         5.6         5.7         5.8   
North America                                    
Discount rate      5.1         5.7         6.3         6.1   
Rate of increase in salaries      3.0         3.0         3.0         4.6   
Inflation      2.5         2.5         2.5         2.5   
Expected rate of return on equities      7.9         7.9         7.9         7.9   
Expected rate of return on bonds 1      4.3         4.7         5.1         5.1   
Expected rate of return on cash and other      6.4         6.6         3.4         3.0   
Weighted average return on assets      6.4         6.5         6.6         6.7   
Western Continental Europe                                    
Discount rate      5.3         5.5         5.7         5.5   
Rate of increase in salaries      2.7         2.7         2.8         2.9   
Rate of increase in pensions in payment      2.0         2.0         2.1         2.1   
Inflation      2.0         2.1         2.1         2.2   
Expected rate of return on equities      7.1         7.8         7.2         7.2   
Expected rate of return on bonds 1      4.4         4.1         4.5         4.5   
Expected rate of return on property      6.1         6.5         6.0         5.5   
Expected rate of return on cash and other      4.6         4.6         5.3         4.3   
Weighted average return on assets      5.0         5.1         5.3         5.3   
     2010
% pa
     2009
% pa
     2008
% pa
     2007
% pa
 
Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe                                    
Discount rate      4.0         4.2         3.4         3.9   
Rate of increase in salaries      4.4         4.2         3.9         4.0   
Inflation      5.1         4.9         4.5         4.6   
Expected rate of return on equities      10.0         10.1         10.0         10.0   
Expected rate of return on bonds 1      8.0         8.2         5.3         6.2   
Expected rate of return on cash and other      1.0         1.1         2.1         1.6   
Weighted average return on assets      3.4         3.6         3.1         3.7   

Note

1    

Expected rate of return on bonds assumptions reflect the yield expected on actual bonds held, whereas the discount rate assumptions are based on high-quality corporate bond yields.

 

There are a number of areas in pension accounting that involve judgments made by management. These include establishing the long-term expected rates of investment return on pension assets, mortality assumptions, discount rates, inflation, rate of increase in pensions in payment and salary increases.

 

For the Group’s pension plans, the plans’ assets are invested with the objective of being able to meet current and future benefit payment needs, while controlling balance sheet volatility and future contributions. Pension plan assets are invested with a number of investment managers, and assets are diversified among equities, bonds, insured annuities, property and cash or other liquid investments. The primary use of bonds as an investment class is to match the anticipated cash flows from the plans to pay pensions. Various insurance policies have also been bought historically to provide a more exact match for the cash flows, including a match for the actual mortality of specific plan members. These insurance policies effectively provide protection against both investment fluctuations and longevity risks. The strategic target allocation varies among the individual plans.

 

Management considers the types of investment classes in which the pension plan assets are invested and the expected compound return that can reasonably be expected for the portfolio to earn over time, which reflects forward-looking economic assumptions. Management reviews the expected long-term rates of return on an annual basis and revises them as appropriate.

 

Also, management periodically commission detailed asset and liability studies performed by third-party professional investment advisors and actuaries, which generate probability-adjusted expected future returns on those assets. These studies also project the estimated future pension payments and evaluate the efficiency of the allocation of the pension plan assets into various investment categories. The studies performed at the time these assumptions were set support the reasonableness of the return assumptions based on the target allocation of investment classes and the then current market conditions.

 

At 31 December 2010, the life expectancies underlying the value of the accrued liabilities for the main defined benefit pension plans operated by the Group were as follows:

 

Years life expectancy
after age 65
   All
plans
     North
America
     UK     

Western
Conti-

nental
Europe

     Asia
Pacific 1
 
– current pensioners – male      20.7         19.7         22.4         20.0         19.3   
– current pensioners – female      22.7         21.6         23.8         23.3         24.7   
– future pensioners (current age 45) – male      22.3         21.2         23.6         22.5         19.3   
– future pensioners (current age 45) – female      23.9         22.5         25.0         25.2         24.9   

 

Note

1    

Includes Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe.

 

F-29

23. Provision for post-employment benefits (continued)


Table of Contents

 

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

23. Provision for post-employment benefits (continued)

 

 

The life expectancies after age 65 at 31 December 2009 were 20.5 years and 22.5 years for male and female current pensioners respectively, and 21.9 years and 23.7 years for male and female future pensioners (current age 45), respectively.

 

In the determination of mortality assumptions, management uses the most up-to-date mortality tables available in each country.

 

For a 0.25% increase or decrease in the discount rate at 31 December 2010, the effect on the year-end 2010 pension deficit would be a decrease or increase, respectively, of approximately £26 million.

 

(b) Assets and liabilities

At 31 December, the fair value of the assets in the pension plans, and the assessed present value of the liabilities in the pension plans are shown in the following table:

 

    2010
£m
    %     2009
£m
    %     2008
£m
    %  
Equities     188.2        29.8        168.5        28.6        162.6        29.6   
Bonds     245.7        38.9        256.8        43.7        245.1        44.5   
Insured annuities     66.3        10.5        68.7        11.7        64.9        11.8   
Property     9.6        1.5        9.8        1.7        12.6        2.3   
Cash and other     121.5        19.3        84.3        14.3        65.2        11.8   
Total fair value of assets     631.3        100.0        588.1        100.0        550.4        100.0   
Present value of liabilities     (871.2             (836.1             (819.1        
Deficit in the plans     (239.9             (248.0             (268.7        
Irrecoverable surplus     (0.9             (3.1             (2.4        
Unrecognised past service cost     (0.7             (0.7             (0.9        
Net liability 1     (241.5             (251.8             (272.0        
Plans in surplus     2.8                0.7                0.4           
Plans in deficit     (244.3             (252.5             (272.4        

 

Note

1    

The related deferred tax asset is discussed in note 15.

 

The total fair value of assets, present value of pension plan liabilities and deficit in the plans were £504.0 million, £637.6 million and £133.6 million in 2007 and £470.4 million, £657.0 million and £186.6 million in 2006, respectively.

 

Deficit in plans by region    2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
UK      (3.5     (22.0     (24.8
North America      (144.4     (140.9     (153.4
Western Continental Europe      (75.9     (73.9     (80.0
Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe      (16.1     (11.2     (10.5
Deficit in the plans      (239.9     (248.0     (268.7

 

23. Provision for post-employment benefits (continued)

 

 

Some of the Group’s defined benefit plans are unfunded (or largely unfunded) by common custom and practice in certain jurisdictions. In the case of these unfunded plans, the benefit payments are made as and when they fall due. Pre-funding of these plans would not be typical business practice.

 

The following table shows the split of the deficit at 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008 between funded and unfunded pension plans.

 

    2010
Deficit
£m
    2010
Present
value of
liabilities
£m
    2009
Deficit
£m
    2009
Present
value of
liabilities
£m
    2008
Deficit
£m
    2008
Present
value of
liabilities
£m
 
Funded plans by region                                                
UK     (3.5     (305.5     (22.0     (293.5     (24.8     (269.5
North America     (66.8     (306.5     (65.2     (274.5     (71.0     (266.8
Western Continental Europe     (29.7     (103.8     (25.0     (119.9     (30.1     (126.5
Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe     (5.6     (21.1     (3.7     (16.1     (3.3     (16.8
Deficit/liabilities in the funded plans     (105.6     (736.9     (115.9     (704.0     (129.2     (679.6
Unfunded plans by region                                                
UK                                          
North America     (77.6     (77.6     (75.7     (75.7     (82.4     (82.4
Western Continental Europe     (46.2     (46.2     (48.9     (48.9     (49.9     (49.9
Asia Pacific, Latin America, Africa & Middle East and Central & Eastern Europe     (10.5     (10.5     (7.5     (7.5     (7.2     (7.2
Deficit/liabilities in the unfunded plans     (134.3     (134.3     (132.1     (132.1     (139.5     (139.5
Deficit/liabilities in the plans     (239.9     (871.2     (248.0     (836.1     (268.7     (819.1

 

In accordance with IAS 19, plans that are wholly or partially funded are considered funded plans.

 

F-30


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

23. Provision for post-employment benefits (continued)

 

 

(c) Pension expense

The following table shows the breakdown of the pension expense between amounts charged to operating profit, amounts charged to finance income and finance costs and amounts recognised in the statement of comprehensive income (OCI):

 

     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Current service cost      23.3        22.0        16.7   
Past service (income)/cost      (0.6            2.5   
Gain on settlements and curtailments      (3.6     (1.1     (0.6
Charge to operating profit      19.1        20.9        18.6   
Expected return on pension plan assets      (30.6     (28.7     (31.3
Interest on pension plan liabilities      45.9        46.1        38.9   
Charge to profit before taxation for defined benefit plans      34.4        38.3        26.2   
Gain/(loss) on pension plan assets relative to expected return      31.9        44.0        (93.7
Experience gain/(loss) arising on the plan liabilities      3.4        (7.6     4.4   
Changes in assumptions underlying the present value of the plan liabilities      (37.9     (42.7     8.0   
Change in irrecoverable surplus      2.2        (0.9     (0.9
Actuarial loss recognised in OCI      (0.4     (7.2     (82.2

 

As at 31 December 2010 the cumulative amount of net actuarial losses recognised in equity since 1 January 2001 was £180.7 million (31 December 2009: £180.3 million, 31 December 2008: £173.1 million). Of this amount, a net loss of £79.6 million was recognised since the 1 January 2004 adoption of IAS 19.

 

(d) Movement in plan liabilities

The following table shows an analysis of the movement in the pension plan liabilities for each accounting period:


     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Plan liabilities at beginning of year      836.1        819.1        637.6   
Service cost      23.3        22.0        16.7   
Interest cost      45.9        46.1        38.9   
Actuarial loss/(gain)      34.5        50.3        (12.4
Benefits paid      (57.2     (52.9     (40.7
Loss/(gain) due to exchange rate movements      9.7        (50.5     133.8   
Net (disposals)/acquisitions             (0.9     44.3   
Settlements and curtailments      (26.4     (3.3     (6.1
Other 1      5.3        6.2        7.0   
Plan liabilities at end of year      871.2        836.1        819.1   

Note

1    

Other includes plan participants’ contributions, plan amendments and reclassifications. In the 2009 and 2008 financial statements these were presented as separate line items. The reclassifications represent certain of the Group’s defined benefit plans which are included in this note for the first time in the periods presented.

 

(e) Movement in plan assets

The following table shows an analysis of the movement in the pension plan assets for each accounting period:


     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
 
Fair value of plan assets at beginning of year      588.1        550.4        504.0   
Expected return on plan assets      30.6        28.7        31.3   
Actuarial gain/(loss) on plan assets      31.9        44.0        (93.7
Employer contributions      53.3        47.7        44.2   
Benefits paid      (57.2     (52.9     (40.7
Gain/(loss) due to exchange rate movements      5.9        (28.3     79.0   
Net (disposals)/acquisitions             (0.9     29.4   
Settlements      (22.8     (2.2     (5.5
Other 1      1.5        1.6        2.4   
Fair value of plan assets at end of year      631.3        588.1        550.4   
Actual return on plan assets      62.5        72.7        (62.4

 

23. Provision for post-employment benefits (continued)

 

 

Note

1    

Other includes plan participants’ contributions and reclassifications. In the 2009 and 2008 financial statements these were presented as separate line items.

 

(f) History of experience gains and losses


     2010
£m
    2009
£m
    2008
£m
       
Gain/(loss) on pension plan assets relative to expected return:                                 
Amount      31.9        44.0        (93.7        
Percentage of plan assets      5.1     7.5     (17.0 %)         
Experience gain/(loss) arising on the plan liabilities:                                 
Amount      3.4        (7.6     4.4           
Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities      0.4     (0.9 %)      0.5        
Total loss recognised in OCI:                                 
Amount      (0.4     (7.2     (82.2        
Percentage of the present value of the plan liabilities      (0.0 %)      (0.9 %)      (10.0 %)         

 

The experience (loss)/gain on pension plan assets and plan liabilities were (£6.0) million and £0.1 million in 2007 and £9.3 million and £3.5 million in 2006, respectively.

 

 


 

24. Risk management policies

 

Foreign currency risk

The Group’s results in pounds sterling are subject to fluctuation as a result of exchange rate movements. The Group does not hedge this translation exposure to its earnings but does hedge the currency element of its net assets using foreign currency borrowings, cross-currency swaps and forward foreign exchange contracts.

 

The Group effects these currency net asset hedges by borrowing in the same currencies as the operating (or ‘functional’) currencies of its main operating units. The majority of the Group’s debt is therefore denominated in US dollars, pounds sterling and euros. Borrowings in these currencies represented 96.0% of the Group’s gross indebtedness at 31 December 2010 (at $1,640 million, £1,350 million and 1,274 million) and 96.8% of the Group’s average gross debt during the course of 2010 (at $2,003 million, £1,653 million and 1,274 million).

 

The Group’s operations conduct the majority of their activities in their own local currency and consequently the Group has no significant transactional foreign exchange exposures. Any significant cross-border trading exposures are hedged by the use of forward foreign-exchange contracts. No speculative foreign exchange trading is undertaken.

 

Interest rate risk

The Group is exposed to interest rate risk on both interest-bearing assets and interest-bearing liabilities. The Group has a policy of actively managing its interest rate risk exposure while recognising that fixing rates on all its debt eliminates the possibility of benefiting from rate reductions and similarly, having all its debt at floating rates unduly exposes the Group to increases in rates.

 

Including the effect of interest rate and cross-currency swaps, 82.5% of the year-end US dollar debt is at fixed rates averaging 6.54% for an average period of 44 months; 73.3% of the sterling debt is at a fixed rate of 6.07% for an average period of 83 months; and 66.7% of the euro debt is at fixed rates averaging 6.50% for an average period of 63 months.

 

Other than fixed rate debt, the Group’s other fixed rates are achieved principally through interest rate swaps with the Group’s bankers. The Group also uses forward rate agreements and interest rate caps to manage exposure to interest rate changes. At 31 December 2010 no forward rate agreements or interest rate caps were in place. These interest rate derivatives are used only to hedge exposures to interest rate movements arising from the Group’s borrowings and surplus cash balances arising from its commercial activities and are not traded independently. Payments made under these instruments are accounted for on an accruals basis.

 

F-31


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

24. Risk management policies (continued)

 

 

Going concern and liquidity risk

In considering going concern and liquidity risk, the directors have reviewed the Group’s future cash requirements and earnings projections. The directors believe these forecasts have been prepared on a prudent basis and have also considered the impact of a range of potential changes to trading performance to factor in an uncertain economic environment. The directors have concluded that the Group should be able to operate within its current facilities and comply with its banking covenants for the foreseeable future and therefore believe it is appropriate to prepare the financial statements of the Group on a going concern basis.

 

At 31 December 2010, the Group has access to £4.7 billion of committed funding and bank facilities with maturity dates spread over the years 2011 to 2020 as illustrated below:


    £m    

2011

£m

   

2012

£m

    2013
£m
   

2014

£m

    2015
£m
    2016
£m
    2017
£m
    2018+
£m
 

£ bonds £200m

(6.375% ’20)

    200.0                                                                200.0   

£ bonds £400m

(6.0% ’17)

    400.0                                                        400.0           

Eurobonds

750m

(6.625%’16)

    642.9                                                642.9                   

Eurobonds

500m

(5.25%’15)

    428.6                                        428.6                           

£450m convertible bonds

(5.75%’14)

    450.0                                450.0                                   

US bonds

$650m

(5.875%’14)

    416.9                                416.9                                   

US bonds

$600m

(8.0%’14)

    384.8                                384.8                                   

Eurobonds

600m

(4.375%’13)

    514.4                        514.4                                           
Bank revolver $1,600m     1,026.2                1,026.2                                                   
TNS acquisition revolver £200m     200.0        200.0                                                           
TNS private placements $55m     35.3                19.2                16.1                                   
Total committed facilities available     4,699.1        200.0        1,045.4        514.4        1,267.8        428.6        642.9        400.0        200.0   
Drawn down facilities at 31 December 2010     3,554.0               100.3        514.4        1,267.8        428.6        642.9        400.0        200.0   
Undrawn committed facilities     1,145.1                                                                   
Drawn down facilities at 31 December 2010     3,554.0                                                                   
Net cash at 31 December 2010     (1,709.8                                                                
Other adjustments     44.2                                                                   
Net debt at 31 December 2010     1,888.4                                                                   

 

The Group’s borrowings are evenly distributed between fixed and floating rate debt. Given the strong cash generation of the business, its debt maturity profile and available facilities, the directors believe the Group has sufficient liquidity to match its requirements for the foreseeable future.

 

Treasury activities

Treasury activity is managed centrally from London, New York and Hong Kong, and is principally concerned with the monitoring of working capital, managing external and internal funding requirements and the monitoring and management of financial market risks, in particular interest rate and foreign exchange exposures.

 

24. Risk management policies (continued)

 

 

The treasury operation is not a profit centre and its activities are carried out in accordance with policies approved by the Board of Directors and subject to regular review and audit.

 

The Group manages liquidity risk by ensuring continuity and flexibility of funding even in difficult market conditions. Undrawn committed borrowing facilities are maintained in excess of peak net-borrowing levels and debt maturities are closely monitored. Targets for debt and cash position are set on an annual basis and, to assist in meeting this, working capital targets are set for all the Group’s major operations.

 

Capital risk management

The Group manages its capital to ensure that entities in the Group will be able to continue as a going concern while maximising the return to stakeholders through the optimisation of the debt and equity balance. The capital structure of the Group consists of debt, which includes the borrowings disclosed in note 10, cash and cash equivalents and equity attributable to equity holders of the parent, comprising issued capital, reserves and retained earnings as disclosed in the consolidated statement of changes in equity and in notes 26 and 27.

 

Credit risk

The Group’s principal financial assets are cash and short-term deposits, trade and other receivables and investments, the carrying values of which represent the Group’s maximum exposure to credit risk in relation to financial assets, as shown in note 25.

 

The Group’s credit risk is primarily attributable to its trade receivables. The majority of the Group’s trade receivables are due from large national or multinational companies where the risk of default is considered low. The amounts presented in the consolidated balance sheet are net of allowances for doubtful receivables, estimated by the Group’s management based on prior experience and their assessment of the current economic environment. A relatively small number of clients make up a significant percentage of the Group’s debtors, but no single client represents more than 5% of total trade receivables as at 31 December 2010.

 

The credit risk on liquid funds and derivative financial instruments is limited because the counterparties are banks with high credit-ratings assigned by international credit-rating agencies or banks that have been financed by their government.

 

A relatively small number of clients contribute a significant percentage of the Group’s consolidated revenues. The Group’s clients generally are able to reduce advertising and marketing spending or cancel projects at any time for any reason. There can be no assurance that any of the Group’s clients will continue to utilise the Group’s services to the same extent, or at all, in the future. A significant reduction in advertising and marketing spending by, or the loss of one or more of, the Group’s largest clients, if not replaced by new client accounts or an increase in business from existing clients, would adversely affect the Group’s prospects, business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Sensitivity analysis

The following sensitivity analysis addresses the effect of currency and interest rate risks on the Group’s financial instruments. The analysis assumes that all hedges are highly effective.

 

Currency risk

A 10% weakening of sterling against the Group’s major currencies would result in the following losses, which would be posted directly to equity. These losses would arise on the retranslation of foreign currency denominated borrowings and derivatives designated as effective net investment hedges of overseas net assets. These losses would be partially offset in equity by a corresponding gain arising on the retranslation of the related hedged foreign currency net assets. A 10% strengthening of sterling would have an equal and opposite effect. There are no other material foreign exchange exposures which would create gains or losses to the functional reporting currencies of individual entities in the Group.

     2010
£m
     2009
£m
 
US dollar      91.0         87.9   
Euro      73.7         76.3   

 

Interest rate risk

A one percentage point increase in market interest rates for all currencies in which the Group had cash and borrowings at 31 December 2010 would increase profit before tax by approximately £8.0 million (2009: decrease of £2.4 million). A one percentage decrease in market interest rates would have an equal and opposite effect. This has been calculated by applying the interest rate change to the Group’s variable rate cash and borrowings.

 

F-32


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

 


25. Financial instruments

 

Currency derivatives

The Group utilises currency derivatives to hedge significant future transactions and cash flows and the exchange risk arising on translation of the Group’s investments in foreign operations. The Group is a party to a variety of foreign currency derivatives in the management of its exchange rate exposures. The instruments purchased are primarily denominated in the currencies of the Group’s principal markets.

 

At 31 December 2010, the fair value of the Group’s currency derivatives is estimated to be a net liability of approximately £62.9 million (2009: £3.1 million). These amounts are based on market values of equivalent instruments at the balance sheet date, comprising £60.4 million (2009: £79.6 million) assets included in trade and other receivables and £123.3 million (2009: £82.7 million) liabilities included in trade and other payables. The amounts charged to and deferred in equity during the year for currency derivatives that are designated and effective hedges were £27.9 million (2009: £111.1 million) for net investment hedges and £34.8 million (2009: £60.5 million) for cash flow hedges.

 

Changes in the fair value relating to the ineffective portion of the currency derivatives amounted to a gain of £11.7 million (2009: £3.3 million, 2008: £2.7 million) which is included in the revaluation of financial instruments for the year. This gain resulted from a £59.3 million loss on hedging instruments and a £71.0 million gain on hedged items.

 

The Group currently designates its foreign currency-denominated debt and cross-currency swaps as hedging instruments against the currency risk associated with the translation of its foreign operations.

 

At the balance sheet date, the total nominal amount of outstanding forward foreign exchange contracts not designated as hedges was £130.1 million (2009: £309.4 million). The Group estimates the fair value of these contracts to be a net liability of £0.8 million (2009: asset of £4.6 million).

 

These arrangements are designed to address significant exchange exposure and are renewed on a revolving basis as required.

 

Interest rate swaps

The Group uses interest rate swaps as hedging instruments in fair value hedges to manage its exposure to interest rate movements on its borrowings. Contracts with nominal values of 600 million have fixed interest receipts at 4.38% up until December 2013 and have floating interest payments averaging EURIBOR plus 0.56%. Contracts with a nominal value of 500 million have fixed interest receipts of 5.25% up until January 2015 and have floating interest payments averaging EURIBOR plus 0.80%. Contracts with a nominal value of 100 million have fixed interest payments of 5.56% until June 2014 and have floating rate receipts averaging EURIBOR plus 0.96%.

 

Contracts with a nominal value of £200 million have fixed interest receipts of 6.00% up until April 2017 and have floating rate payments averaging LIBOR plus 0.64%.

 

A contract with a nominal value of $45 million has fixed interest receipts averaging 6.29% until on average July 2013 and has floating rate payments averaging LIBOR plus 0.59%.

 

A contract with a nominal value of $300 million has fixed rate payments averaging 2.58% until on average October 2020 and has floating rate receipts of LIBOR plus 0.29%.

 

The fair value of interest rate swaps entered into at 31 December 2010 is estimated to be a net asset of approximately £129.0 million (2009: £103.0 million). These amounts are based on market values of equivalent instruments at the balance sheet date, comprising £133.4 million (2009: £103.2 million) assets included in trade and other receivables and £4.4 million (2009: £0.2 million) liabilities included in trade and other payables. Included in these amounts are certain interest rate swaps that are not designated as hedges, comprising £26.1 million assets and £6.1 million liabilities.

 

Changes in the fair value relating to the ineffective portion of interest rate swaps amounted to a gain of £12.6 million (2009: gain of £11.7 million, 2008: charge of £13.0 million) which is included in the revaluation of financial instruments for the year. This gain resulted from a £14.4 million loss on hedging instruments and a £27.0 million gain on hedged items.

 

An analysis of the Group’s financial assets and liabilities by accounting classification is set out below:

 

   

Derivatives

in

designated

hedge

relationships

   

Held

for

trading

    Loans &
receivables
    Available
for sale
    Amortised
cost
    Carrying
value
 
    £m     £m     £m     £m     £m     £m  
2010                                                
Other investments                          173.7               173.7   
Cash and short-term deposits                   1,965.2                      1,965.2   
Bank overdrafts and loans                                 (255.4     (255.4
Bonds and bank loans                                 (3,598.2     (3,598.2
Trade and other receivables: amounts falling due within one year                   7,135.3                      7,135.3   
Trade and other receivables: amounts falling due after more than one year                   77.3                      77.3   
Trade and other payables: amounts falling due within one year                                 (7,769.9     (7,769.9
Trade and other payables: amounts falling due after more than one year                                 (11.4     (11.4
Derivative assets     168.6        26.1                             194.7   
Derivative liabilities     (123.3     (6.1                          (129.4
Liabilities in respect of put options            (171.0                          (171.0
      45.3        (151.0     9,177.8        173.7        (11,634.9     (2,389.1

 

F-33

25. Financial instruments (continued)


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

25. Financial instruments (continued)

 

 

   

Derivatives

in

designated

hedge

relationships

   

Held
for

trading

    Loans &
receivables
    Available
for sale
    Amortised
cost
    Carrying
value
 
    £m     £m     £m     £m     £m     £m  
2009                                                
Other investments                          294.6               294.6   
Cash and short-term deposits                   1,666.7                      1,666.7   
Bank overdrafts and loans                                 (720.7     (720.7
Bonds and bank loans                                 (3,586.4     (3,586.4
Trade and other receivables: amounts falling due within one year                   6,011.3                      6,011.3   
Trade and other receivables: amounts falling due after more than one year                   71.6                      71.6   
Trade and other payables: amounts falling due within one year                                 (6,482.6     (6,482.6
Trade and other payables: amounts falling due after more than one year                                 (29.2     (29.2
Derivative assets     182.8        5.3                             188.1   
Derivative liabilities     (82.9     (0.7                          (83.6
Liabilities in respect of put options            (168.2                          (168.2
      99.9        (163.6     7,749.6        294.6        (10,818.9     (2,838.4

 

25. Financial instruments (continued)

 

 

The following table provides an analysis of financial instruments that are measured subsequent to initial recognition at fair value, grouped into levels 1 to 3 based on the degree to which the fair value is observable:

 

Level 1 fair value measurements are those derived from quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities;

 

Level 2 fair value measurements are those derived from inputs other than quoted prices included within level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly (i.e. as prices) or indirectly (i.e. derived from prices);

 

Level 3 fair value measurements are those derived from valuation techniques that include inputs for the asset or liability that are not based on observable market data (unobservable inputs).

 

     Level 1
£m
     Level 2
£m
    Level 3
£m
    Carrying
value
£m
 
2010                                  
Derivatives in designated hedge relationships                                  
Derivative assets              168.6               168.6   
Derivative liabilities              (123.3            (123.3
Held for trading                                  
Derivative assets              26.1               26.1   
Derivative liabilities              (6.1            (6.1
Liabilities in respect of put options                     (171.0     (171.0
Available for sale                                  
Other investments                     173.7        173.7   
               65.3        2.7        68.0   

 

     Level 1
£m
     Level 2
£m
    Level 3
£m
    Carrying
value
£m
 
2009                                  
Derivatives in designated hedge relationships                                  
Derivative assets              182.8               182.8   
Derivative liabilities              (82.9            (82.9
Held for trading                                  
Derivative assets              5.3               5.3   
Derivative liabilities              (0.7            (0.7
Liabilities in respect of put options                     (168.2     (168.2
Available for sale                                  
Other investments      18.4                276.2        294.6   
       18.4         104.5        108.0        230.9   

 

 

F-34


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

25. Financial instruments (continued)

 

Reconciliation of level 3 fair value measurements:

 

     Liabilities in
respect of
put options
£m
    Other
investments
£m
    Carrying
value
£m
 
1 January 2009      (122.1     292.8        170.7   
Gains/(losses) recognised in the income statement      15.3        (11.1     4.2   
Losses recognised in other comprehensive income             (15.1     (15.1
Exchange differences      2.5        (26.0     (23.5
Additions      (78.3     53.7        (24.6
Disposals             (18.1     (18.1
Settlements      14.4               14.4   
31 December 2009      (168.2     276.2        108.0   
Losses recognised in the income statement      (3.6     (35.3     (38.9
Losses recognised in other comprehensive income             (61.3     (61.3
Exchange differences      (3.1     (23.4     (26.5
Additions      (5.9     20.2        14.3   
Disposals             (2.7     (2.7
Settlements      9.8               9.8   
31 December 2010      (171.0     173.7        2.7   

 

The fair value of financial assets and liabilities are based on quoted market prices where available. Where the market value is not available, the Group has estimated relevant fair values on the basis of publicly available information from outside sources or on the basis of discounted cash flow models where appropriate.

 


26. Authorised and issued share capital

 

    

Equity

ordinary

shares

     Nominal
value
£m
 
Authorised                  
1 January 2009      1,750,000,000         175.0   
31 December 2009      1,750,000,000         175.0   
31 December 2010      1,750,000,000         175.0   
                   
Issued and fully paid                  
1 January 2009      1,255,343,263         125.5   
Exercise of share options      1,148,051         0.1   
31 December 2009      1,256,491,314         125.6   
Exercise of share options      7,899,907         0.8   
31 December 2010      1,264,391,221         126.4   

 

Company’s own shares

The Company’s holdings of own shares are stated at cost and represent shares held in treasury and purchases by the Employee Share Ownership Plan (‘ESOP’) trusts of shares in WPP plc for the purpose of funding certain of the Group’s share-based incentive plans.

 

The trustees of the ESOP purchase the Company’s ordinary shares in the open market using funds provided by the Company. The Company also has an obligation to make regular contributions to the ESOP to enable it to meet its administrative costs. The number and market value of the ordinary shares of the Company held by the ESOP at 31 December 2010 was 22,083,378 (2009: 24,941,529), and £174.3 million (2009: £152.0 million) respectively. The number and market value of ordinary shares held in treasury at 31 December 2010 was 2,172,126 (2009: 2,435,288) and £17.1 million (2009: £14.8 million) respectively.

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

 

Share options

WPP Executive Stock Option Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 6,206,412 and unexercised options over ADRs of 1,700,034 have been granted under the WPP Executive Stock Option Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary

shares under option

   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise dates  
12,195      3.414         2012 - 2018   
21,197      3.763         2006 - 2013   
42,154      4.210         2005 - 2012   
502,077      4.210         2005 - 2012   
22,994      4.210         2005 - 2013   
3,832      4.210         2005 - 2012   
19,161      4.210         2005 - 2012   
3,065      4.210         2005 - 2012   
3,832      4.210         2005 - 2012   
77,552      4.438         2005 - 2012   
6,759      4.438         2005 - 2012   
51,247      4.615         2007 - 2013   
22,533      4.865         2004 - 2011   
345,570      4.865         2004 - 2011   
2,000,000      5.490         2007 - 2014   
27,288      5.520         2008 - 2014   
94,777      5.535         2007 - 2014   
578,542      5.535         2007 - 2014   
447,676      5.535         2007 - 2014   
6,124      5.535         2008 - 2014   
6,124      5.535         2007 - 2015   
24,390      5.535         2007 - 2014   
2,469      5.535         2007 - 2014   
167,935      5.535         2007 - 2014   
143,400      5.595         2006 - 2013   
725,343      5.595         2006 - 2013   
17,194      5.595         2006 - 2014   
7,853      5.595         2007 - 2013   
2,680      5.595         2006 - 2013   
13,572      5.595         2006 - 2013   
224,473      5.595         2006 - 2013   
2,902      5.725         2007 - 2014   
2,419      5.725         2007 - 2014   
11,423      5.775         2009 - 2015   
14,826      5.818         2008 - 2015   
2,964      5.818         2008 - 2015   
6,705      5.895         2008 - 2015   
4,470      5.895         2008 - 2015   
2,235      5.895         2008 - 2015   
9,834      5.895         2008 - 2015   
4,268      5.903         2011 - 2018   
6,402      5.903         2011 - 2018   
4,268      5.903         2011 - 2018   
5,959      6.105         2008 - 2015   
4,914      6.105         2008 - 2015   
7,876      6.228         2011 - 2017   
2,140      6.718         2009 - 2016   
6,420      6.718         2009 - 2016   
3,913      6.718         2009 - 2016   

 

F-35


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

Number of ordinary

shares under option

   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise dates  
69,369      6.718         2009 - 2016   
45,153      7.180         2005 - 2012   
24,123      7.550         2005 - 2012   
20,196      7.550         2005 - 2012   
34,921      7.550         2005 - 2012   
201,805      7.550         2005 - 2012   
3,741      7.550         2006 - 2012   
11,109      7.723         2010 - 2017   
17,788      8.110         2004 - 2011   
30,886      8.110         2004 - 2011   
4,929      8.193         2004 - 2011   
14,446      8.193         2004 - 2011   

 

Number of ADRs

under option

   Exercise price
per ADR ($)
     Exercise dates  
3,844      26.010         2012 - 2019   
1,662      30.080         2006 - 2013   
2,692      30.080         2006 - 2013   
1,644      30.410         2011 - 2018   
282,563      33.200         2005 - 2012   
3,764      33.200         2005 - 2012   
164,040      35.380         2004 - 2011   
454,270      47.410         2006 - 2013   
14,338      47.410         2006 - 2013   
21,610      47.410         2006 - 2013   
1,548      48.450         2007 - 2014   
10,061      50.670         2008 - 2015   
197      50.670         2008 - 2015   
487,784      50.800         2007 - 2014   
196      50.800         2007 - 2014   
9,938      50.800         2007 - 2014   
2,952      50.800         2007 - 2014   
25,486      50.800         2007 - 2014   
18,252      51.220         2007 - 2014   
8,624      53.030         2005 - 2012   
10,878      54.050         2005 - 2012   
99,855      54.050         2005 - 2012   
4,581      54.570         2008 - 2015   
4,486      55.740         2008 - 2015   
898      55.740         2008 - 2015   
898      55.740         2008 - 2015   
2,691      57.020         2008 - 2015   
14,925      57.020         2008 - 2015   
13,178      58.238         2004 - 2011   
856      58.460         2009 - 2016   
14,113      58.460         2009 - 2016   
856      58.460         2009 - 2016   
8,324      58.886         2004 - 2011   
844      59.170         2011 - 2018   
1,267      59.170         2011 - 2018   
1,641      63.900         2009 - 2020   
4,278      75.940         2010 - 2017   

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

 

WPP Worldwide Share Ownership Program

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 9,339,277 and unexercised options over ADRs of 1,334,208 have been granted under the WPP Worldwide Share Ownership Program as follows:

 

Number of ordinary

shares under option

   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise dates  
110,300      3.903         2006 - 2013   
1,000      3.903         2006 - 2013   
3,000      3.903         2007 - 2013   
4,625      4.210         2005 - 2012   
625      4.210         2005 - 2013   
35,340      4.819         2011 - 2018   
250      5.210         2004 - 2011   
185,000      5.435         2007 - 2014   
1,529,987      5.483         2012 - 2019   
29,041      5.483         2012 - 2016   
12,250      5.483         2012 - 2020   
9,375      5.483         2013 - 2019   
274,363      5.483         2013 - 2019   
45,738      5.483         2012 - 2019   
143,375      5.608         2012 - 2019   
2,875      5.775         2008 - 2015   
29,400      5.913         2011 - 2018   
108,000      5.917         2011 - 2018   
1,000      5.990         2004 - 2011   
1,089,954      6.028         2011 - 2018   
428,500      6.195         2008 - 2015   
6,375      6.668         2009 - 2017   
81,125      6.740         2009 - 2016   
718,550      6.938         2009 - 2016   
23,596      7.005         2010 - 2017   
2,548,001      7.113         2013 - 2020   
58,250      7.113         2013 - 2020   
19,375      7.113         2013 - 2017   
33,750      7.113         2014 - 2020   
329,750      7.113         2014 - 2020   
292,525      7.180         2005 - 2012   
6,000      7.180         2006 - 2012   
76,457      7.478         2011 - 2017   
878,225      7.718         2010 - 2017   
223,300      7.960         2004 - 2011   

 

Number of ADRs

under option

   Exercise price
per ADR ($)
     Exercise dates  
27,640      30.800         2006 - 2013   
279,490      44.560         2012 - 2019   
38,075      49.880         2007 - 2014   
23,715      53.030         2005 - 2012   
22,890      56.480         2004 - 2011   
381,100      56.560         2013 - 2020   
193,853      59.500         2011 - 2018   
92,020      59.520         2008 - 2015   
123,575      60.690         2009 - 2016   
151,850      75.760         2010 - 2017   

 

 

F-36


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

Tempus Group plc 1998 Long Term Incentive Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 24,306 have been granted under the Tempus Group plc 1998 Long Term Incentive Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary

shares under option

   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise dates  
24,306      4.920         2001 - 2011   

 

The Grey Global Group, Inc 1994 Stock Incentive Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 54,365 and unexercised options over ADRs of 27,639 have been granted under the Grey Global Group, Inc 1994 Stock Incentive Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary

shares under option

   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise dates  
54,365      3.499         2007 - 2011   

 

Number of ADRs

under option

   Exercise price
per ADR ($)
     Exercise dates  
7,089      28.2100         2006 - 2013   
1,827      28.3000         2007 - 2012   
3,632      30.8300         2007 - 2012   
6,371      31.4200         2005 - 2012   
8,720      31.7500         2008 - 2011   

 

24/7 Real Media, Inc 2002 Stock Incentive Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ADRs of 54,020 have been granted under the 24/7 Real Media, Inc 2002 Stock Incentive Plan as follows:

 

Number of ADRs

under option

   Exercise price
per ADR ($)
     Exercise dates  
8      1.3400         2007 - 2013   
552      15.8800         2007 - 2014   
427      17.1500         2007 - 2014   
69      20.0100         2007 - 2015   
187      20.0700         2007 - 2015   
69      20.3300         2007 - 2015   
12      20.8400         2007 - 2014   
66      22.4900         2007 - 2015   
79      23.1800         2007 - 2015   
78      23.4400         2007 - 2015   
19      23.8200         2007 - 2014   
263      24.2000         2007 - 2014   
50      25.1500         2007 - 2015   
315      25.9200         2007 - 2015   
79      26.1100         2007 - 2015   
787      27.1200         2007 - 2015   
14,852      27.5000         2007 - 2015   
148      28.7700         2007 - 2015   
170      34.6200         2007 - 2015   
82      35.0600         2007 - 2015   
89      38.8700         2007 - 2015   
26,410      40.6500         2007 - 2016   
110      41.4700         2007 - 2015   
110      45.2900         2007 - 2016   
118      46.0500         2007 - 2016   
69      46.6200         2007 - 2016   
345      48.3300         2007 - 2016   
157      49.5400         2007 - 2016   
115      49.6000         2007 - 2016   
314      49.6700         2007 - 2016   
89      50.4900         2007 - 2016   

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

Number of ADRs

under option

   Exercise price
per ADR ($)
     Exercise dates  
157      50.6800         2007 - 2016   
236      50.7500         2008 - 2017   
472      51.3800         2008 - 2017   
156      52.5900         2008 - 2017   
92      53.1000         2006 - 2017   
157      53.4800         2008 - 2017   
78      53.6700         2008 - 2017   
314      54.1100         2007 - 2016   
944      54.2400         2007 - 2016   
472      54.5600         2007 - 2016   
314      55.2600         2007 - 2016   
74      55.6400         2007 - 2016   
59      55.7600         2007 - 2016   
105      55.8900         2007 - 2016   
157      56.2700         2007 - 2016   
574      56.7200         2007 - 2016   
78      57.4800         2008 - 2017   
235      58.9400         2007 - 2017   
393      60.0200         2007 - 2016   
78      61.2300         2008 - 2017   
108      61.9200         2007 - 2016   
314      62.0500         2007 - 2016   
759      62.9400         2008 - 2017   
157      63.3200         2008 - 2017   
708      63.8900         2008 - 2017   
112      64.2700         2007 - 2016   
54      64.6500         2007 - 2016   
78      64.9700         2007 - 2016   
78      65.5400         2007 - 2016   
112      67.5800         2007 - 2016   
157      70.5000         2008 - 2017   

 

Taylor Nelson Sofres plc

2005 Long Term Incentive Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 62,828 have been granted under the Taylor Nelson Sofres plc 2005 Long Term Incentive Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary
shares under option
   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise
dates
 
29,849              2012   
32,979              2013   

 

2008 New Share Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 28,649 have been granted under the Taylor Nelson Sofres plc 2008 New Share Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary
shares under option
   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise
dates
 
28,649              2012   

 

F-37


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

 

2005 Key Employee Equity Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 4,519 have been granted under the Taylor Nelson Sofres plc 2005 Key Employee Equity Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary
shares under option
   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise
dates
 
245              2011   
4,274              2012   

 

1999 Worldwide Employee Sharesave Plan

As at 31 December 2010, unexercised options over ordinary shares of 1,315,225 have been granted under the Taylor Nelson Sofres plc 1999 Worldwide Employee Sharesave Plan as follows:

 

Number of ordinary
shares under option
   Exercise price
per share (£)
     Exercise
dates
 
1,115      1.2700         2011   
797,386      1.7300         2013 - 2015   
258,353      1.9500         2011 - 2012   
22,940      2.2900         2009 - 2011   
5,226      2.5600         2009 - 2012   
142,653      2.6500         2012 - 2014   
2,236      2.9900         2010 - 2011   
85,316      3.0000         2011 - 2013   

 

The aggregate status of the WPP Share Option Plans during 2010 was as follows:

 

Movements on options granted (represented in ordinary shares)

 

          Outstanding     Exercisable  
    1
January
2010
number
    Granted
number
    Exercised
number
    Lapsed
number
    31
December
2010
number
    31
December
2010
number
 
WPP     23,551,894               (6,133,058     (2,712,254     14,706,582        14,633,578   
WWOP     13,593,366        5,022,250        (417,951     (2,187,348     16,010,317        5,442,153   
Y&R     862,676               (668,610     (194,066              
Tempus     56,468               (32,162            24,306        24,306   
Grey     392,950               (178,645     (21,745     192,560        192,560   
24/7     616,205               (293,095     (53,010     270,100        222,220   
TNS     1,657,024               (175,246     (70,557     1,411,221        31,517   
      40,730,583        5,022,250        (7,898,767     (5,238,980     32,615,086        20,546,334   

 

Weighted-average exercise price for options over:

 

          Outstanding     Exercisable  
    1
January
2010
    Granted     Exercised     Lapsed     31
December
2010
    31
December
2010
 
Ordinary shares (£)                                           
WPP     5.566               5.147        6.934        5.489        5.492   
WWOP     6.306        7.113        5.700        5.512        6.218        6.954   
Y&R     7.052                      7.052                 
Tempus     5.445                             4.920        4.920   
Grey     3.499                             3.499        3.499   
TNS     1.870               2.046        2.116        1.836        2.348   
ADRs ($)                                                
WPP     46.939               37.307        54.148        45.814        45.857   
WWOP     56.187        56.560        36.712        55.704        56.457        62.076   
Y&R     52.298                      57.376                 
Grey     30.949               30.733        36.110        30.417        30.417   
24/7     38.578               37.920        42.054        38.610        38.121   

 

 

26. Authorised and issued share capital (continued)

 

Options over ordinary shares

Outstanding

 

Range of

exercise
prices
£

   Weighted average
exercise price
£
   Weighted average
contractual life
Months
nil – 8.193    5.763    69

 

Options over ADRs

Outstanding

 

Range of

exercise
prices
$

   Weighted average
exercise price
$
   Weighted average
contractual life
Months
1.340 – 76.940    50.110    61

 

As at 31 December 2010 there was £6.8 million (2009: £5.8 million) of total unrecognised compensation cost related to share options. That cost is expected to be recognised over a weighted average period of 21 months (2009: 20 months).

 

Share options are satisfied out of newly issued shares.

 

The weighted average fair value of options granted in the year calculated using the Black-Scholes model, was as follows:

 

     2010      2009      2008  
Fair value of UK options (shares)      144.5p         115.5p         129.5p   
Fair value of US options (ADRs)    $ 10.97       $ 8.95       $ 8.36   
Weighted average assumptions:                           

UK Risk-free interest rate

     1.76%         2.27%         3.93%   

US Risk-free interest rate

     1.05%         1.85%         2.25%   

Expected life (months)

     48         48         48   

Expected volatility

     30%         30%         25%   

Dividend yield

     2.5%         2.5%         1.75%   

 

Options are issued at an exercise price equal to market value on the date of grant.

 

The weighted average share price of the Group for the year ended 31 December 2010 was £6.78 (2009: £4.72, 2008: £5.12) and the weighted average ADR price for the same period was $52.51 (2009: $37.23, 2008: $48.26).

 

Expected volatility is sourced from external market data and represents the historic volatility in the Group’s share price over a period equivalent to the expected option life.

 

Expected life is based on a review of historic exercise behaviour in the context of the contractual terms of the options, as described in more detail below.

 

Terms of share option plans

The Worldwide Share Ownership Program is open for participation to employees with at least two years’ employment in the Group. It is not available to those participating in other share-based incentive programs or to executive directors. The vesting period for each grant is three years and there are no performance conditions other than continued employment with the Group.

 

The Executive Stock Option Plan has historically been open for participation to WPP Group Leaders, Partners and High Potential Group. It is not currently offered to parent company executive directors. The vesting period is three years and performance conditions include achievement of various TSR (Total Share Owner Return) and EPS (Earnings per Share) objectives, as well as continued employment. In 2005, the Group moved away from the issuance of stock options for Leaders, Partners and High Potential Group and has since largely made grants of restricted stock instead (note 22).

 

The Group grants stock options with a life of ten years, including the vesting period. The terms of stock options with performance conditions are such that if, after nine years and eight months, the performance conditions have not been met, then the stock option will vest automatically.

 

 

F-38


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 


 

27. Other reserves

 

Other reserves comprise the following:

 

     Equity
reserve
£m
   

Revaluation
reserve

£m

    Translation
reserve
£m
    Total
other
reserves
£m
 
1 January 2009      (82.9     87.3        1,246.1        1,250.5   
Exchange adjustments on foreign currency net investments                    (142.2     (142.2
Loss on revaluation of available for sale investments             (13.5            (13.5
Recognition and remeasurement of financial instruments      (36.4                   (36.4
Equity component of convertible bonds (net of deferred tax)      34.7                      34.7   
31 December 2009      (84.6     73.8        1,103.9        1,093.1   
Exchange adjustments on foreign currency net investments                    146.6        146.6   
Loss on revaluation of available for sale investments             (59.8            (59.8
Recognition and remeasurement of financial instruments      2.9                      2.9   
31 December 2010      (81.7     14.0        1,250.5        1,182.8   

 


 

28. Acquisitions

 

The Group accounts for acquisitions in accordance with IFRS 3 (revised) Business Combinations. IFRS 3 (revised) requires the acquiree’s identifiable assets, liabilities and contingent liabilities (other than non-current assets or disposal groups held for sale) to be recognised at fair value at acquisition date. In assessing fair value at acquisition date, management make their best estimate of the likely outcome where the fair value of an asset or liability may be contingent on a future event. In certain instances, the underlying transaction giving rise to an estimate may not be resolved until some years after the acquisition date. IFRS 3 (revised) requires the release to profit of any acquisition reserves which subsequently become excess in the same way as any excess costs over those provided at acquisition date are charged to profit. At each period end management assess provisions and other balances established in respect of acquisitions for their continued probability of occurrence and amend the relevant value accordingly through the consolidated income statement or as an adjustment to goodwill as appropriate under IFRS 3 (revised).

 

Acquisitions in 2010

 

The Group acquired a number of subsidiaries in the year. The following table sets out the book values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired and their fair value to the Group. The fair value adjustments for certain acquisitions have been determined provisionally at the balance sheet date.

 

     Book
value at
acquisition
£m
    Fair value
adjustments
£m
    Fair
value
to
Group
£m
 
Intangible assets      0.7        25.5        26.2   
Property, plant and equipment      9.1               9.1   
Cash      57.0               57.0   
Trade receivables due within one year      161.7               161.7   
Other current assets      56.2               56.2   
Total assets      284.7        25.5        310.2   
Current liabilities      (259.1            (259.1
Trade and other payables due after one year      (1.1     (3.4     (4.5
Deferred tax liabilities      (0.1     (9.3     (9.4
Provisions      (0.5     (0.7     (1.2
Total liabilities      (260.8     (13.4     (274.2
Net assets      23.9        12.1        36.0   
Non-controlling interests                      (0.5
Fair value of equity stake in associate undertakings before acquisition of controlling interest                      (32.6
Goodwill                      161.1   
Consideration                      164.0   
Consideration satisfied by:                         
Cash                      131.2   
Payments due to vendors (note 19)                      32.8   

 

Goodwill arising from acquisitions represents the value of synergies with our existing portfolio of businesses and skilled staff to deliver services to our clients. Goodwill expected to be deductible for tax purposes is £14.3 million.

 

Non-controlling interests in acquired companies are measured at the non-controlling interest’s proportionate share of the acquirees’ identifiable net assets.

 

The contribution to revenue and operating profit of acquisitions completed in the year was not material. There were no material acquisitions completed between 31 December 2010 and the date the financial statements have been authorised for issue.

 

F-39

28. Acquisitions (continued)


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

28. Acquisitions (continued)

 

 

Acquisitions in 2009

The Group acquired a number of subsidiaries in the year. The following table sets out the book values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired and their fair value to the Group. The fair value adjustments for certain acquisitions have been determined provisionally at the balance sheet date.

     Book
value at
acquisition
£m
    Fair value
adjustments
£m
    Fair
value to
Group
£m
 
Intangible assets             6.6        6.6   
Property, plant and equipment      2.6               2.6   
Current assets      17.0               17.0   
Total assets      19.6        6.6        26.2   
Current liabilities      (11.8     (0.1     (11.9
Trade and other payables due after one year      (1.2            (1.2
Deferred tax liabilities             (2.8     (2.8
Provisions      (0.1            (0.1
Total liabilities      (13.1     (2.9     (16.0
Net assets      6.5        3.7        10.2   
Non-controlling interest                      (2.4
Goodwill                      13.1   
Consideration                      20.9   
Consideration satisfied by:                         
Cash                      15.4   
Payments due to vendors                      4.6   
Capitalised acquisition costs                      0.9   

 

Goodwill arising from acquisitions represents the value of synergies with our existing portfolio of businesses and skilled staff to deliver services to our clients.

 

The contribution to revenue and operating profit of acquisitions completed in the year was not material. There were no material acquisitions completed between 31 December 2009 and the date the financial statements have been authorised for issue.

 

28. Acquisitions (continued)

 

 

Acquisitions in 2008

 

Acquisition of Taylor Nelson Sofres plc

On 29 October 2008 the Group completed its acquisition of the issued share capital of Taylor Nelson Sofres plc (TNS). The following table sets out the book values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired and their fair value to the Group. The fair value adjustments have been determined provisionally at the corresponding balance sheet date.

    

Book
Value at
Acquisition

£m

   

Accounting
policy
alignments 1

£m

   

Fair Value
adjustments 2

£m

   

Fair
Value to
Group

£m

 
Intangible assets      17.4               708.3        725.7   
Property, plant and equipment      88.8        (7.9     10.3        91.2   
Interests in associates and other investments      2.8        15.1        (1.4     16.5   
Deferred tax assets      44.1               (29.4     14.7   
Current assets      601.8        (119.0     (9.3     473.5   
Total assets      754.9        (111.8     678.5        1,321.6   
Current liabilities      (548.2     115.9        (51.7     (484.0
Bonds and bank loans 3      (577.8                   (577.8
Trade and other payables due after one year      (18.7     0.1        (38.0     (56.6
Deferred tax liabilities      (34.3            (210.2     (244.5
Provisions      (41.2     0.4        (16.0     (56.8
Total liabilities      (1,220.2     116.4        (315.9     (1,419.7
Net (liabilities)/assets      (465.3     4.6        362.6        (98.1
Non-controlling interest                              (9.6
Goodwill                              1,132.7   
Consideration                              1,025.0   
Consideration satisfied by:                                 
Cash                              737.0   
Shares 4                              267.7   
Shares to be issued                              2.8   
Capitalised acquisition costs                              17.5   

 

Notes

1    

Accounting policy alignments comprise adjustments to bring the assets and liabilities of TNS into compliance with WPP plc’s accounting policies. These were principally in relation to revenue recognition and the application of the equity method of accounting to joint ventures which had been previously accounted for under the proportional method.

2    

Fair value adjustments comprise adjustments to bring the book value of the assets and liabilities of TNS to fair value, principally through the recognition of intangible assets (comprising customer relationships, proprietary tools and brands), their related deferred tax liabilities and other provisions including taxes.

3    

At acquisition date TNS had £577.8 million of debt, of which £395.7 million was paid off by WPP in November 2008 out of its own debt facilities. The total of consideration and debt acquired for TNS is therefore £1,602.8 million.

4    

Share consideration comprises 80.5 million ordinary shares.

 

F-40


Table of Contents

Notes to the consolidated financial statements (continued)

 

28. Acquisitions (continued)

 

 

Net cash (outflows)/inflows in respect of TNS comprised:

     £m  
Cash consideration      (737.0
Cash and cash equivalents (net)      18.2   
Acquisition costs      (17.5
       (736.3

 

The post-acquisition contribution of TNS was £269.6 million to revenue and £12.4 million to operating profit. Operating profit is stated after charging £18.5 million amortisation of acquired intangible assets.

 

Other acquisitions

The Group acquired a number of other subsidiaries during 2008. The following table sets out the book values of the identifiable assets and liabilities acquired and their fair value to the Group. The fair value adjustments of certain acquisitions have been determined provisionally at the corresponding balance sheet date.

     Book
value at
acquisition
£m
    Fair value
adjustments
£m
    Fair value
to Group
£m
 
Intangible assets      1.7        18.7        20.4   
Property, plant and equipment      5.5        (0.1     5.4   
Current assets      147.1               147.1   
Total assets      154.3        18.6        172.9   
Current liabilities      (106.3     (0.3     (106.6
Trade and other payables due after one year      (4.2     (19.7     (23.9
Deferred tax liabilities      (0.2     (4.3     (4.5
Provisions      (1.2            (1.2
Total liabilities      (111.9     (24.3     (136.2
Net assets/(liabilities)      42.4        (5.7     36.7   
Non-controlling interest                      (15.8
Goodwill                      132.4   
Consideration                      153.3   
Consideration satisfied by:                         
Cash                      108.2   
Payments due to vendors                      37.4   
Capitalised acquisition costs                      7.7   

 

In aggregate, other acquisitions completed in 2008 contributed £106.7 million to revenues and £17.9 million to operating profit.

 

If all acquisitions, including TNS, had been completed on the first day of the financial year, Group revenues for the period would have been £8,534.4 million and operating profit would have been £824.8 million.

 


 

29. Principal subsidiary undertakings

 

The principal subsidiary undertakings of the Group are:

 

     Country of Incorporation
Grey Global Group, Inc    US
J. Walter Thompson Company, Inc    US
GroupM Worldwide, Inc    US
The Ogilvy Group, Inc    US
Young & Rubicam, Inc    US
Taylor Nelson Sofres Group Holdings Ltd    UK

 

All of these subsidiaries are operating companies and are 100% owned by the Group.

 


 

30. Related party transactions

 

From time to time the Group enters into transactions with its associate undertakings. These transactions were not material for any of the years presented.

 


31. Reconciliation of profit before interest and taxation to headline PBIT:

 

Reconciliation of profit before interest and taxation to headline PBIT:


    

2010

£m

   

2009

£m

   

2008

£m

 
Profit before interest and taxation      1,028.2        818.7        922.0   
Gains on disposal of investments      (4.1     (31.1     (3.4
Gains on re-measurement of equity on acquisition of controlling interest      (13.7              
Goodwill impairment      10.0        44.3        84.1   
Goodwill write-down relating to utilisation of pre-acquisition tax losses                    1.5   
Amortisation and impairment of acquired intangible assets      170.5        172.6        78.4   
Share of exceptional losses of associates      0.3        1.6        0.5   
Investment write-downs      37.5        11.1        30.5   
Cost of changes to corporate structure                    4.6   
Headline PBIT      1,228.7        1,017.2        1,118.2   
Headline PBIT margin (as a percent of revenue)      13.2%        11.7%        15.0%   

 

 


32. Condensed consolidating financial information

 

WPP Finance (UK) is the issuer of $650 million of 5.875% bonds due June 2014, with WPP plc as parent guarantor and WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited, and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings as subsidiary guarantors, previously registered under the Securities Act of 1933. A Form 15 giving notice of termination of registration was filed with the SEC in relation to this security on 2 August 2006. In addition, during June 2009 WPP Finance (UK) issued $600 million of 8% bonds due September 2014, with WPP plc as parent guarantor and WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited and WPP 2005 Limited as subsidiary guarantors.

 

The issuer and guarantors of the bonds are each subject to the reporting requirements under section 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Accordingly, condensed consolidating financial information containing financial information for WPP Finance (UK) and the guarantors is presented beginning on page F-42. Condensed consolidating financial information is prepared in accordance with the Group’s IFRS accounting policies applied in the year ended 31 December 2010, except to the extent that, in the parent company, subsidiary issuer and subsidiary guarantors columns investments in subsidiaries are accounted for under the equity method of accounting. Under the equity method, earnings of subsidiaries are reflected as “share of results of subsidiaries” in the income statement and as “investments in subsidiaries” in the balance sheet, as required by the SEC.

 

Although the $600 million bonds do not have the identical subsidiary guarantor structure as the $650 million bonds, the exclusion of the financial information of Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings has no financial impact on the columns presented in the condensed consolidating financial information for the years ended 31 December 2010, 2009 and 2008, as it is an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of WPP Air 1 Limited with no operations or cash flows of its own and its sole assets are its interests in certain operating subsidiaries.

 

In the event that WPP Finance (UK) fails to pay the holders of the securities, thereby requiring WPP plc, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited, Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings or WPP Air 1 Limited to make payment pursuant to the terms of its full and unconditional guarantee of those securities, there is no impediment to WPP plc, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited, Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings or WPP Air 1 Limited in obtaining reimbursement for any such payments from WPP Finance (UK).

 

F-41


Table of Contents

 

32.    Condensed consolidating financial information (continued)

 

Condensed consolidating income statement information

 

For the year ended 31 December 2010, £m

 

    

WPP

plc

   

Subsidiary

Guarantors 1

    WPP
Finance
(UK)
    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications /
Eliminations
    Consolidated
WPP plc
 

Revenue

     —          —          —          9,331.0        —          9,331.0   

Direct costs

     —          —          —          (770.5     —          (770.5

Gross profit

     —          —          —          8,560.5        —          8,560.5   

Operating costs

     (3.1     19.4        (0.1 )     (7,603.7     —          (7,587.5

Operating profit/(loss)

     (3.1     19.4        (0.1 )     956.8        —          973.0   

Share of results of subsidiaries

     626.8        734.7        —          —          (1,361.5     —     

Share of results of associates

     —          —          —          55.2        —          55.2   

Profit/(loss) before interest and taxation

     623.7        754.1        (0.1 )     1,012.0        (1,361.5     1,028.2   

Finance income

     —          94.6        18.3        (31.2     —          81.7   

Finance costs

     (37.7     (224.5     (57.6     43.0        —          (276.8

Revaluation of financial instruments

     —          0.7        —          17.5        —          18.2   

Profit/(loss) before taxation

     586.0        624.9        (39.4     1,041.3        (1,361.5     851.3   

Taxation

     —          1.9        —          (192.2     —          (190.3

Profit/(loss) for the year

     586.0        626.8        (39.4     849.1        (1,361.5     661.0   

Attributable to:

                                                

Equity holders of the parent

     586.0        626.8        (39.4     774.1        (1,361.5     586.0   

Non-controlling interests

     —          —          —          75.0        —          75.0   

Profit/(loss) for the year

     586.0        626.8        (39.4     849.1        (1,361.5     661.0   

 

For the year ended 31 December 2009, £m

  

    

WPP

plc

   

Subsidiary

Guarantors 1

    WPP
Finance
(UK)
    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications /
Eliminations
    Consolidated
WPP plc
 

Revenue

     —          —          —          8,684.3        —          8,684.3   

Direct costs

     —          —          —          (703.6     —          (703.6

Gross profit

     —          —          —          7,980.7        —          7,980.7   

Operating costs

     (5.0     (100.4     —          (7,113.6     —          (7,219.0

Operating profit/(loss)

     (5.0     (100.4     —          867.1        —          761.7   

Share of results of subsidiaries

     465.5        733.6        —          —          (1,199.1     —     

Share of results of associates

     —          —          —          57.0        —          57.0   

Profit before interest and taxation

     460.5        633.2        —          924.1        (1,199.1     818.7   

Finance income

     —          165.8        14.6        (30.0     —          150.4   

Finance costs

     (22.8     (340.3     (42.5     50.2        —          (355.4

Revaluation of financial instruments

     —          6.0        —          42.9        —          48.9   

Profit/(loss) before taxation

     437.7        464.7        (27.9     987.2        (1,199.1     662.6   

Taxation

     —          0.8        —          (156.5     —          (155.7

Profit/(loss) for the year

     437.7        465.5        (27.9     830.7        (1,199.1     506.9   

Attributable to:

                                                

Equity holders of the parent

     437.7        465.5        (27.9     761.5        (1,199.1     437.7   

Non-controlling interests

     —          —          —          69.2        —          69.2   

Profit/(loss) for the year

     437.7        465.5        (27.9     830.7        (1,199.1     506.9   

 

Note

1  

Includes: WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings.

 

 

F-42


Table of Contents

 

32.    Condensed consolidating financial information (continued)

 

Condensed consolidating income statement information (continued)

 

For the year ended 31 December 2008, £m

  

  

     WPP
plc
   

Subsidiary

Guarantors 1

    WPP
Finance
(UK)
    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications /
Eliminations
    Consolidated
WPP plc
 

Revenue

     —          —          —          7,476.9        —          7,476.9   

Direct costs

     —          —          —          (467.5     —          (467.5

Gross profit

     —          —          —          7,009.4        —          7,009.4   

Operating costs

     (0.3     (96.7     1.5        (6,037.9     —          (6,133.4

Operating profit/(loss)

     (0.3     (96.7     1.5        971.5        —          876.0   

Share of results of subsidiaries

     439.4        758.4        —          —          (1,197.8     —     

Share of results of associates

     —          —          —          46.0        —          46.0   

Profit before interest and taxation

     439.1        661.7        1.5        1,017.5        (1,197.8     922.0   

Finance income

     —          92.5        10.4        66.7        —          169.6   

Finance costs

     —          (304.1     (21.7     6.4        —          (319.4

Revaluation of financial instruments

     —          (11.3     —          (14.1     —          (25.4

Profit/(loss) before taxation

     439.1        438.8        (9.8     1,076.5        (1,197.8     746.8   

Taxation

     —          0.6        —          (233.5     —          (232.9

Profit/(loss) for the year

     439.1        439.4        (9.8     843.0        (1,197.8     513.9   

Attributable to:

                                                

Equity holders of the parent

     439.1        439.4        (9.8     768.2        (1,197.8     439.1   

Non-controlling interests

     —          —          —          74.8        —          74.8   

Profit/(loss) for the year

     439.1        439.4        (9.8     843.0        (1,197.8     513.9   

 

Note

1    

Includes: WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings.

 

F-43


Table of Contents

 

32.    Condensed consolidating financial information (continued)

 

Condensed consolidating cash flow statement information

 

For the year ended 31 December 2010, £m

 

     WPP
plc
    Subsidiary
Guarantors 1
   

WPP

Finance

(UK)

    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications /
Eliminations
   

Consolidated

WPP plc

 
Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities      28.1        (395.6     (30.6     1,759.3        —          1,361.2   
Investing activities                                                 
Acquisitions and disposals      —          20.2       —          (220.3     —          (200.1
Purchases of property, plant and equipment      —          (3.9     —          (186.6     —          (190.5
Purchases of other intangible assets (including capitalised computer software)      —          —          —          (27.0     —          (27.0
Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment      —          —          —          7.6        —          7.6   
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from investing activities      —          16.3        —          (426.3     —          (410.0
Financing activities                                                 
Share option proceeds      42.7       —          —          —          —          42.7   
Cash consideration for non-controlling interests      —          —          —          (15.1 )     —          (15.1
Share repurchases and buy-backs      —          —          —          (46.4     —          (46.4
Net increase in borrowings      —          —          —          19.8        —          19.8   
Financing and share issue costs      —          —          —          (3.5     —          (3.5
Capital contribution (paid)/received      —          —          —          —          —          —     
Equity dividends paid      (13.4     (187.0     —          —          —          (200.4
Dividends paid to non-controlling interests in subsidiary undertakings      —          —          —          (66.7     —          (66.7
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from financing activities      29.3        (187.0     —          (111.9     —          (269.6
Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents      57.4        (566.3     (30.6     1,221.1        —          681.6   
Translation differences      0.1        (27.9     25.9        84.1        —          82.2   
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year      (56.1     (2,245.0     726.7        2,520.4        —          946.0   
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year      1.4        (2,839.2     722.0        3,825.6        —          1,709.8   
For the year ended 31 December 2009, £m     
 
WPP
plc
  
  
   
 
Subsidiary
Guarantors 1
  
  
   

 

 

WPP

Finance

(UK)

  

  

  

   
 
Other
Subsidiaries
  
  
   
 
Reclassifications /
Eliminations
  
  
   

 

Consolidated

WPP plc

  

  

Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities      (468.3     (223.6     (28.5     1,539.3        (0.1     818.8   
Investing activities                                                 
Acquisitions and disposals      —          —          —          (118.4     —          (118.4
Purchases of property, plant and equipment      —          (2.1     —          (220.8     —          (222.9
Purchases of other intangible assets (including capitalised computer software)      —          —          —          (30.4     —          (30.4
Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment      —          —          —          9.2        —          9.2   
Net cash outflow from investing activities      —          (2.1     —          (360.4     —          (362.5
Financing activities                                                 
Share option proceeds      4.1       —          —          —          —          4.1   
Cash consideration for non-controlling interests      —          —          —          (26.4 )     —          (26.4
Share repurchases and buy-backs      (9.5     —          —          —          —          (9.5
Net (decrease)/increase in borrowings      450.0        (1,050.7     370.7        (196.3     —          (426.3
Financing and share issue costs      (10.0     —          —          (8.8     —          (18.8
Capital contribution (paid)/received      —          (111.7     —          111.7        —          —     
Equity dividends paid      (22.3     (55.9     —          (111.7     0.1        (189.8
Dividends paid to non-controlling interests in subsidiary undertakings      —          —          —          (63.0     —          (63.0
Net cash (outflow)/inflow from financing activities      412.3        (1,218.3     370.7        (294.5     0.1        (729.7
Net (decrease)/increase in cash and cash equivalents      (56.0     (1,444.0     342.2        884.4        —          (273.4
Translation differences      0.1        (207.8     (41.4     150.4        —          (98.7
Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year      (0.2     (593.2     425.9        1,485.6        —          1,318.1   
Cash and cash equivalents at end of year      (56.1     (2,245.0     726.7        2,520.4        —          946.0   

 

Note

1    

Includes: WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings.

 

F-44


Table of Contents

 

32.    Condensed consolidating financial information (continued)

 

Condensed consolidating cash flow statement information (continued)

 

For the year ended 31 December 2008, £m

 

     WPP
plc
    Subsidiary
Guarantors 1
   

WPP

Finance

(UK)

    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications /
Eliminations
   

Consolidated

WPP plc

 

Net cash inflow/(outflow) from operating activities

     (0.3     522.5        (11.9     413.5        (1.1     922.7   

Investing activities

                                                

Acquisitions and disposals

     —          (1.3     —          (1,028.1     —          (1,029.4

Purchases of property, plant and equipment

     —          (2.1     —          (194.7     —          (196.8

Purchases of other intangible assets (including capitalised computer software)

     —          —          —          (23.8     —          (23.8

Proceeds on disposal of property, plant and equipment

     —          —          —          11.5        —          11.5   

Net cash outflow from investing activities

     —          (3.4     —          (1,235.1     —          (1,238.5

Financing activities

                                                

Share option proceeds

     —          10.6        —          —          —          10.6   

Cash consideration for non-controlling interests

     —          —          —          (19.7 )     —          (19.7

Share repurchases and buy-backs

     —          (105.3     —          —          —          (105.3

Net increase/(decrease) in borrowings

     —          1,236.3        —          (425.9     —          810.4   

Financing and share issue costs

     0.1        (15.0     —          (4.5     —          (19.4

Capital contribution (paid)/received

     —          —          —          —          —          —     

Equity dividends paid

     —          (162.9     —          —          1.1        (161.8

Dividends paid to non-controlling interests in subsidiary undertakings

     —          —          —          (63.5     —          (63.5

Net cash inflow/(outflow) from financing activities

     0.1        963.7        —          (513.6     1.1        451.3   

Net increase/(decrease) in cash and cash equivalents

     (0.2     1,482.8        (11.9     (1,335.2     —          135.5   

Translation differences

     —          307.0        116.0        (302.7     —          120.3   

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

     —          (2,383.0     321.8        3,123.5        —          1,062.3   

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

     (0.2     (593.2     425.9        1,485.6        —          1,318.1   

 

Note

1  

Includes: WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings.

 

F-45


Table of Contents

 

32.    Condensed consolidating financial information (continued)

 

 

Condensed consolidating balance sheet information

 

At 31 December 2010, £m

 

    

WPP

plc

    Subsidiary
guarantors 1
    WPP
Finance
(UK)
    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications/
Eliminations
    Consolidated
WPP plc
 

Non-current assets

                                                

Intangible assets:

                                                

Goodwill

     —          —          —          9,106.3        —          9,106.3   

Other

     —          —          —          1,904.5        —          1,904.5   

Property, plant and equipment

     —          4.6        —          703.8        —          708.4   

Investment in subsidiaries

     6,469.4        12,520.8        —          —          (18,990.2     —     

Interests in associates

     —          —          —          792.1        —          792.1   

Other investments

     —          —          —          173.7        —          173.7   

Deferred tax assets

     —          —          —          79.1        —          79.1   

Trade and other receivables

     —          126.2        —          197.3        —          323.5   
       6,469.4        12,651.6        —          12,956.8        (18,990.2     13,087.6   

Current assets

                                                

Inventory and work in progress

     —          —          —          366.0        —          366.0   

Corporate income tax recoverable

     —          —          —          82.9        —          82.9   

Trade and other receivables

     0.3        50.1        2.8        8,790.2        —          8,843.4   

Cash and short-term deposits

     1.4        903.7        722.0        4,081.0        (3,742.9     1,965.2   
       1.7        953.8        724.8        13,320.1        (3,742.9     11,257.5   

Current Liabilities

                                                

Trade and other payables

     (4.8     (72.6     (10.1     (11,616.1     —          (11,703.6

Corporate income tax payable

     —          —          —          (115.8     —          (115.8

Bank overdrafts and loans

     —          (3,742.9     —          (255.4     3,742.9        (255.4
       (4.8     (3,815.5     (10.1     (11,987.3     3,742.9        (12,074.8

Net current (liabilities)/assets

     (3.1     (2,861.7     714.7        1,332.8        —          (817.3

Total assets less current liabilities

     6,466.3        9,789.9        714.7        14,289.6        (18,990.2     12,270.3   

Non-current liabilities

                                                

Bonds and bank loans

     (413.2     (1,608.8     (797.4     (778.8     —          (3,598.2

Trade and other payables

     —          (110.1     —          (278.5     —          (388.6

Corporate income tax liability

     —          —          —          (481.8     —          (481.8

Deferred tax liabilities

     —          —          —          (750.7     —          (750.7

Provisions for post-employment benefits

     —          —          —          (241.5     —          (241.5

Provisions for liabilities and charges

     —          —          —          (161.6     —          (161.6
       (413.2     (1,718.9     (797.4     (2,692.9     —          (5,622.4

Net intercompany receivable/(payable)

     393.5        (1,601.6     —          1,208.1        —          —     

Net assets/(liabilities)

     6,446.6        6,469.4        (82.7     12,804.8        (18,990.2     6,647.9   

Attributable to:

                                                

Equity share owners’ funds

     6,446.6        6,469.4        (82.7     12,603.5        (18,990.2     6,446.6   

Non-controlling interests

     —          —          —          201.3        —          201.3   

Total equity

     6,446.6        6,469.4        (82.7     12,804.8        (18,990.2     6,647.9   

 

Note

1    

Includes: WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings.

 

F-46


Table of Contents

 

32.    Condensed consolidating financial information (continued)

 

 

Condensed consolidating balance sheet information (continued)

 

At 31 December 2009, £m

 

    

WPP

plc

    Subsidiary
guarantors 1
    WPP
Finance
(UK)
    Other
Subsidiaries
    Reclassifications/
Eliminations
    Consolidated
WPP plc
 

Non-current assets

                                                

Intangible assets:

                                                

Goodwill

     —          —          —          8,697.5        —          8,697.5   

Other

     —          —          —          2,000.7        —          2,000.7   

Property, plant and equipment

     —          2.5        —          678.0        —          680.5   

Investment in subsidiaries

     5,905.2        11,659.7        —          —          (17,564.9     —     

Interests in associates

     —          —          —          729.3        —          729.3   

Other investments

     —          —          —          294.6        —          294.6   

Deferred tax assets

     —          —          —          67.5        —          67.5   

Trade and other receivables

     —          115.3        —          170.8        —          286.1   
       5,905.2        11,777.5        —          12,638.4        (17,564.9     12,756.2   

Current assets

                                                

Inventory and work in progress

     —          —          —          306.7        —          306.7   

Corporate income tax recoverable

     —          —          —          73.0        —          73.0   

Trade and other receivables

     0.9        48.1        9.6        7,490.3        —          7,548.9   

Cash and short-term deposits

     1.7        1,296.8        727.8        3,182.2        (3,541.8     1,666.7   
       2.6        1,344.9        737.4        11,052.2        (3,541.8     9,595.3   

Current Liabilities

                                                

Trade and other payables

     (4.5     (85.8     (9.7     (9,674.0     —          (9,774.0

Corporate income tax payable

     —          —          —          (71.6     —          (71.6

Bank overdrafts and loans

     (57.8     (3,541.8     (1.1     (661.8     3,541.8        (720.7
       (62.3     (3,627.6     (10.8     (10,407.4     3,541.8        (10,566.3

Net current (liabilities)/assets

     (59.7     (2,282.7     726.6        644.8        —          (971.0

Total assets less current liabilities

     5,845.5        9,494.8        726.6        13,283.2        (17,564.9     11,785.2   

Non-current liabilities

                                                

Bonds and bank loans

     (402.3     (1,624.2     (766.6     (793.3     —          (3,586.4

Trade and other payables

     —          (109.5     —          (313.8     —          (423.3

Corporate income tax liability

     —          —          —          (485.5     —          (485.5

Deferred tax liabilities

     —          —          —          (809.6     —          (809.6

Provisions for post-employment benefits

     —          —          —          (251.8     —          (251.8

Provisions for liabilities and charges

     —          —          —          (152.9     —          (152.9
       (402.3     (1,733.7     (766.6     (2,806.9     —          (5,709.5

Net intercompany receivable/(payable)

     450.8        (1,855.9     —          1,405.1        —          —     

Net assets/(liabilities)

     5,894.0        5,905.2        (40.0     11,881.4        (17,564.9     6,075.7   

Attributable to:

                                                

Equity share owners’ funds

     5,894.0        5,905.2        (40.0     11,699.7        (17,564.9     5,894.0   

Non-controlling interests

     —          —          —          181.7        —          181.7   

Total equity

     5,894.0        5,905.2        (40.0     11,881.4        (17,564.9     6,075.7   

 

Note

1    

Includes: WPP Air 1 Limited, WPP 2008 Limited, WPP 2005 Limited and Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings.

 

F-47


Table of Contents

REPORT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

 

To the Board of Directors and Shareholders of WPP DAS Ltd

 

We have audited the accompanying balance sheets of WPP DAS Ltd (the “Trust”) at 31 December 2010 and 2009 and the related cash flow statements and statements of changes in equity for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2010 and the period from 9 July 2008 through 31 December 2008. These financial statements are the responsibility of the Trust’s management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on these financial statements based on our audits.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with standards of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States). Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement. The Trust is not required to have an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. Our audit includes consideration of internal control over financial reporting as a basis for designing audit procedures that are appropriate in the circumstances, but not for the purpose of expressing any opinion on the Trust’s internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such separate opinion. Our audits of the financial statements included examining, on a test basis, evidence supporting the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements, assessing the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, and evaluating the overall financial statement presentation. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

In our opinion, such financial statements referred to above present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Trust as at 31 December 2010 and 2009, and its cash flows for each of the two years in the period ended 31 December 2010 and the period from 9 July 2008 through 31 December 2008, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

Deloitte LLP

London, United Kingdom

29 April 2011

 

F-48


Table of Contents

Cash flow statement

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010 and 2009 and the period from 9 July 2008 to 31 December 2008

 

     Notes     

2010

£m

    

2009

£m

   

2008

£m

 

Net cash inflow from operating activities

                               

Investing activities

                               

Financing activities

                               

Issue of ordinary shares

     3                 111.7          

Dividends Paid

     4                 (111.7       

Net cash inflow from financing activities

                               

Net increase in cash and cash equivalents

                               

Cash and cash equivalents at beginning of year

                               

Cash and cash equivalents at end of year

                               

Note

The accompanying notes form an integral part of this cash flow statement.

 

Balance sheet

 

At 31 December 2010, 2009

 

    

2010

£m

  

2009

£m

Assets

     

Liabilities

     

Net assets

     

Equity

     

Note

The accompanying notes form an integral part of this balance sheet.

 

Statement of changes in equity

 

For the years ended 31 December 2010 and 2009 and the period from 9 July 2008 to 31 December 2008

 

     Notes   

Share
capital

£m

 

Distributable
Reserve

£m

   

Total

£m

 

Issue of ordinary shares

                     

Capital reduction

                     

Dividends

                     

At 31 December 2008

                     

Issue of ordinary shares

   3    167.6            167.6   

Capital reduction

   3    (167.6)     167.6          

Dividends

   4        (167.6     (167.6

At 31 December 2009

                     

Issue of ordinary shares

   3    187.0            187.0   

Capital reduction

   3    (187.0)     187.0          

Dividends

   4        (187.0     (187.0

At 31 December 2010

                     

Note

The accompanying notes form an integral part of this statement of changes in equity.

 

 

F-49


Table of Contents

Notes to the financial statements

 


1. The dividend access trust

 

WPP DAS Limited (the “Trust”) was established on 9 July 2008 by WPP plc (“WPP”). The Trust is governed by the applicable laws of England and Wales and is a resident for tax purposes in the United Kingdom, WPP is a resident for tax purposes in the Republic of Ireland. The Trust is a wholly owned subsidiary of WPP 2008 Limited which is an indirect wholly owned subsidiary of WPP plc.

 

WPP DAS Limited was formed as part of WPP’s Dividend Access Plan, which was primarily designed to ensure that WPP share owners may continue to receive UK dividends, meaning in particular that under the Dividend Access Plan, no Irish tax is required to be withheld from the payment of dividends to share owners. To facilitate WPP’s Dividend Access Plan, the Trust issued one dividend access share to the trustee. WPP share owners will not have any interest in the dividend access share and will not have any rights against the Trust as the issuer of the dividend access share. The only assets held in trust for the benefit of share owners will be dividends paid to the trustee in respect of the dividend access share.

 

To ensure compliance with UK trust law rules, the period during which the dividend access trust may continue is restricted. However, the dividend access trust under current law is able to continue for 80 years.

 


2. Accounting policies

 

Basis of preparation

The financial statements have been prepared under the historical cost convention and in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (IASB) as they apply to the financial statements of the Trust for the year ended 31 December 2010.

 

The financial statements were approved by the Board of Directors and authorised for issue on 29 April 2011.

 

Income statement and statement of comprehensive income

An income statement and a statement of comprehensive income are not presented with these financial statements because the Trust did not receive income, incur expense or recognise any gain or loss during the period under review.

 

The directors received no remuneration during the period for services to the Trust. The Trust had no other employees during the period. All operating expenses, including the auditors’ remuneration of £1,000, were borne by WPP 2005 Limited.

 

Functional currency

The functional currency of the Trust is pounds sterling.

 

Taxation

The Trust is not required to withhold at source any amount in respect of UK tax from dividend payments it makes under the Dividend Access Plan regardless of who the recipient of the payments is.

 


3. Share capital and distributable reserve

 

In July 2008 the Trust issued 1 ordinary share with a nominal value of £1 to WPP 2008 Limited and in April 2009 the Trust issued 1 non-voting dividend access share with a nominal value of £1.

 

On 30 June 2009 the Trust issued 111,691,009 ordinary shares of £1 each to another Group company and on the same date a capital reduction was performed. On 30 October 2009 the Trust issued a further 55,865,345 ordinary shares of £1 each and on the same date a capital reduction was performed. As a result of this transaction the Trust remained with called-up share capital of 1 ordinary share of £1 and 1 dividend access share of £1.

 

On 25 March 2010 the Trust issued 117,301,956 ordinary shares of £1 each to another Group company and on the same date a capital reduction was performed. On 28 October 2010 the Trust issued a further 69,706,978 ordinary shares of £1 each and on the same date a capital reduction was performed. As a result of this transaction the Trust remained with called-up share capital of 1 ordinary share of £1 and 1 dividend access share of £1.

 


4. Dividends

 

    

2010

£m

    

2009

£m

    

2008

£m

 
2008 second interim dividend of 10.28p per ordinary share              111.7           
2009 first interim dividend of 5.19p per ordinary share 1              55.9           
2009 second interim dividend of 10.28p per ordinary share 1      117.3                   
2010 first interim dividend of 5.97p per ordinary share 1      69.7                   
       187.0         167.6           

 

1    

This dividend was settled in cash by another Group company on behalf of the Trust.


 

F-50


Table of Contents

Exhibit Index

 

Exhibit No.

  

Exhibit Title

  4.23    Service Agreement in the USA, effective 26 November 2010, between WPP Group USA, Inc. and Sir Martin Sorrell.
    8.1    List of subsidiaries.
  12.1    Certification of Group Chief Executive.
  12.2    Certification of Group Finance Director.
  13.1    Certification of Group Chief Executive under 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.
  13.2    Certification of Group Finance Director under 18 U.S.C. Section 1350.
  14.1    Consent of Independent Registered Public Accounting Firm.

Exhibit 4.23

 

We hereby certify that this is a

true and correct copy of the original

Dated

 

      01/12/2010                             

HAMMONDS LLP

 

7, DEVONSHIRE SQUARE

LONDON

EC2M 4YH          Hammonds LLP

 

 

DATED 26 NOVEMBER 2010

     
 

 

WPP GROUP USA, INC

  

(1)

  
 

 

and

     
 

 

SIR MARTIN STUART SORRELL

  

(2)

  
       
 

 

 

SERVICE AGREEMENT

     
 

in the USA effective 26 November 2010

 

     

Hammonds LLP

7 Devonshire Square London EC2M 4YH DX 136546 Bishopsgate 2

Telephone +44 (0)20 7655 1000 Fax +44 (0)20 7655 1001

Website www.hammonds.com

Reference WPP.2-1375

 


DATE OF SERVICE AGREEMENT 26 NOVEMBER 2010

PARTIES

 

(1)

WPP GROUP USA, INC, a Delaware Corporation of 100 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10017-5529 (the “Company” )

 

(2)

SIR MARTIN STUART SORRELL with a business address at 100 Park Avenue, New York, New York 10017-5529 (the “Executive” )

INTRODUCTION

 

A

The Company employs the Executive in the United States of America in order to assist the Company, its Affiliates and Subsidiaries in the management, control, organisation and development of their respective businesses and trades within the United States of America pursuant to an agreement embodying the terms of such employment dated 16 August 2004 (as amended through 19 November 2008, the “2004 Agreement” ).

 

B

The Company and the Executive desire to continue such employment, subject to the terms and provisions of the 2004 Agreement but with the modifications herein contained (the “Agreement” ).

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the premises and mutual covenants contained herein and for other good and valuable consideration, the receipt of which is mutually acknowledged, the Company and the Executive (individually a “Party” and together the “Parties” ) agree that the 2004 Agreement is hereby amended and restated, effective 26 November, 2010 to read in its entirety as follows:

IT IS AGREED THAT:

 

1

DEFINITIONS

“Affiliate” of a person or other entity shall mean a person or other entity that directly or indirectly controls, is controlled by, or is under common control with the person or other entity specified.

“Appointment Letter” means the agreement between WPP plc (1) and Sir Martin Stuart Sorrell (2) dated even date relating to the Executive’s directorship of the Parent and which is effective from 19 November 2008.

“Base Salary” shall mean the salary provided for in clause 7.1 below or any increased salary granted to the Executive pursuant to clause 7.1.

“Board” shall mean the Board of Directors of the Company.

“Compensation Committee” shall mean the Compensation Committee of the Board of Directors of the Parent.

“Director’s Fee” means the fee payable to the Executive under the Appointment Letter.

“Group” shall mean the Company and the Parent together with their Subsidiaries and Affiliates and “Group Company” shall be anyone of them.

“LEAP” shall mean the WPP Group plc Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan adopted by the share owners of WPP Group plc (now WPP 2008 Limited) on 16 April 2004, as amended.

 

22140645/10/L

2


“LEAP III” shall mean the WPP plc Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan III adopted by the share owners of WPP plc on 2 June 2009, as amended.

“Parent” shall mean WPP plc a company incorporated in Jersey with registered number 101749.

“Schedule” shall mean Schedule 1 attached hereto.

“Subsidiary” shall mean any corporation of which the Parent owns, directly or indirectly, more than 50% of the Voting Stock.

“Term of Employment” shall mean the period specified in clause 3 below.

“UK Employment Contract” shall mean an agreement between WPP 2005 Limited and the Executive which is effective from 19 November 2008.

“Voting Power” shall mean the number of votes available to be cast (determined by reference to the maximum number of votes entitled to be cast by the holders of such Voting Stock upon any matter submitted to stockholders where the holders of all Voting Stock vote together as a single class) by the holders of Voting Stock.

“Voting Stock” shall mean capital stock of any class or classes having general voting power under ordinary circumstances, in the absence of contingencies, to elect the Executives of a corporation.

 

2

APPOINTMENT

 

2.1

During the Term of Employment, the Company shall employ the Executive to provide services in the United States of America and the Executive:

 

 

(a)

shall use his best endeavours to promote the interests of the Company, its Affiliates and Subsidiaries and also Group Companies in the United States of America in the management, control, organisation and development of their respective businesses and trades and in addition the Executive shall comply with all reasonable directions which the Board may give to him and the Executive shall furnish to the Board all such explanations, information and assistance as it may reasonably require;

 

 

(b)

will not, without first obtaining the prior written approval of the Company, on his own behalf enter into any contract or other arrangement with any other firm, person or company whose business is in competition with the businesses of the Company or any Group Company.

 

2.2

During the Term of Employment under this Agreement the Executive shall be a member of the Board and of the Board of Executives of such Group Company as the Parties from time to time shall agree and the Executive shall continue in his current positions as Chairman, President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company in which capacity he shall, subject to clause 2.1(a), be responsible for the overall management control, organisation and development of the affairs of the Company, its Affiliates and Subsidiaries and also the Group Companies but in all cases in the United States of America and he shall be responsible to the Board for all aspects of the conduct of such businesses.

 

3

TERM OF EMPLOYMENT

 

3.1

The Company hereby agrees to continue to employ the Executive, and the Executive hereby accepts such continued employment and, subject to clause 15, the Company and the Executive

 

22140645/10/L

3


 

can terminate the Term of Employment by written notice taking effect immediately on the date of its service on the other party, in which event the Executive’s employment with the Company shall terminate as of the date of such notice. Any notice to terminate the Term of Employment given by either the Executive or the Company (other than a notice by the Company pursuant to clause 15.1 hereof) shall be deemed to be a notice given by such party on the grounds of the Executive’s retirement and upon giving such notice, the Executive shall be deemed to have retired and qualified for retirement treatment for purposes of all plans, policies, programs, arrangements of, or other agreements with, the Company or any Group Company. If such notice is given by the Company, the termination of the Term of Employment shall be treated, for purposes of section 409A of the U.S. Internal Revenue Code (the “Code” ) and the regulations, rulings, notices and other guidance issued by the Internal Revenue Service ( “IRS” ) thereunder or interpreting same (collectively, “Code section 409A” ), as an involuntary separation from service, with respect to any amounts that become payable to the Executive upon such termination hereunder, or under any other plan, policy, program arrangement of, or other agreement with, the Company or any Group Company and that are treated as deferred compensation for purposes of Code section 409A. In the event of any termination of the Term of Employment, save as provided in clauses 3.2,15.4,15.5, 15.6 and 19 below, the Executive will have no entitlement to any further payments from the Company hereunder and he hereby irrevocably waives any entitlement to notice or pay and/or benefits in lieu of any period of notice. Nothing in this clause 3.1 shall prejudice the Company’s right to terminate the Term of Employment hereunder pursuant to clause 15.1 hereof.

 

3.2

Following termination of the Term of Employment the Executive shall continue to be entitled to receive amounts due hereunder which are accrued up to and including the date on which the employment terminates but not yet paid, subject to any adjustment under clause 7.2 and/or clause 12.3, if applicable.

 

4

DIRECTOR’S FEES

Save for the Director’s Fee and unless otherwise agreed in writing between the Company and the Executive the Executive shall not be entitled to any director’s fees from the Company or from any Group Company in addition to the remuneration payable by the Company to the Executive hereunder; provided that if the Executive is at any time removed from the office of director whether of the Company or the Parent (other than as a consequence of the Executive being terminated in accordance with clauses 15.1 or 15.2 of this Agreement) the Term of Employment shall automatically terminate and such termination shall be deemed to be by the Company for a reason other than provided for in clauses 15.1 or 15.2 of this Agreement.

 

5

ACCOMMODATION

 

5.1

The Company undertakes to the Executive to provide suitable offices and suitable office and secretarial facilities for his use as are compatible with the Executive’s role as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company and the Executive shall carry out his duties there and in such other places as the Executive judges appropriate.

 

5.2

The Company shall make available for the use of the Executive (at the expense of the Company) an apartment in New York City while the Executive is in New York City and engaged in or conducting business on behalf of the Company or its Subsidiaries and Affiliates, including, but not limited to, any company referred to in clause 2.2.

 

22140645/10/L

4


6

HOURS OF WORK

 

6.1

The Executive shall work at such times and for such periods as the efficient and conscientious discharge of his duties hereunder shall reasonably require. There are no normal working hours for the Executive. The Company acknowledges that the Executive has obligations under the Appointment Letter and the UK Employment Contract for the provision of his services which will affect the time during which and the times at which he can discharge his duties under this Agreement.

 

7

SALARY

 

7.1

The Company shall pay to the Executive a Base Salary for each calendar year calculated and determined in accordance with the Schedule. The Base Salary shall accrue from day to day.

 

7.2

The Company will pay on 1 January and 1 July (or such other dates as may be agreed from time to time between the Company and the Executive) in each year during the Term of Employment hereunder instalments of an amount on account of the Base Salary payable under clause 7.1 above for that year in advance equal to one-half of 40% of such Aggregate Basic Income (as defined in the Schedule). Except as otherwise set forth herein, any instalment due hereunder shall be payable in accordance with the regular payroll practices of the Company. At appropriate times during the year adjustments shall be made to reflect the US Time (as defined in the Schedule) and such adjustments may be made by adjusting the amount of Base Salary paid for future services hereunder or by adjusting the portion of the bonus earned for the year in which such Base Salary is being adjusted that is attributable to US Time (as defined in the Schedule).

 

8

ANNUAL INCENTIVE AWARDS

 

8.1

The Executive shall, subject to satisfaction of the criteria set out below and subject to any adjustment as set forth in clause 7.2 above, also be entitled to receive, in respect of each financial year of the Parent that occurs during the Term of Employment hereunder, a bonus determined by reference to the financial performance of the Parent for the period to which it relates. The annual bonus payable hereunder to the Executive in respect of any financial year of the Parent shall be paid to him in a single payment in the next following calendar year, by no later than 15 March of such following year; provided, however, that if calculation of the amount of such bonus is not administratively practicable as of such date, then payment of such bonus shall be made 30 days after (but in any event by no later than 31 December next following) the date on which calculation of the amount of such bonus first becomes administratively practicable. The bonus shall be deemed to accrue from day to day during the period to which it relates and determined and based on three separate components, each comprising one-third of the amount of the bonus, as follows:

 

 

(a)

One component is based on financial performance of the Parent measured against budgeted operating profit and cash flow to be agreed between the Executive and the Company in consultation with the Compensation Committee (but which shall be measured in the same way as the Parent’s financial performance for the purpose of calculating bonus payments for the Group’s other senior executives).

 

 

(b)

One component is based on the Parent’s performance relative to a peer group of major public advertising companies. The peer group will be reviewed by the Company and the Parent from time to time as necessary and any changes to the peer group will be notified to

 

22140645/10/L

5


 

the Executive, provided always that the Company and the Parent will act reasonably and will consult with the Executive prior to making any changes to the companies in the peer group.

The performance levels and the criteria for achieving them will be agreed between the Executive and the Company in respect of each year and will take into account the following criteria inter alia:

 

 

(i)

Total shareholder return (i.e. share price appreciation plus reinvestment of dividends in shares);

 

 

(ii)

Increase in operating profit;

 

 

(iii)

Increase in earnings per share and/or operating margins.

Adjustments shall be made in relation to the Parent and the peer group of companies referred to above as necessary to enable an accurate comparison of performance to be made, provided always that the Company and the Parent will act reasonably and will consult with the Executive prior to making any such adjustments.

 

 

(iv)

One component shall be based on the achievement of key strategic initiatives which shall be agreed by the Executive and the Company as early as practicable during the relevant year.

 

 

(v)

For the purposes of determining the bonus payable to the Executive for the calendar year 2008, the term “Parent” shall mean WPP Group plc for the portion of such year ending on 18 November 2008 and WPP for the remainder of such year.

The total bonus comprising each of the three components shall be targeted so as to equal 100 per cent of the Base Salary under clause 7.1 as at 31 December of the relevant year (calculated in accordance with the Schedule) and the maximum bonus shall be 200 per cent of that Base Salary.

The Executive and the Compensation Committee may agree from time to time an alternative structure for determining the amount of the bonus payable under this clause, including the target and maximum amounts of that bonus.

 

8.2

If either the Executive or the Company terminates the Term of Employment for whatever reason (and in the Company’s case other than pursuant to clause 15.1 hereof), after the end of the performance period to which the bonus period refers but prior to the payment date of any such bonus, the Executive will continue to be treated on the same basis as if he were employed on the relevant payment date. For the avoidance of doubt, if the Executive or Company terminate the Term of Employment at any time before the end of the performance period referred to then the Executive loses all and any rights under this clause and the Executive has no rights against the Company and/or Parent in respect of the same except as otherwise provided pursuant to the applicable annual incentive plan.

 

9

OTHER INCENTIVE AWARDS

The Executive shall have no entitlement to participate in any incentive arrangements for executives, except as expressly provided herein, or as agreed in writing in advance by the

 

22140645/10/L

6


Company or the Parent. The Executive shall be entitled at the discretion of the Compensation Committee to participate in the WPP 2004 Leadership Equity Acquisition Plan, the WPP Performance Share Plan and such other plans and arrangements which at the discretion of such Compensation Committee shall be made available for the most senior executives of the Company and the Group Companies, subject always to the rules of the applicable plan or scheme.

 

10

EXPENSES

The Executive is authorised to incur reasonable expenses in carrying out his duties and responsibilities under this Agreement and the Company shall promptly reimburse him for all business expenses incurred in connection with carrying out the business of the Company, subject to documentation in accordance with the Company’s policy.

To the extent that the reimbursement of any expenses or the provision of any in-kind benefits under this clause 10, or under clause 5.1, clause 5.2 or clause 11 hereof, is subject to Code section 409A, (i) the amount of such expenses eligible for reimbursement, or in-kind benefits to be provided, during any one calendar year shall not affect the amount of such expenses eligible for reimbursement, or in-kind, benefits to be provided, in any other calendar year; (ii) reimbursement of any such expense shall be made by no later than 31 December of the year following the calendar year in which such expense is incurred; and (iii) the Executive’s right to receive such reimbursements or in-kind benefits shall not be subject to liquidation or exchange for another benefit

 

11

CAR AND CLUB

The Company shall make available to the Executive as required a car and driver appropriate for his sole use. The Company shall maintain, service, and comprehensively insure the car as appropriate and shall arrange for the supply to the Executive of fuel for his use in such car. The Company shall also pay the cost and shall reimburse the Executive for his reasonable properly vouchered club expenses incurred in connection with the Company’s business in accordance with Company policy as from time to time in effect.

 

12

INSURANCES AND PENSION

 

12.1

The Company shall or will procure that WPP 2005 Limited shall provide for the benefit of the Executive and his dependants life and accident assurance and health insurance and any other benefits as may be agreed between the Company and the Executive.

 

12.2

The Company shall pay 50% of the reasonable cost of providing for the benefit of the Executive and his dependants insurance cover on such basis and for such amounts, as shall from time to time be agreed between the Company and the Executive provided that such cover is available, which provides a payment in the event that the Term of Employment is terminated because of the Executive’s death, ill-health or disability.

 

12.3

Unless otherwise agreed between the parties, the Executive shall be entitled to a supplemental pension to be funded by or on behalf of the Company by an annual payment of a sum (the “Pensions Contribution” ) calculated in accordance with the Schedule, to be funded by or on behalf of the Company by an appropriate funding mechanism for the payment of such Pensions Contribution or payment or provision in lieu thereof. An amount on account of the Pensions

 

22140645/10/L

7


 

Contribution will be paid or funded, as the case may be, on the first day of January of each year during the Term of Employment under this Agreement in respect of the year for which it is paid equal to 40% of the Aggregate Pensions Provision (as defined in the Schedule) at that time, shall be paid or funded in equal instalments in arrears on 31 March, 30 June, 30 September and 31 December in respect of the year for which it is paid. All necessary adjustments to reflect US Time (as defined in the Schedule) shall be made at regular times during the year in accordance with the understanding between the Parties.

 

13

VACATION

 

13.1

In addition to bank and other public holidays in the United Kingdom the Executive shall be entitled to six weeks paid vacation per year.

 

13.2

The vacation shall be taken at such time or times as the Executive shall decide but in any event it shall be taken at the same time as the Executive’s holiday entitlement from the Parent.

 

14

SICKNESS ABSENCE

Subject to clause 3.1, the Company shall continue to pay to the Executive all sums due to him (without deduction) during any period of absence from work due to his illness or disability.

 

15

TERMINATION OF EMPLOYMENT

 

15.1

In any of the following cases, but without prejudice to clause 3.1, the Company may terminate the Term of Employment by written notice taking effect on the date of its service on the Executive in which case the Executive shall not be entitled to any further payment from the Company hereunder (other than pursuant to clause 19 hereof, if applicable) except such sums as shall then have accrued or become due.

 

 

(a)

If the Executive is convicted in the United States of a felony involving moral turpitude, fraud or dishonesty and sentenced to a term of imprisonment.

 

 

(b)

If the Executive engages in conduct that constitutes wilful gross neglect or wilful gross misconduct in carrying out his duties under this Agreement, resulting, in either case, in material economic harm to the Company.

 

 

(c)

If the Executive be adjudicated bankrupt under the laws of the United Kingdom.

 

 

(d)

If WPP 2005 Limited terminates the Term of Employment under the UK Employment Contract pursuant to clause 14.1 thereof.

 

15.2

The Company may terminate the Term of Employment by reason of the Executive’s illness or disability by giving written notice to the Executive in any of the following cases:

 

 

(a)

the Executive is substantially unable properly to perform the duties required under this Agreement by reason of illness or physical or mental incapacity or disability (irrespective of the cause or causes) for a period of 180 consecutive working days or for a period or periods aggregating at least 261 working days in any period of 18 months.

 

 

(b)

the Executive is permanently prevented as a result of any deterioration of his health from providing the services to the Company which he is required to provide under this

 

22140645/10/L

8


 

Agreement and in particular to act as President and Chief Executive Officer of the Company. Whether or not the Executive is permanently incapacitated shall be determined by a medical doctor selected by the Parties, and in default of agreement by such medical doctor appointed by the President of the British Medical Association.

 

15.3

If the Term of Employment under the UK Employment Contract terminates for any reason whatsoever the Company or the Executive (as the case may be) may terminate the Term of Employment hereunder, provided that any such termination shall be deemed to be on the same basis as the Term of Employment under the UK Employment Contract, as the case may be, was terminated.

 

15.4

 

 

(a)

Subject always to the provisions of clause 15.5, in the event it shall be determined that any payment, benefit, entitlement or distribution in the nature of compensation (within the meaning of Section 280G(b)(2) of the Code) to or for the benefit of the Executive by the Company or any Group Company, whether paid or payable pursuant to this Agreement or otherwise (a “Payment” ), would be subject to any excise tax imposed by Section 4999 of the Code (any such excise tax, together with any interest or penalties imposed with respect thereto, are hereinafter collectively referred to as the “Excise Tax” ), then the Executive shall be entitled to receive an additional payment (a “Gross-Up Payment” ) in an amount such that and subject to the adjustments pursuant to the provision of clause 15.5, after payment by the Executive of all taxes, whether imposed under United States or United Kingdom tax laws, including, without limitation, any income, employment, excise or other taxes (which shall include social security, Medicare and similar imposts) and any interest or penalties imposed with respect thereto, the Executive retains an amount of the Gross-Up Payment equal to the Excise Tax imposed upon the Payment All determinations required to be made pursuant to this clause, including whether any Excise Tax is payable with respect to any Payment and if so, the amount thereof, whether and when a Gross-Up Payment is required, the amount of such Gross-Up Payment and the assumptions to be utilised in arriving at such determinations, shall be made by an independent auditor (the “Auditor” ) jointly selected by the Company and the Executive and paid by the Company. The Auditor shall be a nationally recognised United States public accounting firm which has not during the two years preceding the date of its selection, acted in any way on behalf of the Company or any Group Company. If the Executive and the Company cannot agree on the firm to serve as the Auditor, then the Executive and the Company shall each select one accounting firm and those two firms shall jointly select the accounting firm to serve as the Auditor. The Auditor shall be requested to provide detailed supporting calculations both to the Company and the Executive within 30 business days of a request for a determination by the Company. The Executive may request such determination by providing written notice thereof to the Company, which will promptly thereafter make such a request of the Auditor. The Auditor shall also make any determination as to whether any Payment shall be required to be reduced pursuant to Rule 11.1 of LEAP or LEAP III, as applicable. in the event the Auditor determines that the Executive will be better off with a reduction (after taking into account all arrangements between the Company and the Executive including the arrangement for the Gross-Up Payment pursuant to this clause 15.4(a)) such reduction shall be made even if not required by the terms of Rule 11.1 of LEAP or LEAP III, as applicable. If the Auditor determines that any reduction is so required, the Payments to be reduced, and the reduction to be made to such Payments, shall be determined by the Auditor in its sole discretion in a manner which will result in the least economic cost to the

 

22140645/10/L

9


 

Executive, and if the reduction with respect to two or more Payments would result in equivalent economic cost to the Executive, such Payments shall be reduced in the inverse chronological order of the dates on which such Payments were otherwise scheduled to be made to the Executive, until the required reduction has been fully achieved.

 

 

(b)

Any Gross-Up Payment determined by the Auditor to be payable to the Executive pursuant to clause 15.4(a) shall be paid by the Company to the Executive within 10 days of the receipt of the Auditor’s determination. Except as otherwise provided in this clause 15.4(b) and in clause 15.4(c), any determination made by the Auditor pursuant to clause 15.4(a) shall be binding upon the Company and the Executive. If it should subsequently be determined by the Auditor or by the IRS that Excise Tax is payable with respect to a Payment in an amount greater than the amount of Excise Tax, if any, initially determined by the Auditor to be payable with respect to such Payment pursuant to clause 15.4(a) (such greater amount, “Additional Excise Tax” ) the Company shall pay to the Executive an additional Gross-up Payment with respect to such Additional Excise Tax, in an amount determined in the manner provided in the first sentence of clause 15.4(a) but subject to clause 15.5 In addition, if it should subsequently be determined by the Auditor or by the IRS that Additional Excise Tax is payable with respect to a Payment for which no Gross-Up Payment is payable and except in circumstances where no Gross-Up Payment is payable by virtue of the operation of clause 15.5, the Executive shall be indemnified on a fully grossed-up basis, as determined in the manner provided in the first sentence of clause 15.4(a), but subject to clause 15.5, for all interest and penalties included in such Additional Excise Tax that the Executive incurs on account of the Auditor’s initial determination under clause 15.4(a) that no Excise Tax was payable by the Executive, or that a lesser amount of Excise Tax was payable by him, with respect to such Payment.

 

 

(c)

The Executive shall notify the Company in writing of any written claim by the IRS or other taxing authority that, if successful, would require the payment by the Company of a Gross-Up Payment (a “Claim” ) or a potential Claim by the IRS (a “Potential Claim” ). For this purpose, a Potential Claim shall mean a Claim that has been asserted against the Executive by the IRS in discussion with the Executive or his advisers but which has not yet been asserted in writing to the Executive. Such notification shall be given within 10 business days after the Executive is informed in writing of such Claim or 10 business days after the Executive first becomes aware of a Potential Claim. The Executive shall apprise the Company of the nature Of any such Claim and the date on which such Claim is required to be paid by sending a copy of such Claim to the Company marked for the attention of the Group General Counsel for the time being. The Executive shall also apprise the Company of the nature of any such Potential Claim by sending written details of the circumstances giving rise to the Potential Claim to the Company marked for the attention of the Group General Counsel for the time being. The Executive shall not pay such Claim prior to the expiration of a period of 30 business days following the date on which he gives such notice of the Claim to the Company. If the Company decides that it will not contest such Claim, it shall so notify the Executive in writing prior to the expiration of such 30 day period, and shall include with such notice to the Executive, the Gross-Up Payment required to be paid by the Company to the Executive with respect to the Excise Tax asserted to be payable in such Claim and any additional amounts due the Executive pursuant to clause 15.4(b) above but subject to clause 15.5. If the Company notifies the Executive in writing prior to the expiration of such period that it desires to contest such Claim in a legally permissible manner or to pay on the Executive’s behalf the Excise Tax asserted to be payable in such Claim and have the Executive sue for a refund of the Excise Tax so paid (in which latter

 

22140645/10/L

10


 

case the Company shall pay such Excise Tax to the applicable taxing authorities on the Executive’s behalf on or before the expiration of such 30 day period and shall indemnify and hold harmless the Executive, on an after-tax basis, from any Excise Tax or income or employment taxes (including interest and penalties with respect thereto) imposed on the Executive by reason of the Company’s payment of such Excise Tax), the Executive shall:

 

 

(i)

give the Company any information reasonably requested by the Company relating to such Claim or Potential Claim;

 

 

(ii)

take such action in connection with contesting such Claim or Potential Claim as the Company shall reasonably request in writing from time to time, including, without limitation, accepting legal representation with respect to such claim by an attorney selected by the Company;

 

 

(iii)

cooperate with the Company in good faith in order to effectively contest such Claim or Potential Claim, and

 

 

(iv)

permit the Company to participate in any proceedings relating to such Claim or Potential Claim;

provided, however, that the Company shall bear and pay directly all costs and expenses (including additional interest and penalties) incurred in connection with such contest and shall indemnify the Executive for and hold the Executive harmless from, on an after-tax basis, any Excise Tax or income or employment tax (including interest and penalties with respect thereto) imposed as a result of the Company’s payment of all costs and expenses related to such contest. Furthermore, the Company’s control of the contest shall be limited to issues with respect to which a Gross-Up Payment would be payable hereunder and the Executive shall be entitled to settle or contest, as the case may be, any other issue raised by the IRS or other taxing authority, including any liability for Excise Tax in respect of which no Gross-Up Payment is payable.

 

 

(d)

If, following a payment by the Company of an Excise Tax amount on the Executive’s behalf pursuant to clause 15.4(c), the Executive becomes entitled to receive any refund with respect to any amount so paid by the Company, the Executive shall promptly after its receipt by him pay to the Company the amount of such refund (together with any interest paid or credited thereon after taxes) including, without limitation, any income, employment, excise and other taxes (which shall include social security, Medicare and similar imposts) applicable thereto). Notwithstanding the foregoing, the Executive shall be entitled to apply as an offset against the amount payable by him to the Company pursuant to the preceding sentence any amounts which, at the time of the Executive’s receipt of the refund referred to therein, the Company is still obligated to pay to the Executive with respect to its undertakings under clause 15.4(c) above (i) to bear and pay all costs and expenses in connection with the Executive’s pursuing its claim for such refund at the Company’s request, (ii) to indemnify the Executive on an after-tax basis for any Excise Tax or income or employment tax (including interest and penalties with respect thereto) imposed on the Executive by reason of the Company paying such costs and expenses, (iii) to indemnify the Executive on an after-tax basis for any Excise Tax or income or employment tax imposed on the Executive by reason of the Company paying the Excise Tax sought to be recovered by means of such claim for refund. If, after payment by the Company of an Excise Tax amount on the Executive’s behalf pursuant to clause 15.4(c), a determination is made that

 

22140645/10/L

11


 

the Executive shall not be entitled to any refund with respect to the Excise Tax amount so paid and the Company does not notify the Executive in writing of its intent to contest such denial of refund prior to the expiration of 30 days after such determination, then the amount of the Excise Tax so paid shall offset, to the extent thereof, the amount of the Gross-Up Payment required to be paid by the Company in respect of the Excise Tax asserted in the Claim contested by means of such refund suit

 

15.5

Any Gross-Up Payment shall be calculated subject to the principle that neither the Company nor any Affiliate will be liable to make a Gross-Up Payment due to an Excise Tax or a greater Excise Tax imposed on the Executive as a result of the fact that the Executive:

 

 

(a)

did not exercise his rights to the whole of his Capital Investment Plan award on 30 November 2011;

 

 

(b)

elected to defer payment with respect to his 2004, 2005 and 2006 LEAP Award Shares (all as defined in sub-clause (iii) below); and

 

 

(c)

should the Executive so elect (with the agreement of WPP), elects to defer payment with respect to any or all of his 2007, 2008 and 2009 LEAP Award Shares

and that such adjustments as are necessary to give effect to that principle will be made to the calculation of the amount payable under clause 15.4 and including the following principles:

 

 

(i)

the Gross-Up Payment shall be calculated as if the Executive had exercised his rights to the whole amount of his award under the Capital Investment Plan on 30 November 2011 and as if payment with respect to the Executive’s 2004, 2005 and 2006 LEAP Award Shares were made to him on 15 March 2008, 2010 and 2011 respectively;

 

 

(ii)

if the Executive elects (in accordance with the provisions of clause 15.5(c) above) to defer payment with respect to all or any of his 2007, 2008 and 2009 LEAP Award Shares the Gross-Up Payment shall be calculated as if payment with respect to such of those awards in respect of which he so elects to defer payment were received on 15 March of the year after the end of the l&P Period (as defined in LEAP and LEAP III as applicable) in respect of such award; and

 

 

(iii)

for purposes of this clause 15.5, the Executive’s “2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 and 2008 LEAP Award Shares” shall mean the aggregate number of Matching Shares and Dividend Fund Shares payable with respect to the Executive’s US Awards granted respectively in 2004, 2005, 2007 and 2008 and with respect to his UK Awards granted respectively in 2004, 2005, 2006, 2007 and 2008 in all cases under LEAP as of the Vesting Date (as defined in the LEAP) with respect to such Shares, as determined by the Compensation Committee and the Executive’s 2009 LEAP Award Shares shall mean the aggregate number of Matching Shares and Dividend Fund Shares payable with respect to the Executive’s US Award granted in 2009 and with respect to his UK Award granted in 2009 under LEAP III as of the Vesting Date (as defined in the LEAP III) with respect to such Shares, as determined by the Compensation Committee.

For the avoidance of doubt the Company shall not be required to make any Gross-Up Payment with respect to any Excise Taxes that are not actually paid by or on behalf of the Executive.

 

15.6

Notwithstanding any provision in clause 15.4 or clause 15.5 to the contrary, any Gross-up Payment payable to the Executive thereunder or any indemnification to be made thereunder to

 

22140645/10/L

12


 

the Executive with respect to any Excise Tax or income or employment taxes payable by him and interest or penalties imposed with respect thereto, shall be made to the Executive by no later that the date by which the Excise Tax, income or employment taxes, interest or penalties to which such Gross-up Payment or indemnification relates are due and payable to the applicable taxing authorities, or if the amount of such Gross-up Payment or indemnification cannot be determined as of such date, as soon thereafter as it can be determined but in any event by no later that by December 31 of the year following the year in which such taxes, interest or penalties are remitted to the applicable taxing authorities.

 

15.7

Notwithstanding the foregoing, with regard to any payment to be made to the Executive by the Company hereunder, the Company shall be required to withhold taxes and transmit such taxes to the appropriate governmental authority in accordance with applicable law, and any payment made to the Executive by the Company hereunder shall be net of such withholding.

 

16

CONFIDENTIAL INFORMATION

 

16.1

The Executive shall not (except in the proper performance of his duties hereunder or the proper performance of his duties and obligations as an executive of the Company or a Group Company) either during the Term of Employment or at any time after the termination thereof divulge to any person whomsoever or otherwise make use of and shall use his reasonable endeavours at the cost of the Company to prevent the publication or disclosure of any trade secret or other confidential information concerning the business, finances, dealings, transactions or affairs of the Company or any Group Company or of any of their respective customers or clients (which information belongs to the Company or a Group Company) entrusted to the Executive or arising or coming to the Executive’s knowledge during the course of the Term of Employment under this Agreement.

 

16.2

The Executive shall upon the termination of the Term of Employment immediately deliver to the Company all price lists of customers’ correspondence and other documents papers and property belonging to the Company or any Group Company which may have been prepared by him or have come into his possession during the Term of Employment and shall not retain any copies thereof. Anything herein to the contrary notwithstanding, and subject always to the Executive providing full details to the Company in writing beforehand, the Executive shall be entitled to retain:

 

 

(a)

papers and other materials of a personal nature, including, but not limited to, photographs, correspondence, personal diaries, calendars and Rolodexes, personal files and personal phone books;

 

 

(b)

information regarding the Executive’s compensation and/or benefits or relating to reimbursement of expenses;

 

 

(c)

information that the Executive needs for personal tax purposes; and

 

 

(d)

copies of plans, programs and agreements relating to the Executive’s provision of services to the Company (or the termination of such services) having made a written request to the Company detailing what is required beforehand.

 

16.3

The Executive shall not have any liability under the provisions of this Agreement by reason of:

 

 

(a)

using or divulging knowledge or information, by reason of legal or accounting requirements or, after the termination of the Term of Employment hereunder, which would not at the time

 

22140645/10/L

13


 

of use or divulging be considered confidential or proprietary to, or capable of protection by, the Company in accordance with customary business practices in the United States of America;

 

 

(b)

any act or statement done or made by the Executive at the request of the Company or any Group Company or required to be done or made for the proper performance of duties under this Agreement;

 

 

(c)

use or disclosure of information which at the time is in public domain;

 

 

(d)

by reason of such disclosure being required by law or by any Court, mediator, arbitrator or legislative or regulatory body (including any committee thereof) either in the United Kingdom or the USA with actual or apparent jurisdiction to order disclosure or the making accessible of such information; or

 

 

(e)

in connection with any litigation, mediation or arbitration involving this Agreement, the UK Service Agreement, the Appointment Letter and/or the UK Employment Contract, including any enforcement of such agreements.

 

16.4

The Executive shall not knowingly at any time make any untrue statement which shall when made result in a violation of any statutory requirement or the regulations of any competent authority, in relation to the Company or any Group Company and in particular shall not after the termination of the Term of Employment wrongfully represent himself as being employed by or connected with any such company.

 

17

ASSIGNABILITY: BINDING NATURE

This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Parties and their respective successors, heirs (in the case of the Executive) and assigns. No rights or obligations of the Company under this Agreement may be assigned or transferred by the Company except that such rights or obligations may be assigned or transferred pursuant to a merger or consolidation in which the Company is not the continuing entity, or the sale or liquidation of all or substantially all of the assets of the Company, provided that the assignee or transferee is the successor to all or substantially all of the assets of the Company and such assignee or transferee assumes the liabilities, obligations and duties of the Company, as contained in this Agreement, either contractually or as a matter of law. The Company further agrees that, in the event of a sale of assets or liquidation as described in the preceding sentence, the Company shall take whatever action it legally can in order to cause such assignee or transferee to expressly assume the liabilities, obligations and duties of the Company hereunder. No rights or obligations of the Executive under this Agreement may be assigned or transferred by the Executive other than his rights to compensation and benefits, which may be transferred only by will or operation of law except as provided in clause 26 below.

 

18

ENFORCEMENT OF RIGHT

 

18.1

No failure to exercise or delay in exercising or enforcing any right or remedy under this Agreement shall constitute a waiver thereof and no single or partial exercise or enforcement of any right or remedy under this Agreement shall preclude or restrict the further exercise or enforcement of any such right or remedy. The rights and remedies of the Parties are cumulative and not exclusive of any rights and remedies provided by law.

 

22140645/10/L

14


18.2

Except as otherwise provided in the second sentence of this clause 18.2, time shall not be of the essence in this Agreement, but may be made so on the giving of not less than two clear days’ (other than a Saturday, Sunday or public holiday in England and Wales) notice to that effect after any failure to comply with any provision of this Agreement To the extent required to avoid any violation of the requirements of Code section 409A, time shall be of the essence as to the provisions herein specifying the time for payment of any amount payable to the Executive that is subject to Code section 409A, or that would be subject to Code section 409A if not paid by the time specified herein for the payment of such amount.

 

19

INDEMNIFICATION

 

19.1

The Company agrees that if the Executive is made a party, or is threatened to be made a party, to any action, suit or proceeding (including a request for discovery), whether civil, criminal, administrative or investigative ( “Proceeding” ), by reason of the fact that he is or was a director, executive, officer or employee of the Company or is or was serving at the request of the Company as a director, executive, officer, member, employee, trustee or agent of another corporation, partnership, joint venture, trust or other enterprise, including service with respect to employee benefit plans, whether or not the basis of such Proceeding is the Executive’s alleged action in an official capacity while serving as a director, executive, officer, member, employee, trustee or agent, the Executive shall be indemnified and held harmless by the Company to the fullest extent legally permitted or authorised by the Company’s certificate of incorporation or bylaws or resolutions of the Board or, if greater, by the laws of the State of Delaware, against all cost expense, liability and loss (including, without limitation, attorney’s fees, judgments, fines, ERISA excise taxes or penalties and amounts paid or to be paid in settlement) reasonably incurred or suffered by the Executive in connection therewith, and such indemnification shall continue as to the Executive even if he has ceased to be a director, executive, officer, member, employee, trustee or agent of the Company or other entity and shall inure to the benefit of the Executive’s heirs, executors and administrators. The Company shall advance to the Executive all reasonable costs and properly vouched expenses incurred by him in connection with a Proceeding within 20 days after receipt by the Company of a written request for such advance. Such request shall include an undertaking by the Executive to repay the amount of such advance if it shall ultimately be determined that he is not entitled to be indemnified against such costs and expenses.

 

19.2

Neither the failure of the Company (including the Board, independent legal counsel or stockholders) to have made a determination prior to the commencement of any proceeding concerning payment of amounts claimed by the Executive under clause 19.1 above that indemnification of the Executive is proper because he has met the applicable standard of conduct, nor a determination by the Company (including the Board, independent legal counsel or stockholders) that the Executive has not met such applicable standard of conduct, shall create a presumption that the Executive has not met the applicable standard of conduct

 

19.3

The Company agrees to continue and maintain a directors’ and officers’ liability insurance policy covering the Executive to the extent the Company provides such coverage for its other senior executive officers.

 

20

CODE SECTION 409A

Notwithstanding any provision to the contrary in this Agreement or in any plan maintained by the Company or any of its Affiliates in which the Executive is a participant or in any other agreement

 

22140645/10/L

15


between the Executive and the Company and any of its Affiliates (each such plan or agreement a “Plan” ), if the Executive is a “specified employee” within the meaning of Code section 409A at the time of his “separation from service” with the Company and all of its Affiliates within the meaning of Code section 409A (as determined by the Company and its Affiliates), then any payment otherwise required to be made to the Executive under any Plan on account of the Executive’s separation from service, to the extent such payment (after taking into account all exclusions applicable to such payment under Code section 409A) is properly treated as deferred compensation subject to Code section 409A’s requirements, shall not be made until the first business day after (i) the expiration of six (6) months from the date of the Executive’s separation from service, or (ii) if earlier, the date of the Executive’s death (the “Delayed Payment Date” ). On the Delayed Payment Date, there shall be paid to the Executive or, if the Executive has died, to the Executive’s estate, all payments delayed pursuant to the preceding sentence, plus, in the case of any cash amounts payment of which was so delayed, interest thereon at the Delayed Payment Interest Rate (as defined below) computed from the date on which each such delayed payment otherwise would have been made to the Executive until the Delayed Payment Date. For purposes of the foregoing, the “Delayed Payment Interest Rate” shall mean the national average annual rate of interest payable on jumbo six-month bank certificates of deposit, as quoted in the business section of the most recently published Sunday edition of The New York Times preceding the date as of which the Executive is treated as having incurred a separation from service for purposes of Section 409A. In the case of each Plan under which the Executive is entitled to receive amounts treated as deferred compensation subject to the Code section 409A and which provides for payment of such amounts in the form of “a series of installment payments”, as defined in Treas. Reg. §1.409A-2(b)(2)(iii), (A) the Executive’s right to receive such payments shall be treated as a right to receive a series of separate payments under Treas. Reg. §1.409A-2(b)(2)(iii), and (B) to the extent such Plan does not already so provide, it is hereby amended to so provide, with respect to amounts payable to the Executive thereunder.

 

21

REPRESENTATION

The Company represents and warrants that it is fully authorised and empowered to enter into this Agreement and that the performance of its obligations under this Agreement will not violate any agreement between it or any other person, firm or organisation. The Executive represents that he knows of no agreement between him and any other person, firm or organisation (other than the UK Employment Contract and the Appointment Letter) that would be violated by the performance of his obligations under this Agreement

 

22

ENTIRE AGREEMENT

This Agreement contains the entire understanding and agreement between the Parties concerning the subject matter hereof and supersedes all prior agreements, understandings, discussions, negotiations and undertakings, whether written or oral, between discussions, negotiations and undertakings, whether written or oral, between the Parties with respect thereto including the agreement entered into on 16 August 2004 (other than any agreements with respect to any outstanding equity awards, including equity agreements providing for settlement in cash or other non-equity assets).

 

23

AMENDMENT OR WAIVER

No provision in this Agreement may be amended unless such amendment is agreed to in writing and signed by the Executive and an authorised officer of the Company (other than the

 

22140645/10/L

16


Executive). No waiver by either Party of any breach by the other Party of any condition or provision contained in this Agreement to be performed by such other party shall be deemed a waiver of a similar or dissimilar condition or provision at the same or any prior or subsequent time. Any waiver must be in writing and signed by the Executive or an authorised officer of the Company (other than the Executive), as the case may be.

 

24

SEVERABILITY

In the event that any provision or portion of this Agreement shall be determined to be invalid or unenforceable for any reason, in whole or in part, the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall be unaffected thereby and shall remain in full force and effect to the fullest extent permitted by law.

 

25

SURVIVORSHIP

The respective rights and obligations of the Parties under this Agreement shall survive any termination of the Term of Employment to the extent necessary to the intended preservation of such rights and obligations.

 

26

BENEFICIARIES/REFERENCES

The Executive shall be entitled, to the extent permitted under any applicable law to select and change a beneficiary or beneficiaries to receive any compensation or benefit payable hereunder following the Executive’s death by giving the Company written notice thereof. In the event of the Executive’s death or a judicial declaration of his incompetence, reference in this Agreement to the Executive shall be deemed, where appropriate, to refer to his beneficiary, estate or other legal representative.

 

27

GOVERNING LAW/JURISDICTION

 

27.1

This Agreement shall be governed by and construed and interpreted in accordance with the laws of New York without reference to principles of conflict of laws.

 

27.2

Any judicial proceeding brought against either of the Parties on any dispute arising out of this Agreement or any matter related hereto may be brought in the courts of the State of New York and in the United States District Court for the Southern District of New York, and by execution and delivery of this Agreement, each of the Parties accepts for himself or itself the exclusive jurisdiction of the aforesaid courts and irrevocably agrees to be bound by any judgment rendered thereby in connection with this Agreement Each of the Parties irrevocably waives to the fullest extent permitted by-law any objection that he or it may now or hereafter have to the laying of the venue of any judicial proceeding brought in such courts and any claim that any such judicial proceeding has been brought in an inconvenient forum.

 

28

NOTICES

 

28.1

Any notice required or permitted to be given hereunder shall be given in writing delivered personally or sent by first class post prepaid recorded delivery (or if via United States mail, by certified or registered mail, postage prepaid, return receipt requested) or by telefax to the Company at its registered office from time to time (or such address as it may have notified to the

 

22140645/10/L

17


 

Executive in accordance with this clause) or to the Executive at the last address notified to the Company.

 

28.2

Any notice delivered personally shall be deemed to be received when delivered to the address referred to in clause 28.1 and any notice sent by pre-paid recorded delivery post (or if via United States mail, by certified or registered mail, postage prepaid, return receipt requested) shall be deemed (in the absence of evidence of earlier receipt) to be received two days after posting and in proving the time of dispatch it shall be sufficient to show that the envelope containing such notice was properly addressed, stamped and posted. A notice sent by telefax shall be deemed to have been received on receipt by the sender of the correct “answerback”.

 

29

HEADINGS

The headings of the sections contained in this Agreement are for convenience only and shall not be deemed to control or affect the meaning or construction of any provision of this Agreement.

 

30

EXCHANGE RATE

Where any amount is expressed as a sterling amount it shall be converted into United States dollars at the rate prevailing on the due date for payment and paid in United States Dollars.

 

31

COUNTERPARTS

This Agreement may be executed in two or more counterparts.

 

WPP Group USA, Inc.

By:

 

LOGO

 

Sir Martin Stuart Sorrell

By:

 

Martin Sorrell

 

22140645/10/L

18


SCHEDULE 1

Calculation of Base Salary, Bonus and Pension Contributions

 

1

In addition to the definitions above in this Agreement, the following words and expressions shall have the following meanings except where inconsistent with the context.

“Aggregate Time” the aggregate of US Time and Services Time in respect of a calendar year.

“Aggregate Basic Income” means, as at the date of this Agreement the sum of £1,000,000 per annum as that sum may be adjusted pursuant to Paragraph 3 of Schedule 1.

“Aggregate Pensions Provision” the aggregate of the Pensions Contribution payable in respect of a calendar year under clause 12.3 of this Agreement and the Pensions Contributions payable under clause 11.3 of the UK Employment Contract being at the date of this Agreement £400,000 and subsequently such higher sum as may be agreed between the Company and the Executive for any year before the first day of January of that year, which in no event shall be less than 40% of the Aggregate Basic Income.

“Services Time” the aggregate of the amount of time (computed in working days) which the Director has spent during a calendar year in the provision of services pursuant to the UK Employment Contract as the case may be.

“US Time” the aggregate of the amount of time (computed in working days) which the Director has spent during a calendar year in performing the duties of his employment pursuant to this Agreement.

 

2

The annual Base Salary payable under clause 7.1 of the Agreement shall be calculated by applying the following formula:

 

 

Amount of annual Base Salary =

  

US Time

  
 

Aggregate Basic Income x

     
    

Aggregate Time

  

 

3

The Base Salary payable under clause 7.1 shall be reviewed (but not downwards) from time to time in accordance with the practices adopted by the Company’s Board of Directors on the recommendations from time to time of its Compensation Committee and, in reviewing the Base Salary, regard shall be had to how those practices and recommendations apply to the senior executives of the Company and the Group’s senior executives and due regard shall also be had to the practices of the Parent’s peer group in relation to their chief executive officers.

 

4

The Pensions Contribution payable under clause 12.3 of this Agreement shall be calculated by applying the following formula:

 

 

Pensions Contribution = Aggregate

  

US Time

  
 

Pensions Provision x

     
    

Aggregate Time

  

 

5

At all times and immediately after the end of each calendar year, the Executive will provide to the Company full details of the Aggregate Time, including US Time which the Executive has spent in that calendar year. The Company is entitled to rely without inquiry on any notice of the amount of Aggregate Time and US Time which the Executive has provided to the Company for any calendar year.

 

22140645/10/L

19

Exhibit 8.1

 

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

 

United States

  

141 Hawaii, LLC

   Delaware

141 Worldwide Boomerang Inc.

   Delaware

24/7 Real Media US, Inc.

   Delaware

24/7 Real Media, Inc.

   Delaware

A. Eicoff & Company, Inc.

   Delaware

AAD:Fitch Architecture, PLLC

   New York

AAD:Fitch, Inc.

   Arizona

Absolute Color LLC

   Delaware

Advertising Ventures Inc.

   Delaware

All Global LLC

   New York

Avenue Grey Inc.

   Delaware

Avon Group, Inc.

   Connecticut

Baker, Winokur, Ryder, Inc.

   California

Barleycorn LLC

   Delaware

Bates Advertising USA, Inc.

   New York

Bates Worldwide, Inc.

   Delaware

Berlin, Cameron & Partners, Inc.

   Delaware

Blast Radius, Inc.

   Delaware

Blue Interactive Marketing Inc.

   Delaware

Blue Sky Green LLC

   Delaware

Blue State Digital Inc.

   Delaware

BrandEdge Inc.

   Delaware

Bridge Worldwide LLC

   Delaware

BSB Club Bar, Inc.

   New York

Burson-Marsteller, LLC

   Delaware

Capital IV LLC

   Delaware

Center Partners, Inc.

   Delaware

Cheskin

   California

Cole & Weber, Inc.

   Oregon

Commodore Thompson Music, Inc.

   Delaware

Compas, Inc.

   New Jersey

Compete, Inc.

   Delaware

Competitive Media Reporting, LLC

   Delaware

Cordiant Finance, Inc.

   Delaware

Cordiant US Holdings, Inc.

   Delaware

Crescendo Productions Inc.

   New York

Current Medical Directions, LLC

   Delaware

Cygnet Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Cymfony, Inc.

   Delaware

Datacore Marketing, LLC

   Delaware

Dewey Square Group, LLC

   Delaware

Digitaria Interactive, Inc.

   California

Direct.com LLC

   Delaware

Drummer Associates, Inc.

   California

DynamicLogic, Inc.

   Delaware

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Elemental Interactive Design & Development Inc.

   Georgia

Enfatico LLC

   Delaware

Extension 11, Inc.

   California

Eyepatch LA Inc.

   California

Eyepatch Productions, Inc.

   New York

FAST4WD Ogilvy US, Inc.

   Delaware

Finsbury US LLC

   Delaware

Fitch Inc.

   Ohio

Food Group, Inc.

   New York

Fortelligent LLC

   Delaware

FOVA Inc.

   Delaware

Future Vision Media LLC

   Michigan

G2 Refinery LLC

   Delaware

G2 Worldwide Inc.

   New York

Geoff Howe Marketing Communications, Inc.

   Missouri

Global Strategies Holding Inc.

   Delaware

Global Strategies International, LLC

   Connecticut

Go Direct LLC

   Delaware

Good Neighbor Foundation Inc.

   New York

Grey Direct Services Inc.

   Delaware

Grey Global Atlanta Inc.

   Delaware

Grey Global Group Inc.

   Delaware

Grey Healthcare Group Inc.

   New York

Grey IFC 2 LLC

   Delaware

Grey IFC LLC

   Delaware

Grey India Inc.

   Delaware

Grey Maryland LLC

   Delaware

Grey Ventures Inc.

   Delaware

Grey Worldwide Inc. (US)

   Delaware

Grey Worldwide Los Angeles Inc.

   Delaware

Group M Movie Entertainment Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Group M Movie Entertainment, Inc.

   Delaware

Group M Worldwide, Inc.

   Delaware

GWE Inc.

   New York

HealthAnswers Education LLC

   Delaware

Healthworld Corporation

   Delaware

Healthworld International Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Hi Resolution Inc.

   New York

Hill & Knowlton/Samcor LLC

   Delaware

Hill and Knowlton, Inc.

   Delaware

HLS Holding LLC (DEL)

   Delaware

Hurd Studios Inc.

   Delaware

I-Behavior Inc.

   Delaware
 

 

1


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Icodia Inc.

   California

icon International, Inc.

   Delaware

IEG, LLC

   Delaware

Imaginet LLC

   Minnesota

Innovative Customer Solutions LLC

   Delaware

Insight Medical Communications Inc.

   Delaware

International Meetings & Science Inc.

   Delaware

J. Walter Thompson Company

   Delaware

J. Walter Thompson Company Caribbean

   Delaware

J. Walter Thompson Company Peruana

   Delaware

J. Walter Thompson Far Eastern Company

   Delaware

J. Walter Thompson U.S.A., Inc.

   Delaware

J. Walter Thompson Venture Company, Limited

   Delaware

JWT - Music, Inc.

   Delaware

JWT Holdings, Inc.

   Delaware

JWT SO5 LLC

   Delaware

JWT Specialized Communications, Inc.

   California

JWT/OgilvyAction Inc.

   Delaware

JWTWO Productions LLC

   Delaware

Kantar Health Inc.

   Delaware

Kantar Media Research, Inc.

   Delaware

Kantar Retail America, Inc.

   Delaware

Kantar Retail LLC

   Delaware

Kazaam! Inc.

   New York

KMR Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

KnowledgeBase Marketing Inc.

   Delaware

Landor Associates International Ltd.

   California

Landor Ohio LLC

   Delaware

Landor, LLC

   Delaware

Leopard Communications Inc.

   Colorado

Level 2 Post LLC

   Delaware

Lighthouse Global Network, Inc.

   Delaware

Lightspeed Online Research LLC

   Delaware

LiveWorld-WPP, L.L.C.

   Delaware

Local Marketing Corporation

   Ohio

Love Bug Productions LLC

   Delaware

M 80 Services, Inc.

   California

Marketing and Planning Systems LLC

   Delaware

Marketing Direct LLC

   Delaware

Mather Productions, LLC

   Delaware

Maxus Communications LLC

   Delaware

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Maxx Marketing Inc.

   Nevada

ME Scholar LLC

   Delaware

Media Innovation Group, LLC

   Delaware

Mediacom Worldwide Inc.

   Delaware

Mediaedge:cia, LLC

   Delaware

Millward Brown, Inc.

   Illinois

Mindshare Days Productions, LLC

   Delaware

Mindshare Entertainment USA, LLC

   Delaware

Mindshare USA, LLC

   New York

MJM Creative Services, Inc.

   New York

mOne Worldwide LLC

   Delaware

MosaicaMD, Inc.

   Delaware

MRB Group, Inc.

   New York

MRC Holdco, Inc.

   Delaware

MSB, Inc.

   Delaware

Nectar Acquisition LLC

   Delaware

neo@Ogilvy LLC

   Delaware

NFO Asia-Pacific, Inc.

   Delaware

NFO Europe, Inc.

   Delaware

O&M After-Hours Club, Inc.

   New York

Ogilvy & Mather Songs, Inc.

   New York

Ogilvy & Mather Venture Company, Limited

   Delaware

Ogilvy & Mather Worldwide, Inc.

   New York

Ogilvy CommonHealth Worldwide LLC

   Delaware

Ogilvy Healthworld, LLC

   Delaware

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide Inc.

   Delaware

OgilvyAction LLC

   Delaware

OgilvyOne, LLC

   Delaware

Osprey Communications Inc.

   Connecticut

Outrider North America LLC

   Delaware

Owl Group Holdings, Inc.

   Delaware

Pace Communications Group, Inc.

   New York

Palisades Media Ventures LLC

   Delaware

Peclers Paris North America, Inc.

   Delaware

Penn, Schoen & Berland Associates, LLC

   Delaware

Penny Black Media LLC

   Delaware

PERQ/HCI, LLC

   Delaware

Phase Five Communications Inc.

   Delaware

Piranha Kid LLC

   Delaware

Planetactive LLC

   Delaware

Poster Publicity Inc.

   Delaware

Preferred Professionals Inc.

   New York

Prime Policy Group, LLC

   Delaware

Promotion Mechanics, Inc.

   Delaware
 

 

2


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH

ORGANISED

Public Relations & International Sports Marketing, Inc.

   Delaware

Public Strategies, Inc.

   Texas

Quinn Gillespie & Associates LLC

   Delaware

Rasor Communications Inc.

   Delaware

Rasor Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Red Magasin, Inc.

   Delaware

RedWorks, Inc.

   Delaware

Reese Communications Companies, Inc.

   District Of Columbia

Ring Retail LLC

   Delaware

Robinson Lerer & Montgomery, LLC

   Delaware

S&S MCC and MCC. Inc.

   New York

Schematic Inc.

   California

Schematic Latin America, LLC

   Delaware

SCPF America LLC

   Delaware

Secondary Holding Company L.L.C.

   Delaware

Sentinel Productions, Ltd.

   New York

Soho Square Public Relations Inc.

   New York

Soho Square, Inc.

   Delaware

Spafax Airline Network Inc.

   Delaware

Strategic Information Management, Inc.

   Indiana

Studio 466 Inc.

   New York

Studio 58 Inc.

   Delaware

Studiocom.com Inc.

   Georgia

Sudler & Hennessey, LLC

   Delaware

Summit Grey Inc.

   New York

Taxi, Inc.

   Delaware

TeamDetroit Stat LLC

   Delaware

TeamDetroit, Inc.

   Delaware

Ted Bates Worldwide Inc.

   New York

Tempus Group North America Holdings LLC

   Delaware

The Brand Union Company, Inc.

   New York

The Farm LA, Inc.

   Delaware

The Focus Network Inc.

   New York

The GCI Group LLC

   Delaware

The Geppetto Group LLC

   Delaware

The Harvard Group Inc.

   New York

The Leonhardt Group Inc.

   Washington

The Leverage Group Inc.

   New York

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

The Midas Exchange Inc.

   Delaware

The Ogilvy Group, Inc.

   New York

The Partners (Brand Consultants) LLC

   Delaware

The Reality Shop Inc.

   Delaware

The Tape Center Inc.

   Delaware

TNS Acquisition 2010, Inc.

   Delaware

TNS Custom Research, Inc.

   Pennsylvania

TNS Ireland LLC

   Delaware

TNS Media Research, LLC

   Delaware

TNS North America, Inc.

   Delaware

Umagination Labs, L.P.

   Delaware

VF Holding I Inc.

   Delaware

VML, Inc.

   Missouri

Vogel-Farina LLC

   Delaware

WPP Deliver LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Eight) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Eighteen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Eleven) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Fifteen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Five) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Four) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Fourteen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Nine) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Nineteen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (One) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Seven) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Seventeen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Six) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Sixteen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Ten) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Thirteen) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Three) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twelve) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twenty) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twenty-One) LLC

   Delaware
 

 

3


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twenty-Three) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twenty-Two) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Two) LLC

   Delaware

WPP Finance Square LLC

   Delaware

WPP Global Technology Services LLC

   Delaware

WPP Group Holdings Corp.

   Delaware

WPP Group Holdings Corp. II

   Delaware

WPP Group Management Inc.

   Delaware

WPP Group MTV III Holding LLC

   Delaware

WPP Group U.S. Finance Corp.

   Delaware

WPP Group US Investments, Inc.

   Delaware

WPP Group USA, Inc.

   Delaware

WPP Luxembourg Square LLC

   Delaware

WPP Properties

   Delaware

WPP Team Chemistry LLC

   Delaware

WPP US Holdings, Inc.

   Delaware

WPP/MIG Holdings, LLC

   Delaware

WPPIH 2001, Inc.

   Delaware

WPPTP Marketing, LLC IN

   Delaware

Wunderman Media LLC

   Delaware

Wunderman Worldwide, LLC

   Nevada

Y&R Asia Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Y&R Far East Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Y&R Latin American Holding Co.

   Delaware

Y&R PARTNER THREE L.L.C.

   Delaware

Y&R Properties Holdings One LLC

   Delaware

Y&R SNC Holdings-II, L.L.C.

   Delaware

Yankelovich Holdings Inc.

   Delaware

Yankelovich Partners LLC

   Delaware

York Merger Square 2004 LLC

   Delaware

York Merger Square 2009 Corp.

   Delaware

Young & Rubicam Inc.

   Delaware

Non-US

  
J Walter Thompson (Algeria) SARL    Algeria
Taylor Nelson Sofres S.a.r.l.    Algeria

141 Bonta S.A.

   Argentina

ADHL S.A.

   Argentina

Burson-Marsteller S.A.

   Argentina

Grey Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

Hill & Knowlton de Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

Información y Decisión Consultores, S.A.

   Argentina

J Walter Thompson Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

JWT S.A.

   Argentina

LatinPanel Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Mediacom Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

MindShare Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

Multigap S.A.

   Argentina

Ogilvy & Mather Argentina S.A.

   Argentina

Red Cell S.A.

   Argentina

Santo Buenos Aires S.A.

   Argentina

SMA S.A.

   Argentina

The Mediaedge S.A.

   Argentina

Thompson Connect Worldwide S.A.

   Argentina

TNS Gallup SA (Argentina)

   Argentina

Wunderman Cato Johnson S.A.

   Argentina

Y&R Inversiones Publicitarias S.A.

   Argentina

Young & Rubicam S.A.

   Argentina

20:20 Brand Action Pty Limited

   Australia

24/7 Real Media Pty Ltd.

   Australia

ABKP Ideaworks Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Added Value Australia Pty Limited

   Australia

Beyond Interactive Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Blaze Advertising Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Burson-Marsteller Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Candle Lit Films Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Carl Byoir & Associates Australia Pty. Limited

   Australia

CAW Marketing Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

Chameleon Digital Systems Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Collins Thomas Cullen Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Corplite Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Daipro Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

Dialog Marketing Communications Pty Ltd.

   Australia

ENFATICO PTY LTD.

   Australia

eSaratoga Lab Pty Ltd.

   Australia

EWA Heidelberg Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Expanded Media Holdings Pty Limited

   Australia

Expanded Media Investments Pty Limited

   Australia

Financial & Management Services (Australia) Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Fudge Group Pty Ltd.

   Australia

G2 Graffiti Pty Ltd.

   Australia

G2 Pty Ltd.

   Australia

GCI Group Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

George Patterson Partners Pty Limited

   Australia

George Patterson Y&R Pty Limited

   Australia

Glendinning Management Consultants Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia
 

 

4


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey Australia New Zealand Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

Grey Canberra Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Grey Global Group Australia Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

Grey Healthcare Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

Grey Healthcare Unit Trust

   Australia

Grey Worldwide Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

Group Employee Services Pty Limited

   Australia

GroupM Communications Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Hill and Knowlton Australia Pty. Limited

   Australia

Howorth Communications Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Ideaworks (Holdings) Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Ideaworks Collateral Services Pty Limited

   Australia

Ideaworks Design Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Ideaworks Environmental Design Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Ideaworks Media Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Impact Employee Communications Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Interface Advertising Pty Ltd.

   Australia

ITX Corporation Pty Ltd.

   Australia

J Walter Thompson Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Jay Grey Pty Ltd.

   Australia

JWT Specialised Communications Pty Limited

   Australia

Kinetic Worldwide Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Landor Associates Pty Limited

   Australia

Lightspeed Research Australia Pty Limited

   Australia

M Media Group Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Marketing Communications Holdings Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Maxx Marketing Pty Limited

   Australia

Mediacom Australia Pty Limited

   Australia

Mediacompete Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Mediaedge:cia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Millward Brown Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Mindshare Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Motivator Media Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Ogilvy Healthworld Pty Limited

   Australia

Ogilvy Health PR Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide Pty Limited

   Australia

Outrider Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Phase Five Pty Ltd.

   Australia

PPR (WA) Pty Ltd.

   Australia

PR Dynamics Australia Pty Limited

   Australia

Premier Automotive Advertising Pty Ltd.

   Australia

PRISM Team Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Professional Public Relations Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Pulse Communications Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Research International Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Salespoint Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Sudler & Hennessey Australia Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Taylor Nelson Sofres Asia Pacific Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Taylor Nelson Sofres Australia Proprietary Limited

   Australia

The Added Value Group (Aust.) Pty Ltd.

   Australia

The Campaign Palace Melbourne Unit Trust

   Australia

The Campaign Palace Pty Limited

   Australia

The Campaign Palace Sydney Unit Trust

   Australia

The Communications Group Holdings Pty Ltd.

   Australia

WhizzbangArt Pty. Ltd.

   Australia

WPP Holdings (Australia) Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Wunderman Pty Limited

   Australia

Young & Rubicam Brands Holding Pty Ltd.

   Australia

Young & Rubicam Brands Pty Limited

   Australia

Young & Rubicam Group Pty Limited

   Australia

Young & Rubicam Pty Limited

   Australia

141 Austria Werbeagentur GmbH

   Austria

aha puttner red cell Werbeagentur GmbH

   Austria

DavidO Werbeagentur GmbH

   Austria

Engage CEE GmbH

   Austria

GroupM Holding GmbH

   Austria

International Facilities Holding GmbH

   Austria

JWT Wien Werbeangentur Gesellschaft mbH

   Austria

Maxus Media Communications GmbH

   Austria
 

 

5


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

“MediaCom” Agentur fur Media Beratung, Planug - Forschung und Einkauf Gesellschaft m.b.H.

   Austria

Mediaedge:cia GmbH

   Austria

MindShare GmbH & Co. KG

   Austria

Ogilvy & Mather CIS Media Services GmbH

   Austria

Ogilvy & Mather Gesellschaft m.b.H.

   Austria

Ogilvy & Mather Media Services GmbH

   Austria

Ogilvy & Mather Media Services GmbH & Co. KG

   Austria

OgilvyInteractive Worldwide Multimedia Beratung GmbH

   Austria

OgilvyOne worldwide Werbeagentur und Marketingberatung GmbH

   Austria

Red Cell Werbeagentur Gesellschaft mbH

   Austria

Redworks GmbH

   Austria

rmg:connect Marketing Gesellschaft mbH

   Austria

Wunderman Direct Marketing Agentur GmbH

   Austria

Young & Rubicam Vienna GmbH

   Austria

AMRB MENA W.L.L.

   Bahrain

Gulf Hill & Knowlton WLL

   Bahrain

Intermarkets Bahrain S.P.C.

   Bahrain

J Walter Thompson - Bahrain WLL

   Bahrain

J Walter Thompson Middle East and North Africa E.C.

   Bahrain

TNS Middle East & Africa WLL (Bahrain)

   Bahrain
Grey Advertising (Bangladesh) Ltd.    Bangladesh
Ogilvy & Mather Communications Private Limited    Bangladesh

Software People Bangladesh Limited

   Bangladesh

Behigh SA

   Belgium

Burson-Marsteller sprl/bvba

   Belgium

Dimarso S.A.

   Belgium

Dorland & Grey SA

   Belgium

Friday Communications SA

   Belgium

GroupM Belgium SA

   Belgium

Hill & Knowlton International Belgium SA

   Belgium

J Walter Thompson SA

   Belgium

Kinetic Belgium SA

   Belgium

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

LDV United NV

   Belgium

Ludon SA

   Belgium

Marketing Services Risk Surety Ltd.

   Belgium

Media+ SA

   Belgium

Mediaedge:cia Belgium SA

   Belgium

Mindshare SA

   Belgium

NID SA

   Belgium

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide SA

   Belgium

Ogilvy Shared Services SA

   Belgium

Ogilvy & Mather SA

   Belgium

OgilvyOne Worldwide SA

   Belgium

Redworks S.A.

   Belgium

Sobemap Marketing NV

   Belgium

Sudler & Hennessey Belgium SA

   Belgium

Tagora SA

   Belgium

The European Omnibus Survey scrl

   Belgium

These Days NV

   Belgium

WPP Algani SNC

   Belgium

WPP Group Services SNC

   Belgium

Wunderman NV

   Belgium

Young & Rubicam Belgium SPRL

   Bermuda

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide SA

   Bolivia

Redworks S.A.

   Bolivia

141 SoHo Square Comunicação Ltda

   Brazil

9ine Sports & Entertainment Consultoria Ltda

   Brazil

Ação Produções Gráficas e Electrônicas Ltda

   Brazil

Action Line Telemarketing do Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

Bates Latin America Holdings Ltda

   Brazil

Bates Propaganda e Produções Ltda

   Brazil

Burson Marsteller Ltda

   Brazil

CBBA Propaganda Ltda

   Brazil

DCSNET SA

   Brazil

Energia Brasil Propaganda Ltda

   Brazil

Energia, Y&R Communicações de Varejo Ltda

   Brazil

Energy Marketing & Communição Ltda

   Brazil

G2.Grey Comunicação e Marketing Ltda

   Brazil

Goldfarb Consultants Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

GPAT S.A. - Propaganda e Publicidade

   Brazil

Grey Communição Ltda

   Brazil
 

 

6


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey Interactive Ltda

   Brazil

Grey Zest Direct Marketing e Publicidade Ltda

   Brazil

Hill & Knowlton Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

HotWorks Comunicação Ltda

   Brazil

ICherry Publicidade E Propoganda Ltda

   Brazil

J Walter Thompson Publicidade Ltda

   Brazil

LatinPanel do Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

Marketdata Solutions Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

Marsteller Limitada

   Brazil

Master Pubicidade SA

   Brazil

Millward Brown do Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

Newcomm Holdings Ltda

   Brazil

Newdesign Participações Ltda

   Brazil

Ogilvy Publicidade Ltda

   Brazil

Ogilvy & Mather Brasil Comunicação Ltda

   Brazil

OgilvyInteractive Brasil Comunicação Ltda

   Brazil

OgilvyOne Brasil Comunicação Ltda

   Brazil

One Publicidade Ltda

   Brazil

P2All Serviços Temporários Ltda

   Brazil

PTR Comunicações Ltda

   Brazil

RMG Connect Comunicação Ltda

   Brazil

Supermirella Participações Ltda

   Brazil

TNS Interscience S.A.

   Brazil

TNS Interscience Serviços S.A.

   Brazil

TNS Serviços de Pesquisa de Mercado Ltda

   Brazil

Tribeca Propaganda Publicidade e Participações Ltda

   Brazil

WPP (Curitiba) Participações Ltda

   Brazil

WPP (Porto Alegre) Participações Ltda

   Brazil

WPP do Brasil - Participações Ltda

   Brazil

Wunderman Brasil Comunicações Ltda

   Brazil

Y&R Propaganda Ltda

   Brazil

Young & Rubicam do Brasil Ltda

   Brazil

Grey Worldwide Bulgaria EOOD

   Bulgaria

Index AD

   Bulgaria

Research and Marketing Company Limited

   Cameroon

24/7 Media Canada Holding Company

   Canada

24/7 Real Media Inc. (Canada)

   Canada

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Blast Radius Inc.

   Canada

Feinstein Kean Partners - Canada, Ltd.

   Canada

GCI Communications Inc./Communication GCI Inc.

   Canada

Grey Advertising (Vancouver) ULC

   Canada

Grey Advertising ULC/Publicite Grey ULC

   Canada

GroupM Canada Inc.

   Canada

Hill and Knowlton Canada Limited

   Canada

Hill and Knowlton/Ducharme Perron Ltee

   Canada

J. Walter Thompson Company Limited La Compagnie J. Walter Thompson Limitee

   Canada

Marketforce Communication ULC

   Canada

Marketing Communication Group Inc.

   Canada

Media Buying Services ULC

   Canada

Media Evolution Technologies Inc.

   Canada

Mediacom Canada

   Canada

Mediacom Canada ULC

   Canada

Millward Brown Canada, Inc.

   Canada

MindShare Canada

   Canada

OgilvyAction Quebec Ltd./OgilvyAction Quebec Ltee

   Canada

OgilvyOne Worldwide Ltd.

   Canada

Soho Square Advertising Ltd.

   Canada

Spafax Canada Inc.

   Canada

Taxi Canada Ltd./Taxi Canada Ltée

   Canada

The Meadow Wood Communication Group Inc. Le Group De Communication Meadow Wood, Inc.

   Canada

The Young & Rubicam Group of Companies ULC

   Canada

TNS Canadian Facts Inc.

   Canada

WPP Group Canada Communications Limited

   Canada

WPP Group Canada Finance, Inc.

   Canada

WPP Group Quebec Limited / Groupe WPP Québec Limitée

   Canada

WPP Simcoe Square Ltd.

   Canada

Y&R Canada Investments LP

   Canada
 

 

7


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Actionline Chile SA

   Chile

Burson-Marsteller Communicaciones Limitada

   Chile

Design Direct Chile SA

   Chile

Energía Young & Rubicam SA

   Chile

Estrategia Integral de Comunicaciones SA

   Chile

Glue Chile SAC

   Chile

Grey Chile SA

   Chile

GroupM Chile SAC

   Chile

Hill & Knowlton Captiva SA

   Chile

Inversiones CI S.A.

   Chile

J Walter Thompson Chilena SAC

   Chile

Kantar Worldpanel Chile Investigación de Mercados Limitada

   Chile

Media Edge Comunicaciones Chile Limitada

   Chile

Ogilvy Action Chile S.A.

   Chile

Ogilvy & Mather Chile SA

   Chile

Ogilvyone Chile SA

   Chile

Prolam Young & Rubicam SA

   Chile

Spafax Medios y Publicidad Ltda

   Chile

Time Research Chile S.A.

   Chile

TNS Chile S.A.

   Chile

Wunderman Chile Consultoría y Comunicaciones Ltda

   Chile

Young Media SA

   Chile

Agenda (Beijing) Ltd.

   China

Always (Shanghai) Marketing Services Co. Ltd.

   China

BatesApex Integrated Marketing Co. Ltd.

   China

Beijing Channel Marketing Service Center Co. Ltd.

   China

Beijing Contract Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China

Beijing ITOP 24/7 Co. Ltd.

   China

Beijing J Walter Thompson Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China

Beijing Ogilvyone Marketing Co., Ltd.

   China

Beijing Soho Square Marketing Co. Ltd.

   China

Beijing WDT Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China

Blue Interactive Technology Department (Beijing) Co. Ltd.

   China

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Cohn & Wolfe Marketing Communications Consulting (Shanghai) Co. Ltd.

   China

David Communications (Beijing) Group Co. Ltd.

   China

DAYI (Shanghai) Consulting Co. Ltd.

   China

Effort Ogilvy (Fujian) Advertising Limited

   China

G2 Aviavision China Sourcing Co. Ltd.

   China

G2 China Co. Ltd.

   China

G2 Star Echo Marketing Communications Co. Ltd.

   China

Glendinning Management Consultants (Shanghai) Co. Ltd.

   China

Grey China Advertising Co. Ltd. (Beijing)

   China

Grey China Marketing Communications Co. Ltd.

   China

GroupM (Shanghai) Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China

Guangdong Burson-Marsteller Public Relations Co., Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou Bates Dahua Advertising Co., Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou Dawson Human Resources Service Co. Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou Dawson Marketing Communications Consulting Co. Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou G2 Aviavision Trading Co. Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou G2 Star Echo Human Resources Co. Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou Kai Dai Advertising Ltd. (Batey)

   China

Guangzhou Win-Lin Management Consulting Co. Ltd.

   China

Guangzhou Zdology Market Research Co., Ltd.

   China

Hill & Knowlton (China) Public Relations Co. Ltd.

   China

H-Line Ogilvy Communications Company Ltd.

   China

J. Walter Thompson Bridge Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China
 

 

8


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Kinetic Advertising (Shanghai) Co. Ltd.

   China

Millward Brown ACSR Co. Ltd.

   China

Neo@ogilvy Co. Ltd.

   China

Oracle Added Value Market Research Company Limited

   China

PowerForce (Shanghai) Marketing Services Co. Ltd.

   China

Red Wasabi Marketing Consulting (Shanghai) Co., Ltd.

   China

Research International China (Guangzhou) Ltd.

   China

RMG Relationship Marketing Group Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Bates Evision Digital Marketing Consulting Co. Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Bates MeThinks Marketing Communications Co. Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Iconmobile Co. Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Ogilvy & Mather Advertising Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Ogilvy & Mather Marketing Communications Consulting Co. Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Star Echo Marketing & Communication Co., Ltd.

   China

Shanghai Sudler MDS Healthcare Communications Co., Ltd.

   China

Shenzhen Black Arc Ogilvy Advertising Media Limited

   China

Soho Square Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China

The Brand Union China

   China

TNS China Co., Ltd.

   China

TNS Marketing Consultancy (Shanghai) Co. Ltd.

   China

WPP (China) Management Co. Limited

   China

Young & Rubicam (Beijing) Advertising Co. Ltd.

   China

C & C Action Marketing Ltda

   Colombia

Energía Y&R Ltda.

   Colombia

G2 Colombia Ltda

   Colombia

J. Walter Thompson Colombia Ltda

   Colombia

LatinPanel Perú S.A. Sucursal Colombia

   Colombia

Mediaedge: Cia Ltda

   Colombia

Millward Brown Colombia Ltda

   Colombia

MindShare de Colombia Ltda

   Colombia

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Ogilvy & Mather S.A. (Colombia)

   Colombia

REP Grey Worldwide S.A.

   Colombia

RMG Connect Colombia Ltda

   Colombia

SCPF Colombia S.A.S

   Colombia

Young & Rubicam Brands Ltda

   Colombia

J Walter Thompson SA

   Costa Rica

Schematic Costa Rica Ltda

   Costa Rica

TNS Data S.A. (Costa Rica)

   Costa Rica

Research & Marketing Services International Sarl

   Cote d’Ivoire

Grey Zagreb d.o.o. Zatrisno Kommuniciranje

   Croatia

Mediacom Zagreb d.o.o.

   Croatia

Poster Publicity SEE (South East Europe)

   Croatia

Grey Worldwide Middle East Network Ltd.

   Cyprus

Pelerdon Holdings Ltd.

   Cyprus

Bates Praha s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Bi Praha Red Cell s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

GCI/Hill&Knowton s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

GroupM s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Kantar Media a.s.

   Czech Republic

LGM s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Mather Activation s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Mather Advertures s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Mather Communications s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Mather Public Relations s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

MAXUS Czech Republic s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

MediaCom Praha s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Mediaedge:cia Czech Republic s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Millward Brown Czech Republic s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

MindShare s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

MQI Brno spol. s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Ogilvy Action s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Ogilvy CID s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Ogilvy One A.S.

   Czech Republic

Ogilvy Public Relations s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Ogilvy & Mather Morava spol. s r.o.

   Czech Republic

Ogilvy & Mather spol. s r.o.

   Czech Republic

RedWorks s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Rmg:connect s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Team Red s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

The Core Group s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

TNS AISA s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

Wunderman s.r.o.

   Czech Republic
 

 

9


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH

ORGANISED

Young & Rubicam Praha s.r.o.

   Czech Republic

ADPeople A/S

   Denmark

ADProduction A/S

   Denmark

Bates/Red Cell Gruppen A/S

   Denmark

Burson Marsteller A/S

   Denmark

Cohn & Wolfe A/S

   Denmark

Dyhr / Hagen A/S

   Denmark

Friendly Film A/S

   Denmark

Future Lab Business ApS

   Denmark

Future Lab Business Group A/S

   Denmark

Futurelab Business Consulting A/S

   Denmark

Grey Nordic ApS

   Denmark

Grey Shared Services A/S

   Denmark

Grey Worldwide Kobenhavn A/S

   Denmark

GroupM Denmark A/S

   Denmark

Halbye Kaag JWT A/S

   Denmark

Hill & Knowlton A/S

   Denmark

Hundred Percent Film Production A/S

   Denmark

JLM Holdings ApS

   Denmark

Mannov A/S Country

   Denmark

Mannov Holding A/S

   Denmark

Maxus Communications A/S

   Denmark

MEC: Access ApS

   Denmark

Mediabroker A/S

   Denmark

MediaCom Danmark A/S

   Denmark

Mediaedge:CIA Denmark A/S

   Denmark

Mediaedge:CIA Denmark Holding A/S

   Denmark

Mindshare A/S

   Denmark

Nordic Retails Group A/S

   Denmark

Ogilvy Danmark A/S

   Denmark

Outrider A/S

   Denmark

Ogilvy Danmark A/S

   Denmark

Mindshare A/S

   Denmark

WPP Holding Denmark A/S

   Denmark

Uncle Grey A/S

   Denmark

Y&R Denmark Holdings II APS

   Denmark

Burson Marsteller A/S

   Denmark

ProMedia A/S

   Denmark

ADProduction A/S

   Denmark

J. Walter Thompson Dominicana S.A.

   Dominican Republic

LatinPanel Ecuador S.A.

   Ecuador

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

A.M.R.B. Egypt L.L.C.

   Egypt

Grey Worldwide Middle East Network Limited

   Egypt

MediaCom Egypt

   Egypt

Team Y&R LLC (Egypt)

   Egypt

TMI J Walter Thompson Egypt Ltd.

   Egypt

TNS Egypt Ltd.

   Egypt

J Walter Thompson S.A. de C.V.

   El Salvador

TNS Data S.A. de C.V. (El Salvador)

   El Salvador

Emor AS

   Estonia

Hill A Knowlton Eesti As

   Estonia
Extern Finland Oy    Finland

GroupM Finland Oy

   Finland

Happi Mindshare Finland Oy

   Finland

Hill & Knowlton Finland Oy

   Finland

J Walter Thompson Finland Oy

   Finland

Maxus Oy

   Finland

MEC Finland Oy

   Finland

Mediaedge:CIA Finland OY

   Finland

Mindshare Finland Oy

   Finland

Suomen Gallup Elintarviketieto Oy

   Finland

Taylor Nelson Sofres Suomi OY

   Finland

TNS Gallup OY

   Finland

Young & Rubicam Finland OY

   Finland

141 France SAS

   France

24/7 Real Media France SARL

   France

Added Value SAS

   France

Argonautes SA

   France

Audit Et Systemes Consultants SAS

   France

AV Co. Sarl

   France

AxiCom Communications SARL

   France

Banner Media France SASU

   France

Bates SAS

   France

Burson-Marsteller SAS

   France

CB Associees SAS

   France

CBA Architecture Commerciale et Design D’environnement SA

   France

Cohn & Wolfe SA

   France

Compagnie Fonciere Les Yvelines

   France

Concorde Finance France SAS

   France

CT Finances SA

   France

Design Direct SAS

   France

Fieldwork RI SAS

   France

Financiere RKW Holding SAS

   France

Fitch Vendome SAS

   France

G2 France SAS

   France

GIE Media Insight

   France

GIE Mindshare

   France
 

 

10


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey Global Group France SAS

   France

Grey Healthcare Paris SA

   France

Grey Paris SAS

   France

GroupM SAS

   France

HFT SA

   France

Hill & Knowlton SAS

   France

Impiric Interactive

   France

J Walter Thompson SAS

   France

JFC Informatique & Media SAS

   France

Kantar Health SAS

   France

Kantar Retail France SAS

   France

Kantar SAS

   France

Kassius SA

   France

Kinetic SAS

   France

Knowledgebase Marketing France SAS

   France

Landor Associates SAS

   France

Le Lab Consulting SAS

   France

Les Ouvriers du Paradis Babylone United SAS

   France

Les Ouvriers du Paradis Bourgognes SAS

   France

Lob Conseils SA

   France

Louiseholding SAS

   France

Lumiere Publicite SARL

   France

Mather Communications SAS

   France

Mediacom Paris SA

   France

Mediaedge:CIA France SAS

   France

Millward Brown SAS

   France

Ogilvy Action SAS

   France

Ogilvy Healthworld France SAS

   France

Ogilvy Public Relations SAS

   France

Ogilvy & Mather S.A.S

   France

OgilvyOne Worldwide SAS

   France

Peclers Paris SAS

   France

Plein Papier SARL

   France

Prism SAS

   France

Pro Deo SAS

   France

Public Relations AKKA SAS

   France

Relations Publiques Caroline Allain RPCA SAS

   France

RMG SAS

   France

Rmg:connect SAS

   France

Sofres Asia Pacific SAS

   France

Sofres Communication SAS

   France

Sofres Lyon SARL

   France

Strateme SARL

   France

Sudler & Hennessey SAS

   France

Taylor Nelson Sofres SAS

   France

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

The Brand Union Paris SARL

   France

The Shop SARL

   France

TNS Direct SAS

   France

TransGrey SAS

   France

WPP Finance Holdings SAS

   France

WPP Finance SA

   France

Wunderman SAS

   France

Young & Rubicam SAS

   France

141 worldwide GmbH

   Germany

24/7 Real Media Deutschland GmbH

   Germany

AdGenus GmbH

   Germany

Advanced Techniques Group (ATG) GmbH

   Germany

argonauten G2 GmbH

   Germany

Atletico Germany GmbH

   Germany

AxiCom Axiom Communications GmbH

   Germany

Best of Media GmbH

   Germany

Burson-Marsteller GmbH

   Germany

Cohn & Wolfe Public Relations GmbH & Co. KG

   Germany

Cohn & Wolfe Verwaltungs GmbH

   Germany

Concept Media Gesellschaft für Planung und Beratung mbH

   Germany

Concept Media Gesellschaft für Planung und Beratung mit beschränkter Haftung

   Germany

Concept! Venture GmbH

   Germany

CONNECT 21 GmbH

   Germany

Cordiant Holdings GmbH

   Germany

cpz Ogilvy Public Relations GmbH

   Germany

Diebitz, Stöppler, Braun & Kuhlmann Werbeagentur GmbH

   Germany

Dorland Werbeagentur GmbH

   Germany

EMNID Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung

   Germany

F + I GmbH, Research Consulting Marktforschung

   Germany

facts + fiction GmbH

   Germany

FutureCom GmbH

   Germany

G2 Düsseldorf GmbH

   Germany

G2 Kommunikationsagentur GmbH

   Germany

Global “Sportnet” Beteiligungs GmbH

   Germany

Global “Sportnet” Sportmarketing GmbH & Co. KG

   Germany

GRAMM Werbeagentur GmbH

   Germany

Grey CIS Werbeagentur GmbH

   Germany
 

 

11


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey G2 Group GmbH

   Germany

Grey GmbH

   Germany

Grey Healthcare GmbH

   Germany

Grey Holding Central Europe GmbH

   Germany

Grey Worldwide GmbH

   Germany

GroupM Competence Center GmbH

   Germany

groupm Germany GmbH

   Germany

HealthLive GmbH

   Germany

Hering Schuppener Consulting Strategieberatung für Kommunikation GmbH

   Germany

Hering Schuppener Unternehmensberatung für Kommunikation GmbH

   Germany

Hill & Knowlton Communications GmbH

   Germany

icon added value GmbH

   Germany

icon Wirtschafts- und Finanzmarktforschung GmbH

   Germany

“INCH” Design-Service GmbH

   Germany

InfraLive GmbH

   Germany

Infratest dimap Gesellschaft für Trend- und Wahlforschung mbH

   Germany

Infratest Gesellschaft mit beschränkter Haftung

   Germany

InterBates Beteiligungsgesellschaft mbH & Co. KG

   Germany

InterCom Management GmbH

   Germany

IntraMedic GmbH

   Germany

J. Walter Thompson GmbH

   Germany

J. Walter Thompson Verwaltungs GmbH

   Germany

JWT Engage GmbH

   Germany

JWT Germany GmbH

   Germany

Kantar Health GmbH

   Germany

Kantar Media GmbH

   Germany

KBM GmbH

   Germany

Kinetic Worldwide Germany GmbH

   Germany

Landor Associates GmbH

   Germany

Magic Moments Agentur für Kommunikation GmbH

   Germany

Magic Poster GmbH

   Germany

Mather Direct GmbH

   Germany

Maxus Communications GmbH

   Germany

MEC Access GmbH

   Germany

MEC GmbH

   Germany

Media Consult WPP GmbH

   Germany

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

MediaCom Agentur für Media-Beratung GmbH

   Germany

MediaCom CIS GmbH

   Germany

MediaCom Hamburg GmbH

   Germany

MediaCom Holding Central and Eastern Europe GmbH

   Germany

MediaCom Interaction GmbH

   Germany

MediaCom München GmbH

   Germany

Mediaedge:cia Germany Holding GmbH

   Germany

Michael Vagedes GmbH

   Germany

Millward Brown Germany GmbH

   Germany

MindShare GmbH

   Germany

MM MEDIA MARKETING GMBH

   Germany

Neo@Ogilvy GmbH

   Germany

NFO International GmbH Holding

   Germany

Ogilvy Action GmbH

   Germany

Ogilvy Brand Center GmbH

   Germany

Ogilvy Brand Center Verwaltungs GmbH

   Germany

Ogilvy Healthworld GmbH

   Germany

Ogilvy & Mather Advertising GmbH

   Germany

Ogilvy & Mather Deutschland GmbH

   Germany

Ogilvy & Mather Werbeagentur GmbH

   Germany

OgilvyBrains GmbH

   Germany

OgilvyFinance AG

   Germany

OgilvyOne Düsseldorf GmbH

   Germany

OgilvyOne GmbH

   Germany

OSCAR Service GmbH

   Germany

Performance SportEnt Worldwide GmbH

   Germany

PQ PLAKATQUALITÄT Agentur für Außenwerbung GmbH

   Germany

PRISM INTERNATIONAL GmbH

   Germany

Quisma GmbH

   Germany

Red Cell Werbeagentur GmbH

   Germany

RedWorks GmbH

   Germany

RMG Connect GmbH

   Germany

s&kGrey GmbH

   Germany

santamaria GmbH

   Germany

spring infotainment Wirtz und Pischke Verwaltungsgesellschaft mbH

   Germany

spring Wirtz und Pischke GmbH & Co. KG

   Germany
 

 

12


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Sudler & Hennessey Berlin GmbH

   Germany

Sudler & Hennessey GmbH

   Germany

The Brand Union GmbH

   Germany

Tillmanns, Ogilvy & Mather GmbH

   Germany

TNS EMNID GmbH & Co. KG

   Germany

TNS Emnid Medien- und Sozialforschung GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest Beteiligungs GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest Forschung GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest Holding GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest RI GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest Sozialforschung GmbH

   Germany

TNS Infratest Verwaltungs GmbH

   Germany

Transmission Advertising Services GmbH

   Germany

Verwaltungsgesellschaft Global “Sportnet” Sportmarketing mbH

   Germany

WPP Deutschland Holding GmbH & Co. KG

   Germany

WPP Deutschland Verwaltungs GmbH

   Germany

WPP Digital Germany GmbH

   Germany

WPP Marketing Communications Germany B.V., Zweigniederlassung Frankfurt am Main

   Germany

WPP Marketing Communications Germany GmbH

   Germany

WPP Media Holdings GmbH

   Germany

WPP Service GmbH

   Germany

Wunderman Consulting GmbH

   Germany

Wunderman GmbH

   Germany

Wunderman GmbH

   Germany

Wunderman Verwaltungs GmbH

   Germany

Young & Rubicam Brands Germany GmbH

   Germany

Young & Rubicam GmbH

   Germany

Young & Rubicam GmbH

   Germany

ZEG-Zentrum für Epidemiologie und Gesundheitsforschung Berlin GmbH

   Germany

Millward Brown West Africa Limited

   Ghana

Mindshare Ghana Ltd.

   Ghana

RMS International (GH) Limited

   Ghana

GEO Young & Rubicam S.A.

   Greece

Grey Athens SA

   Greece

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Maxus Commercial Communications SA

   Greece

MediaCom Ltd.

   Greece

Movielab SA

   Greece

Panmail Advertising SA

   Greece

Publicom Hill & Knowlton Hellas Ltd.

   Greece

Red Cell Advertising SA

   Greece

Research International Hellas S.A

   Greece

Salesplus Ltd.

   Greece

Screen Design & Production of Advertising and Promotional Material Ltd.

   Greece

Spot Thompson Total Communication Group SA

   Greece

Taylor Nelson Sofres ICAP Market Research SA

   Greece

The Media Edge SA

   Greece

Tribe Advertising Services SA

   Greece

WCJ Advertising SA

   Greece

Hill & Knowlton SA

   Guatemala

J Walter Thompson SA

   Guatemala

TNS Data S.A. (Guatemala)

   Guatemala

TNS Finance (CI) Limited

   Guernsey

TNS Finance (G) Limited

   Guernsey

TNS Finance Limited

   Guernsey

J Walter Thompson SA

   Honduras

Agenda (China) Limited

   Hong Kong

Agenda (Hong Kong) Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Agenda Group (Asia) Limited

   Hong Kong

Bates China Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Bates Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

BatesAsia Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

BatesAsia Limited

   Hong Kong

Beyond Communications Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

Beyond Interactive Co. Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Blue Interactive Marketing Limited

   Hong Kong

Burson-Marsteller (Asia) Limited

   Hong Kong

Burson-Marsteller (Hong Kong) Limited

   Hong Kong

Carl Byoir Asia Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Conquest Marketing Communications (Hong Kong) Limited

   Hong Kong

Conquest Marketing Communications (Taiwan) Limited

   Hong Kong
 

 

13


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Contract Advertising Company Limited

   Hong Kong

CSM HK Limited

   Hong Kong

David Communications Group Limited

   Hong Kong

Design Direct (Hong Kong) Limited

   Hong Kong

Era Ogilvy Public Relations Co., Limited

   Hong Kong

Fitch Design Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Freeway Communications Ltd.

   Hong Kong

G2 Hong Kong Ltd.

   Hong Kong

G2 Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Grand Wealth International Holdings Limited

   Hong Kong

Grey Advertising Hong Kong Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Grey Advertising Limited

   Hong Kong

Grey Healthcare Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Grey Interactive China Company Limited

   Hong Kong

Grey Interactive Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Grey International Limited

   Hong Kong

Grey Public Relations Company Ltd.

   Hong Kong

GroupM Communications Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

GroupM Limited

   Hong Kong

HeathWallace (HK) Limited

   Hong Kong

Hill and Knowlton Asia Limited

   Hong Kong

Hill and Knowlton Asia Pacific Limited

   Hong Kong

H-Line Worldwide Limited

   Hong Kong

HWGL Investment (Holding) Company Limited

   Hong Kong

IMRB MILLWARD BROWN INTERNATIONAL LIMITED

   Hong Kong

iPR Ogilvy (China) Limited

   Hong Kong

iPR Ogilvy Holdings Limited

   Hong Kong

iPR Ogilvy Limited

   Hong Kong

J. Walter Thompson (Taiwan) Limited

   Hong Kong

J. Walter Thompson Company (North Asia) Limited

   Hong Kong

J. Walter Thompson Company Limited

   Hong Kong

Landor Associates Designers & Consultants Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Lightspeed Research HK Limited

   Hong Kong

Maximise (Hong Kong) Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Maxus Communications Limited

   Hong Kong

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Maxx Marketing Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Media Investment Holdings Limited

   Hong Kong

Mediacom Limited

   Hong Kong

MediaCompany Communications Limited

   Hong Kong

Mediaedge:CIA Hong Kong Pte Limited

   Hong Kong

Millward Brown Limited

   Hong Kong

MindShare Communications Limited

   Hong Kong

MindShare Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

NFO Asia Pacific Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy Health Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy & Mather (China) Holdings Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy & Mather (China) Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy & Mather (Hong Kong) Private Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy & Mather Marketing Communications Limited

   Hong Kong

Ogilvy & Mather Marketing Services Limited

   Hong Kong

OgilvyAction Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

OgilvyActivation Global Launch Limited

   Hong Kong

OgilvyInteractive Asia Pacific Limited

   Hong Kong

OgilvyInteractive Worldwide Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

OgilvyOne Worldwide Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

Oracle Added Value Limited

   Hong Kong

Promotional Campaigns (Asia) Limited

   Hong Kong

Pulse Communications Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Red Wasabi Limited

   Hong Kong

RedWorks Limited

   Hong Kong

Relationship Marketing Group Limited

   Hong Kong

Research International Asia Limited

   Hong Kong

Rikes Hill & Knowlton Limited

   Hong Kong

RMG Connect Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Sapphire Bright Limited

   Hong Kong

Shengshi International Media (Group) Limited

   Hong Kong

Signature Promotions Limited

   Hong Kong

Soho Square Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong
 

 

14


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Taylor Nelson Sofres Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

Team Y&R Holdings Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

The Brand Union Limited

   Hong Kong

The Bridge Communications Company Limited

   Hong Kong

TOTAL GLORY INTERNATIONAL LIMITED

   Hong Kong

Underline:Fitch Hong Kong Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Whizzbangart Hong Kong Ltd.

   Hong Kong

Wit Ocean Limited

   Hong Kong

WPP Captive Holdings Limited

   Hong Kong

WPP Group (Asia Pacific) Limited

   Hong Kong

WPP Marketing Communications (Hong Kong) Limited

   Hong Kong

XM Hong Kong Limited

   Hong Kong

Young & Rubicam (HK) Limited

   Hong Kong

Barci es Partners Kft

   Hungary

Bates 141 Hungary Advertising Kft

   Hungary

GRAMM Kft

   Hungary

Grey Worldwide Hungary Kft

   Hungary

Hill and Knowlton Hungary Public Relations Kft

   Hungary

JWT Budapest Marketing Szolgáltató KFT

   Hungary

Kantar Media Kft

   Hungary

Mac-Mester Kft

   Hungary

Mather Communications Reklamugynokseg Kft

   Hungary

MC MediaCompany Nemzetkozi Mediaugynoki Kft

   Hungary

MEC Interaction Hungary Kft

   Hungary

Media Zone Hungary Kft.

   Hungary

Mediaedge: cia Hungary Kft

   Hungary

Millward Brown Hungary Kft.

   Hungary

Ogilvy Group Zrt

   Hungary

Portland Kozteruleti Reklamugynokseg Kft

   Hungary

Redworks Budapest Kft

   Hungary

Taylor Nelson Sofres Hungary Business and Social Marketing and Consulting Limited

   Hungary

Team Hungary Kft

   Hungary

TGI Hungary Marketing Research Company Kft

   Hungary

The Mediaedge Kft

   Hungary

Wunderman Kft

   Hungary

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Young & Rubicam Budapest International Advertising Agency Kft

   Hungary

Atlas Advertising Private Ltd.

   India

Bates India Private Ltd.

   India

Brand David Communications Private Limited

   India

Contract Advertising India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Encompass Events Private Ltd.

   India

Fortune Communications Ltd.

   India

G2 Communications Pvt Ltd.

   India

G2 Rams India Pvt Ltd.

   India

G3 Communications Pvt. Ltd.

   India

Genesis Burson-Marsteller Public Relations Private Ltd.

   India

Grey Worldwide (India) Pvt.Ltd.

   India

GroupM Media India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Hindustan Thompson Associates Private Limited

   India

Icon Added Value Private Ltd.

   India

Indian Market Research Bureau Ltd.

   India

Interactive Television Private Limited

   India

Kantar Market Research Services Pvt Ltd.

   India

Loose Screws Production Pvt Ltd.

   India

Matrix Publicities & Media India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Mediacom Media India Private Ltd.

   India

Mediaedge:cia India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Meridian Communication Pvt. Ltd.

   India

Meritus Analytics India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Millward Brown Market Research Services India Private Ltd.

   India

Mindshare India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Ogilvy & Mather Pvt Ltd.

   India

Optima India Private Ltd.

   India

Options Communications India Pvt Ltd.

   India

Portland India Outdoor Advertising Private Ltd.

   India

Quasar Media Private Ltd.

   India

Ray & Keshavan Design Associates Pvt. Ltd.

   India

Results India Communications Pvt Ltd.

   India

Sercon India Private Limited

   India

Sharp Shooter Films Private Ltd.

   India
 

 

15


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Sudler & Hennessey India Pvt Ltd.

   India

TNS India Private Limited

   India

TNS Mode Private Limited

   India

Triyaka Communications Pvt. Ltd.

   India

Triyaka First Serve Advertising (Pvt) Ltd.

   India

Arena Productions Limited

   Ireland

Bell Advertising Limited

   Ireland

Culverbridge Limited

   Ireland

Dearadh Teoranta “Interact”

   Ireland

Drumgoff Holdings

   Ireland

EWA Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Grey Advertising Limited (Ireland)

   Ireland

Group M WPP Ltd.

   Ireland

Hill & Knowlton Limited

   Ireland

Hunter/Red Cell Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Imagecom Graphics Ltd.

   Ireland

John Hunter Ltd.

   Ireland

Kinetic Advertising Limited (Ireland)

   Ireland

Lansdowne Market Research Ltd.

   Ireland

Mediacom (Media Planning and Buying) Ltd.

   Ireland

Mediaedge:cia Ireland Limited

   Ireland

MediaWatch Limited

   Ireland

Millward Brown Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Millward Brown Irish Marketing Surveys Ltd.

   Ireland

MindShare Limited

   Ireland

Mindshare Media Ireland Limited

   Ireland

Ogilvy One Worldwide Limited

   Ireland

Ogilvy & Mather Group Limited

   Ireland

Ogilvy & Mather Limited

   Ireland

Rational Decisions Limited

   Ireland

RMG Connect Ireland Limited

   Ireland

Sudler & Hennessey Healthcare Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Taylor Nelson Sofres Ireland Limited

   Ireland

The Brand Union Limited

   Ireland

The Helme Partnership Limited

   Ireland

The Helme Production Limited

   Ireland

TNS Marketing Pathways Limited

   Ireland

Wilson Hartnell Public Relations Limited

   Ireland

WPP Air 1 Limited

   Ireland

WPP Air 2 Limited

   Ireland

WPP Air 3 Limited

   Ireland

WPP Ireland Holdings Limited

   Ireland

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

WPP Ireland Limited

   Ireland

WPP Ireland UK

   Ireland

WPP Ireland US

   Ireland

WPP UK Holdings Ltd. (Ireland)

   Ireland

Wunderman Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Y&R Advertising Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Young & Rubicam Brands Ireland Ltd.

   Ireland

Connect Sales Promotions Direct Marketing and Events Ltd.

   Israel

JTC Scan Ltd.

   Israel

JWT Israel Ltd.

   Israel

Media Edge Israel Ltd.

   Israel

Meishav Hafakot Ltd.

   Israel

Netking (1999) Ltd.

   Israel

Shalmor Avnon Amichay Advertising Ltd.

   Israel

Single Source Research Israel (1999) Limited

   Israel

Taylor Nelson Sofres Teleseker Limited

   Israel

Tele-gal The Israeli Rating Company Ltd.

   Israel

TNS Teleseker - Policy Qualitat Research Ltd.

   Israel

TNS-Tel-Gal Media Research Ltd.

   Israel

United Media (R.S. 2005) Ltd.

   Israel

Y&R Interactive 2.1 Ltd.

   Israel

1861 United Srl

   Italy

24/7 Real Media Italy Srl

   Italy

Added Value Srl

   Italy

AxiCom Italia Srl

   Italy

Bates Srl

   Italy

Burson Marsteller Srl

   Italy

Carl Byoir Srl

   Italy

CIA Medianetwork Club Srl

   Italy

CIA Medianetwork Milano Srl

   Italy

Cohn & Wolfe Srl

   Italy

Digital PR Srl

   Italy

FAST - Financial Administration Solutions & Technologies Srl

   Italy

G2 Srl

   Italy

G2-Promotions Italia SpA

   Italy

Grey Healthcare Italia Srl

   Italy

Grey Worldwide Italia Srl

   Italy

GroupM plus Srl

   Italy

GroupM Srl

   Italy

H-Art Srl

   Italy

Hill & Knowlton Gaia Srl

   Italy
 

 

16


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

International Strategic Communications Srl

   Italy

Intramed Communications Srl

   Italy

J Walter Thompson Roma Srl

   Italy

J. Walter Thompson Italia SpA

   Italy

Kantar Health Srl

   Italy

Kinetic Srl

   Italy

Landor Associates Srl

   Italy

LGM Little Green Men Srl

   Italy

Lorien Consulting Srl

   Italy

MAXUS MC2 Spa

   Italy

Maxus Srl

   Italy

Media Club SpA

   Italy

Media Insight Srl

   Italy

Mediacom Italia Srl

   Italy

Mediaedge:CIA Italy Srl

   Italy

Millward Brown Srl

   Italy

Mindshare SpA

   Italy

Mindshare Trevenzie Srl

   Italy

Nexthealth Srl

   Italy

Ogilvy Healthworld Srl

   Italy

Ogilvy Interactive Srl

   Italy

Ogilvy & Mather SpA

   Italy

OgilvyOne Worldwide SpA

   Italy

One Four One Srl

   Italy

Quisma Italy Srl

   Italy

Red Cell Srl

   Italy

Red Productions Srl

   Italy

rmg:connect Srl

   Italy

Sentrix Global Health Communications Srl

   Italy

Soho Square Srl

   Italy

sPrint Production Srl

   Italy

Sudler & Hennessey Srl

   Italy

Team Alfa Srl

   Italy

TNS Infratest S.P.A.

   Italy

TNS Italia Srl

   Italy

WPP Holdings (Italy) Srl

   Italy

WPP Marketing Communications (Italy) Srl

   Italy

Wunderman Srl

   Italy

Y&R Italia Srl

   Italy

Y&R Roma Srl

   Italy

Bates Asia Japan Inc.

   Japan

Burson-Marsteller Co. Ltd.

   Japan

Carl Byoir Japan Ltd.

   Japan

David Communications KK

   Japan

Design Direct Japan KK

   Japan

Enfatico Tokyo Inc.

   Japan

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey Direct Inc.

   Japan

Grey Healthcare Japan Inc.

   Japan

Grey Worldwide Inc. (Japan)

   Japan

GroupM Japan KK

   Japan

GroupM KK

   Japan

Hill & Knowlton Japan Ltd.

   Japan

International Creative Marketing KK

   Japan

J Walter Thompson Japan KK

   Japan

Japan Kantar Research Inc.

   Japan

Logic Inc.

   Japan

Millward Brown Japan KK

   Japan

Neo@Ogilvy KK

   Japan

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide (Japan) KK

   Japan

Ogilvy & Mather Japan KK

   Japan

OgilvyAction Japan KK

   Japan

OgilvyOne Japan KK

   Japan

Redworks Japan KK

   Japan

Soho Square Japan K.K.

   Japan

TNS Infoplan Limited

   Japan

WPP Marketing Communications KK

   Japan

WPP plc

   Jersey

Ogilvy & Mather Kazakhstan Limited Liability Company

   Kazakhstan

TNS Gallup Media Asia

   Kazakhstan

BluePrint Marketing Limited

   Kenya

Millward Brown East Africa Ltd.

   Kenya

MindShare Kenya Limited

   Kenya

Ogilvy & Mather (Eastern Africa) Limited

   Kenya

Ogilvy Africa Media Ltd

   Kenya

Ogilvy East Africa Limited

   Kenya

Ogilvy Public Relations Limited

   Kenya

TNS Research International Ltd.

   Kenya

24/7 Real Media Inc. (Korea)

   Korea, Republic of

Burson-Marsteller Korea Co. Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

Burson-Marsteller Korea Inc.

   Korea, Republic of

Diamond Ogilvy Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

Grey Worldwide Korea Inc.

   Korea, Republic of

JWT Adventure Co. Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

Lee & Jang OgilvyOne Worldwide Co. Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

Longitude One LLC

   Korea, Republic of
 

 

17


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Millward Brown Media Research Inc.

   Korea, Republic of

Ogilvy & Mather Korea Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

Pharmax Ogilvy Healthworld Inc.

   Korea, Republic of

Synergy Hill & Knowlton Co. Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

Taylor Nelson Sofres Korea Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

The Lacek Group, Inc.

   Korea, Republic of

Wunderman International Co. Ltd.

   Korea, Republic of

JWT Advertising & Marketing Co. WLL

   Kuwait

Team Advertising and Marketing WLL

   Kuwait

Hill & Knowlton Latvia SIA

   Latvia

Mediaedge:CIA Baltic Ltd.

   Latvia

TNS Latvia SIA

   Latvia

Asdaa Advertising & Public Relations Sarl

   Lebanon

Digital Factory S.A.L (Offshore)

   Lebanon

Grey Worldwide ME Network - SARL

   Lebanon

Intermarkets SAL

   Lebanon

JWT SAL (Offshore)

   Lebanon

MEC Sarl (Lebanon)

   Lebanon

MediaCom Lebanon

   Lebanon

Team Advertising SARL (Lebanon)

   Lebanon

Tihama Al Mona International - J Walter Thompson S.A.R.L

   Lebanon

TNS Liban SARL

   Lebanon

SIC Gallup Media UAB

   Lithuania

TNS Gallup UAB

   Lithuania

Grey Worldwide Luxembourg S.A.

   Luxembourg

Luxembourg Finance Holdings Seven CV

   Luxembourg

NFO (Luxembourg) SARL

   Luxembourg

NFO Holding (Luxembourg) S.a.r.l.

   Luxembourg

TNS Luxembourg Alpha S.a.r.l.

   Luxembourg

TNS Luxembourg Beta S.a.r.l.

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Beta Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Beta Three Sarl

   Luxembourg

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

WPP Luxembourg Beta Two Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Europe SARL

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Gamma Five Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Gamma Four Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Gamma Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Gamma Three Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Gamma Two Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Germany Holdings 2 S.à r.l.

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Germany Holdings 3 Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Germany Holdings S.à r.l

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Holdings Eight Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Holdings Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Holdings Seven SARL

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Holdings Six SARL

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Holdings Three Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Holdings Two Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg IH 2001 Holdings Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Square LLC Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg Theta Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg US Holdings Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Luxembourg YMC Sarl

   Luxembourg

WPP Quebec Square S.a r.l.

   Luxembourg

WPP TNS US S.a.r.l.

   Luxembourg

WPP Union Square Sarl

   Luxembourg

J.Walter Thompson Company (Malawi) Ltd.

   Malawi

Advertising Ventures Pvt Ltd.

   Mauritius

Millward Brown Mauritius Limited

   Mauritius

Research and Marketing Group Investment Limited

   Mauritius

WPP Holdings (Mauritius) Ltd.

   Mauritius

141 Worldwide, SA de CV

   Mexico
 

 

18


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Agencia de Comunicación Interactiva, SA de CV

   Mexico

Asesoría Estratégica Maxus, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Burson Marsteller México, S.de R.L. de C.V.

   Mexico

Cohn & Wolfe México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Compañía Hill & Knowlton México, SA de CV

   Mexico

Comunicaciones Connect SA de CV

   Mexico

Dinamica Multiple SA

   Mexico

Empresas del Sur, SRL de CV

   Mexico

Estudios de Mercado LP de México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

G7.0 Servicios Gráficos, SA de CV

   Mexico

Goldfarb Consultants México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Grey México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Greycomex, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

J. Walter Thompson de México, S.A.

   Mexico

JWT México, S.R.L. de C.V.

   Mexico

Millward Brown México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Millward Brown Servicios SA de CV

   Mexico

MindShare de México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Multidim SA

   Mexico

Mystery Shopper México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Ogilvy & Mather SA

   Mexico

Ogilvyinteractive SA de CV

   Mexico

OgilvyOne SA

   Mexico

RedWorks SA de CV

   Mexico

Segarra, Cuesta, Puig, Fernandez De Castro, SRL de CV

   Mexico

Servicios de Publicidad Interactivos SA de CV

   Mexico

Servicios Profesionales de Administración LPM, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Taylor Nelson Sofres México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

The Media Edge S de RL de CV

   Mexico

TNS México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

Walter Landor y Asociados, S de RL de CV

   Mexico

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Worldwide Mediacom México, S.A. de C.V.

   Mexico

WPP México, S.R.L. de C.V.

   Mexico

WPP Second, S. de R.L. de C.V

   Mexico

Wunderman SRL de CV

   Mexico

Young & Rubicam S de RL de CV

   Mexico

CBS-AXA (Limited)

   Moldova, Republic of

Grey Worldwide North Africa Network SARL

   Morocco

J Walter Thompson Morocco SARL

   Morocco

Mediacompete Morocco

   Morocco

Mediaedge:cia Morocco SARL

   Morocco

NFO WorldGroup (Maroc) S.a.r.l.

   Morocco

Team Y&R SARL

   Morocco

TNS Maroc S.a.r.l.

   Morocco

Wunderman SARL (Morocco)

   Morocco

Thompson Nepal Private Ltd.

   Nepal

141 Amsterdam BV

   Netherlands

24/7 Real Media Investment Holding BV

   Netherlands

AdValue International BV

   Netherlands

AdValue Nederland BV

   Netherlands

Akron Reclame en Marketing BV

   Netherlands

Arbour Square B.V.

   Netherlands

Atface Internet Facility Centre BV

   Netherlands

Axicom BV

   Netherlands

Bates Nederland Holding BV

   Netherlands

Bates Not Just Film B.V.

   Netherlands

Bercum Boender Cardozo & Werkendam BBCW B.V.

   Netherlands

Berkeley Square Holding BV

   Netherlands

Blast Radius BV

   Netherlands

Borgi Advertising BV

   Netherlands

Brown KSDP Netherlands BV

   Netherlands

Burson-Marsteller B.V.

   Netherlands

Cato Johnson B.V.

   Netherlands

Cavendish Square Holding BV

   Netherlands

Chafma B.V.

   Netherlands

CIA Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

Colon Marketing BV

   Netherlands

Consult Brand Strategy B.V.

   Netherlands

Dentsu 24/7 Search Holdings BV

   Netherlands

Dolphin Square Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

GCI Nederland BV

   Netherlands

Grey Advertising B.V.

   Netherlands

Grey Brasil Holdings B.V.

   Netherlands

Grey Communications Group B.V.

   Netherlands
 

 

19


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey Netherlands Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

Group M BV

   Netherlands

Group M India Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

Healthworld BV

   Netherlands

Healthworld Communications Group (Netherlands) B.V.

   Netherlands

Hill & Knowlton Nederland BV

   Netherlands

Integres Holding BV

   Netherlands

J Walter Thompson Company B.V.

   Netherlands

JWT (Netherlands) Holding BV

   Netherlands

JWT International BV

   Netherlands

Kader Advertising Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

KSM B.V.

   Netherlands

La Communidad, Interactive & Event Marketing BV

   Netherlands

LdB Ogilvy & Mather B.V.

   Netherlands

Leicester Square Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

Lexington International B.V.

   Netherlands

Lightspeed Research B.V.

   Netherlands

Luxembourg Finance Beta CV

   Netherlands

Luxembourg Finance Europe CV

   Netherlands

Luxembourg Finance Gamma CV

   Netherlands

Luxembourg Finance Holdings Six C.V.

   Netherlands

Luxembourg Finance Holdings Two CV

   Netherlands

Marketique Interactive Marketing Services BV

   Netherlands

Maxus B.V.

   Netherlands

MB Centrum BV

   Netherlands

Media Basics BV

   Netherlands

MediaCom B.V.

   Netherlands

Mediaedge:cia BV

   Netherlands

Millward Brown BV

   Netherlands

MindShare BV

   Netherlands

Miniato B.V.

   Netherlands

Netherlandser G.C.I. B.V.

   Netherlands

Nipo Software B.V.

   Netherlands

Ogilvy Groep (Nederland) B.V.

   Netherlands

Ogilvy & Mather Africa B.V.

   Netherlands

PPGH/JWT Groep VOF

   Netherlands

Process Blue B.V.

   Netherlands

Promotion Makers BV

   Netherlands

Promotional Campaigns BV

   Netherlands

Reddion BV

   Netherlands

Research International Nederland BV

   Netherlands

Research Resources Rotterdam BV

   Netherlands

Research SA B.V.

   Netherlands

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Russell Square Holding BV

   Netherlands

Santo Europe BV

   Netherlands

Scribble Beheer BV

   Netherlands

Sirolf II BV

   Netherlands

Taylor Nelson Sofres BV

   Netherlands

TBK/G2 BV

   Netherlands

The Office Advertising Group BV

   Netherlands

These Days BV

   Netherlands

Tiddens, Brahler, De Kemp Reklame en Marketing B.V.

   Netherlands

TNS Consult B.V.

   Netherlands

TNS Nipo BV

   Netherlands

Trafalgar Square Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

Trefpunt Sports and Leisure Marketing B.V.

   Netherlands

UFO Centrum BV

   Netherlands

Uforce BV

   Netherlands

VBAT BV

   Netherlands

Veldkamp Marktonerzoek BV

   Netherlands

Vincent Square Holding BV

   Netherlands

WPP Equity Portugal B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Frankfurt Square B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Herald Square B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Holdings (Holland) B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP International Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Japan Holding B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Kiev Square B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Kraken 2 B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Kraken B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Madison Square B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Management Services (Holland) B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Marketing Communications Germany B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Minotaur B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Netherlands B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Ontario Square BV

   Netherlands

WPP Rio Square BV

   Netherlands

WPP Sheridan Square B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Square 4 B.V.

   Netherlands

WPP Square one B.V

   Netherlands

WPP Superior Square BV

   Netherlands

WPP US Investments BV

   Netherlands

WPP Washington Square B.V.

   Netherlands

Y & R Minority Holdings C.V.

   Netherlands

Young & Rubicam Amsterdam B.V.

   Netherlands

Young & Rubicam Group Netherlands B.V.

   Netherlands
 

 

20


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH

ORGANISED

Young & Rubicam International Group B.V.

   Netherlands

Young & Rubicam Netherlands BV

   Netherlands

Team Holdings Curacao N.V.

   Netherlands Antilles

Endicott Enterprises Limited

   New Zealand

Financial & Media Services (NZ) Ltd.

   New Zealand

Focus Research Limited

   New Zealand

Grey Global Group New Zealand Ltd.

   New Zealand

J Walter Thompson International (NZ) Limited

   New Zealand

MediaCom (New Zealand) Ltd.

   New Zealand

Millward Brown NZ Ltd.

   New Zealand

MindShare New Zealand Limited

   New Zealand

NeedScope International Limited

   New Zealand

NFO Worldgroup N.Z. Holdings Ltd.

   New Zealand

P R Dynamics Limited

   New Zealand

Professional Public Relations NZ Holdings Limited

   New Zealand

Professional Public Relations NZ Limited

   New Zealand

Research International N.Z. Limited

   New Zealand

TNS New Zealand Ltd.

   New Zealand

WPP Holdings (New Zealand) Limited

   New Zealand

Y&R Limited

   New Zealand

Young & Rubicam Holdings Limited

   New Zealand

J Walter Thompson SA

   Nicaragua

Aqvilo Norway AS

   Norway

Bates United AS

   Norway

Bates–Gruppen AS

   Norway

Brindfors Enterprise IG AS

   Norway

Burson-Marsteller AS

   Norway

CIA Norway Holdings AS

   Norway

Gambit Hill & Knowlton AS

   Norway

GCI Communique AS

   Norway

Grey Oslo AS

   Norway

GroupM Norway AS

   Norway

Maxus Communications AS

   Norway

Media.com Interactive AS

   Norway

MediaCom AS (Norway)

   Norway

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Mediaedge:CIA Norway AS

   Norway

MediaPLUS AS

   Norway

Mindshare Norway AS

   Norway

Norsk Gallup Institute AS

   Norway

Ogilvy & Mather AS

   Norway

TNS Gallup AS

   Norway

Uncle Grey Oslo AS

   Norway

WPP Norway AS

   Norway

Wunderman Oman - Diamonds Screen SOC

   Oman

GroupM Pakistan (Private) Ltd.

   Pakistan

WPP Marketing Communications (Pvt) Ltd.

   Pakistan

ASDAA Public Relations Holding Inc.

   Panama

G2 International Corp.

   Panama

IMT Advertising (Holding) Inc.

   Panama

J Walter Thompson S.A.

   Panama

TNS Data S.A. (Panama)

   Panama

WNDRM Inc.

   Panama

JWT SA

   Paraguay

Ad-Hoc SA

   Peru

Energía Publicitaria S.A.

   Peru

GCG Perú S.A.C.

   Peru

LatinPanel Perú S.A.

   Peru

Millward Brown Perú S.R.L.

   Peru

MindShare Perú S.A.C.

   Peru

Momentum Ogilvy & Mather SA

   Peru

The MediaEdge SA

   Peru

Y&R SA

   Peru

360 TTL Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland

Argonauts sp.z.o.o

   Poland

Bates Poland Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Cohn & Wolfe Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland

Grey Worldwide Warszawa Sp. z.o.o

   Poland

GroupM Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland

Gruppa 66 Ogilvy Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Hill and Knowlton Sp. z o.o

   Poland

J Walter Thompson Warszawa Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

JWT Engage Spz.o.o.

   Poland

Kantar Media sp. z o.o

   Poland

Mather Communications Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Maxus Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland

Maxus Warszawa Sp z.o.o

   Poland

MEC Sp.z.o.o

   Poland

Media Plan Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland

MediaCom - Warszawa Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland
 

 

21


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

MindShare Polska Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Ogilvy Action Sp z.o.o.

   Poland

Ogilvy Brand Consulting Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Ogilvy One Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Ogilvy PR Sp. z o.o.

   Poland

Osrodek Badania Opinii Publicznej Sp.z.o.o.

   Poland

Pentor Research International Poznan Sp. z.o.o

   Poland

Pentor Research International S.A.

   Poland

Raymond Sp. z.o.o

   Poland

Redworks Sp z.o.o.

   Poland

SMG/KRC Poland Media S.A.

   Poland

Soho Square Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Taylor Nelson Sofres Poland Sp.z o.o

   Poland

Testardo Gram Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

The Media Insight Polska Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Wunderman Polska Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

Young & Rubicam Poland Sp. z.o.o.

   Poland

APP - Agencia Portugesa de Producao ACE

   Portugal

Bates Red Cell Portugal - Publicidade e Marketing S.A.

   Portugal

Easy Media Central de Meios de Publicidade S.A.

   Portugal

Euroteste-Marketing e Opiniao, SA

   Portugal

Futurecom (Portugal) - Marketing, Telemarketing e Sistemas de Informacao Lda

   Portugal

Grey Lisboa- Agencia de Publicidad S.A.

   Portugal

GroupM Publicidade Advertising S.A.

   Portugal

Hill & Knowlton Portugal SA

   Portugal

J Walter Thompson Publicidade S.A.

   Portugal

Maxus Portugal Lda

   Portugal

Media Insight - Tempo e Meios Publicitarios, Lda

   Portugal

Mediaedge:CIA - Servicos Publicitarios Ltda

   Portugal

MindShare - Planeamento e Compra de Tempo e Meios Publicitarios ACE

   Portugal

Mindshare II - Meios Publicitarios Lda

   Portugal

Ogilvy Interactive SA

   Portugal

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Ogilvy Public Relations, Unipessoal, Lda

   Portugal

Ogilvy & Mather Design,Unipessoal Lda

   Portugal

Ogilvy & Mather Portugal - Publicidade, Unipessoal, Lda

   Portugal

Ogilvy & Mather Portugal Directo Servicos S.A.

   Portugal

Outrider Search Marketing - Consultoria e Servicos Web Lda

   Portugal

Publimeios Publicidade e Distribucao de Meios S.A.

   Portugal

Red Partner Unipessoal, Lda

   Portugal

Synergy Connect - Communicacao De Publicidade Interactiva Unipessoal, Lda

   Portugal

WPP (Portugal) Sociedade Gestora de Participacoes Sociais Lda

   Portugal

WPP Portugal - Servicos Partihados, Unipessaoal, Lda

   Portugal

Wunderman Cato Johnson (Portugal) Lda

   Portugal

Young & Rubicam (Portugal) - Publicidade, S.A.

   Portugal

Young & Rubicam (Portugal) - Sociedade Gestora de Participacoes Sociais Unipessoal, Lda

   Portugal

Grey Puerto Rico, Inc.

   Puerto Rico

GroupM Puerto Rico Inc.

   Puerto Rico

Hill & Knowlton PR Inc.

   Puerto Rico

J Walter Thompson Promotions & Direct Inc.

   Puerto Rico

J. Walter Thompson Puerto Rico, Inc.

   Puerto Rico

Young & Rubicam of Puerto Rico Inc.

   Puerto Rico

Grey Worldwide Middle East Network Qatar W.L.L.

   Qatar

Gulf Hill & Knowlton LLC

   Qatar

Team Y&R WLL (Qatar)

   Qatar

Grey Worldwide Romania SRL

   Romania

Kantar Media Audiences S.R.L.

   Romania

Kinetic Worldwide Romania SRL

   Romania

Mather Communications SRL

   Romania

MediaCom Romania Srl

   Romania

Mediaedge:cia Romania Srl

   Romania

MindShare Media Srl

   Romania
 

 

22


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Ogilvy & Mather Advertising SRL

   Romania

OgilvyAction Romania SRL

   Romania

OgilvyOne Advertising SRL

   Romania

Portland Romania Advertising SRL

   Romania

Alite LLC

   Russian Federation

LLC ‘Ogilvy & Mather’

   Russian Federation

LLC “Mather Communications”

   Russian Federation

LLC “Maximise”

   Russian Federation

LLC “Mindshare Interaction”

   Russian Federation

LLC “Mindshare”

   Russian Federation

LLC Young & Rubicam FMS

   Russian Federation

Marketing Information Center

   Russian Federation

Mediacom LLC

   Russian Federation

TNS Gallup Adfact

   Russian Federation

TNS Gallup Media

   Russian Federation

TNS Marketing Information Center St. Petersburg

   Russian Federation

TNS Marketing Information Center Tula

   Russian Federation

Wunderman LLC

   Russian Federation

Advanced Marketing Results Al Baheth LLC

   Saudi Arabia

Arab for Advertising LLC (Grey Saudi Arabia)

   Saudi Arabia

Arab for Advertising LLC (MediaCom Saudi Arabia)

   Saudi Arabia

International Marketing Company WLL

   Saudi Arabia

RMG Connect (Altawasol International For Advertising) Ltd.

   Saudi Arabia

Team Advertising SP

   Saudi Arabia

Tihama al Mona International Advertising Ltd.

   Saudi Arabia

Research & Marketing Services International Senegal SA (to be renamed TNS RMS Senegal SA)

   Senegal

Grey d.o.o. Belgrad

   Serbia, Republic of

10AM Communications Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Bates 141 Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Bates 141 Singapore Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Batey (Pte) Ltd.

   Singapore

Batey Holdings Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Blue Interactive Marketing Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Burson-Marstelller (S.E.A.) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Carl Byoir (SEA) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Comwerks Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Cybersoft OgilvyInteractive Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Deliriumcybertouch (Asia) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Demand Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Dentsu Young & Rubicam Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Encompass Private Ltd.

   Singapore

Enfatico Pte Limited

   Singapore

Fitch Design Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Grey Group PTE Ltd.

   Singapore

GroupM Asia Pacific Holdings Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

GroupM ESP Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

GroupM Singapore Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Hill & Knowlton (SEA) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

IMRB Millward Brown International Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

J Walter Thompson (Singapore) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Kinetic Worldwide Media Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Landor Associates Designers & Consultants Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

MEC Media Singapore Pte. Ltd.

   Singapore

Ogilvy & Mather (Singapore) Private Ltd.

   Singapore

Redworks (Singapore) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Research International Asia Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Saffron Hill Research Pte Limited

   Singapore

Scotts Road Management Services LLP

   Singapore

Sercon Asia Pacific Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Siang Design International Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Soho Square Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Spafax Airline Network (Singapore) Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Taylor Nelson Sofres Singapore Pte Limited

   Singapore

The Brand Union Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

WPP Holdings (S) Pte. Ltd.

   Singapore

WPP Singapore Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Wunderman Asia Holdings Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Wunderman Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

XM Asia Pacific Pte Ltd.

   Singapore

Creo/Young & Rubicam s.r.o.

   Slovakia

Barci & Partner Bratislava s.r.o.

   Slovakia

Mediaedge:cia Slovak Republic s.r.o

   Slovakia

Mindshare Slovakia s.r.o.

   Slovakia

MediaCom Bratislava s.r.o.

   Slovakia

TNS Slovakia s.r.o

   Slovakia
 

 

23


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

TNS Infratest Slovakia s.r.o.

   Slovakia

GroupM Slovakia s.r.o.

   Slovakia

Redworks Digital Bratislava s.r.o.

   Slovakia

Grey Ljubiljana Agencija za truze kommunique d.o.o.

   Slovenia

Poster Publicity Ltd. Ljubljana

   Slovenia

Aqua Online (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Base Two Digtital (Propietary) Limited

   South Africa

Bates 141 (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

BLGK Bates (Proprietary) Limited (South Africa)

   South Africa

Brand Activation 141 (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

CiForce (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Code Red Communications (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa

Coley Porter Bell South Africa (Proprietary) Ltd.

   South Africa

Glendinning Management Consultants South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

GrappelGroup 141 (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Grey Channel (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Grey Financial Services (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Grey Group South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Grey Worldwide South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

GroupM Media South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Hamilton Russell South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Harrison Human Bates (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Interactive Edge (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

J Walter Thompson Cape Town (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

J Walter Thompson Company (CT) (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

J Walter Thompson Company (JHB) (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

J Walter Thompson Company South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

J Walter Thompson South Africa Holdings (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Kantar South Africa (Pty) Limited

   South Africa

KSDP Brandafrica (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

KSDP Group (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

KSDP Johannesburg (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

KSDP Pentagraph (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Mediacompete (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Mediaedge:cia (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Millward Brown South Africa (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa

Mindshare South Africa (Cape) (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Mindshare South Africa (Gauteng) (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

MindShare South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Mother Russia Communications (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa

Nota Bene Media Planning Agency (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Ogilvy Action (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa

Ogilvy Cape Town (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Ogilvy Healthworld South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Ogilvy Interactive Worldwide (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Ogilvy Johannesburg (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Ogilvy Neo South Africa (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Ogilvy South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

OgilvyOne Worldwide Cape Town (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

OgilvyOne Worldwide Johannesburg (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Orange Juice Design (Cape Town) (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Redworks Communications (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa

Redworks Communications Johannesburg (Pty) Ltd.

   South Africa
 

 

24


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Research International (South Africa) (Proprietary) Ltd.

   South Africa

The Added Value Group (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

The Brand Union (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

The Customer Equity Company (SA) (PTY) Limited

   South Africa

Thompson Connect (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

TNS Research Surveys (Pty) Limited

   South Africa

WPP Memeza Holding (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Young & Rubicam Hedley Byrne (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Young & Rubicam South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Zing Communications (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Zoom Advertising South Africa (Proprietary) Limited

   South Africa

Added Value Planners SL

   Spain

Adhoc Share Holdings SL

   Spain

Ad-Hoc Young & Rubicam SL

   Spain

Agora GCI Barcelona SL

   Spain

Atletico International Advertising SL

   Spain

Axicom Spain SL

   Spain

Bassat Ogilvy Comunicación SL

   Spain

Bassat, Ogilvy & Mather Barcelona SA

   Spain

Bassat, Ogilvy & Mather Madrid SA

   Spain

Beaumont Bennett Madrid SLU

   Spain

Boole Relaciones Inteligentes con Clientes SL

   Spain

BSB Publicidad Asturias SL

   Spain

BSB Publicidad SA

   Spain

BSB Publicidad Tenerife SL

   Spain

Burson-Marsteller SL

   Spain

CB’a Graell Design, SL

   Spain

Centro de investigacion y Compra de Medios SL

   Spain

Comercial de Productos y Alquileres, S.A.

   Spain

Comunicacion y Servicio Consultores de Marketing y Publicidad SL

   Spain

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Cordiant Advertising Holding SA

   Spain

Delvico 2IN SL

   Spain

Delvico Communicacion SLU

   Spain

Estudio Graphic Line SLU

   Spain

Expansion de Ventas SL

   Spain

Focus Media SL

   Spain

Full Contact la Agencia de Comunicacion Integrada SLU

   Spain

G2 Intelligence SL

   Spain

G2 Worldwide Spain S.L.U

   Spain

GMBG Holdings Spain SL

   Spain

Grey Espana SLU

   Spain

Grey Healthcare Spain SL

   Spain

Grey Iberia SL

   Spain

GroupM Publicidad Worldwide SAU

   Spain

Healthworld España SL

   Spain

Hill & Knowlton Espana SA

   Spain

Indecsa Research International SA

   Spain

JWT Delvico SLU

   Spain

Kantar Media S.A.

   Spain

Kantya Estrategias de Marca SL

   Spain

Kinetic Worldwide SA

   Spain

Madrid Redes de Campo SA

   Spain

Mass Media Station SA

   Spain

MEC Interaction Worldwide SL

   Spain

MEC Sponsorship Worldwide SL

   Spain

Mediacom Iberia SA

   Spain

Mediaedge:cia Mediterranea SA

   Spain

Mediaedge:CIA, SL

   Spain

Mediasur Agencia De Medios SA

   Spain

Millward Brown Spain SAU

   Spain

Mindshare Spain SA

   Spain

Mr John Sample S.L.

   Spain

Neo Ogilvy SA

   Spain

NFO Infratest SL

   Spain

Ogilvy Action BCN SA

   Spain

Ogilvy Action SA

   Spain

Ogilvy Healthworld Barcelona SA

   Spain

Ogilvy Healthworld Madrid S.L.U.

   Spain

Ogilvy Interactive SA

   Spain

OgilvyOne Worldwide SA

   Spain

Outrider SL Unipersona

   Spain

Power Station Factory SL

   Spain

Real Media SA

   Spain

Red de Medios SA

   Spain

Red Shots SL

   Spain

RMG Connect SL

   Spain
 

 

25


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Segarra Cuesta Puig Fernadez De Castro SL (SCPF )

   Spain

Sociograma SL

   Spain

Sra Rushmore SA

   Spain

Tapsa Agencia de Publicidad SL

   Spain

Tapsa Barcelona Agencia de Publicidad SL

   Spain

Taylor Nelson Sofres Group Spain SL

   Spain

Taylor Nelson Sofres Healthcare SA

   Spain

Taylor Nelson Sofres S.A. (in Spain)

   Spain

Technical Full Marketing SL

   Spain

Tempus Media Holding SL

   Spain

The Brand Union Iberia SL

   Spain

The Reality Shop S.L.

   Spain

TNS Area Investigacion SA

   Spain

TNS Area Operaciones S.L.

   Spain

TNS Investigacion de Mercados Y Opinion SRL

   Spain

Tramontana Dream Holdings SL

   Spain

Ulmara SLU

   Spain

Unimedia Central de Medios SL

   Spain

Valverde de Miquel & Dorland SL

   Spain

Vinizius Young & Rubicam SL

   Spain

WPP Holdings Spain SA

   Spain

Wunderman SL

   Spain

Young & Rubicam S.L.

   Spain

Batey Public Relations Marketing Pvt Ltd.

   Sri Lanka

Grey First Serve Advertising Pvt Ltd.

   Sri Lanka

J Walter Thompson Private Ltd.

   Sri Lanka

Ogilvy Action (Pvt) Ltd.

   Sri Lanka

Phoenix O&M (Private) Ltd.

   Sri Lanka

TNS Lanka Private Limited

   Sri Lanka

AB Frigga

   Sweden

Adaptus International Stockholm AB

   Sweden

Adrians Perch AB

   Sweden

Aqvilo Sweden AB

   Sweden

Axicom AB

   Sweden

Bates Red Cell Sweden AB

   Sweden

Becker Spielvogel Bates Goteborg AB

   Sweden

BG Intressenter 1997 AB

   Sweden

Brando Design AB

   Sweden

Burson-Marsteller AB

   Sweden

Cohn & Wolfe Goteberg AB

   Sweden

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Cohn & Wolfe Gruppen AB

   Sweden

Cohn & Wolfe Stockholm AB

   Sweden

Cronert & Co. AB

   Sweden

Everystone Nordic AB

   Sweden

G2 Stockholm AB

   Sweden

GCI Mannov Malmo AB

   Sweden

Grey Direkt AB

   Sweden

Grey Global Group Sweden AB

   Sweden

Grey Holdings AB

   Sweden

Grey Reklamebyrå i Malmo AB

   Sweden

Grey Worldwide Stockholm AB

   Sweden

GroupM Holding AB

   Sweden

GroupM Sweden AB

   Sweden

Hall & Cederqvist/Young & Rubicam AB

   Sweden

Halson Partners AB

   Sweden

Hill & Knowlton Sweden AB

   Sweden

Impiric AB

   Sweden

Infratest Burke International AB

   Sweden

J Walter Thompson Oresund AB

   Sweden

KGM Datadistribution AB

   Sweden

Kinetic Sweden AB

   Sweden

Maxus Communications AB

   Sweden

Media Insikt AB

   Sweden

Media Support Scandanavian AB

   Sweden

Mediacommunications Göteborg AB

   Sweden

MediaCommunications Services Sverige AB

   Sweden

Mediacommunications Sverige I Stockholm AB

   Sweden

MediaCompany Sweden AB

   Sweden

Mediaedge:cia Content AB

   Sweden

Mediaedge:cia Nordic AB

   Sweden

Mediaedge:cia Sweden AB

   Sweden

Mindshare BroadMind Sweden AB

   Sweden

Mindshare Sweden AB

   Sweden

Moller Mortensen Annonsbyra AB

   Sweden

Navigare Medical Marketing Research AB

   Sweden

Nomina Prospecting AB

   Sweden

O&A Purchaser AB

   Sweden

Observera Grey Annonsbyrå AB

   Sweden

Ogilvy Activation AB

   Sweden

Ogilvy Advertising AB

   Sweden

Ogilvy Nordic AB

   Sweden

Ogilvy Sweden AB

   Sweden

OgilvyOne Worldwide AB

   Sweden

Ogvily Group AB

   Sweden
 

 

26


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Ogvily PR AB

   Sweden

Old Bates AB

   Sweden

Outrider Sweden AB

   Sweden

Promedia Sverige AB

   Sweden

PS International AB

   Sweden

Real Media Scandinavia AB

   Sweden

Research International Sweden AB

   Sweden

SCP AB

   Sweden

Sifo International AB

   Sweden

Sifo Management Group AB

   Sweden

Sifo Sweden AB

   Sweden

Spielvogel Bates Helsingborg AB

   Sweden

Strenstrom Red Cell AB

   Sweden

Svenska Gallup AB

   Sweden

Taylor Nelson Sofres Sverige AB

   Sweden

The Brand Union AB

   Sweden

Tidningsstatistik AB

   Sweden

TNS Automotive AB

   Sweden

TNS Gallup AB

   Sweden

TNS Prospera AB

   Sweden

WPP Sweden AB

   Sweden

Wunderman Sweden AB

   Sweden

Young & Rubicam Sweden AB

   Sweden

24/7 Real Media Europe Holding SA

   Switzerland

24/7 Real Media Technology SA

   Switzerland

Advico Young & Rubicam AG

   Switzerland

All Access AG

   Switzerland

Burson-Marsteller AG

   Switzerland

Dr Schlegel Pharmamarketing AG

   Switzerland

FutureCom Interactive AG

   Switzerland

Grey Worldwide AG

   Switzerland

GroupM Switzerland AG

   Switzerland

Guye Benker Werbeagentur AG

   Switzerland

J Walter Thompson AG

   Switzerland

Kinetic Worldwide Switzerland AG

   Switzerland

Landor Associates Branding Consultants and Designers Worldwide (Switzerland) Sarl

   Switzerland

MC Media Company AG

   Switzerland

Mediaedge:CIA Switzerland AG

   Switzerland

MindShare AG

   Switzerland

Ogilvy PR AG

   Switzerland

Ogilvy & Mather AG

   Switzerland

OgilvyOne AG

   Switzerland

Red Cell AG

   Switzerland

TNS International SARL

   Switzerland

Wunderman AG

   Switzerland

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

Young & Rubicam Business Communications SA

   Switzerland

Young & Rubicam Holding AG

   Switzerland

Agenda Taiwan Ltd.

   Taiwan

Bates Taiwan Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

David Advertising (Taiwan) Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Dentsu Young & Rubicam Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

G2 Taiwan Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Mediaedge:cia Taiwan Ltd.

   Taiwan

Millward Brown Ltd., Taiwan Branch

   Taiwan

Ogilvy Identity Enterprise IG (Taiwan) Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Ogilvy & Mather (Taiwan) Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Ogilvy & Mather Direct (Taiwan) Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Ogilvy & Mather Identity Management Ltd.

   Taiwan

Taylor Nelson Sofres Taiwan Ltd.

   Taiwan

Team-Mate Marketing Consultants Co. Ltd.

   Taiwan

Team-Mate Marketing Development & Services Ltd.

   Taiwan

141 (Thailand) Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

141 Worldwide Ltd.

   Thailand

Bates (Thailand) Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Conquest Communicatons Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Contract Advertising (Thailand) Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Dentsu Young & Rubicam Ltd.

   Thailand

Enterprise IG Limited

   Thailand

Grey (Thailand) Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Grey Direct Interactive Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Grey Siam Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Kinetic Worldwide (Thailand) Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

MDK Consultants (Thailand) Ltd.

   Thailand

MediaCom Co. Ltd.

   Thailand

Millward Brown Firefly Ltd.

   Thailand

Minteraction Company Ltd.

   Thailand

Monday People Co., Ltd.

   Thailand

Ogilvy Brands by Design Ltd.

   Thailand

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide Limited

   Thailand

OgilvyAction Ltd.

   Thailand
 

 

27


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER
WHICH
ORGANISED

OgilvyOne Worldwide Limited

   Thailand

Power Response Advertising Limited

   Thailand

Research International Asia (Thailand) Ltd.

   Thailand

Taylor Nelson Sofres (Thailand) Limited

   Thailand

WhizzbangArt Ltd.

   Thailand

WPP (Thailand) Ltd.

   Thailand

WPP Marketing Communications (Thailand) Ltd.

   Thailand

J Walter Thompson (Tunisia) Limited

   Tunisia

Capitol Halkla Iliskiler ve Iletisim Hizmetleri A.S.

   Turkey

Gram Reklamcilik Ltd. Sti

   Turkey

Grey Worldwide Istanbul Reklamcilik Ltd. Sti

   Turkey

GroupM Medya Hizmetleri Ltd. Sti

   Turkey

Kinetic Reklam Hizmetleri Limited

   Turkey

Maxus Medya Hizmetleri Ticaret A.S.

   Turkey

MEC Ýletiþim Planlama Hizmetleri Limited Þirketi

   Turkey

MediaCom Istanbul Medya Hizmetleri A.S.

   Turkey

Millward Brown Pazar Arastirmalari Ticaret Limited Sti

   Turkey

Mindshare Medya Hizmetleri A.S.

   Turkey

Ogilvy and Mather Reklamcilik A.S.

   Turkey

Ogilvy Healthworld Reklamcilik Hizmetleri A.S.

   Turkey

Ogilvy One Dogrudan Pazarlama A.S.

   Turkey

Soho Square Reklamcilik Limited Sirketi

   Turkey

Studyo Reklamcilik Sanayi LTD. Sti

   Turkey

Team Red Reklamcýlýk ve Yayýncýlýk Limited Þirketi

   Turkey

TNS Piyasa Araþtýrma Danýþmanlýk ve Ticaret Anonim Þirketi

   Turkey

Young & Rubicam Reklamevi Reklamcilik LTD. Sti

   Turkey

Enterprise Grey LLC

   Ukraine

Mather Communications LLC

   Ukraine

Mediacom LLC

   Ukraine

Mediaedge:cia LLC

   Ukraine

Mindshare LLC

   Ukraine

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH

ORGANISED

Ogilvy Group Ltd.

   Ukraine

Taylor Nelson Sofres Ukraine Limited

   Ukraine

Young & Rubicam LLC

   Ukraine

ADVERTISING & MARKETING RESULTES - AL BAHETH (A.M.R.B) L.L.C.

   United Arab Emirates

Asdaa Advertising FZ LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Asdaa Advertsing LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Classic Partnership Advertising FZ LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Grey Worldwide Co. LLC

   United Arab Emirates

gsFITCH FZ-LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Intermarkets Advertising FZ- LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Intermarkets Advertising LLC

   United Arab Emirates

J Walter Thompson LLC

   United Arab Emirates

MEC (Mediaedge CIA) FZ LLC

   United Arab Emirates

RMG Connect Consultancy FZE

   United Arab Emirates

Tatoo FZ LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Team Gulf Advertising LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Team Y&R Advertising LLC (Abu Dhabi)

   United Arab Emirates

Wunderman WCJ FZ LLC

   United Arab Emirates

Wunderman WCJ FZ LLC

   United Arab Emirates

141 Blue Skies Limited

   United Kingdom

24/7 Real Media UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Added Value Group Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Added Value Limited

   United Kingdom

Addison Corporate Marketing Limited

   United Kingdom

Addison Investments Limited

   United Kingdom

Airport Media International Ltd.

   United Kingdom

All Global Limited

   United Kingdom

Allan Burrows Limited

   United Kingdom

Alton Wire Products Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ambassador Square

   United Kingdom

Applied Research & Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Art Company (Creative Services) Limited (The)

   United Kingdom
 

 

28


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Artwork Direct Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Asset Marketing Limited

   United Kingdom

Atlas Advertising Limited

   United Kingdom

Automotive Marketing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Aviator Media Limited

   United Kingdom

Axicom Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Axicom Limited

   United Kingdom

B1 Media Limited

   United Kingdom

B1.com Limited

   United Kingdom

Bamber Forsyth Limited

   United Kingdom

Banner Corporation PLC

   United Kingdom

Banner Public Relations Limited

   United Kingdom

Bates Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Bates Europe Limited

   United Kingdom

Bates Healthcom Limited

   United Kingdom

Bates Integrated Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Bates Overseas Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

BDG Facilities Ltd.

   United Kingdom

BDG MCCOLL LIMITED

   United Kingdom

BDGWORKFUTURES LIMITED

   United Kingdom

Beaumont Square

   United Kingdom

Beaumont-Bennett Limited

   United Kingdom

Belgrave Square

   United Kingdom

Beyond Interactive Limited

   United Kingdom

Bisqit Design Limited

   United Kingdom

BJK & E Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

BJM Research and Consultancy Limited

   United Kingdom

Black Cat Direct Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Black Cat RMG Connect Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Blanc And Otus (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Blue Skies Agency Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Blue State Digital UK Limited

   United Kingdom

BMRB Customer Satisfaction Ltd.

   United Kingdom

BMRB Customer Satisfaction Measurements Ltd.

   United Kingdom

BMRB UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Bone Studio Limited

   United Kingdom

Brand Futures Consultancy Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Brand Union Holdings Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

Brand Union Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Brand Union Worldwide Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

Brandamp Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Brandmade Media Group Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Brilliant Books Ltd.

   United Kingdom

British Market Research Bureau Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Buchanan Communications Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Bulletin International Limited

   United Kingdom

Bulletin International UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Burson-Marsteller (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Burson-Marsteller Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Business Design Group McColl Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Business Planning and Research Limited

   United Kingdom

Campaign Planning Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Carl Byoir (UK) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

CCG.XM (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

CCG.XM Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Cheetham Bell JWT Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Chelsea Market Research Limited

   United Kingdom

CIA Medianetwork Ireland Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

CIA Nominees Limited

   United Kingdom

City Research Associates Limited

   United Kingdom

City Research Group Limited

   United Kingdom

City & Corporate Counsel Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Clarion Communications (P.R.) Limited

   United Kingdom

CLEVER MEDIA PRODUCTIONS LTD.

   United Kingdom

CME Scholar Limited

   United Kingdom

Cockpit Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Cockpit Two Limited

   United Kingdom

Cohn & Wolfe Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Coley Porter Bell Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Colwood Healthworld Limited

   United Kingdom

Common Technology Centre EEIG

   United Kingdom

Communique Public Relations Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Connect Five Limited

   United Kingdom

Connect One Limited

   United Kingdom

Connect Six Limited

   United Kingdom

Conquest Creative Services Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Conquest Europe (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Conquest Media Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Cordiant (US) Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Cordiant Communications Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Cordiant Communications Group Trustees Limited

   United Kingdom
 

 

29


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Cordiant Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Cordiant Overseas Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Cordiant Pension Trustee Company Limited

   United Kingdom

Cordiant Property Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Corporate Vision Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Creative Services Unit Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Creative Strategy Limited

   United Kingdom

Credit Call Research

   United Kingdom

Darwin - Grey Limited

   United Kingdom

Decision Shop Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Deckchair Studio Limited

   United Kingdom

Dialogue Marketing Partnership Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Digital Artwork & Reprographic Technology Limited

   United Kingdom

Digitlondon Limited

   United Kingdom

Direct MediaCom Limited

   United Kingdom

DirectCom Limited

   United Kingdom

Dovetail Contract Furniture Limited

   United Kingdom

Dr. Puttner And Bates Limited

   United Kingdom

Dynamiclogic (Europe) Limited

   United Kingdom

Eaton Square Limited

   United Kingdom

Ecumedia Limited

   United Kingdom

Effective Sales Personnel Limited

   United Kingdom

Enduring Organisation

   United Kingdom

Enduring Organisation Three

   United Kingdom

Enduring Organisation Two

   United Kingdom

Enfatico Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Enterprise IG UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Euroclearing Limited

   United Kingdom

Eurocrew Limited

   United Kingdom

European Market Research Bureau Limited

   United Kingdom

Everystone Limited

   United Kingdom

EWA Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Farm Post Production Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

FAST4WD OGILVY LIMITED

   United Kingdom

Fieldcontrol Limited

   United Kingdom

Finchdean Limited

   United Kingdom

Finsbury Limited

   United Kingdom

Finsbury.com Ltd.

   United Kingdom

FIPRA EU Limited

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Fipra UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

First Music Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Fitch Design Consultants Limited

   United Kingdom

Fitch International Limited

   United Kingdom

Fitch Limited

   United Kingdom

Fitch Live Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Fitch Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

Fitch: Qatar Limited

   United Kingdom

Flamingo Perspectives Limited

   United Kingdom

Flexible Organisation

   United Kingdom

Forward Data Management Limited

   United Kingdom

Forward Limited

   United Kingdom

Forward Publishing Agency Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Forward Publishing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Foster Turner & Benson Ltd.

   United Kingdom

G2 Agency Limited

   United Kingdom

G2 Branding and Design Limited

   United Kingdom

G2 Data Dynamics Limited

   United Kingdom

G2 Interactive Limited

   United Kingdom

G2 London Limited

   United Kingdom

Garrott Dorland Crawford Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI Financial (Holdings) Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI Financial Group Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI Group Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI Healthcare Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI Jane Howard Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI London Limited

   United Kingdom

GCI UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Genesis Studios Ltd.

   United Kingdom

GfK Taylor Nelson Sofres Limited

   United Kingdom

GfK-TNS Limited

   United Kingdom

GHG Access Limited

   United Kingdom

GI Consulting Limited

   United Kingdom

Global Sportnet UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Goldfarb Consultants UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Goldfarb Focus Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Grey Advertising Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Communications Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Direct Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Entertainment and Media Limited

   United Kingdom
 

 

30


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Grey Europe Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey GB Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Global Group (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Group Services Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Healthcare London Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Interactive Europe Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey London Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Midlands Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Network Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey North Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey NT Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey PTK Advertising Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Technology Services Limited

   United Kingdom

Grey Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

Greycom Limited

   United Kingdom

Group Activation Ltd.

   United Kingdom

GroupM Entertainment Ltd.

   United Kingdom

GROUPM UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Hamsard 2750 Limited

   United Kingdom

Harrison Patten Troughton Limited

   United Kingdom

Headcount Worldwide Field Marketing Limited

   United Kingdom

Headlight Vision Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Healthworld Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Heath Wallace Limited

   United Kingdom

Henley Centre Headlight Vision Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Hereford Telecommunications

   United Kingdom

Hi Resolution (Production) Limited

   United Kingdom

Hill & Knowlton CIS Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Hill & Knowlton Limited

   United Kingdom

Hilton Advertising Limited

   United Kingdom

Hive Management Services Limited

   United Kingdom

Horizon Video Ltd.

   United Kingdom

HP:ICM Limited

   United Kingdom

Icomms Media Group Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Icon Holdings (UK) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ignite JV Limited

   United Kingdom

Infratest Burke Asia Pacific Limited

   United Kingdom

Infratest Burke Core Company Limited

   United Kingdom

Infratest Burke Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Infratest Burke International Services Limited

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Infratest Burke Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Intact Limited

   United Kingdom

Intelliquest, Ltd.

   United Kingdom

International Market Research Bureau Limited

   United Kingdom

International Presentations Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Interstar Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

i-syt Limited

   United Kingdom

J Walter Thompson Company (Manchester) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

J. Walter Thompson Company Ltd.

   United Kingdom

J. Walter Thompson Group Limited

   United Kingdom

J. Walter Thompson U.K. Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Jack Morton Company Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Jermyn Street Communications Centre Limited

   United Kingdom

JWT Specialized Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Kantar Group Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Kantar Media Intelligence Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Kantar Media Research Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Kantar Media UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Kantar Retail UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Key Lead Limited

   United Kingdom

Kinetic Worldwide Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Kinetic Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

Kingsway Media Services Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Lambie-Nairn & Company Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Landor Associates Europe Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Lighthouse Holdings (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Lightspeed Research Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Line Exchange Limited

   United Kingdom

M 101 Limited

   United Kingdom

Management Ventures Europe Limited

   United Kingdom

Mando Corporation Limited

   United Kingdom

Mando Services Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Market Behaviour Limited

   United Kingdom

Market Research Bureau Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Market Research Bureau Limited

   United Kingdom

Marketing Blueprint Limited

   United Kingdom

Marketing Consultancy Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom
 

 

31


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Marplan Limited

   United Kingdom

Marsteller Advertising Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Mass-Observation (UK) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Mass-Observation Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Mather Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Matthew Poppy Advertising Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Maxus Communications (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Maxus Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Media Business Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Media Insight Outdoor Limited

   United Kingdom

Media Research Consultancy Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

MediaCom Group Limited

   United Kingdom

MediaCom Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Mediacom North Ltd.

   United Kingdom

MediaCom Scotland Limited

   United Kingdom

MediaCom UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Mediaedge:CIA (UK) Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Mediaedge:cia International Investments Limited

   United Kingdom

Mediaedge:cia International Limited

   United Kingdom

Mediaedge:cia UK Investments Limited

   United Kingdom

Mediaedge:CIA UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Mediaedge:CIA Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

Mediahead Communications Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Mellors Reay & Partners Limited

   United Kingdom

Metro Broadcast Limited

   United Kingdom

Metro Ecosse Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Milburn Finance Limited

   United Kingdom

Millward Brown Market Research Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Millward Brown Precis Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Millward Brown UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Millward Brown Ulster Limited

   United Kingdom

Milton Marketing Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Milton Marketing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Milton Public Relations Limited

   United Kingdom

Mind Over Media Limited

   United Kingdom

Mindshare Media UK Limited

   United Kingdom

Mindshare Media Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

MJM Creative Services UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Module Communications Group Limited

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Mone Limited

   United Kingdom

Moonraid Limited

   United Kingdom

Mortimer Square Limited

   United Kingdom

MRB Group Limited

   United Kingdom

MRB International Limited

   United Kingdom

MRB Research Group Ltd.

   United Kingdom

MRB Research Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Netcoms Europe Limited

   United Kingdom

Network (The Ogilvy Media Company) Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Newcrosse Limited

   United Kingdom

NFO European Access Panels Limited

   United Kingdom

NFO Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

North Kent Plastic Cages Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Nylon Marketing Communications Ltd.

   United Kingdom

O&M Consulting Ltd.

   United Kingdom

O&M Europe Limited

   United Kingdom

Oakley, Young Associates Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy 4D Limited

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Adams & Rinehart Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Advertising Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy And Mather Advertising Limited

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Health PR Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Healthworld Advertising Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Healthworld Europe Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Healthworld UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Primary Contact Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy Public Relations Worldwide Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Dataconsult Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Direct Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Europe Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Group (Holdings) Limited

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather International Media Limited

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Management Services

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Partners Limited

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Public Relations Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvy & Mather Teleservices Ltd.

   United Kingdom
 

 

32


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Ogilvyinteractive Limited

   United Kingdom

OgilvyOne Connections Group Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

OgilvyOne Dataservices Ltd.

   United Kingdom

OgilvyOne Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ogilvyone Management Services

   United Kingdom

OgilvyOne Teleservices Ltd.

   United Kingdom

OGILVYONE WORLDWIDE LTD.

   United Kingdom

Ohal Limited

   United Kingdom

Onezeroone Media Limited

   United Kingdom

Opinion Research Limited

   United Kingdom

Optitech Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Outdoor Connection Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Outdoor Focus Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Outdoor MediaCom Limited

   United Kingdom

Outrider Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Outside The Box Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Oxford Academy for Professional Health Education Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

P S D Associates Limited

   United Kingdom

P.O.A. Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Parker Bishop Limited

   United Kingdom

Partners (Design Consultants) Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

PCI:Live Ltd.

   United Kingdom

PDM Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Peacock Services Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Permanent Organisation

   United Kingdom

Permanent Organisation Two

   United Kingdom

Piler Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Piranhakid Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Portland Outdoor Advertising Limited

   United Kingdom

Possible Worldwide Limited

   United Kingdom

Poster Business Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

Poster Publicity Group Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Poster Publicity Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Poster Publicity Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Poster Sites Management Limited

   United Kingdom

Precis (567) Limited

   United Kingdom

Precis Limited

   United Kingdom

Premiere Consultants Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Premiere Elite Limited

   United Kingdom

Premiere Group Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Premiere Licensing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Premiere Management Ltd.

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Premiere Recruitment Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Premiere Sponsorship Marketing Limited

   United Kingdom

Premiere Television Limited

   United Kingdom

Presswatch Media Limited

   United Kingdom

Primeads International Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Prognostics Limited

   United Kingdom

Promotional Campaigns Limited

   United Kingdom

Promotional Studios Limited

   United Kingdom

Prophaven Limited

   United Kingdom

Propose Two Limited

   United Kingdom

Public Attitude Surveys Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Public Attitude Surveys Limited

   United Kingdom

Public Relations and International Sports Marketing Limited

   United Kingdom

Public Strategies Global Limited - strike off requested

   United Kingdom

QCI Assessment Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Qualitative Workshop Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

Quisma Limited

   United Kingdom

R.I. Specialist Units Limited

   United Kingdom

Rainey Kelly Campbell Roalfe Limited

   United Kingdom

Rainey Kelly Campbell Roalfe/Young & Rubicam Limited

   United Kingdom

ReadySquare Limited

   United Kingdom

Readysquare Two Limited

   United Kingdom

RealSubstance Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Red Cell Scotland Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Red Dot Square Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Red Dot Square Solutions Limited

   United Kingdom

Relish Marketing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Research Bureau Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Research International Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Research International Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Research Resources Ltd.

   United Kingdom

RMG:Black Cat Ltd.

   United Kingdom

RMG:Connect Ltd.

   United Kingdom

RMS Instore Limited

   United Kingdom

ROCQM Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Rodney Fitch International Design Consultants Limited

   United Kingdom

Rono Online Limited

   United Kingdom

RWG Limited

   United Kingdom

S.H. Benson (India) Limited

   United Kingdom

S.H. Benson International Limited

   United Kingdom
 

 

33


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Sadek Wynberg Millward Brown Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Sampson Tyrrell Corporate Marketing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Schemetype Limited

   United Kingdom

Scott Stern Associates Limited

   United Kingdom

Scott Stern Limited

   United Kingdom

Secure Two Limited

   United Kingdom

SGA Research International Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Sharpen Troughton Owens Response Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Showcase Placements (UK) Limited

   United Kingdom

Signposter.com Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Sirius Holdings

   United Kingdom

SJS Management Services Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Softmedia Limited

   United Kingdom

Soho Square (Advertising) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Sonic Sun Limited

   United Kingdom

Spafax Airline Network Ltd.

   United Kingdom

SparkLab Limited

   United Kingdom

SponsorCom Limited

   United Kingdom

Sponsorship Business Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

Squash DVD Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Stickleback Limited

   United Kingdom

Strategic Marketing Consultancy Limited

   United Kingdom

Stream Digital Artwork Systems Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Sudler & Hennessey Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Taylor Nelson Sofres International Limited

   United Kingdom

Taylor Nelson Sofres Services Limited

   United Kingdom

Taylor Nelson Sofres Trustees Limited

   United Kingdom

TBU Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ted Bates Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Telebingo Limited

   United Kingdom

Telephone Market Research Bureau Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Tempest Online Marketing Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Tempus Employees

   United Kingdom

Tempus Group Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Tempus Group Limited

   United Kingdom

Tempus Group Trust Company (1990) Limited (The)

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

Tempus Media Technologies Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Tempus Partners Limited

   United Kingdom

The Customer Equity Company Limited

   United Kingdom

The Store Consulting Limited

   United Kingdom

Thistleclub Limited

   United Kingdom

TMC International Ltd.

   United Kingdom

TNS AGB Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Asia Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Field Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Global Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Group Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Healthcare Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Insight Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Magasin Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Overseas Holdings (Alpha) Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Overseas Holdings (Beta) Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Overseas Holdings (Delta) Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Overseas Holdings (Epsilon) Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Overseas Holdings (Gamma) Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Overseas Media Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Research Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS RMS UK Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Sport Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS UK Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS UK Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS Worldpanel Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS-NFO UK Limited

   United Kingdom

TNS-NFO US

   United Kingdom

Transact Communications Limited

   United Kingdom

Transart Educational Marketing Systems Limited

   United Kingdom

Transart Pharmaceutical Limited

   United Kingdom

Tranzformer Limited

   United Kingdom

Tripcare Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Tutssels Enterprise IG Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Tyrell Corporation Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Ultimate Events Limited

   United Kingdom

Ultimate Square

   United Kingdom

Uncle Post Production Limited

   United Kingdom
 

 

34


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

United London Communications Ltd.

   United Kingdom

VAP Group Limited

   United Kingdom

VAP International Communications Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Visual Art Productions (Oxford) Limited

   United Kingdom

VML London Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Voluntarily United Creative Agencies Limited

   United Kingdom

Warwicks UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Watershed Studio Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Westbourne Terrace Management Services Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WG Consulting Healthcare Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Wildfire Word of Mouth Limited

   United Kingdom

Wire & Plastic Products Limited

   United Kingdom

Wise Conclusion

   United Kingdom

WOW Factory Ltd. (The)

   United Kingdom

WPP 1177

   United Kingdom

WPP 1178

   United Kingdom

WPP 2005 Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP 2008 Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP 2318 Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP 2323 Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP 2709 Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP 2828 Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP AMC Holdings

   United Kingdom

WPP ATTICUS

   United Kingdom

WPP Beans Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Brandz

   United Kingdom

WPP Cap Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Communications Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP COMPETE

   United Kingdom

WPP Consulting Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP CP Finance plc

   United Kingdom

WPP Das Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Direct Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Eight)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Eleven)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Fifteen)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Five)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Four)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Fourteen)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Nineteen)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (One)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Seven)

   United Kingdom

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Seventeen)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Six)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Sixteen)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Ten)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Thirteen)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Three)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twelve)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Twenty)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dotcom Holdings (Two)

   United Kingdom

WPP Dutch Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Enterprise Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Finance (UK)

   United Kingdom

WPP Finance 2010

   United Kingdom

WPP Finance Co. Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Finance One plc

   United Kingdom

WPP Flame

   United Kingdom

WPP Global

   United Kingdom

WPP Group (Nominees) Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Group (UK) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Group Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Group Nominees Five Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Group Nominees Four Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Group Nominees One Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Group Nominees Three Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Group Nominees Two Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP GUSA UK

   United Kingdom

WPP Headline

   United Kingdom

WPP India Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Insight Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Investments Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP James Holdings Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Jargon Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Knowledge

   United Kingdom

WPP LN Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Madrid Square Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Magic Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Marketing Communications Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Marketing Communications Spain

   United Kingdom

WPP Montreal Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Netherlands

   United Kingdom

WPP No. 2337 Limited

   United Kingdom
 

 

35


COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION
UNDER

WHICH
ORGANISED

WPP No. 2356 Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP North Atlantic Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Ottawa Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Pearls Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Pension Trustees Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Phoenix 2004

   United Kingdom

WPP Phoenix Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Phoenix Two Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP PREDICTIONS

   United Kingdom

WPP Rasor UK

   United Kingdom

WPP Rocky Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Sparkle Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Sparky Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Spike Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Toronto Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP Unicorn Limited

   United Kingdom

WPP Vancouver Ltd.

   United Kingdom

WPP.Com Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Wunderman Cato Johnson Nominees Limited

   United Kingdom

Wunderman Limited

   United Kingdom

XM

   United Kingdom

Y & R Brazilian Holdings Limited

   United Kingdom

Yes Solutions UK Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Young & Rubicam Brands US Holdings

   United Kingdom

Young & Rubicam Development (Holdings) Limited

   United Kingdom

Young & Rubicam Europe Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Young & Rubicam Group Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Young & Rubicam Holdings (UK) Ltd.

   United Kingdom

Young & Rubicam Pension Trustees Limited

   United Kingdom

Despatch S.A.

   Uruguay

J. Walter Thompson Uruguaya S.A.

   Uruguay

Renier S.A.

   Uruguay

COMPANY NAME

  

JURISDICTION

UNDER

WHICH

ORGANISED

Young & Rubicam S.A.

   Uruguay

141 Coimbra Publicidad, C.A.

   Venezuela

Burson Marsteller de Venezuela CA

   Venezuela

Grey Advertising de Venezuela, C.A.

   Venezuela

J Walter Thompson de Venezuela C.A.

   Venezuela

LatinPanel Venezuela C.A.

   Venezuela

MindShare, C.A.

   Venezuela

Ogilvy & Mather Andina C.A.

   Venezuela

Servicios Portland de Venezuela C.A.

   Venezuela

Bates 141 Vietnam Ltd.

   Vietnam

Dentsu Young & Rubicam Vietnam Limited

   Vietnam

Grey Global Group Vietnam Co. Ltd.

   Vietnam

Millward Brown Vietnam Company Limited

   Vietnam

NFO Vietnam Ltd.

   Vietnam

Ogilvy & Mather Vietnam Ltd.

   Vietnam

T&A Ogilvy Joint Venture Company Limited

   Vietnam

T&A Ogilvy Joint Venture Company Ltd.

   Vietnam

Taylor Nelson Sofres Vietnam Pte Limited

   Vietnam

WPP Marketing Communications Vietnam Company Limited

   Vietnam

WPP Media Ltd.

   Vietnam

Infinitude Holdings Ltd.

   Virgin Islands, British

Impact Market Management Ltd.

   Virgin Islands, British
 

 

36

Exhibit 12.1

Certification

I, Sir Martin Sorrell, certify that:

 

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of WPP plc;

 

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4. The company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

 

  a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

  b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

  c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

  d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5. The company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

  a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

  b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: 29 April 2011

 

/s/    Sir Martin Sorrell

Sir Martin Sorrell

Group Chief Executive

(principal executive officer)

Exhibit 12.2

Certification

I, Paul Richardson, certify that:

 

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of WPP plc;

 

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4. The company’s other certifying officer and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

 

  a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

  b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

  c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

  d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5. The company’s other certifying officer and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

  a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

  b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

Date: 29 April 2011

 

/s/    Paul W.G. Richardson

Paul W.G. Richardson

Group Finance Director

(principal financial officer)

 

EXHIBIT 13.1

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,

AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906

OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

In connection with the Annual Report of WPP plc (the “Company”) on Form 20-F for the period ending 31 December 2010 (the “Report”), I, Sir Martin Sorrell, Group Chief Executive Officer of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:

 

1) The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

2) The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the Company’s financial position and results of operations.

Date: 29 April 2011

 

/s/    Sir Martin Sorrell

Sir Martin Sorrell

Group Chief Executive

EXHIBIT 13.2

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO 18 U.S.C. SECTION 1350,

AS ADOPTED PURSUANT TO SECTION 906

OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY ACT OF 2002

In connection with the Annual Report of WPP plc (the “Company”) on Form 20-F for the period ending 31 December 2010 (the “Report”), I, Paul Richardson, Group Finance Director of the Company, certify, pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, that:

 

1) The Report fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

2) The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the Company’s financial position and results of operations.

Date: 29 April 2011

 

/s/    Paul W.G. Richardson

Paul W.G. Richardson

Group Finance Director

EXHIBIT 14.1

 

CONSENT OF INDEPENDENT REGISTERED PUBLIC ACCOUNTING FIRM

 

We consent to the incorporation by reference in these Registration Statements No. 333-06378, No. 333-40516, No. 333-103888, No. 333-108149, No. 333-119949, No. 333-129640, No. 333-129733, No. 333-145041, No. 333-152662 and No. 333-157729, each on Form S-8, and Registration Statement No. 333-158262 and 333-159691 each on Form F-3 of our reports relating to the consolidated financial statements of WPP plc and subsidiaries (the “Company”) the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting dated 29 April 2011, appearing in the Annual Report on Form 20-F of WPP plc for the year ended 31 December 2010.

 

 

/s/ Deloitte LLP

DELOITTE LLP

London, United Kingdom

29 April 2011